Reference Guide
Reference Guide
TM
Reference Guide
Copyright
Copyright 2005 Aruba Wireless Networks, Inc. All rights reserved. Specifications in this manual are subject to change without notice. Originated in the USA.
Trademarks
ArubaOS, Aruba 800, Aruba 2400, Aruba 5000/6000, Aruba 60/61, Aruba 2E, and Aruba 70 are trademarks of Aruba Wireless Networks, Inc. in the United States and certain other countries. Any other trademarks appearing in this manual are owned by their respective companies.
Legal Notice
The use of Aruba Wireless Networks Inc switching platforms and software, by all individuals or corporations, to terminate Cisco or Nortel VPN client devices constitutes complete acceptance of liability by that individual or corporation for this action and indemnifies, in full, Aruba Wireless Networks Inc. from any and all legal actions that might be taken against it with respect to infringement of copyright on behalf of Cisco Systems or Nortel Networks.
ii
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
xxv An Overview of this Manual . . . xxv Related Documents . . . . . . . . xxvi Text Conventions . . . . . . . . . . xxvi Contacting Aruba Wireless Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . xxviii
Preface
Part 1
Chapter 1
Overview
................. 1
Management Options . . . Command-Line Interface . . . . Web Interface . . . . . . . . . . . General Screen Elements . Page Elements. . . . . . . . . Command Line Basics . Connecting to the Switch . Local Serial Console . . . Local or Remote Telnet . Logging In . . . . . . . . . . . Access Modes . . . . . . . . . Command Context . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. 3 . 3 . 3 . 4 . 5 . 7 . 7 . 7 . 8 . 9 . 9
10 11 11 12 12 12 13 14 14
Chapter 2
Saving Configuration Changes Viewing the Configuration . . . Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Command Completion . . . . Command Help . . . . . . . . . Command History . . . . . . . Command Line Editing . . . . Command Syntax . . . . . . .
iii
Part 2
Chapter 3
. . . . . . . . . 17
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
20 20 21 21 21 22 23 23 23 24 25 25 26 26 35 48 49 50 53 53 53 54 56 56 57 64 65 65 66 66
Chapter 4
Security Options . . . . . Default Open Ports . . . . . AirOS Security Options . . User Roles . . . . . . . . . . . Role Design . . . . . . . . Role Configuration . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Introduction to Firewall and Traffic Policies . . . . . . . . Configuring Traffic Policies . Access Control Lists . . . . . . Standard ACLs . . . . . . . . . . Extended ACLs . . . . . . . . . . MAC ACLs . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ethertype ACLs . . . . . . . . . . Authentication and Accounting
iv
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Servers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 RADIUS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 LDAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Internal Authentication Database . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Accounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Authentication Methods . . . . . . 77 802.1x Authentication. . . . . . 78 VPN Authentication . . . . . . . 82 Captive Portal Authentication 83 MAC Address Role Mapping . 85 Stateful 802.1x . . . . . . . . . . 86 SSID Role Mapping . . . . . . . . 88 Encryption Type Role Mapping 89 Advanced Authentication . . . 90 Configuring VPN Settings . . . . . 91 IPSec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 PPTP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 VPN Dialer Configuration . . . . 95 VPN Server Emulation . . . . . . 98 Advanced Authentication . . . 99 SecureID Token Caching . . . 100 Firewall Settings . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Advanced Security Options . . . 103 Service Aliases . . . . . . . . . . 103 Source/Destination Aliases . 104 Bandwidth Contracts . . . . . 106 NAT Pools . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Time Range . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Additional Information . . . . . . . 108 Encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Authentication . . . . . . . . . . 110 Supported VPN Clients . . . . 112 Configuring L2TP and IPSec 112
Part 3
Chapter 5
Switch Configuration . . .
115
Basic Network Configuration . . VLANs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port Trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . Spanning Tree. . . . . . . . . . . Making Configuration Backups . Creating an On-System Backup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Saving to a New Location . . Restoring the Configuration File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Annotating Configuration Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Upgrading the AirOS Software . Reset Configuration to Defaults Chapter 6
117 117 119 119 120 121 122 122 122 123 127 129 129 130 130
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
Wireless Client Station Classifications . . . . . . Enforcement Policies . . . . . . AP Policies . . . . . . . . . . . Wireless Client Station Policies . . . . . . . . . . . Global Policies . . . . . . . . Statistics Events . . . . . . . . . General WMS Attributes . . . AiroPeek Support for Packet Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . Starting Packet Capture . . The AiroPeek Application . Stopping Packet Capture . Remediation with Sygate . . . Chapter 7
vi
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
PEAP or TLS for Windows 2000 146 Prepare the Operating System 146 Configure the Service . . . . . 146 Validate the User Credentials 152 PEAP or TLS for Windows XP . 154 Cisco-PEAP for Windows XP . . 156 Prepare the Operating System 156 Enable Wireless Zero Configuration . . . . . . . . . 156 Configure the Cisco ACU . . 157 Configure the Wireless Network Connection . . . . 160 Validate the User Credentials 165 Chapter 8
vii
(Virtual Switch) Operation Rules of Operating a Virtual Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hot Swapping Support . . . . Resetting the Other SC . . . . DHCP Server Configuration . DHCP Pool Configuration . . . DHCP Excluded Address Configuration . . . . . . . . . Chapter 9
viii
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Odyssey Client . . . . . . . . 228 Certificate Configuration . . . 229 Odyssey Client Configuration 229 Trusted Servers Configuration 229 Profile Configuration . . . . . . 230 Networks Configuration . . . 230 Connection Configuration . . 230 Push to Device . . . . . . . . . . 231 Captive Portal Certificates with Intermediate CAs . . 231 Captive Portal and Wired 802.1x 231 Chapter 10
802.1x Solution Cookbook Physical Topology . . . . . . . . Wireless Network Operation . Wireless Laptops . . . . . . . Printers . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
233 234 234 234 238 238 238 240 241 243 243 244 245 245 245 246
Aruba 5000 Switch Configuration . . . . . . . . . Firewall Policies . . . . . . . . . User Role Configuration . . . Authentication Parameters . VLAN and IP Address Configuration . . . . . . . . . Wireless Configuration . . . . AP Configuration . . . . . . . . Microsoft Active Directory Server Configuration . . . . . . Remote Access Permission . Windows Group Membership Configuration Group Policy Configuration . Microsoft Internet Authentication Server Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . RADIUS Client Configuration Policy Configuration . . . . . . Microsoft Windows XP Client Configuration . . . . . . . . . . .
Microsoft PocketPC 2003 Client Configuration . . . . . . Export Trusted Certification Authority . . . Install Certificate Authority . . Configure Wireless Settings . Login to Wireless Network . . Microsoft Requirement . . . . Chapter 11
Chapter 12
. . . .
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
283 285
287 287 287 289 289 290 292 Configuration of RF Monitoring 293 Coverage Hole Detection . . . 293 Interference Detection . . . . . 295 Event Threshold Configuration . . . . . . . . . 296 Advanced Parameters . . . . . 299 Chapter 14
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
Intrusion Detection Configuration . . . . . . WLAN Intrusion Detection . Rogue AP . . . . . . . . . . . Denial of Service . . . . . . . Rate Analysis . . . . . . . . FakeAP Detection . . . . . Man-in-the-Middle . . . . . . MAC Spoofing . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
303 303 304 306 306 308 309 310 310 311 312 314 314 318 318 319 319 321
Station Disconnection Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . EAP Handshake Analysis. . . Sequence Number Analysis . AP Impersonation Protection Signature Detection . . . . . . . . WLAN Policies . . . . . . . . . . . . Ad-hoc Network Protection . Wireless Bridge Detection . . Misconfigured AP Protection Weak WEP Detection . . . . . Multi-Tenancy Policies and
xi
334 335 336 338 339 341 342 343 343 344 344 345 346 346
xii
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Using the CLI . . . . . . . . . . . Server Rules . . . . . . . . . . . Configuring the Internal Authentication Database Using the CLI . . . . . . . . . . . Configuring RADIUS Accounting Using the CLI . . Configuring 802.1x Authentication Using the CLI Adding 802.1x Authentication Servers . . Configuring VPN Authentication Using the CLI Configuring Captive Portal Authentication Using the CLI Configuring MAC Address Role Mapping Using the CLI Configuring Stateful 802.1x Using the CLI . . . . . . . . . . . AP/Server Configuration for Stateful 802.1x . . . . . Role Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . SSID Role Mapping . . . . . . . Encryption Type Role Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . Notes on Advanced AAA Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The Problem . . . . . . . . . . . The AirOS Solution . . . . . . . Chapter 16
347 349
350 350 351 354 354 354 356 356 357 357 357 357 358 358 359
IAS Server Configuration . . 363 Starting the IAS Server . . . . . . 364 Creating NAS Client Entries . . . 365
Creating Remote Access Policies . . . . . . . . . . Adding a User . . . . . . . . Configuring ACS . . . . . . Configuring SBR . . . . . . . Configuring Funk . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
xiii
Chapter 17
Firewall Configuration . . . . Setting Policies Using Web UI . Aliases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defining Service Aliases . . .
Defining Source and Destination Aliases . . . . Firewall Policies . . . . . . . . Defining Roles Using Web UI . Role Design . . . . . . . . . . . Configuring Roles . . . . . . . Setting Policies Using the CLI . Defining Service Aliases . . . Defining Source and Destination Aliases . . . . Firewall Policies . . . . . . . . Defining Roles Using the CLI . Configuring Roles . . . . . . . Defining Access Control Lists in the CLI . . . . . . . . . Standard ACLs . . . . . . . . . Extended ACLs . . . . . . . . . MAC ACLs . . . . . . . . . . . . Ethertype ACLs . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
377 377 377 377 379 381 386 386 386 390 390 391 392 394 394 394 394 395 395 395
Chapter 18
Captive Portal Setup . . . . . . 397 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 Add Users to the Database . . 398
Configure RADIUS Server Information . . . . . . . . . . . Apply a Server to Captive Portal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Customize the Logon Role . . Allow Guest Access . . . . . . Configure Other User Roles . Configuring Role Derivation . Import a Server Certificate . . Customize the Login Screen . Sample Configuration . . . . . . . Show Commands . . . . . . . . . . 399 400 401 404 405 406 407 409 410 411
May 2005
xiv
Part 0500055-03
Chapter 19
Setting Access Rights . . . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defining Alias . . . . . . . . . . . Defining Service Alias . . . Defining Destination Alias.
. . . . .
415 415 416 416 416 417 417 417 418 418 420
Creating Session ACLs and Roles .............. Creating A Session ACL for Logon . . . . . . . . . . . Creating Session ACLs for Users . . . . . . . . . . . . Role Derivation . . . . . . . . . . . . How Role Derivation Works . Show Commands . . . . . . . . . . Chapter 20
xv
Profile Attributes . . . . . . CLI Configuration Examples Viewing AP Attribute Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . Viewing AP Information and Statistics . . . . . . . . AP Reprovisioning . . . . . . . . . Chapter 21
VPN Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . Prerequisites . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data Used In The Examples . . Network Setup . . . . . . . . . . . RADIUS Server Setup. . . . . . . Internal Database Setup . . . . .
Aruba Switch VPN Dialer Setup VPN Dialer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Before You Begin . . . . . . . . Downloading the Client . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connecting With VPN . . . . . Aruba VPN Dialer Features . . Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . Generating a Self-Distributable Aruba Dialer . . . . . . . . . . . . 499 Chapter 22
xvi
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Caching Using Web UI . . . . Configuring IPSec Using the CLI Configuring PPTP Using the CLI Configuring the VPN Dialer Using the CLI . . . . . . . . . . . Configuring VPN Server Emulation Using the CLI . . . Configuring SecureID Token Caching Using Web UI . . . . VPN Quick Start Guide . . . . . . Requirements From Customer . . . . . . . . . . . Network Topology In Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting Up a VPN . . . . . . . . Verification and T roubleshooting . . . . . . . . Example VPN Configurations . . Using Cisco VPN Client on Aruba Switches . . . . . . . Typical Third-Party VPN Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . Configuring VPN on Master-Local Switches . . . . Chapter 23
511 512 513 514 515 516 516 516 517 517 523 528 528 535 540 541 541 541 543 543 543 544 544
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
xvii
File Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . 545 Copy Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545 Copy Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547 Copy Crash Files . . . . . . . . . 547 Backup Flash . . . . . . . . . . . 548 Restore Flash . . . . . . . . . . . 548 Delete Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549 WLAN Maintenance . . . . . . . . . 549 Rebooting Access Points . . . 550 Managing the WMS Database 550 Captive Portal Maintenance . . . 553 Customizing the Login Page . 553 Upload Certificate . . . . . . . . 554 Upload Custom Login Pages 554
Part 4
. . . . . . . . 557
Chapter 24
Monitoring the Wireless Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . 559 Network Monitoring . . . . . . . . 560 Switch Monitoring. . . . . . . . . . 561
Sample Monitoring Information . . . . . . . . . . . Events ............... Creating Custom Reports . . . WLAN Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . Debug Information. . . . . . . . . . Creating Custom Logs . . . . . . . Reports ............... Example Report: Rogue APs . AP Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . Custom Reports . . . . . . . . . Understanding Heat Maps . . . . 562 571 573 574 574 575 575 576 577 578 579
Chapter 25
Chapter 26
xviii Part 0500055-03
. . . .
. . . .
Client finds AP, but cannot associate . . . . . . . . . . . . Client associates to AP, but higher-layer authentication fails . . . . . Client associates/ authenticates, but has no network connectivity . Client initially has network connectivity, then loses connectivity . . . . . . . . . . Client has network connectivity, then loses wireless association . . . . Client experiences poor performance . . . . . . . . . Troubleshooting Access Points Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . 802.1x. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VPN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sample Packet Captures . . . . . Broadcast Probe Request Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FCS - Frame Check Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . Specific Network Probe Request Frame . . . . . . . . Beacon Frame . . . . . . . . . . Probe Response Frame . . . . 802.11 Authenticate Frame . 802.11 Authenticate Response (Success) . . . . Association Request Frame
593
593
594
595 596 597 601 601 605 609 609 610 610 612 615 617 618
xix
(includes WPA) . . . Association Response Packet Sniffing . . . . . . . Packet Capture . . . . . SESSION MIRRORING Chapter 27
. . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . .
627 627 627 628 629 Contacting Technical Support 629 Access Point Diagnostics . . . . . 629 Received Configuration . . . . 629 Software Status . . . . . . . . . 630 Debug Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630 Detailed Statistics . . . . . . . . 631 Web Diagnostic. . . . . . . . . . 631
. . . . General Information .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
Part 5
Chapter 28
Command Reference . . .
Understanding the Command Line Interface . . . . . . . . . . . Navigating the CLI . . . . . . . . Getting Help . . . . . . . . . . . . Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Execute Mode Commands . . . . Privileged Mode Commands . . . aaa Commands . . . . . . . . . . clear Commands . . . . . . . . . . . Configure Terminal Commands .
633
xx
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
aaa Commands . . . . . . . . . . aaa xml-api client . . . . . . . adp Commands . . . . . . . . ads Commands . . . . . . . . ap Commands . . . . . . . . . arm Commands . . . . . . . . arp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . banner motd . . . . . . . . . . clock Commands . . . . . . . crypto Commands . . . . . . database synchronize . . . . destination . . . . . . . . . . . dot1x Commands . . . . . . . enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . encrypt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . firewall Commands. . . . . . foreign-agent . . . . . . . . . . home-agent . . . . . . . . . . . hostname . . . . . . . . . . . . Interface Commands. . . . . IP Commands . . . . . . . . . key TBC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . logging Commands . . . . . loginsession timeout. . . . . mac-address-table static . . master-redundancy. . . . . . masterip . . . . . . . . . . . . . mgmt-role . . . . . . . . . . . . mgmt-user . . . . . . . . . . . . mobagent . . . . . . . . . . . . mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . mobility-local . . . . . . . . . . mobmaster primary-subnet mux-address . . . . . . . . . . mux-vlan . . . . . . . . . . . . . netdestination . . . . . . . . . netservice . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
679 702 703 703 705 709 711 712 712 714 723 724 724 733 733 733 738 740 741 741 752 759 759 760 765 766 766 768 768 770 771 771 775 776 777 777 778 783
xxi
newbury . . . . . . . . . . . . no . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ntp server . . . . . . . . . . . packet-capture-defaults . ping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . pptp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . program-ap . . . . . . . . . . prompt . . . . . . . . . . . . . rap-wml . . . . . . . . . . . . router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . sapm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . service . . . . . . . . . . . . . shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . site-survey . . . . . . . . . . snmp-server . . . . . . . . . spanning-tree . . . . . . . . stm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . syscontact . . . . . . . . . . syslocation . . . . . . . . . . telnet cli . . . . . . . . . . . . time-range . . . . . . . . . . traceroute . . . . . . . . . . . trusted . . . . . . . . . . . . . udp-port . . . . . . . . . . . . user . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . user-role . . . . . . . . . . . . version . . . . . . . . . . . . . vlan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . vpdn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . vpn-dialer . . . . . . . . . . . vrrp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . web-server . . . . . . . . . . web-ui . . . . . . . . . . . . . wms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chapter 29
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
786 788 797 798 801 801 803 805 806 808 809 810 811 811 816 818 821 831 831 832 833 834 836 836 837 838 841 842 843 846 849 850 853 854
xxii
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Commands . . . . . . . . . . . Layer 2/Layer 3 Commands . Privileged Mode Commands . . . Switch Management Commands . . . . . . . . . . . Layer 2/Layer 3 Commands . Air Management Commands Authentication Commands . . Clear Commands. . . . . . . . . Debug Commands . . . . . . . Panic Commands . . . . . . . . Screen Display Commands . . Chapter 30
872 872 873 873 877 877 880 882 883 884 884
. . 885 . . 885 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
891 892 892 895 897 898 905 906 906 908 911 912 913 924 924 933 936
. . 937
xxiii
Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . Aruba Soft AP Commands . . Authentication Commands . . . . General Authentication Commands . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE 802.1x Commands . . . . Accounting, Authentication, Authorization . . . . . . . . . Local Database Commands . Dialer Commands . . . . . . . . Access Lists Commands . . . . . MUX Commands . . . . . . . . . . . Enhanced Show Commands . .
939 939 944 944 947 949 955 955 956 958 959 961 963
Part 6
Appendices . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Glossary
xxiv
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Preface
This preface includes the following information:
z An overview of the sections in this manual z A list of related documentation for further reading z A key to the various text conventions used throughout this z Aruba Wireless Networks support and service information
manual
z Part 1, Overview
Explains the Mobility Controller interfaces, including the Command-Line Interface (CLI) and the Web UI.
z Part 2, Design
Explains the basic network design issues in adding a Wireless LAN switch to a network.
z Part 3, Configuration
Explains the features that can be configured for Aruba WLAN switches.
z Part 4, Monitoring
Explains how Aruba WLAN switches are managed and maintained.
z Part 6, Appendix
Includes a glossary of terms used in this document.
Preface
xxv
Related Documents
The following items are part of the complete documentation for the Aruba system:
z Aruba WLAN Switch Installation Guides (A800, A2400, and A5000) z Aruba AirOS User Guide z Aruba AP Installation Guides (A52 and A60/61)
Text Conventions
The following conventions are used throughout this manual to emphasize important concepts:
Description
This style is used to emphasize important terms and to mark the titles of books. This fixed-width font depicts the following:
z Sample screen output z System prompts z Filenames, software devices, and certain commands
when mentioned in the text. Commands In the command examples, this bold font depicts text that the user must type exactly as shown. The name of the object (button, link, etc.) on the interface that you click.
Button
xxvi
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
In this example, the user would type send at the system prompt exactly as shown, followed by the text of the message they wish to send. Do not type the angle brackets. [ Optional ] { Item A | Item B } In the command examples, items enclosed in brackets are optional. Do not type the brackets. In the command examples, items within curled braces and separated by a vertical bar represent the available choices. Enter only one choice. Do not type the braces or bars.
Preface
xxvii
Web Site
z Main Site z Support
http://www.arubanetworks.com http://www.arubanetworks.com/support
E-mail
z Sales z Support
[email protected] [email protected]
Telephone Numbers
z Main z Fax z Sales z Support
408-227-4500 408-227-4550 408-754-1201 In the U.S.: 800-WI-FI-LAN (800-943-4526) International:408-754-1200
xxviii
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Part
Overview
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Command-Line Interface
The Command-Line Interface (CLI) provides the most direct method for configuring the switch and collecting system information. The CLI has the following features:
z Accessible from a local console terminal z Optionally available through Telnet or SSH to local management console or remote network connection
Web Interface
The Web interface provides an intuitive, graphical interface to special configuration and design tools. The Web interface provides the following:
z Compatible with a standard Web browser1 z Accessible from the local management console or remote network connection
1.ArubaOS requires Internet Explorer 6.0 or higher. Other browsers may work but with limited functionality and are therefore not officially supported.
Management Options 3
z Monitor the state and performance of the WLAN z Perform a site survey to assist deployment of Aruba Access Points and Air
Monitors
Tool Bar
z Tool BarThis contains buttons for the various tools available in the Web UI
software. Click on a button to select the tool.
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 1
z Page TreeEach tool has its own information or configuration pages and
sub-pages.
The page tree lists all of the pages available when using the currently selected tool. You can navigate to any of the listed pages by clicking on the page name.
NOTESome of the items in the page tree are merely headings for their sub-pages and cannot be selected. Selectable pages become highlighted when the mouse cursor is placed over them. Non-selectable items do not react.
z Page DisplayThis area displays all the information and/or input fields relevant to the current page of the current tool.
Page Elements
Each tool in the Web UI has its own unique information or configuration pages, each with specialized data and control fields. Some of the page items appear on multiple pages in multiple tools and provide a similar navigation or configuration function in each.
Navigation Items
z Scroll-barsIn some cases, there will be more fields than can be conveniently displayed on one window. When this occurs, standard Windows scroll-bars will be available to let you access the rest of the page.
z Page TabsSome pages feature a row of tabs near the top of the page display area. Each tab represents a different form available from the current page.
Fields
z Information FieldsThese fields are used only for displaying information.
The data in these fields cannot be edited directly on the displayed screen.
Management Options
z Scrolling MenusThese fields allow you to select an item from a preset list.
Use the scroll arrows to view the available options. To select a specific item from the list, click on the item when displayed.
Action Buttons
The following buttons are generally available on configuration pages.
z ApplyAccept all configuration changes made on the current page and send
the completed form to the WLAN switch.
z ClearReset all options on the current page to their last applied or saved
settings.
z AddAdd a new item to the current page. This generally displays a set of
relevant configuration fields for the added item.
z EditEdit the configuration of the selected item. z DeleteRemove the selected item from the page configuration. z Save ConfigurationSave all applied configuration changes made since during this configuration session. Saved settings will be retained when the switch is rebooted or turned off. Unsaved configuration changes will be permanently lost.
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Data Bits
8
Parity
None
Stop Bits
1
Flow Control
None
Press <Enter> a few times.to establish the connection and access the login prompt. NOTEThe serial port accepts an RS-232 serial cable with an RJ-45 male connector (see the Aruba 5000 Installation Guide for more port and cable specifications).
Use the local serial console to log in as the administrator. Enter configuration mode and select the management interface sub-mode:
(aruba) # configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z (aruba) (config) # interface mgmt
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 2
Logging In
Once connected, the system displays its host name (aruba if not configured), followed by the log in prompts. Log in using the administrator account. For example:
As shown above, the default administrator user name is admin, and the default password is also admin. If the password has been changed, use the correct one. When properly logged in, the user mode CLI prompt will be displayed:
(host) > _
Access Modes
Once logged in, there are two levels of access to the switch: user mode and privileged mode.
z User Mode
User mode provides only limited access for basic operational testing, such as running ping and traceroute. User mode is entered immediately upon login and is shown with the following prompt:
(host) >
where host is the host name of the switch if configured, or aruba if not configured. User mode commands are documented starting on page 871.
z Privileged Mode
All configuration and management functions are available in privileged mode. To move from user mode to privileged mode requires an additional password:
Command Context
The commands available while in the privileged mode are divided into a number of context groups:
z Action Commands
The Action Commands take effect as soon as they are entered. They affect the current behavior or operation of the switch, but are not saved as part of the permanent configuration. The Immediate commands are documented starting on page 871.
z Master Commands
One Mobility Controller on the network is responsible for loading software and configuration files to the Aruba Access Points and for managing enhanced WLAN switching features (such as air management and wireless load balancing). In a system with only one switch, the single switch always acts as the master. In a system with more than one switch, one (and only one) switch is selected as the master. The master switch has an extended command set for handling Access Points and enhanced WLAN features. The master commands are documented starting on page 797.
z Local Commands
In a system with two or more switches, only one acts as the master. The others act as local switches with a more limited command set. Commands on local switches mostly affect Layer 2/Layer 3 configuration (such as physical ports and routing interfaces). The local commands are documented starting on page 445.
10
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 2
z Show Commands
The show commands list information about the switch configuration and performance and are invaluable for debugging system configuration. The show commands are documented starting on page 885.
z startup-config
This holds the configuration options which will be used the next time the system is rebooted. It contains all the options last saved using the write memory command. Presently unsaved changes are not included. To view the startup-config, use the following command:
z running-config
This holds the current switch configuration, including all pending changes which have yet to be saved. To view the running-config, use the following command:
11
Shortcuts
Command Completion
To make command input easier, you can usually abbreviate each key word in the command. You need type only enough of each keyword to distinguish it from similar commands. For example:
(aruba) # con t
Three characters (con) represent the shortest abbreviation allowed for configure. Typing only c or co would not work because there are other commands (like copy) which also begin with those letters. The configure command is the only one that begins with con. As you type, you can press the spacebar or tab to move to the next keyword. The system will then attempt to expand the abbreviation for you. If there is only command keyword that matches the abbreviation, it will be filled in for you automatically. If the abbreviation is too vague (too few characters), the cursor will not advance and you must type more characters or use the help feature to list the matching commands.
Command Help
You can use the question mark (?) to get various types of command help.
(host) > ? enable logout ping traceroute Turn on Privileged commands Exit this session. Any unsaved changes are lost. Send ICMP echo packets to a specified IP address. Trace route to specified IP address.
12
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 2
(host) # c? clear clock configure copy Clear configuration Configure the system clock Configuration Commands Copy Files
If more than one item is shown, type more of the keyword characters to distinguish your choice. However, if only one item is listed, the keyword or abbreviation is valid and you can press tab or the spacebar to advance to the next keyword.
and start from scratch to a file in the file system to memory to terminal
The <Enter> entry (carriage return, or the enter key) indicates that the command can be entered without additional parameters. Any other parameters are optional.
Command History
The system records your most recently entered commands. You can review the history of your actions, or reissue a recent command easily, without having to retype it. To view items in the command history, use the <up arrow> to move back through the list and <down arrow> key to forward. To reissue a specific command, press <enter> when it appears. You can even use the command line editing feature to make changes to the command prior to entering it.
13
Effect
Home Back Delete Right End Forward
Description
Move the cursor to the beginning of the line. Move the cursor one character left. Delete the character to the right of the cursor. Move the cursor to the end of the line. Move the cursor one character right.
Delete all characters to the right of the cursor. Display the next command in the command history. Display the previous command in the command history. Swap the character to the left of the cursor with the character to the right of the cursor. Clear the line. Delete the characters from the cursor up to and including the first space encountered. Delete all characters to the left of the cursor.
Alpha-numeric characters are always inserted into the line at the cursor position.
Command Syntax
CLI commands use basic notations for the parameters that modify a command. These include:
z Brackets [ ]denotes that the object(s) inside are optional. z Braces { }denotes that the object(s) inside are required. If more than one
object is included inside a brace, one of the objects must be specified.
14
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 2
z Angles < >denotes the parameter is required and must be specified. z Pipe | denotes a two or more parameters, separated one from the other
by the | symbol. For example:
15
16
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Part
17
18
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
CHAPTER 3 RF Design
The Aruba RF Plan Tool
RF Plan is a three-dimensional wireless deployment modeling tool that enables Network Administrators to design an efficient Wireless Local Area Network (WLAN) for their corporate environment, optimizing coverage and performance, and eliminating complicated WLAN network setup. RF Plan provides the following critical functionality:
z z z z z z z
Defines WLAN coverage Defines WLAN environment security coverage Assesses equipment requirements Optimizes radio resources Creates an exportable WLAN profile that may be imported into an Aruba switch and be used to configure and deploy the WLAN. AP validation Rogue AP triangulation
RF Plan provides a view of each floor, allowing Network Administrators to specify how Wi-Fi coverage should be provided. RF Plan then provides coverage maps and AP/AM placement locations.
Unlike other static site survey tools that require administrators to have intricate knowledge of building materials and other potential Radio Frequency (RF) hazards, RF Plan calibrates coverage on the fly through a sophisticated RF calibration algorithm. This real-time calibration lets administrators characterize the indoor propagation of RF signals in order to determine the best channel and transmission power setRF Design 19
tings for each AP . Real-time calibration can be automatically programmed or manually undertaken at any time in order to quickly adapt to changes in the wireless environment.
Getting Started
The RF Plan application is available on the Aruba WLAN switch or as a standalone Windows application. This chapter describes the functionality for both versions of RF Plan. Where there are differences in how the two difference versions are used, they are noted.
z Windows 2000 or Windows XP z Microsoft Internet Explorer 6.0 or later1 z Macromedia Flash 6.0 or later plug-in for Internet Explorer z Intel Pentium III 800Mhz (min) or equivalent z 128MB RAM z 10MB available hard drive space
Installing RF Plan
To install RF Plan, follow the three steps below:
NOTERF Plan only runs on Windows 2000 and WindowsXP .
1.Other browsers may work with ArubaOS but with limited capability and are therefore unsupported.
20 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 3
Launching RF Plan
To open RF Plan select: Start > All Programs > Aruba Offline RF Plan> Aruba RF Plan.
RF Plan Basics
Page Summary
The following is a brief summary of the functionality of each of the pages in RF Plan.
The Building List page provides a list of buildings that you have created and saved. You may use this page to add or delete buildings from you saved database. You may also import or export buildings here. The Building Overview page allows you to see all the dimensional data and modeling parameters for your buildings. Specify the dimensions of your building and name it in the Building Specifications page. Specify the AP Modeling parameters on this page. Specify the AM Modeling parameters on this page. Use this page to import and export building database files. The Planning Floors page allows you to see approximate coverages of APs and AMs, as well as any floor plans you may have imported as background images. Use this page to upload background images for each floor, name the floor and delete floors.
NOTEYou cannot have more than one browser window open when you are trying to upload images.
z AP Modeling Page z AM Modeling Page z Import and Export z Planning Floors Page
RF Design
21
Use this page to specify areas on each floor where coverage is not desirable or where Access Points/Air Monitors may not be physically deployed. Use this page to manually create, position, or configure Access Points or Air Monitors. The AP Plan page is used to initialize the position of Access Points and launch RF Plans positioning algorithm. The AP Plan page is used to initialize the position of Air Monitors and launch RF Plans positioning algorithm.
Page Fields
Each tool in the RF Plan has its own unique information or configuration pages, each with specialized data and control fields. Some of the page items appear on multiple pages and provide a similar navigation or configuration function in each.
z Scrolling MenusThese fields allow you to select an item from a preset list.
Use the scroll arrows to view the available options. To select a specific item from the list, click on the item when displayed.
22
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
Navigation
The RF Plan tool is a wizard in that it logically guides you through the process of defining radio coverage for all the buildings on your campus. The left pane of the wizard screens shows the progression you follow each time you click Apply. The button on the top, right corner also takes you to the next logical step. You can also click the link on the left pane to go to any screen in the wizard. Regardless of your current location, you can always return to the opening window by clicking Plan on the menu bar.
z SaveSave all applied configuration changes made since during this configuration session to a database file. Unsaved configuration changes will be lost when the RF Plan tool is exited. NOTEAlways Apply. If you advance to the next step without clicking on the Apply button the information will be lost.
RF Design
23
Opening Screen
When RF Plan opens, the browser window will show the default page: the RF Plan Building List page.
Use this button to create a new building. See Adding a New Building to the Plan on page 26. Use this button to edit existing buildings in the building list. See Adding a New Building to the Plan on page 26 Use this button to delete existing buildings in the building list. Use this button to export a database file with all the specifications and background images of a selected building(s) in the building list. See Import and Export on page 33 Use this button to import database files defining pre-existing buildings into the RF Plan building list. See Import and Export on page 33 Use this button to find the specified building.
z Import z Locate
24
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
z Search
When the database of buildings has been created, use this feature to find a specific building, on a specific campus, or search for a name string.
You may add, edit, and delete buildings using this window. You may also import and export buildings using the import and export buttons.
Using RF Plan
Task Overview
Before you begin take a minute to review this section, it explains the general steps in the order they should be taken to create a building and plan the WLAN for it.
z Gather information about your buildings dimensions and floor plan. z Determine the level of coverage you want for your Access Points and Air
Monitors.
z Create a new building and add its dimensions. z Enter the parameters of your Access Point coverage. z Enter the parameters of your Air Monitor coverage. z Add floors to your building and import the floor plans. z Define special areas. z Generate suggested AP and AM tables by executing the AP/AM Plan features.
RF Design
25
Planning Requirements
You should collect the following information before beginning to plan your network. Having the information below readily available will expedite your planning efforts.
z z z z z z z z z z z
Building Dimensions Number of floors Distance between floors Number of users and number of users per AP Radio type(s) Overlap Factor Desired data rates for access points Desired monitoring rates for air monitors Areas of your building(s) that you dont necessarily want coverage Areas of your building(s) where you dont want to, or cannot, deploy an AP or AM Any area where you want to deploy a fixed AP or AM.
Building Dimensions
Height: Number of Floors: Width:
User Information
Number of Users: Radio Types: Overlap Factor: Users per AP:
AP Desired Rates
802.11b|g: 802.11a:
AM Desired Rates
802.11b|g: 802.11a:
26
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
The Overview page shows the default values for your new building, most of which you can change in the following pages.
On Building Overview Page you will be able to view the specifications for the following:
z Your buildings dimensions. z Access Point modeling parameters. z Air Monitor modeling parameters.
To define your building, click Building Dimensions. The Specification page displays.
RF Design
27
Enter the appropriate values in the text boxes in the Dimension window.
z Building ID
This consists of two decimal numbers separated by a dot. The first is the campus ID. The campus ID will always be 1 if there is only one campus. The second is the building number. The valid range for these fields is any integer from 1 to 255.
z Width and
Height
Enter the rectangular exterior dimensions of the building. The valid range for this field is any integer from 1 to a 12 value corresponding to 1 10 .
z Inter-floor
Height
This is the distance between floor surfaces in the building. The valid range for this field is any integer from 1 to a 12 value corresponding to 1 10 .
NOTEThis is NOT the distance from floor to ceiling. Some buildings have a large space between the interior ceilings and the floor above.
28
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
z Floors
Enter the number of floors in your building here. The valid range for this field is any integer from 1 to a 12 value corresponding to 1 10 .
z Units
Specify the units of measurement for the dimensions you specified on the page. The choices are feet and meters.
Maximum Width
When height and width are specified, RF Plan creates a rectangular area in the Planning feature pages that represent the overall area covered by the building. You will need to import an appropriate background image (see, Floor Editor Page on page 38.) to aid you in defining areas that dont require coverage or areas in which you do not wish to deploy Access Points and Air Monitors (see,Area Editor Page on page 39). Define your first building on this campus and click Apply. The AM Modeling page displays.
Maximum Height
RF Design
29
AP Modeling Page
The AP Modeling page allows you to specify all the information necessary for RF Plan to determine the appropriate placement of your APs.
Controls on this page allow you to select or control the following functions:
Use this pull-down menu to specify the radio type in the appropriate combination of a, b, and or g configuration. Specify AP 52 or AP 60. Use this option to let RF Plan automatically determine the number of APs based on desired data rates and the configuration of your building. The desired rate is selectable from 1 to 54 Mbps in both the Coverage and Capacity models. Use this option to let RF Plan determine the number of APs based upon the total number of users, ratio of users to APs, and desired data rates. The desired rate is selectable from 1 to 54 Mbps in both the Coverage and Capacity models. Use this option to simply specify a fixed number of APs.
z Capacity
z Overlap Factor Use this field and pull-down to specify an overlap factor.
Use these pull-down to specify the data rates desired on your Access Points. Selectable for Capacity or Custom models. Selectable for Capacity or Custom models.
30
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
Radio Type
Specify the radio type(s) of your APs using the pull-down Radio Type menu on the Modeling Parameters page.
Available Radio Type Choices:
5GHz, Orthogonal Frequency Division Multiplexing (OFDM) with data rates up to 54Mbps. 2.4GHz, Direct Spread Spectrum (DSSS) multiplexing with data rates up to 11Mbps. 2.4GHZ, OFDM/CCK (Complementary Code Keying) with data rates up to 54Mbps.
Overlap Factor
The Overlap Factor is the amount of signal area overlap that you want when the APs are operating. Overlap is important if an AP fails. It allows the network to self-heal with adjacent APs powering up to assume some of the load from the failed device. Although there may be no holes in coverage in this scenario, there will likely be a loss of throughput. Increasing the overlap will allow for higher throughputs when an AP has failed and will allow for future capacity as the number of users increases. The valid range of values for the overlap factor are from 100% to 1000%.
Users
NOTEThe Users text boxes are active only when the Capacity model is selected.
Enter the number of users you expect to have on your WLAN in the Users text box. Enter the number of users per access point you expect in the Users/AP text box. The numbers entered in the these two text boxes must be no-zero integers between 1-255 inclusive.
Rates
NOTEThe Rate pull-down menus are active only when the Coverage or Capacity design models are selected.
Select the desired data rates from the pull-down menus for 802.11b/g and 802.11a.
RF Design
31
High data transmission rates will require an increased number of AP to be placed in your building. You should carefully evaluate your users data rate needs. Click Apply and the AM Modeling page displays.
AM Modeling Page
The AM Modeling page allows you to specify all the information necessary for RF Plan to determine the appropriate placement of your AMs.
Controls on this page allow you to select or control the following functions:
Use this pull-down menu to specify the desired monitor rate for your Air Monitors. Use this field to manually specify the number of Air Monitors to deploy (Custom Model only). Use these radio buttons to specify a design model to use in the placement of Air Monitors.
32
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
Design Models
Two radio buttons on the page allow you to control the kind of model which will be used to determine the number and type of APs.
Design Model Radio Button Options:
z Coverage
Use this option to let RF Plan automatically determine the number of AMs based on desired monitor rates and the configuration of your building. Desired rate is selectable from 1 to 54 Mbps in the Coverage model.
z Custom
Use this option to simply specify a fixed number of AMs. When the AM Plan portion of RF Plan is executed, RF Plan will make an even distribution of the AMs.
NOTEThe monitor rates you select for the AMs should be less than the data rates you selected for the APs. If you set the rate for the AMs at a value equal to that specified for the corresponding PHY type AP , RF Plan will allocate one AM per AP . If you specify a monitor rate larger than the data rate, RF Plan will allocate more than one AM per AP .
Monitor Rates
Use the drop down menus to select the desired monitor rates for 802.11b/g and 802.11a air monitors.
NOTEThis option is available only when the coverage design model is selected.
RF Design
33
Import Buildings
The Import Buildings page allows you to import configuration information from an existing Aruba switch so you can modify it for use on another switch or in an another building. Only XML files exported from an Aruba switch or from Aruba RF Plan may be imported into RF Plan.
NOTEImporting any other file, including XML files from other applications, may result in unpredictable results. Any file you wish to import must be in the C:\Program Files\Aruba RF Plan\data\ path. You can not specify any other path in the RF Plan Import Buildings dialog.
Export Buildings
The Export Buildings page allows you to export the configuration of the WLAN you just created so that it may be imported into and used to automatically configure your Aruba switches.
34
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
Files exported from RF Plan will be placed in the C:\Program Files\Aruba RF Plan\data\ directory on your hard drive. When exporting a building file it is recommended that you check the Include Images check box. When naming your exported file, be sure to give the file the .XML file extension.
Example: My_Building.XML
The Planning Floors page enables you to see what the footprint of your floors look like. You can select or adjust the following features on the Planning Floors Page.
z Zoom
Use this pull-down menu or type a zoom factor in the text field to increase or decrease the size of the displayed floor area.
RF Design
35
z Access Point Editor Click on this link to launch the Access Point Editor.
Zoom
The Zoom control sets the viewing size of the floor image. It is adjustable in finite views from 10% to 1000%. You may select a value from the pull-down zoom menu or specify a value in the text box to the left of the pull-down. When you specify a value, RF Plan adjusts the values in the pull-down to display a set of values both above and below the value you typed in the text box.
Coverage
Select a radio type from the Coverage pull-down menu to view the approximate coverage area for each of the APs that RF Plan has deployed in AP Plan or AM Plan. Adjusting the Coverage values will help you understand how the AP coverage works in your building.
36
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
NOTEYou will not see coverage circles displayed here until you have executed either an AP Plan or an AM Plan.
Coverage Rate
Adjusting the coverage rate will also affect the size of the coverage circles for AMs. Adjusting the rate values will help you understand how the coverage works in your proposed building.
RF Design
37
Naming
You may name the floor anything you choose as long as the name is an alpha-numeric string with a maximum length of 64 characters. The name you specify appears just to the right of the Floor Number displayed just above the background image in the Planning view.
38
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
Background Images
A background image (floor plan image) may be imported into RF Plan for each floor. A background image is extremely helpful when specifying areas where coverage is not desired or areas where an AP/AM is not to be physically deployed. Select a background image using the Browse button on the Floor Editor Dialog.
z Image Scaling
Images are scaled (stretched) to fit the display area. The display area aspect ratio is determined by the building dimensions specified on the Dimension page.
RF Design
39
You specify these areas by placing them on top of the background image using the Area Editor.
Naming
You may name an area using an alpha-numeric string of characters with a maximum length of 64 characters. You should give areas some meaningful name so that they are easily identified.
You may also use the drag and drop feature of the Area Editor to drag your area to where you want it and resize it by dragging one or more of the handles displayed in the corners of the area. Dont Care areas are displayed as orange rectangles.
40
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
Naming
RF Plan automatically names APs using the default convention a number. It assigns the number starting at 1 and increasing by one for each new AP . When you manually create an AP that new AP is then assigned the next a number in sequence and added to the bottom of the suggested AP list. You may name an Access Point anything you wish. The name must be comprised of alpha-numeric characters and be 64 characters or less in length.
RF Design
41
Location
The physical location of the AP is specified by X-Y coordinates beginning at the lower left corner of the display area. The numbers you specify in the X and Y text boxes are whole units. The X coordinates increase as a point moves up the display and the Y coordinates increase as they move from left to right across the display.
262 ft. 98
0,0
126
X 418 ft.
Fixed
Fixed APs dont move when RF Plan executes the positioning algorithm.
NOTEYou might typically set an AP as fixed when you have a specific room, such as a conference room, in which you want saturated coverage. You might also want to consider using a Fixed AP when you have an area that has an unusually high user density.
Choose Yes or No from the drop down box. Choosing Yes will lock the position of the AP as it is shown in the coordinate boxes of the Access Editor. Choosing No will allow RF Plan to move the AP as necessary to achieve best performance.
PHY Types
The PHY Type drop down menu allows you to specify what radio mode the AP will use. You may choose from one of the following:
z z z
42
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
802.11 Types
The 802.11 b/g and 802.11a Type drop down boxes allow you to choose the mode of operation for the access point. You may choose to set the mode of operation to access point (Aruba AP) or Air Monitor.
802.11 Channels
The 802.11a and 802.11b/g channel drop down menus allow you to select from the available channels.
NOTEThe available channels will vary depending on the regulatory domain (country) in which the device is being operated.
802.11a channels begin at channel 34 at a frequency of 5.170 MHz and increase in 20MHz steps through channel 161 at 5.805 Mhz. 802.11b/g channels begin at 1 and are numbered consecutively through 14. The frequencies begin at 2.412 MHz on channel 1 and increase in 22 MHz steps through Channel 14 at 2.484 MHz.
Memo
The Memo text field allows you to enter notes regarding the access point. You may enter a maximum of 256 alpha-numeric characters in the Memo field.
RF Design
43
AP Plan
The AP Plan feature uses the information entered in the modeling pages to locate access points in the building(s) you described.
Initialize
Initialize the Algorithm by clicking on the Initialize button. This makes an initial placement of the access points and prepares RF Plan for the task of determining the optimum location for each of the APs. As soon as you click the Initialize button you will see the AP symbols appear on the floor plan. Access points are represented by this symbol.
44
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
Colored circles around the AP symbols on the floor plan indicate the approximate coverage of the individual AP and the color of the circle represents the channel on which the AP is operating. The circles appear when you select an approximate coverage value on one of the Floors pages. You may also use click on an AP icon and drag it to manually reposition it.
Start
Click on the Start button to launch the optimizing algorithm. You will see the AP symbols moving on the page as RF Plan finds the optimum location for each. The process may take several minutes. You may watch the progress on the status bar of your browser. The algorithm will stop when the movement is less than a threshold value calculated based on the number of APs. The threshold value may be seen in the status bar at the bottom of the browser window.
RF Design
45
The Suggested AP Table lists the coordinates, power, location, power setting, and channel for each of the APs that are shown in the floor plan.
AM Plan
The AM Plan feature calculates the optimum placement for your air monitors (AMs).
Initialize
Initialize the Algorithm by clicking on the Initialize button. This makes an initial placement of the air monitors and prepares RF Plan for the task of determining the optimum location for each of the AMs. As soon as you click the Initialize button you will see the AM symbols appear on the floor plan. Air Monitors are represented by this symbol.
46
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 3
Start
Click on the Start button to launch the optimizing algorithm. You will see the AM symbols moving on the page as RF Plan finds the optimum location for each. The process may take several minutes. You may watch the progress on the status bar of your browser. The algorithm will stop when the movement is less than a threshold value calculated based on the number of AMs. The threshold value may be seen in the status bar at the bottom of the browser window.
The Suggested AP Table lists the coordinates, power, location, power setting, and channel for each of the APs that are shown in the floor plan.
RF Design
47
Locating Devices
To find a specific device by for example a MAC address or ESSID, click Locate on the main menu (Building List). AirOS locates devices by the process of triangulation.
48
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Security Options
49
Port Number
17
Protocol
TCP
21 22 23
WLAN Switch WLAN Switch AP and WLAN Switch WLAN Switch AP (and WLAN Switch if DHCP server is configured ) AP (and WLAN Switch if DHCP server is configured ) WLAN Switch
53 67
UDP UDP
68
UDP
DHCP client
69
UDP
TFTP
50
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Port Number
80
Protocol
TCP
123 161
UDP UDP
443
TCP
Used internally for captive portal authentication (HTTPS) and is exposed to wireless users. A default self-signed certificate is installed after the user explicitly selects this port to be open. Users in a production environment are urged to install a certificate from a well known CA such as Verisign. Self-signed certs are open to man-in-the-middle attacks and should only be used for testing. ISAKMP Syslog L2TP PPTP Internal terminal server opened by telnet soe command. Remote wired MAC lookup.
WLAN Switch WLAN Switch WLAN Switch WLAN Switch WLAN Switch WLAN Switch
Security Options
51
Port Number
4343
Protocol
TCP
4500 8080
UDP TCP
8081
TCP
8082
TCP
8083
TCP
52
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Port Number
8088 8200 8211
Protocol
TCP UDP UDP
z Roles z Policies z AAA Servers z Authentication Methods z VPN Settings z Global Firewall Settings z Advanced
These options are described in this chapter.
User Roles
Role Design
The role of a wireless user determines a number of access policies, including firewall/traffic policies, bandwidth contracts, IP address pool, VLAN assignment, and VPN dialer. The role is determined through some type of authentication mechanism, and can be as simple as employee versus guest, or more granular such as sales user, marketing user, finance user, IT staff. The selection of a role framework is an important design decision.
Security Options
53
Role Configuration
To manage user roles, navigate to Configuration > Security > Roles. Current roles will be displayed, as shown in the figure below.
54
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Security Options
55
user-role IT-staff dialer IT-staff pool l2tp pool3 pool pptp pool3 session-acl allowall ! user-role guest bandwidth-contract guest-1M vlan 2 reauthentication-interval 30 session-acl Internet_Only
56
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
associated with that session should be allowed. ACLs have no memory of what came before at best, ACLs can look at the SYN flag in a TCP packet, treating the session as new if the flag is set and treating the session as established if it is not. This works for normal traffic but is ineffective against many types of attack traffic. Traffic policies in an Aruba Wi-Fi switch are dynamic, meaning that address information in the rules can change as the policies are applied to users. For example, a traffic policy containing the alias user can be created. After the policy is applied to a particular user, this alias is automatically changed to match the IP address assigned to the user. An ACL is typically a static packet filter, with IP addresses hard coded into the rule. Traffic policies are bi-directional. While ACLs are normally applied either to traffic inbound to an interface or outbound from an interface, traffic policies automatically work in both directions. Traffic policy configuration can be simpler than ACL configuration for this reason, since the administrator does not need to worry about building consistent input and output ACLs.
To edit or delete existing policies, click the appropriate button. Note that some policies are system policies and cannot be deleted. The Policy Usage column will display which user roles currently have a policy applied if a policy is in use, it cannot be deleted. To delete a policy that is in use, first edit the user role and delete the policy, then return to the policies screen to delete it. To add a new policy, click the Add button. The Add New Policy screen appears, as shown in the figure below. Supply a descriptive name for the new policy, and click Add under Rules to begin adding rules.
Source/Destination
Identical parameters are available for both source and destination selection. Traffic policies are bi-directional, and will match traffic in either direction. A packet will match a particular rule in the traffic policy only if the rule is matched exactly, meaning that source address, destination address, and service all match. However, traffic policies are stateful. For example, when a wireless user generates a DNS request to a DNS server, the traffic policy will automatically create a session entry for the response so that the response will be permitted. Because traffic policies are stateful, it is not necessary to configure separate rules for inbound and outbound traffic. All packets that match an identified flow will receive the same treatment by the traffic policy. Five choices exist for both source and destination. Any Alias that represents any IP address. User Alias that represents the users IP address. When a traffic policy containing the user alias is applied to an authenticated user, this alias is replaced by the IP address assigned to that user. With this alias, generic traffic policies can be configured that will automatically be customized at the time of user login.
58
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Host A single IP address. Network An IP subnet, consisting of a network number and subnet mask. Alias When Alias is selected, allows selection of a pre-defined source/destination alias, or creation of a new one. See the section of this guide entitled Source/Destination Aliases for more information on these aliases.
Service
Traffic flows are identified in part by their service type. A service type may be defined by IP protocol number, TCP port number(s), or UDP port number(s). Four options are available for service selection: Any Represents any service. TCP Matches TCP packets destined to the specified port(s). To specify a single port, enter it in the Port1 field. To specify a range of ports, enter the lower port number in the Port1 field, and the upper port number in the Port2 field. UDP Matches UDP packets destined to the specified port(s). To specify a single port, enter it in the Port1 field. To specify a range of ports, enter the lower port number in the Port1 field, and the upper port number in the Port2 field. Service Matches a pre-defined service alias, and also provides the ability to create a new service alias by clicking the New button. The use of a service alias allows for a more easily readable and understandable policy. For more information about service aliases, please see the section of this guide entitled Service Aliases. Protocol Matches an IP protocol number. For example, IPSec ESP uses protocol number 50 (IPSec ESP is also a pre-defined service alias called svc-esp.)
Action
The traffic policy action defines what the disposition of packets matching the rule will be. Five options are available: Permit Forwards the packet unmodified Deny Silently drops the packet
Security Options
59
Src-nat Changes the source IP address of the packet. If no source NAT pool is specified, the packet will be given the source IP address of the Aruba switch. If a NAT pool is specified, the packet will be given an IP address from the NAT pool. Add a new NAT pool by clicking New, or manage NAT pools by navigating to Configuration > Security > Advanced > NAT Pools. Dst-nat Changes the destination IP address of the packet to that of the Aruba switch. Used primarily for intercepting VPN sessions to outside VPN concentrators or for captive portal authentication. Redirect The redirect action does not modify the packet, but changes the internal destination of the packet. This action is configured automatically by the system when Stateful 802.1x is enabled. This action can also be configured by the administrator to redirect packets to tunnel interfaces.
Log
If the Log option is checked, all packets matching the rule will be recorded in the system logfile. Use caution when enabling this option for high-volume traffic, since the logfile will quickly grow very large.
Queue
Select this action to place packets outbound to wireless users in either a high or low priority queue. AirOS uses strict queueing, meaning that any time packets are waiting in the high priority queue, they will be transmitted ahead of packets in the low priority queue.
Rule Ordering
After rules have been defined the order of rules may be changed by clicking on the up arrow or down arrow next to each rule, as shown in the figure below. The order of rules is important, since policies are executed from the first rule sequentially to the last rule.
60
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
CLI Configuration
All CLI configuration for traffic/firewall policies is done under the ip access-list session command. Equivalent CLI configuration for the example shown above is:
ip access-list session Internet_Only user alias Internal_Network svc-dhcp permit user alias Internal_Network svc-dns permit user alias Internal_Network any deny user any svc-http permit user any svc-https permit user any svc-ike permit user any any deny
Security Options
61
Firewall Policies
This section provides an ordered list of traffic policies applied to the user role. Traffic policies are executed in order, with an implicit deny all after the final policy. For more information on firewall and traffic policies, see the section entitled Firewall and Traffic Policies. To apply a new policy to the user role, click Add.
Chapter 4
Location field on this line. See the chapter entitled WLAN Configuration Advanced Location-Based AP Configuration for more information on location codes. Create New Policy From Existing Policy Select this option to create a new traffic policy by copying an existing one. The next screen will allow modification of the newly created policy as well as selection of a location code. See the section entitled Firewall and Traffic Policies for information on building traffic policies. dc=arubanetworks, dc=com Create New Policy Create an entirely new traffic policy. The next screen will allow editing of the newly created policy as well as selection of a location code. See the section entitled Firewall and Traffic Policies for information on building traffic policies. Multiple traffic policies may be applied to a user role. When multiple traffic policies are applied, they behave as a single policy that is, once a rule is matched in the policy and action is taken, no further rules are processed in the policy. Rules are executed from top to bottom, so the placement of rules within a policy and of policies within a user role is important. When multiple traffic policies are applied to a user role, their position within the role may be adjusted using the up and down arrows, as shown in the figure below.
Security Options
63
Role VLAN ID This parameter allows the user to be mapped to a particular VLAN based on the role assigned. This parameter only works when using L2 authentication such as 802.1x, MAC address role mapping, ESSID role mapping, or encryption type role mapping, because these happen before an IP address has been assigned. If a user authenticates using a L3 mechanism such as VPN or captive portal, this parameter has no effect. Bandwidth Contract Applies a bandwidth contract, or rate limiting policy, to the user role to prevent any one user from monopolizing network resources. Bandwidth contracts may be viewed or edited by navigating to Configuration > Security > Advanced > Bandwidth Contract. A new bandwidth contract may also be created while adding or editing a user role to do this, select Add New, supply a name for the bandwidth contract, and fill in the desired bandwidth limit either in kilobits per second or in megabits per second. Bandwidth contracts are part of the user role, but are applied independently on a per-user basis. For example, if two users are active on the network and both are part of the same role with a 500kbps bandwidth contract, then each user will be able to use up to 500kbps. VPN Dialer If VPN is used is an access method, a user may login using captive portal and download a customized VPN dialer. This dialer is a Windows application that configures the VPN client built into Microsoft Windows 2000 and Windows XP . The VPN dialer may be customized based on the user role. This parameter specifies which customization profile should be available for download to users who are part of this user role. See the section entitled Configuring VPN Settings for more information on setting up VPN dialers. L2TP Pool If VPN is used as an access method, specifies which address pool the users IP address should be assigned from when the user negotiates an L2TP/IPSec session. Address pools are configured under Configuration > Security > VPN Settings > IPSec > Address Pools. See the section entitled Configuring VPN Settings for more information on setting up L2TP/IPSec. PPTP Pool If VPN is used as an access method, specifies which address pool the users IP address should be assigned from when the user negotiates a PPTP session. Address pools are configured under Configuration > Security > VPN Settings > PPTP > Address Pools. See the section entitled Configuring VPN Settings for more information on setting up PPTP .
64
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
ACLs, and should be used instead. When filtering non-IP traffic on a physical port basis, MAC address ACLs and Ethertype ACLs are both available. All ACL configuration is done through the CLI because these options are not often used, no GUI configuration is available. ACLs are applied to interfaces using the ip access-group command. The direction of traffic to which the ACL is applied must also be specified, using either the keywords in or out. For example:
Standard ACLs
A standard ACL permits or denies traffic based on the source IP address of the packet. Standard ACLs can be either named or numbered, with valid numbers in the range of 1 to 99 and 1300 to 1399. Standard ACLs use a bitwise mask (sometimes inaccurately called an inverse netmask) to specify which portion of the address should be matched. Sample configuration:
ip access-list standard 1 permit 1.0.0.0 0.255.255.255 permit host 10.1.1.3 deny any
The example above permits any traffic from the subnet 1.0.0.0/8. It also permits traffic from a host with IP address 10.1.1.3. All other traffic is denied.
Extended ACLs
Extended ACLS permit or deny traffic based on source or destination IP address, source or destination port number, or IP protocol. Extended ACLs can be named or numbered, with valid numbers in the range of 100 to 199 and 2000 to 2699. The command syntax follows standard Cisco IOS conventions, and extensive context-sensitive help is available by pressing the ? key after each keyword entry.
Sample configuration:
Security Options
65
ip access-list extended 101 permit tcp any host 1.1.1.1 range 67 69 permit icmp 1.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 any echo-reply
The example above permits TCP traffic from any host to 1.1.1.1 on ports 67 through 69. It also permits ICMP echo-replies from the 1.1.1.0/24 subnet to any network.
MAC ACLs
A MAC ACL is used to filter on a specific source MAC address or range of MAC addresses. MAC ACLs can be either named or numbered, with valid numbers in the range of 700 to 799 and 1200 to 1299. Sample configuration:
Ethertype ACLs
Ethertype ACLs are used to filter based on the ethertype field in the frame header. These ACLs could be used, for example, to permit IP while blocking other non-IP protocols such as IPX or AppleTalk. Ethertype ACLs can be named or numbered, with valid numbers in the range of 200 to 299. Sample configuration:
Chapter 4
RADIUS or LDAP server. MAC address authentication also can make use of an authentication server, simplifying access control when many MAC-authenticated devices (such as VoIP handsets) are used in a network. To configure general authentication server settings, navigate to Configuration > Security > AAA Servers > General, as shown in the figure below.
RADIUS
RADIUS is the most commonly used type of authentication server. RADIUS is flexible, extensible, and has a high degree of interoperability. To configure RADIUS server settings navigate to Configuration > Security > AAA Servers > RADIUS, as shown in the figure below.
Security Options
67
68
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Shared Secret Each RADIUS client-server pair must use a shared secret. Treat this shared secret as a password, and ensure that it is not an easily-guessed word. Ensure that the shared secret is configured identically on the RADIUS server. Authentication Port Specifies the UDP port number over which RADIUS exchanges will take place. The default is 1812 this value is typically used by most modern RADIUS implementations. Accounting Port When RADIUS accounting is enabled, this value specifies the UDP port number over which RADIUS accounting exchanges will take place. The default is 1813 this value is typically used by most modern RADIUS implementations. Num Retries Specifies the number of times that the Aruba switch will send authentication requests without receiving a reply Timeout Specifies how long, in seconds, the Aruba switch will wait for a response from the RADIUS server for each request sent. Mode Enables or disables use of this RADIUS server. A server may be disabled, for example, when the server will be offline for maintenance.
The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is: aaa radius-server "Auth2" host 192.168.24.2 key abc123 authport 1812 acctport 1813 retransmit 3 timeout 5 mode "enable"
Server Rules
For each authentication server used by the system, a server rule may be configured to specify how role and VLAN information is determined. Role and VLAN determination may be done simply by specifying a default value per authentication type, or the information may be learned from the authentication server through a RADIUS attribute. Any attribute may be used the server rule specifies how that attribute is mapped into a role or VLAN. Server rules are executed in order, and multiple server rules may be configured for each authentication server. To add a new server rule, click the Add button.
Security Options
69
The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is: aaa derivation-rules server Auth2 set role condition "Filter-Id" value-of
70
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
LDAP
LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocol) is a lightweight protocol for accessing directory services. A directory is a specialized database optimized for searching, reading and browsing. Directories tend to contain descriptive, attribute-based information. LDAP is specifically geared towards X.500 based directory services and runs over TCP/IP .
LDAP Background
The LDAP information model is based on entries, where an entry is a collection of attributes. An attribute has a type and one or more values. A type is typically a mnemonic string, for example, cn for Common Name, or mail for Email Address. The syntax of an attributes value depends on the type of the attribute. It can be a string, for example, the value John Doe for cn, or a binary JPEG format value for an attribute, say jpegPhoto. LDAP allows the administrator to control the attributes in an entry through the use of a special attribute called objectClass. An objectClass defines the attributes for an entry, and specifies which attributes are required, and which ones are optional. In addition to the attributes that comprise an entry, protection and privacy mechanisms for an entry can be specified in LDAP . Access rights for performing the read/write/search operations on the entry can be defined for each entry. In LDAP , the directory entries are organized in a hierarchical tree-like structure. Traditionally, this structure reflected the geographic and/or organizational boundaries. For example, entries representing countries appear at the top of the tree. Below them are entries representing states and national organizations. Below them may be entries representing organizational units, people, printers, documents etc. An example LDAP directory for an organization is shown below.
Security Options
71
dc=arubanetworks,dc=com
ou=Printers
uid=guest,cn=Guest
72
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
and server is a TCP connection, there is a possibility for a third party to snoop the password from the connection. LDAP supports a more secure connection mechanism through SSL/TLS. There are a number of LDAP server implementations that are deployed by organizations including the OpenLDAP server, the Netscape Directory Server and the Microsoft Active Directory.
Security Options
73
Server Name Specifies a human-readable name to reference the LDAP server. Host Name/IP Address Specifies the IP address of the LDAP server. Authentication Port The port on which the LDAP server is configured. The default value is 389. Base DN - The Distinguished Name of the node which contains the entire user database that should be used for user authentication. Admin DN - A user who has read/search privileges across all the entries in the LDAP database. The user need not have write privileges the user should be able to search the database and read attributes of other users in the database. Admin Password - The password of the Admin user defined above. Key Attribute - The attribute that contains the unique key for the LDAP object. This is the name of the attribute that contains the login ID of the users. Filter - The filter that should be applied to search of the user in the LDAP database. The default filter string is: (objectclass=*). Timeout The amount of time that an LDAP request can go unanswered by the LDAP server before that server is considered down. Mode Administratively enables or disables use of this LDAP server. The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is:
aaa ldap-server LDAP1 host 10.1.1.214 authport 389 base-dn cn=Users,dc=lm,dc=arubanetworks,dc=com admin-dn cn=Aruba Admin,cn=Users,dc=lm,dc=arubanetworks,dc=com admin-passwd abc10 key-attribute sAMAccountName filter (objectclass=*) timeout 20 mode enable
74
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Server Rules
For each authentication server used by the system, a server rule may be configured to specify how role and VLAN information is determined. Role and VLAN determination may be done simply by specifying a default value per authentication type, or the information may be learned from the authentication server through an attribute. Any attribute may be used the server rule specifies how that attribute is mapped into a role or VLAN. Server rules are executed in order, and multiple server rules may be configured for each authentication server. To add a new server rule, click Add.
Security Options
75
CLI configuration to add a user to the internal database is done from command mode, rather than configuration mode:
Chapter 4
employee
Accounting
AirOS supports standard RADIUS accounting for tracking user login/logout times. Accounting will track logins accurately, but logouts may not be tracked accurately since the user may roam out of range without logging out. To configure accounting, navigate to ConfigurationSecurityAAA ServersAccounting, as shown in the figure below.
Authentication Methods
Authentication provides a way to identify a user and provide appropriate access to the network for that user. By default, all wireless users in an Aruba network start in the logon role, and use an authentication method to move to an identified, authenticated role. One or more authentication methods may
Security Options 77
be used, ranging from secure authentication methods such as 802.1x, VPN, and captive portal to less secure role mapping. Role mapping should always be combined with firewall policies to provide enhanced security. Once an authentication method has been enabled on the switch, it is automatically available for all ESSIDs configured on that switch.
802.1x Authentication
802.1x is an IEEE standard designed to provide authentication before any L2 access to the network is permitted. 802.1x provides a framework inside of which multiple authentication protocols may operate. A number of authentication protocols, including EAP-TLS, PEAP , and TTLS are ideally suited for wireless network, most notably because they allow the client to authenticate the network as well as allowing the network to authenticate the client. The authentication protocols are all based on EAP (Extensible Authentication Protocol) and are also known as EAP types. An 802.1x system consists of three parts. The supplicant, or client, is the device attempting to gain access to the network. The authenticator is the gatekeeper to the network, either permitting or denying access to supplicants. Finally, the authentication server provides a database of authentication information and signals the authenticator whether or not access should be permitted. An Aruba switch acts as an authenticator, relaying authentication requests between the supplicant and the authentication server. The Aruba switch implements the 802.1x framework, but is transparent to different authentication protocols within 802.1x. As long as the supplicant and authentication server support compatible authentication protocols, the Aruba switch will interoperate with all EAP types.
78
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
To configure 802.1x, navigate to Configuration > Security > Authentication Methods > 802.1x as shown in the figure below.
Security Options
79
Authentication Failure Timeout After authentication fails, the 802.1x state machine enters a quiet period specified by this value, during which the authenticator will make no attempt to acquire the supplicant. The value can be between 1-65535 seconds. The default is 30 seconds. Client Retry Count Sets the maximum number of attempts the switch will make to authenticate a supplicant. The value can be between 0 and 10. The default value is 3. Server Retry Count Specifies the number of attempts the switch may make to obtain authentication from the server after an initial attempt times out. The value can be between 0 and 3. The default value is 2. Enable Reauthentication Forces supplicants to reauthenticate after the reauthentication time interval has elapsed since the last authentication. Unicast keys are updated after each reauthentication. The default is disabled. Reauthentication Time Interval If reauthentication is enabled, specifies the time interval since the last successful authentication after which the client will be forced to reauthenticate. The value can be between 1 and 4,294,967,295 seconds. The default value is 3600 seconds. Enable Multicast Key Rotation Enables periodic rotation of multicast encryption keys. Multicast keys are used to encrypt broadcast and multicast frames that must be sent to all wireless clients. The default is disabled. Multicast Key Rotation Time Interval When multicast key rotation is enabled, specifies the amount of time that must elapse since the last key rotation until a new multicast key rotation is done. The value can be between 1 and 4,294,967,295 seconds. The default value is 1200 seconds. Enable Unicast Key Rotation Enables periodic rotation of unicast encryption keys. The default is disabled. Unicast Key Rotation Time Interval When unicast key rotation is enabled, specifies the amount of time that must elapse since the last key rotation until a new unicast key rotation is done. The value can be between 1 and 4,294,967,295 seconds. The default value is 240 seconds. Reset 802.1x Parameters to Factory Defaults Check this box to reset all 802.1x settings back to default values. The equivalent CLI configuration command is dot1x default. Authentication Failure Threshold for Station Blacklisting If a station fails 802.1x authentication by this number of times in a row, the station will be blacklisted and will not be allowed to associate to the network. Enter 0 to disable blacklisting.
80
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
aaa dot1x default-role "employee" aaa dot1x mode enable dot1x server server-timeout 30 dot1x timeout idrequest-period 30 dot1x timeout quiet-period 30 dot1x max-req 3 dot1x server server-retry 2 dot1x re-authentication dot1x timeout reauthperiod 3600 dot1x multicast-keyrotation dot1x timeout mcastkey-rotation-period 1200 dot1x unicast-keyrotation dot1x timeout ucastkey-rotation-period 240 aaa dot1x max-authentication-failures 0
VPN Authentication
When the use of IPSec or PPTP is desired, Aruba switches provide full VPN termination capabilities using hardware acceleration. All encryption protocols are run in hardware, with encryption hardware being appropriately sized to handle a full load of access points. The majority of VPN settings are configured under a dedicated VPN section below. VPN backend authentication parameters are configured under Configuration > Security > Authentication Methods > VPN, as shown in the figure below.
82
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
aaa vpn-authentication default-role "vpn-role" aaa vpn-authentication auth-server Internal aaa vpn-authentication max-authentication-failures 0
Security Options
83
Enable Guest Logon When this option is selected, the captive portal page will display a field for guest users to enter their email address. The email address is not validated or authenticated, but can be used to keep track of user identity. When a user enters an email address in the guest logon field, the switch will assign the guest role to the user. Enable User Logon When this option is selected, the captive portal page will display a field for a registered user to enter a username and password. The user will be authenticated against the selected authentication server and will be assigned a role according to either the authentication server role information, or the captive portal default role. Enable Logout Popup Window If this option is selected, a second web browser window appears after captive portal authentication succeeds. This browser window will contain a button to allow the user to logout of the system. Protocol Type Selects whether the captive portal page will be transmitted using HTTP or HTTPS (SSL). The default is HTTPS. If HTTP is selected, then usernames and passwords would be transmitted with no encryption, making it possible for anyone to intercept them. Redirect Pause Time After captive portal authentication succeeds, an authentication succeeded page will display, with additional options for downloading a VPN dialer. The page will be displayed for this time interval, after which the browser will be redirected to the original URL requested when the captive portal action took place. Logon Wait Interval If the switch control CPU is in a high load condition, rendering the captive portal page could cause other higher-priority tasks to slow down. This parameter specifies how long the logon process will be delayed if the CPU is in a highly loaded condition. CPU Utilization Threshold - If the switch control CPU is in a high load condition, rendering the captive portal page could cause other higher-priority tasks to slow down. This parameter specifies the CPU load that must be exceeded in order for captive portal delay to take effect. Authentication Failure Threshold for Station Blacklisting If a station fails captive portal authentication by this number of times in a row, the station will be blacklisted and will not be allowed to associate to the network. Enter 0 to disable blacklisting. Authentication Servers An ordered list of authentication servers to be used when clients attempt to authenticate using captive portal. The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is:
84
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
aaa captive-portal default-role "employee" aaa captive-portal guest-logon aaa captive-portal user-logon aaa captive-portal logout-popup-window no aaa captive-portal protocol-http aaa captive-portal redirect-pause 10 aaa captive-portal logon-wait range 5 10 aaa captive-portal logon-wait cpu-utilization 60 aaa captive-portal max-authentication-failures 0 aaa captive-portal auth-server Internal
Security Options
85
Default Role If a client is identified by MAC address, and the authentication server does not provide role information, the default role will be given to the client. Authentication Failure Threshold for Station Blacklisting If a station fails MAC address authentication by this number of times in a row, the station will be blacklisted and will not be allowed to associate to the network. Enter 0 to disable blacklisting. Authentication Servers An ordered list of authentication servers to be used when VPN clients attempt to authenticate. The authentication server should be populated with MAC addresses, with no separating characters, in the field normally used for usernames. Passwords should also be the MAC address with no separating characters. The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is:
86
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
stateful-authentication dot1x mode enable stateful-authentication dot1x timeout "20" stateful-authentication dot1x auth-server test mac-authentication max-authentication-failures 0
AP/Server Configuration
After enabling stateful 802.1x as shown above, a list of each third-party AP for which stateful 802.1x should be performed must be entered as shown in the figure below.
Security Options
87
aaa stateful-authentication dot1x ap-config Cisco22 ap-ipaddr 192.168.3.22 radius-server-name test key radius-key
88
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
method should always be combined with a firewall policy. To configure SSID role mapping, navigate to Configuration > Security > Authentication Methods > SSID as shown in the figure below.
aaa derivation-rules user set role condition essid equals "Guest-SSID" setvalue "guest"
NOTEWhen using the CLI to enter ESSID values, the name string may include space characters only if the string is placed within quotes. When spaces are not used, quotes are not required. For example, the following ESSIDs are valid CompanyESSID#1 "Company ESSID #1" When using the Web Interface, spaces may be used without adding quotes
Security Options
89
bypassed, this method should always be combined with a firewall policy. To configure encryption type role mapping, navigate to Configuration > Security > Authentication Methods > L2 Encryption as shown in the figure below.
aaa derivation-rules user set role condition encryption-type equals open setvalue "guest"
Advanced Authentication
To configure advanced security options, navigate to Configuration > Security > Authentication Methods > Advanced. The Advanced tab appears in the figure below.
90
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
IPSec
AirOS supports termination of IPSec tunnels using both L2TP/IPSec (supported natively by Windows 2000, XP , and PocketPC 2003) and IPSec/XAUTH (supported by most 3rd-party VPN clients). To configure IPSec, navigate to Configuration > Security > VPN Settings > IPSec, as shown in the figure below.
Security Options
91
92
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Address Pools - IPSec tunnel endpoints are assigned IP addresses. The Aruba switch endpoint will always use the switch IP address, while client addresses are assigned from a pool. To add a new address pool, click the Add button and fill in the pool name and the starting and ending addresses for the pool. Multiple pools may be configured. Enable Source NAT If the address range included in the VPN address pool is not routable by the rest of the network, source NAT can be enabled. When this is enabled, the source address of all user traffic emerging from a VPN tunnel will be changed to the switch IP address. This checkbox configures a traffic policy for the VPN default role if multiple roles are being used with VPN, a source-NAT traffic policy will need to be configured for each of them. NAT Pool Specifies the name of the NAT pool. IKE Aggressive Group Name When configuring IPSec XAUTH, enter the group name. This group name must match the group name configured on each client. IKE Shared Secrets Specifies IKE pre-shared keys for different IP address ranges. This option is only used when IKE pre-shared key authentication is in use. To configure a single IKE pre-shared key for all clients, enter a subnet of 0.0.0.0 with a mask length of 0. The IKE pre-shared key must be identically configured on all clients. The shared secret should be treated as a password, and should not be composed of common dictionary words or phrases. IKE Policies Specifies encryption, hash, and authentication parameters for IKE. The default policy configures IKE for triple-DES encryption, SHA1 hash, and RSA public/private key authentication. To enable IKE pre-shared keys, add a policy as shown in the example to enable pre-shared key authentication. The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is:
vpdn group l2tp client configuration dns 1.1.1.1 2.2.2.2 client configuration wins 3.3.3.3 4.4.4.4 ppp authentication PAP ppp authentication CHAP ppp authentication MSCHAP ppp authentication MSCHAPv2 ! ip local pool lt2p-pool 172.16.2.1 172.16.2.24 ! crypto isakmp groupname changeme ! crypto isakmp key test123 address 0.0.0.0 netmask 0.0.0.0 !
Security Options 93
PPTP
PPTP provides an alternative to IPSec that is supported by MacOS, Linux, PocketPC, Windows 2000, Windows XP , and many other platforms. PPTP is considered to be less secure than IPSec, but also requires less configuration. To configure PPTP , navigate to Configuration > Security > VPN Settings > PPTP as shown in the figure below.
94
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Authentication Protocols Primary/Secondar y DNS Server Primary/Secondar y DNS Server Address Pools
Configures the PPTP authentication protocol. Currently, only MS-CHAPv2 is supported. Configures the list of DNS servers that will be passed to clients after authentication. These parameters are optional. Configures the list of WINS servers that will be passed to clients after authentication. These parameters are optional. PPTP tunnel endpoints are assigned IP addresses. The Aruba switch endpoint will always use the switch IP address, while client addresses are assigned from a pool. To add a new address pool, click the Add button and fill in the pool name and the starting and ending addresses for the pool. Multiple pools may be configured
vpdn group pptp client configuration dns 1.1.1.1 2.2.2.2 client configuration wins 3.3.3.3 4.4.4.4 ! pptp ip local pool "pptp-pool1" "172.16.18.1" "172.16.18.24"
Security Options
95
As shown in the figure, two VPN dialers are currently configured. Default-dialer is pre-configured by the system, while test was added manually. Each dialer can be applied to a particular user role, and multiple user roles may use the same dialer. To add a new VPN dialer, click the Add button. Dialer parameters are shown as in the figure below.
Dialer Name Enable PPTP Enable L2TP Send Direct Network Traffic In Clear
Enter a human-readable name for the dialer so that it may be easily referenced. Allows the dialer to negotiate a PPTP tunnel with the Aruba switch. Allows the dialer to negotiate an L2TP/IPSec tunnel with the Aruba switch. Enables split tunneling functionality so that traffic destined for the internal network will be tunneled, while traffic for the Internet will not. For security reasons, this option is not recommended.
96
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Disable Wireless Devices when Client is Wired Enable SecurID New and Next Pin Mode Authentication
Allows the VPN dialer to detect when a wired network connection is in use. If this option is enabled, the wireless interface will be shut down while a wired connection exists. TBC
Specifies the list of authentication protocols to be supported. This list should match the switch IPSec or PPTP configuration, and should also contain at least one protocol supported by the authentication server. It is generally safe to leave all protocols enabled. If SecureID Token Caching is enabled (see the SecureID Token Caching section of this guide below), the system will cache SecureID tokens so that users do not need to reauthenticate every time a network connection is lost. Specifies how long an IKE security association lasts, in seconds. This parameter must match the IKE lifetime configured in the IPSec IKE policy. The default value is 28,800 seconds. Specifies the IKE encryption protocol. This parameter must match the IKE encryption protocol configured in the IPSec IKE policy. The default value is triple-DES.
IKE Lifetime
IKE Encryption
IKE Diffie-Hellman Specifies whether IKE will use Diffie-Hellman group 1 or Group group 2. This parameter must match the IKE Diffie-Hellman group configured in the switch. The default is group 2. IKE Hash Algorithm Specifies the hash algorithm used by IKE either SHA or MD5. This parameter must match the IKE hash algorithm configured in the IPSec IKE policy. The default is SHA. Specifies whether RSA signatures or pre-shared keys should be used for IKE authentication. This parameter must match the IKE Shared Secrets configuration. The default is for pre-shared key authentication. Make sure the pre-shared key specified here matches the pre-shared key specified in the IKE shared secrets policy. Specifies how long an IPSec security association lasts, in seconds. The default is 7200 seconds. Specifies the IPSec Perfect Forward Secrecy (PFS) mode. The default is Group 2. Specifies the encryption type used for IPSec. The default is triple-DES.
Security Options 97
IKE Authentication
Specifies the hash algorithm used by IPSec. The default is to use SHA.
vpn-dialer dialer2 enable l2tp ppp authentication PAP ppp authentication CHAP ppp authentication MSCHAP ppp authentication MSCHAPv2 ike lifetime 28800 ike encryption 3des ike group 2 ike hash sha ike authentication pre-share test123 ipsec lifetime 7200 ipsec pfs group2 ipsec encryption esp-3des ipsec hash esp-sha-hmac
98
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Configure a list containing the switch IP addresses of all Aruba switches that could potentially result in the situation described above. The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is:
ip access-list session vpn-dst-nat any host 1.2.3.4 svc-ike dst-nat any host 1.2.3.4 svc-esp dst-nat any host 1.2.3.4 svc-l2tp dst-nat user-role logon session-acl vpn-dst-nat position 1
Advanced Authentication
To configure advanced authentication options, select Configuration > Security > Authentication Methods > Advanced Authentication.
Security Options
99
where:
Parameter
Rule Type Condition Value Role Name
Description
Specifies the type of rule to be created. Specifies the logical relationship. Specifies the rule type value. The role name description.
vpdn group l2tp ppp authentication CACHE-SECURID ppp securid cache 1440
100 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 4
where:
Parameter
Transform Set Name Encryption Hash Algorithm
Description
The name of the transform set. Specifies the type of encryption to be applied. Specifies the type of hash to be applied.
Firewall Settings
To configure global firewall settings select Configuration > Security > Firewall
Settings.
Security Options
101
where:
Parameter
Monitor Ping Attack Monitor TCP SYN Attack Monitor IP Session Attack Prevent L2 Bridging between Wireless Users Drop All IP Fragments
Description
Monitors incoming pings. Monitors SYN attacks. Monitors IP session attacks. Prevents wireless users from creating ad hoc networks.
Enforce TCP Requires completion of TCP session negotiation before Handshake Before allowing incoming packets. Allowing Data Prohibit IP Spoofing Prohibit RST Replay Attack Log ICMP Errors Disable stateful SIP Processing Allow Tri-session with DNAT Session Mirror Destination Prevents IP spoofing. Prevents RST replay attacks. Logs ICMP (for example, ping) errors. TBC TBC TBC
Disable FTP server Prevents FTP transfers. To apply the new firewall settings, click Apply.
102
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Service Aliases
Service aliases aid in policy configuration by applying a human-readable label to protocols numbers or groups of protocol numbers. To manage service aliases, navigate to Configuration > Security > Advanced > Services, as shown in the figure below.
Security Options
103
Service Name A human-readable name to identify the service alias. Default service aliases begin with svc- followed by the protocol name. This convention may be used if desired, or a new one may be used. Protocol Services can be defined by TCP port numbers, UDP port numbers, or IP protocol number. If a particular service can operate over both TCP and UDP , create two separate services aliases. Starting Port For TCP or UDP services, specifies the lower port number of a port range. To specify a single port, enter the same number in both the starting and ending field. End Port For TCP or UDP services, specifies the upper port number of a port range. To specify a single port, enter the same number in both the starting and ending field. The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is:
Source/Destination Aliases
Source and destination aliases aid in policy configuration by applying a human-readable label to IP addresses and groups of IP addresses. Source/destination aliases are used in traffic policies to specify either the source of a packet or the destination of a packet. To manage source/destination aliases, navigate to Configuration > Security > Advanced > Destinations, as shown in the figure below.
104
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
User When a traffic policy containing the user alias is applied to an authenticated user, this alias is replaced by the IP address assigned to that user. With this alias, generic traffic policies can be configured that will automatically be customized at the time of user login. Mswitch This policy represents the switch IP address (loopback address or VLAN 1 address) of the Aruba switch on which the traffic policy is running. This alias is used in the captive portal policy, as well as in many destination NAT policies. Any Represents any IP address. To add a new source/destination alias, click Add, as shown in the figure below. Configuration options are: Destination Name A human-readable name for the alias. This name appears in all traffic policies making use of this source/destination alias. Invert Specifies that the inverse of the addresses entered should be used. For example, if a network of 172.16.0.0/16 is entered, the invert option specifies that the policy should match everything except 172.16.0.0/16.
Source/destination aliases contain one or more IP addresses or ranges of IP addresses. To add a new address or address range, click the Add button. Three choices are available: Host A single IP address. When entering a single IP address, do not fill in the netmask/range field. Network An IP subnet, consisting of a network number and subnet mask. Range A range of IP addresses consisting of all sequential addresses between a lower value and an upper value. Enter the lower value in the IP Address field, and the upper value in the Network Mask/Range field. The maximum number of addresses in the range is 16 if larger ranges are needed, please convert the range into a network number with a subnet mask and use the Network option. The equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is:
netdestination Internal_Network host 10.14.1.22 network 172.16.0.0 255.255.0.0 range 192.168.1.1 192.168.1.17
Bandwidth Contracts
Bandwidth contracts can be applied on a per-role, per-user, and per-VLAN basis. When applied to a VLAN, the contract only limits multicast traffic and does not affect other data. This is useful because an AP can only send multicast traffic at the rate of the slowest associated station, and because, for compatibility reasons, it is rarely possible to remove the low data rates.. Thus excessive multicast traffic will fill the buffers of the APs, causing frame loss and poor voice quality. As a general rule, every system should have a bandwidth contract of 1Mbps or perhaps even 700Kbps, and it should be applied to all VLANs with which users are associated, especially those VLANs which pass directly through to the upstream router. The exception would be VLANs used intentionally for high speed multicasts, where the SSID is configured without low data rates. To configure bandwidth contracts, go to Configuration > Security > Bandwidth
Contracts.
You can create a bandwidth contract on a VLAN to rate limit only multicast and broadcast packets. The syntax is:
Chapter 4
NAT Pools
To create the collection of IP addresses that are assigned to users inside the firewall, go to Configuration > Security > NAT Pools.
Time Range
To define a time range select Configuration > Security > Advanced > Time Range. The Time Range screen appears.
Security Options
107
Additional Information
This section contains background information on key concepts discussed in this chapter.
Encryption
Encrypting the transmitted data is only one part of the security process. Although this affords some security, all the common data encryption schemes such as WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) have been broken and anyone with the software can read your data in plain text.
Phase I Negotiations
The negation of a contract initially involves three basic steps:
z z z
Policy negotiation consists of four mandatory parameters: encryption algorithm (DES, 3DES), hash algorithm, authentication method, and Diffie-Hellman (DH) group. During the DH exchange only the base information required to generate the actual keys is exchanged. Authentication of the DH key exchange is done to assure that the keys were generated and correctly passed.
Phase II Negotiations
Phase II is the negotiation of the algorithms used to encrypt the payload data. This is comprised of 3 steps:
108
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
z z z
Policy Negotiation Session key materials are exchanged or renewed As (Security Associations), keys, and SPI (Security Parameters Index) are passed to the IPSec driver.
IPSec
IP was originally developed within a highly restricted, secure network. Therefore, IP did not have security features built in. Once the Internet became a public forum, security became a critical need. This need has been, and continues to be addressed by the IETF which had developed a suite of security protocols under the umbrella of IP Security, or IPSec. IPSec defines two encryption modes: Transport mode (which only encrypts the data in a packet) and Tunnel mode (which encrypts the entire packet). All encrypted traffic must be decrypted upon receipt. Therefore, the receiving node (which also must be IPSec compliant) uses a decryption device called a key, which it shares with the encrypting node. The key, known as a public key, is shared between the two communicating nodes by means of the Internet Security Association and Key Management Protocol (ISAKMP).
WEP Encryption
WEP encryption comes in two basic flavors 64-bit and 128-bit encryption. Obviously, the 128-bit version offers stronger encryption. When using WEP both sender and receiver must be using the same key to decrypt the transmitted data. WEP allows for rotation of keys and most equipment will allow you to have as many as 4 keys. Some equipment supports WEP Mapped Keys which are MAC keyed pairwise keys. In this scheme each unique pair of MAC address share a unique WEP key. The pairing is stored in a MIB table.
Security Options
109
Authentication
Authentication of users is critical to protect network resources and data. There are a number of methods for authenticating users/clients. Authentication verifies the identity of users attempting to associate with the network. Authentication in and of itself is not secure. Authentication requests as with all data transmitted over wireless should be encrypted with a form of strong encryption. Authentication should always be coupled with strong firewall policies and/or Access Control Lists (ACLs) which carefully define user roles. Authenticated users should be carefully classified and assigned roles according to their legitimate business needs for access to various resources and data on the network. Aruba AirOS supports 3 basic types of authentication
110
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
RADIUS
RADIUS (Remote Authentication Dial In User Service) originally developed in 1992 is probably the most widely deployed method of client authentication. The RADIUS protocol is described in RFC 2138 (1). It is a highly extensible UDP client/server application protocol. A full implementation of the protocol consists of a RADIUS server and a separate RADIUS Accounting server bound to UDP ports 1812 and 1813 respectively. Usually, both services are combined into a single server daemon. RADIUS servers support several authentication methods, including:
LDAP
LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocol) is defined by RFC 1777 (1995). Originally designed at the University of Michigan to adapt a highly complex directory system to the internet. LDAP provides a means to access complex directory structures to verify user name and password information for authentication.
Security Options
111
MAC
MAC authentication uses the MAC address of the client device to establish an identity for authentication. The actual authentication may be done by RADIUS, LDAP , or Local Database on the switch.
z Microsoft Windows XP with built-in PPTP VPN and L2TP/IPSec support z Microsoft Windows 2000 with built-in PPTP VPN and L2TP/IPSec support z Microsoft Windows NT 4.0 z Microsoft Windows ME z Microsoft Windows 98SE z Microsoft Windows Mobile 203/CE 4.2 with built-in L2TP/IPSec VPN support (PDA)
z Apple MacOS 10.x with built-in PPTP and L2TP/IPSec VPN support z PalmOS 5.x with built-in PPTP VPN z Mergic PPTP VPN for PalmOS 3.54.x z Movian VPN for PalmOS 3.55.x z Movian VPN for Microsoft Windows Mobile/CE z Linux VPNC
PDA, you may not be able to easily exit applications. If necessary, press the reset button and start over.
2. Set up a wireless connection with static WEP . 3. Navigate to Start > Settings > Connections > Edit my VPN servers.
112
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
host IP
7. Navigate to Settings > Connections. 8. Select the Advanced tab. 9. Select Select Networks. 10. Click Exceptions. 11. Click Add new URL. 12. Type */* and click OK. By default Windows mobile 2003 uses unencrypted frames to pass browser data unless it matches the exception list. If you have a proxy server:
z z
Navigate to Settings > Connections > Set up my proxy server. Follow the on-screen instructions.
At this point, if you have wireless connectivity, you should be able to click on the icon at the top of the screen with the two arrows pointing left and right next to the speaker icon. 13. Select Connect VPN. You should be connected and every thing should be working.
NOTEWith AirOS 2.2 or lower, L2TP/IPSEC clients terminating on anything other than the switch IP (loopback or VLAN 1) required the server IP to be in the emulate servers table for dest-natting purposes. With AirOS 2.3.0.0 and higher, this restriction has been removed. The only IPs needed in the emulate servers table are the IPs not present on the current switch itself.
Security Options
113
4. After copying, open the File Explorer on the PDA. 5. Locate where the file was copied to. If following the previous suggestions, it would be under "My Device". 6. Run ArubaReg.exe. A message should show the status of all the L2TP/IPSec entries. The program only needs to be run once after a new entry is created. It will modify the registry in the entries for all L2TP/IPSec entries present in the PDA.
114
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 4
Security Options
115
116
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Part
Switch Configuration
115
116
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
VLANs
Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) are used to divide LAN traffic into manageable broadcast domains. Using VLANs, the LAN can be divided into smaller, logical networks, such as to segregate wireless traffic from the rest of the LAN. VLANs are created in two parts: first the network interface for the VLAN must be defined on the switch, and then physical switch ports must be added to the VLAN.
Common Tasks
117
(aruba) # configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z (aruba) (config) # vlan 2
3
Set the DHCP server for relaying DHCP requests for the interface:
(aruba) (config-subif)# ip helper-address 172.16.14.9
If the DHCP server is on the same subnet as the VLAN interface, then you do not need to create an IP helper address.
5
For example, to select slot 2, ports 0 through 23, enter the following:
118
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 5
Port Trunks
Port trunks allow multiple VLANs on one interface. For example, to configure a Fast Ethernet port interface as an 802.1q trunk, the following configuration commands could be used:
(aruba) (config)# interface fastethernet 2/5 (aruba) (config-if)# switchport trunk allowed vlan 4-5 (aruba) (config-if)# switchport mode trunk (aruba) (config-if)# no shutdown
(Select slot and port) (Set VLAN 4 and 5) (Activate trunk) (Enable port)
Spanning Tree
Aruba WLAN switches support Common Spanning Tree (CST), Per VLAN Spanning Tree (PVST), Multiple instance STP (MISTP), Per VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+), and Rapid Spanning Tree (RSTP) protocols.
Common Tasks
119
Set the spanning tree forward interval. Set the spanning tree hello interval. Set the spanning tree maximum age interval.
z priority <level>
Set the spanning tree priority level.
(aruba) (config)# interface <interface type> <slot>/<port> (aruba> (config-if)# spanning-tree <options...>
Where the following options can be configured:
z port-priority <value>
Set the interfaces spanning tree priority.
z portfast
Change the interface from blocking to forwarding mode.
z Configuration file (for example default.cfg) z wmf database z RF plan database z Local user database
A backup requires that all four files be copied and placed on a external system. To recover or restore a configuration to the WLAN switch, these four files must be copied to the switch from the external system.
120
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 5
For example:
You should see the configuration file and any backup you created. NOTEIn AirOS 2.2.1.0, you can also use tar flash and wms export-db commands to make backups.
Common Tasks
121
copy flash: <source filename> tftp: <TFTP server address> <destination filename>
For example:
For example:
copy tftp: <TFTP server address> <backup filename> flash: <original filename>
For example:
122
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 5
Upload the new software image to an FTP or TFTP server on your network and verify the network connection.
Place the software image file in the root directory of your FTP or TFTP server. The switch must have a valid network route to the FTP or TFTP server. You can verify the route using the ping command from the switch CLI:
ping <destination IP address>
(aruba) # ping 10.1.1.234 Type escape sequence to abort. Sending 5, 100-byte ICMP Echoes to 10.1.1.234, timeout is 2 seconds: !!!!! Success rate is 100 percent (5/5), round-trip min/avg/max = 1/1/1 ms
3 4
Backup your switch configuration (see page 120). Determine which memory partition will be used to hold the new software image.
Of the switchs four memory partitions, two are used to hold switch software images. One of the partitions holds the active software image and the other generally holds a backup. When loading new software, it is recommended to load the new image into the backup partition. In this way, if there is a failure during the download process, the active partition is not compromised. Later, after the download is confirmed, the partition with the new software image is automatically selected for active use, keeping the old image as a backup.
Common Tasks
123
(aruba) # show image version ---------------------------------Partition : 0:0 (/dev/hda1) **Default boot** Software Version : 1.0.0.0 Build number : 1654 Built on : Tue Apr 15 04:52:19 PDT 2003 ---------------------------------Partition : 0:1 (/dev/hda2) /dev/hda2: Image not present ---------------------------------Partition : 1:0 (/dev/hdc1) Not plugged in. ---------------------------------Partition : 1:1 (/dev/hdc2) Not plugged in.
In this example, partition 0 contains the active image and partition 1 is empty. To protect the active image, in the following steps we will load the new image into partition 1. 5
For example:
(aruba) # copy tftp: 10.1.1.234 A5000_2.0.6.0 system: partition1 Upgrading partition1 ............................................................ Copied image successfully. The system will boot from partition1 during the next reboot.
124
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 5
(aruba) # show image version ---------------------------------Partition : 0:0 (/dev/hda1) Software Version : 1.0.0.0 Build number : 1654 Built on : Tue Apr 15 04:52:19 PDT 2003 ---------------------------------Partition : 0:1 (/dev/hda2) **Default boot** Software Version : 1.5.0.0 Build number : 412 Built on : Tue May 15 08:01:24 PDT 2003 ---------------------------------Partition : 1:0 (/dev/hdc1) Not plugged in. ---------------------------------Partition : 1:1 (/dev/hdc2) Not plugged in.
In this example, the new image can be seen in partition 1. 7
Common Tasks
125
126
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 5
Log in as the administrator and enter privileged mode. Erase the switch configuration.
(aruba) # write erase Write Erase successful (aruba) # _
Performing a write erase will also remove the certificate that was uploaded for the Web UI.
(aruba) # reload
When the switch reboots, perform initial setup as described in Chapter 2 on page 9.
Common Tasks
127
128
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
z Static Access Point (AP) configuration z Static Air Monitor (AM) configuration z Access Point Monitor (APM) until needed to recover for a
failed device.
Required Components
z An Aruba Access Point acting as an Air Monitor (AM)
When acting as an AM, the Aruba Access Point works with the Mobility Controller to analyze WLAN traffic in order to classify and enforce security policies. The Aruba Access Point can be configured as a full-time, dedicated AM. It can also be configured to act as AM unless a network failure requires it to automatically become an Access Point (AP).
Air Management
129
WLAN Classification
The WMS continually monitors wireless traffic to detect any new AP or wireless client station that tries to connect to the network. When an AP or wireless client is detected, it is classified and its classification is used in order to determine the security policies which should be enforced on the device.
AP Classifications
AP are classified as one of the following:
z Valid AP (VAP)
An AP that is part of the enterprise providing WLAN services is a valid AP . An AP will be classified as valid under the following circumstances:
z z z
The Aruba AP successfully connects with the switch and loads its software and configuration, or The AP is manually classified as valid by the administrator, or If AP learning is enabled (see page 131), every new AP is classified as valid.
z Interfering AP (IAP)
An AP that is part of a foreign network in a multi-tenancy environment is an Interfering AP . An AP will be classified as interfering under the following circumstances:
z z
An AP can be manually classified as IAP by the administrator, or If AP learning is disabled (see page 131), every new AP is classified as Interfering.
z Unsecure AP (UAP)
An AP that is part of the enterprise by illegally connected to the network is an Unsecure AP . An AP will be classified as unsecure under the following circumstances:
z z
An AP can be manually classified as UAP by the administrator, or The WMS analyzes MAC addresses from the IAPs and the LAN to determine whether an IAP should be classified as a UAP .
If the AM is segregated from the LAN, wired-side MAC addresses can be manually configured (see Wired-Side MAC Addresses on page 132). z DoS AP (DAP)
An AP through which administrator does not want any access to the network is a DoS AP .
130
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 6
Enforcement Policies
Enforcement policies control how the Mobility Controller handles IAPs, UAPs, and various kinds of suspicious traffic. Specific enforcement policies can be enabled or disabled based on your security needs. All policies are configured from the WMS configuration sub-mode, which is accessible as follows:
Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z (aruba) (config) # wms (aruba) (wms) # _
AP Policies
The following policies provide control for AP behavior.
AP Learning
Learning affects the way APs are classified (see AP Classifications on page 130). To enable or disable learning, use the following command:
Air Management
131
Protect Unsecure AP
If this policy is enabled, WMS prevents any wireless client station from accessing the WLAN by connecting through a UAP . The policy is configured as follows:
Protect Misconfigured AP
The administrator can specify the configuration attributes that are part of a VAP . Then, if this policy is enabled, WMS prevents any wireless client station from accessing the WLAN by connecting to a misconfigured AP .
Attributes
wpa privacy short-preamble
Description
Wired Protected Access WEP privacy key Short preamble
132
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 6
z SSID list:
(aruba) (wms) # valid-ssid <SSID> mode {enable|disable}
1.When entered as a command parameter, Organizationally Unique Identifiers (OUIs) must use the following hexadecimal format:
xx:yy:zz:ff:ff:ff
where xx:yy:zz is the organization ID, and ff:ff:ff is the required mask. For example:
00:0b:86:ff:ff:ff
Air Management 133
AP Load Balancing
The AP load balancing feature allows the system to balance wireless traffic across adjacent APs. Load balancing can be triggered based on the number of users or degree of utilization on an AP . When traffic reaches the configured thresholds on an AP where load balancing is allowed, any new wireless client station attempting to associate with the saturated AP will be directed to an adjacent AP instead. Stations which are already associated with the AP not affected. For Aruba Access Points, load balancing is implemented by station management on the Mobility Controller. For third party APs, it is implemented by AMs.
134
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 6
z To set high and low watermarks for number of users per AP:
(aruba) (wms) # ap-lb-user-high-wm <number of users> (for high watermark) (aruba) (wms) # ap-lb-user-low-wm <number of users> (for low watermark)
Maximum number of retries must also be configured for load balancing. The maximum retries is the number of times a new station is encouraged to move to an adjacent access point. If the station still attempts to associate with the AP after that, association is allowed. Use the following commands to configure maximum retries:
Air Management
135
Valid STA
If a station is classified as VSTA and connects to an IAP , the AM will disrupt the connection if this policy is enabled. The policy is configured as follows:
136
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 6
Interference Detection
WMS can be used to detect interference near a wireless client station or AP based on an increase in the Frame Receive Error Rate and Frame Fragmentation Rate. If this policy is enabled, an increase in the expected rates will generate a syslog event. The policy is configured as follows:
Air Management
137
Statistics Events
WMS can generate events when particular statistics exceed configured thresholds. Both high and low watermark values can be specified for each statistic. When the statistic exceeds the high watermark, an event is generated. No new events are generated until the statistic value falls below the low watermark. If a statistic watermark value is set to 0, event generation is disabled for that statistic. Statistics events can be generated for the following:
(aruba) (wms) # event-threshold frr-high-wm <high threshold> (aruba) (wms) # event-threshold frr-low-wm <low threshold>
(aruba) (wms) # event-threshold ffr-high-wm <high threshold> (aruba) (wms) # event-threshold ffr-low-wm <low threshold>
(aruba) (wms) # event-threshold frer-high-wm <high threshold> (aruba) (wms) # event-threshold frer-low-wm <low threshold>
(aruba) (wms) # event-threshold bwr-high-wm <high threshold> (aruba) (wms) # event-threshold bwr-low-wm <low threshold>
(aruba) (wms) # event-threshold fnur-high-wm <high threshold> (aruba) (wms) # event-threshold fnur-low-wm <low threshold>
(aruba) (wms) # event-threshold flsr-high-wm <high threshold> (aruba) (wms) # event-threshold flsr-low-wm <low threshold>
138
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 6
z Poll interval
This defines the interval in milliseconds for communication between the Mobility Controller and the Aruba Access Points and AMs. The WMS will contact the AP or AM every poll-interval to download AP to STA associations, update policy configuration changes, and download AP and STA statistics. By default, the interval is set 60000 milliseconds. This can be set to a lower value if the number of AMs deployed is small.
z Poll retries
This defines the maximum number of failed polling attempts before the polled AP is declared down.
z Grace time
This defines the buffer time for the WMS to AM communication in milliseconds. By default, this is set 2000 milliseconds.
z Laser beam
The AM sends laser beams to APs or wireless stations to enforce policies. For policy enforcement, this feature must be enabled.
Air Management
139
AP to STA
If the laser beam is impersonated as from the AP to the wireless client station (packet header ToDS = 1 and FromDS = 0), the AMs BSSID appears in the 802.11 Addr1 (BSSID) field.
z
STA to AP
If the laser beam is impersonated as from the wireless client station to the AP (packet header ToDS = 0 and FromDS = 1), the AMs BSSID appears in the 802.11 Addr1 (DA) field.
NOTEWhen laser beam debug is enabled, policies may not be enforced in some cases, as 802.11 headers are no longer standards compliant.
140
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 6 Either start a capture on an already configured remote adapter, or create a new remote adapter by assigning the name and IP address of the Air Monitor for which will be forwarding the packets. 3
On the Aruba WLAN switch, configure the AM to send captured packets to the monitoring client station.
NOTEThe AiroPeek software cannot issue commands to start the AM sending captured packets. Use the Aruba Web Interface or CLI instead. The following CLI command can be used to start the AM packet capture:
pcap raw-start <AM IP address> <client IP address> <UDP port> <format> [bssid <radio BSSID>] [channel <channel>]
With the following parameters: AM IP address Client IP address UDP port The IP address of the Air Monitor collecting packets. The IP address of the client station running the AiroPeek monitoring software. The UDP port number on the client station where the captured packets are expected to be received. NOTEMultiple AMs can send packets to the same UDP port or different UDP ports on the client station. However, if sent to different UDP ports, the AiroPeek application can display only packets collected on one UDP port at any given time. format The format for the captured packets:
channel
Air Management
141
The AiroPeek application listen for all Air Monitor packets for the configured client IP address and UDP port. All packets are processed, however, you can apply display filters on the capture window to control the number and type of packets being displayed. In the capture window, the absolute time stamps that are displayed correspond to the time that the packet was received by the client station. This time is not synchronized in any manner with the time on the Air Monitor.
The pcap ID can be found using the show pcap status command to list active packet captures.
Responding to error message: MS XML4 Active X Control is not installed on this machine. If you are using Windows XP Service Pack 2, and there is a warning box above, click on it, then choose Install. Once installation is done, click here to proceed. Click the link and following the installation instructions.
142
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 6
Air Management
143
144
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
z EAP-PEAP and EAP-TLS under Windows 2000 (see page 146) z EAP-PEAP and EAP-TLS under Windows XP (see page 154) z Cisco-PEAP under Windows XP (see page 156)
Additional information can be found at the Microsoft Web site:
http://www.microsoft.com/windowsxp/pro/techinfo/administration/wir elesssecurity/default.asp
145
Install Windows 2000 with Service Pack 3. Download and apply Windows 2000 patch Q313664.
The required patch can be found at the following Web site:
http://www.microsoft.com/windows2000/downloads/recommen ded/q313664/default.asp
146
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
Under Startup type, select Automatic from the pull-down menu. If the service has not already been started (as shown under Service status), click on the Start button. Once the service has started, click on the OK button to close the window.
147
In the Network Connections window, right-click on the Wireless Network Connection entry and select the properties option from the popup menu.
148
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
4Ste
In the Wireless network properties window, select the Association tab and set the following properties:
z Network Authentication: Select Open from the pull-down menu. z Data encryption: Select WEP from the pull-down menu. z The key is provided to me automatically:
If using dynamic WEP , check this box. Otherwise uncheck the box and enter the WEP keys manually.
149
NOTETo configure settings on the Authentication tab, you must be a member of the local Administrators group. In the Wireless network properties window, select the Authentication tab and set the following properties:
z Enable IEEE 802.1x authentication for the network: Check this box to
enable 802.1x authentication.
150
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
z Validate server certificate: Check this box. This will verify that the server
certificate presented to your computer is still valid.
151
Check the box if you want to automatically use the Windows logon name and password as your user credentials. Otherwise, you will have to enter the user credentials manually. If you check this box make sure your windows name and password are the user credentials configured on the Authentication Server (e.g., IAS).
This informs you that a certificate or other credentials are required to access the network. Click on the message to open the user credentials entry window. Specify your user credentials and click on the OK button.
152
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
The wireless client station adapter should now use EAP authentication and the following type of message appears:
This message indicates the root certification authority for the server's certificate. If this indicates the correct certification authority, click on the OK button to accept the connection. Otherwise, click Cancel. Upon successful logon, the status of your Wireless Network Connection will indicate Authentication succeeded:
153
Install Windows XP with Service Pack 1a. Enable the Wireless Network Connection.
From the Windows Start menu, select Control Panel | Network Connections.
If not already enabled, right-click on the Wireless Network Connection entry and select the enable option from the popup menu.
154
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
Select the Access Point for association. z In the Network Connections window, right-click on the Wireless Network
Connection entry and select the properties option from the popup menu.
z Select the option to Use Windows to configure my wireless network settings. This will ensure that Windows is in charge of the wireless connection properties.
z In the Available networks list, select the AP to which you wish to associate, and click on the Configure button. This will open the Wireless Network properties window. 4
155
Install Windows XP with Service Pack 1/1a. Install the Cisco ACU (version 5.05.001 and higher) which includes the Cisco-PEAP supplicant.
NOTEAlthough Windows XP-SP1/SP1a includes the Microsoft PEAP supplicant, it is not compatible with the Cisco PEAP supplicant. To use the Cisco PEAP supplicant, you must install the Cisco-ACU after SP1/SP1a for Windows XP . The latest drivers for the Cisco Wireless Network Adapter can be found at:
http://www.cisco.com/public/sw-center/sw-wireless.shtml
From the Start menu, select Control Panel | Administrative Tools | Services. In the Services window, locate and double-click on the Wireless Zero Configuration item.
156
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
This will launch the Properties window for the Wireless Zero Configuration service. 3
157
z Client Name: Specify the name of the wireless client station (My-Station in
this example).
z SSID1: Specify the SSID of the associated AP (My-AP in this example). z Network type: Select the Infrastructure option.
158
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
z Network Security Type: Select Host Based EAP from the pull-down menu. z WEP: Select the Use Dynamic WEP Keys option.
When finished, click the OK button to close the window. 5
In the profile manager, select Use Selected Profile and choose the Office profile.
159
If not already enabled, right-click on the Wireless Network Connection entry and select the enable option from the popup menu.
160
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
Select the Access Point for association. z In the Network Connections window, right-click on the Wireless Network
Connection entry and select the properties option from the popup menu.
z Select the option to Use Windows to configure my wireless network settings. This will ensure that Windows is in charge of the wireless connection properties.
z In the Available networks list, select the AP to which you wish to associate, and click on the Configure button. This will open the Wireless Network properties window.
161
In the Wireless network properties window, select the Association tab and set the following properties:
z Network Authentication: Select Open from the pull-down menu. z Data encryption: Select WEP from the pull-down menu. z The key is provided to me automatically: Check this box.
162
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
NOTETo configure settings on the Authentication tab, you must be a member of the local Administrators group. In the Wireless network properties window, select the Authentication tab and set the following properties:
z Enable IEEE 802.1x authentication for the network: Check this box to
enable 802.1x authentication.
163
z Validate server certificate: Check this box. This will verify that the server
certificate presented to your computer is still valid.
164
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
z Second Phase EAP Type: Select the Generic Token Card option and click
on properties.
In the Generic Token Card Properties window, select either Static Password or One Time Password (OTP).
For OTP (hardware token), the appropriate support must be installed on the Authentication Server (for example: Cisco-ACS + RSA ACE Server Agent).
This informs you that a certificate or other credentials are required to access the network. Click on the message to configure user credentials. Depending on whether a Static Password or OTP was chosen, one of the following appears:
165
z Static Password:
z OTP:
For OTP , select either the Hardware Token or Software Token option. If you select Software Token, the Password field on the One Time Password screen becomes the PIN field.
Enter your PEAP authentication user name and password (which are registered with the RADIUS server). If using a Static Password, select your domain name from the drop-down list (or type it in if applicable). When finished, click on the OK button. The wireless client station adapter should now use EAP authentication.
166
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 7
This message indicates the root certification authority for the server's certificate. If this indicates the correct certification authority, click on the OK button to accept the connection. Otherwise, click Cancel. Upon successful logon, the status of your Wireless Network Connection will indicate Authentication succeeded:
167
168
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
General Configuration
169
To set the switch role from the CLI, use the command masterip from configuration mode. If this is configured as 127.0.0.1, the switch is a master. If this is configured as any other value, the switch becomes a local switch.
170
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
To set the loopback address through the CLI, enter the following command:
Mobility Configuration
To enable mobility, select the Enable Mobility checkbox.
171
Finally, enable Wi-Fi MUX operation in the GUI by navigating to Configuration > Switch > General. Under the MUX Configuration section, enable MUX operation as shown in the figure below. The MUX Server IP address is the loopback or switch IP address of the MUX Server. On the Wi-Fi MUX itself, do not configure the MUX VLANs section. To enable MUX Server operation, VLANs should be created on the switch as described above. Conceptually, the GRE tunnel from the MUX will be treated as a tagged VLAN port. To specify which VLANs are extended to the MUX,
172
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
navigate to Configuration > Switch > General and specify them in the MUX VLANs section. In the example below, the MUX Server is configured to terminate VLANs 22 and 23 from remote MUXes.
173
174
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
Port Configuration
To configure physical ports on the Aruba switch, navigate to Configuration >
175
Port Selection
To select ports manually, click on the appropriate port(s) in the Port Selection section. Positioning the mouse over each port will show the current status for that port in the Configuration Details section. Multiple ports may be selected for configuration by clicking on each port once.
176
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
To select multiple ports from the CLI, enter commands in the form:
Port Mode Sets the mode of the port with respect to VLAN tagging. If the port is set to access, untagged frames will be sent and received on the port, and all traffic will be part of a single VLAN. If the port is set to trunk, tagged frames will be sent and received. VLAN
z If the port is set to access mode, a single port-based VLAN will be configured here.
z If the port is set to trunk mode, a native VLAN and a list of allowed VLANs
can be configured. The native VLAN specifies the VLAN to which untagged ingress traffic will be mapped. In addition to the native VLAN, the port may be configured to allow all other VLANs in the switch, or to allow only a specific list of VLANs. Firewall Policy Applies a firewall policy to the physical port. Firewall policies are created under Configuration > Security > Policies. Enable MUX Specifies that this port connects to a third-party AP for which the switch will perform the Wi-Fi MUX function. See the section on configuring Wi-Fi MUX for more details. Spanning Tree TBC CLI configuration of interfaces is done using the interface command. An example interface configuration is:
interface fastethernet 2/12 description "To-Bldg4" trusted poe cisco switchport access vlan 4
VLAN Configuration
VLANs configuration on an Aruba switch is similar to that of a standard L2/L3 switch. VLANs can exist locally only, or can be extended to other devices in the network through VLAN tagging. VLANs can exist purely for L2 segmentation, or can have IP addresses assigned. When IP addresses are assigned, the switch will automatically act as a router and perform L3 forwarding between VLANs.
178
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
VLAN 1 is the default VLAN. All ports are part of VLAN 1 until configured otherwise. VLAN 1 cannot be deleted.
If desired, a DHCP helper may be configured for the VLAN. If this option is enabled, all DHCP broadcasts on the VLAN will be unicast-forwarded to the specified DHCP server. When using this option, ensure that there is only one DHCP helper on the VLAN and that the Aruba switch has not been configured as a DHCP server.
The figure below shows the addition of a new VLAN with VLAN ID 26. The Aruba switch interface in the VLAN has IP address 10.26.1.1/24, and a DHCP helper has been configured with all DHCP requests forwarded to 10.4.1.22.
Tunnels
Tunnels.
To configure generic tunnels for the switch, navigate to Configuration > Switch >
180
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
IP Route Configuration
Aruba AirOS supports configuration of static IP routes. To configure these, navigate to Configuration > Switch > IP Routing. On the Aruba 5000, two default routes can be configured one for the management Ethernet port only, and one for the rest of the switch. On other models, a single default gateway may be configured. Costs may be specified on routes to specify priority for multiple routes to the same destination a lower cost equals a higher priority. To configure a static route other than the default route, click Add button and fill in the required parameters as shown in the figure below.
181
VRRP Configuration
AirOS 2.2 supports redundant switch configurations using Virtual Router Redundancy Protocol (VRRP) as the backup mechanism. Please see the Redundancy Design Guide for more information on creating redundant configurations. NOTEAruba recommends that the redundant master switches be of the same type (for example, A5000 to A5000) and configured with the same version of AirOS. The same applies to redundant local switches (same class of switch running same version of AirOS. . The Virtual Router To enable VRRP , navigate to Configuration > Switch > VRRP Table will display all redundant networks in which the switch currently participates.
182
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
Description An optional description of the VRRP instance that can be used for administrator convenience. IP Address The virtual IP address that will be created and used by the VRRP instance. This is the IP address that will be redundant it will be active on the VRRP master, and will become active on the VRRP backup in the event that the VRRP master fails. This IP address must be part of the IP subnet configured on the VLAN, and must be unique the address cannot be the loopback address of the switch, or the address of any VLAN interface. This is the IP address to which Access Points will connect, and should be the address configured as the LMS for an AP Group (see the WLAN-Advanced section of this guide for more information.) Enable Router Pre-emption When enabled, a switch with a higher VRRP priority will always become active while a switch with the lower VRRP priority will always be backup. While this may be desirable in stateless routers, it is recommended that pre-emption be disabled in Aruba switches to avoid excessive interruption to users, or flapping if a problematic switch is cycling up and down. Priority Defines which switch will become VRRP master if pre-emption has been enabled. These values should be different on each member of the redundant pair. A higher number specifies higher priority. This value must be between 1 and 254. Admin State Can be set either up or down. When down, VRRP is not active, although the configuration information is retained. VLAN Specifies the VLAN on which VRRP is active. If the redundant switch pair is connected to more than one VLAN, each VLAN should have a VRRP configuration.
183
The figure below shows a sample VRRP configuration. In this example, the switch has an IP address of 172.16.4.254 configured on VLAN 4. The other switch in the redundant pair also has VLAN 4 configured, with an IP address of 172.16.4.253. The Virtual IP address managed by VRRP is 172.16.4.252.
vrrp 1 priority 1 authentication Floor2 ip address 172.16.4.252 description "Floor 2 Switch1" vlan 4 no shutdown
184
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
2. When two SCs are present in the chassis, SC-0 is dedicated to LC-2 only and SC-1 is dedicated to LC-3 only. In this case, there are two Gigabits of bandwidth available between each LC and SC pairs.
2. Remove SC-0. 3. Install SC-1, LC-2 and LC-3. Configure Layer-2 and Layer-3 on ports 2/ and 3/. 4. Install all the cards. SC-0 will use only LC-2 and SC-l will use only LC-3. However, if one of the SC is removed, the other SC will take over an use the previously set configuration.
Basic Switch Configuration 185
186
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
187
ip dhcp pool vlan26-pool default-router 10.26.1.1 dns-server 192.168.1.10 domain-name net26.test.com lease 0 8 0 network 10.26.1.0 255.255.255.0
188
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 8
189
190
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Background
The IEEE 802.1x standard defines a Layer 2, port-based network access control scheme that provides authenticated network access on wireless Ethernet networks. The ability of a device to transmit and receive data over an Ethernet switch port is denied if the authentication process is unsuccessful. This standard was originally developed for traditional wired networks and has been successfully adapted for use with wireless networks.
802.1x Configuration
191
192
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
EAP-TTLS (EAP- Tunnelled TLS Authentication Protocol) is an EAP protocol that extends EAP-TLS. In EAP-TLS, a TLS handshake is used to mutually authenticate a client and server. EAP-TTLS extends this authentication negotiation by using the secure connection established by the TLS handshake to exchange additional information between client and server. In EAP-TTLS, the TLS handshake may be mutual; or it may be one-way, in which only the server is authenticated to the client. PEAP (Protected EAP) is an authentication protocol that uses TLS to enhance the security of other EAP authentication methods. PEAP for Microsoft 802.1X Authentication Client provides support for EAP-TLS, which uses certificates for both server authentication and client authentication, and Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol version 2 (EAP-MS-CHAP v2), which uses certificates for server authentication and password-based credentials for client authentication. RADIUS (Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service) is a distributed client/server system that secures networks against unauthorized access. Aruba-5000 can be configured as a RADIUS Client and send authentication requests to the configured RADIUS servers that contains all user authentication and network service access information. Supplicant An entity at one end of a point-to-point LAN segment that is being authenticated by an authenticator attached to the other end of that link. Example: Win-XP/2K Wireless station is a supplicant. TLS (Transport Layer Security) provide privacy and data integrity between two communicating applications.
802.1x Configuration
193
194
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL Z. NOTEThe command reference for this action may be found in RADIUS Commands on page 830.
authport Port number used for authentication host The IP address of the RADIUS server.
inservice Bring server in service immediately. key mode Shared secret text string Enable or Disable as an authentication server
retransm Maximum times a RADIUS request is retried it timeout Specify time period between RADIUS requests.
Verify that the radius server was created. RADIUS server is created with the default values, unless otherwise specified.
Type show aaa radius-server <Enter>
Auth Server List ---------------Pri Host IP addr Port Acct Retries Timeout Secret --- ------------- ---- ------- ------- -----1 IAS 10.1.1.214 1812 1813 3 5 tamales
Status -----Enabled
Inservice ----Yes
802.1x Configuration
195
Mode = 'Enabled' Default Role = 'employee' Auth Server List ---------------Pri Name Type Status Inservice Applied --- -------------------- ------1 ARUBA2 RADIUS Enabled Yes 1
The order in which servers are queried is determined by their priority. The server with the highest priority (priority = 1) is queried first. 2 If the priority of the server is too low, change the priority with the aaa dot1x auth-server command.
Type aaa dot1x auth-server <server name> <priority> <number> <Enter>.
196
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL Z. NOTEThe command reference for this action may be found in Access Control List Commands on page 835. The system will display a screen similar to this:
(Aruba) #configure t Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z (Aruba) (config) #
5 Create an ACL with the name TestEmpl-acl (you may choose any name you wish).
Type ip access-list session TestEmpl-acl <Enter>
802.1x Configuration
197
Specify any for the source, destination, and port parameters and permit for the action parameter.
Type any any any permit <Enter>
(Aruba) (config) #user-role TestEmployee (Aruba) (config-role) #session-acl TestEmpl-acl (Aruba) (config-role) #
Type exit<Enter> to exit the config-role mode.
(Aruba) (config) #user-role TestEmployee (Aruba) (config-role) #session-acl TestEmpl-acl (Aruba) (config-role) #exit (Aruba) (config) #
3 Assign the TestEmployee role as the default role for all users authenticated using 802.1X
Type aaa dot1x default-role TestEmployee <Enter>
198
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
(Aruba) (config) #show aaa dot1x Mode = 'Enabled' Default Role = 'TestEmployee' Auth Server List ---------------Pri Name Type Status Inservice Applied --- ---- ----------------- ------1 IAS RADIUS Enabled Yes 1
You may also view the rights that are assigned to the user (TestEmployee)
Type show rights TestEmployee <Enter>.
(Aruba) (config) #show rights TestEmployee Derived Role Bandwidth = Session ACL Session ACL ACL = 19 = 'TestEmployee' No Limit count = 1 List = TestEmpl-acl
TestEmpl-acl -----------Priority Source Destination Service Action Opcode TimeRange Log Expired Queue -------- ------ ----------- ------- ------ ------ --------- --- ------- ----1 any any any permit Low Expired Policies (due to time constraints) = 0
802.1x Configuration
199
dot1x default
The dot1x default command resets the dot1x state machine configuration to its default values.
dot1x multicast-keyrotation
The dot1x multicast-keyrotation command enables the rotation of multicast keys. Multicast keys are used to encrypt multicast packets generated for each AP . Multicast keys are associated with each essid. Default: Disabled
dot1x re-authentication
The dot1x re-authentication command enables the re-authentication of supplicants. Re-authorization occurs after a specific amount of time has elapsed from the last authentication. The time period is specified using the dot1x timeout reauthperiod command (see below). Unicast keys are updated after each re-authorization. Default: Disabled
200
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Dot1x server
The dot1x server commands are used for setting the back-end authentication server configuration.
dot1x timeout
The dot1x timeout commands are used for setting the periods of the timers used in the 802.1x authenticator.
802.1x Configuration
201
202
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
(A5000) #show dot1x config Authentication Server Timeout: 30 Seconds Client Response Timeout: 30 Seconds Fail Timeout: 30 Seconds Client Retry Count: 3 Server Retry Count: 2 Key Retry Count: 1 Reauthentication: Disabled Reauthentication Time Interval: 86400 Seconds Multicast Key Rotation: Disabled Multicast Key Rotation Time Interval: 1800 Seconds Unicast Key Rotation: Disabled Unicast Key Rotation Time Interval: 900 Seconds Countermeasure: Disabled Wired Clients: Enabled Enforce Machine Authentication: Disabled Machine Auth Cache Timeout: 24 Hours Machine Auth Default Role: guest User Auth Default Role: guest WPA Key Retry Count: 3 WPA Key Timeout: 1 Ignore EAPOL-Start after Authentication: Disabled (A5000) #
802.1x Configuration
203
(Aruba) #show dot1x ap-table list-aps AP Table -------MAC IP Essid Enabled Type -------- ------- ---00:30:f1:71:94:08 10.3.25.253 aruba Yes SAP 00:30:f1:71:94:08 10.3.25.253 guest Yes SAP 00:0b:86:80:24:10 10.3.8.191 alpha No SAP
Location Vlan Enc -------- ---- --1.2.3 1 Static-TKIP 1.2.3 7 Static WEP 1.1.1 1 Dynamic WEP
static-wep
Displays the static wep keys of all the APs. The information includes:
z AP MAC Address z WEP Key and Size for each of the four keys.
dynamic wep Displays the dynamic wep keys of all the APs. The information includes:
z AP MAC Address z WEP Key, Size, and Slot for the two keys.
tkip Displays the tkip keys for all APs.
z z
204
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
z z z z z
Authentication Status (yes/no) AP MAC Encryption Key Authorization Mode EAP type
z z z z z z z
The supplicants MAC Address User name The number of times the supplicant has been successfully authenticated. The total number of times the supplicant sent invalid user credentials and/or entered an incorrect password. The number of times authorization requests timed out. The number of times the supplicant has successfully reauthenticated. The number of times a Supplicant NAK occurred. This may be due to an EAP mismatch between the supplicant and authentication server, or if the server has been configured for multiple EAP types. The number of times the Unicast key associated with the supplicant has been rotated. with the supplicant has been rotated.
Auth-Fails
Auth-Tmout Reauths
Supp-Naks
z z
UKeyRotations
802.1x Configuration
205
(Aruba) #show aaa dot1x Mode = 'Enabled' Default Role = 'guest' Auth Server List ---------------Pri Name Type Status Inservice Applied --- -------------------- ------1 ARUBA RADIUS Enabled Yes 1 2 IAS RADIUS Enabled Yes 1
z z z z z
Pri Name Type Status Inservice
The order in which the server will be queried for authentication The name of the authentication server The server type Enabled or Disabled This field indicates the status of connectivity between the switch and the server.
206
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Debug Commands
The commands in this section are used for debugging the authentication module. Debugging is accomplished through a telnet monitor. A two step process is required to enter the debugging mode. First, enter the configure terminal mode, then enter the debug mode. Exit debugging using the no debug command, see Debug Commands on page 883.
The system will display a screen similar to the one shown here.
(Aruba) #configure t Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z
2 Enter the debugging mode
Type logging monitor debugging arubaauth <Enter>
This command enables monitoring of authorization debugging messages on a telnet terminal. Options for the debugging arubaauth command are:
z z z z z z z
dot1xcfg dot1xeapol
Debug 802.1x configuration items. Debug EAPOL messages from supplicants to authenticator. Debug Key messages from the 802.1x authenticator to the supplicant. Debug messages between the radius server and the authenticator. Debug 802.1x authenticator SAP context management. the STM.
dot1xkeymgt
dot1xradius
dot1xspmgt
802.1x Configuration
207
RF Deauthentication Debugging
Using Aruba Air Management features, Aruba APs can identify other APs and client stations that violate configured protection policies. The Aruba APs can also be configured to send deauthentication frames (or laser-beams) to prevent the offending AP or client station behavior (refer to the Aruba AirOS User's Guide). Since deauthentication frames are spoofed on behalf of the AP or client station, the true source of packet is not evident. However, deauthentication debugging reveals the source of these packets to help verify that enforcement policies are behaving as expected. To enable or disable this feature, use the following CLI configuration command:
(config) # wms general laser-beam-debug {enable|disable}
When enabled, Aruba APs alter their deauthentication frames to include their own MAC address. This identifies the source of the laser-beam to packet capture software or inspection equipment (sniffers) and nullifies the deauthentication effect. Because debugging disables the intended deauthentication, is should be turned off except when debugging is required.
Certificates
This section of the chapter deals with authentication certificates. Certificates provide strong security when authenticating users and computers and eliminate the need for less secure password based authentication schemes. Three authentication methods use certificates: Extensible Authentication Protocol-Transport Level Security (EAP-TLS), Protected Extensible Authentication Protocol (PEAP), and TTLS. Aruba AirOS employs all three. This section will describe the process of acquiring certificates for authenticating servers (server certificates) and for authenticating clients (client certificates).
208
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Introduction to Server, Client, and CA Certificates Client Certificates and Certificate Verification
Clients as well as the servers to which they attach may hold authentication certificates that validate their identity. When a client connects to a server for the first time, or the first time since its previous certificate has expired or been revoked, the server will request that the client transmit its authentication certificate. The clients certificate is then verified against the CA certificate of the authority which issued it (Clients do not have to validate the Server certificate in order for 802.1x to function).
802.1x Configuration
209
210
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Select the Retrieve the CA Certificate or certificate revocation list option, then click Next. The following screen should appear in your browser.
802.1x Configuration
211
You may receive one or both of the following warnings. In either case click Yes.
The installation should proceed automatically and the following screen should appear.
212
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
(http://<ip address>/crtserv).
The webpage below should appear in your browser window.
802.1x Configuration
213
Select the Request a certificate option, then click Next. The web page below should appear in your browser window.
214
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
802.1x Configuration
215
Select the Submit a certificate request to this CA using a form option, then click Next. You may receive one of the security warnings shown below. Click Yes.
216
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
The web page form below should appear in your browser window.
Enter the following information in the Identity Information section of the form:
z z z z z
Name (the authentication servers fully qualified name) The administrators email address The name of the company The department within the company to which the server belongs The city, state, and country where the company is located.
802.1x Configuration
217
Select Server Authentication Server Certificate under the Intended Purpose section. Set the following options under the Key Options section:
z z z z z
CSP
Select the Microsoft Base Cryptographics Provider v1.0 option from the drop down box. Select Both Set the key size to 1024 Select Check use local machine store option
Key Usage Key Size Create new key set Use local machine store
Click Submit after you have correctly entered all the information. You may see the warning text box pictured below appear on the screen, Click Yes.
218
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
The web page shown below should appear in your browser window.
Click the Install this certificate button. You may see the warning text box pictured below appear on the screen, Click Yes.
802.1x Configuration
219
(http://<ip address>/crtserv).
The webpage below should appear in your browser window.
220
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Select the Request a certificate option, then click Next. The web page below should appear in your browser window.
802.1x Configuration
221
222
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Select the Submit a certificate request to this CA using a form option, then click Next. You may receive one of the security warnings shown below. Click Yes.
802.1x Configuration
223
The web page form below should appear in your browser window.
Enter the following information in the Identity Information section of the form:
z z z z z
Name (the authentication servers fully qualified name) The Users email address The name of the company The department within the company to which the server belongs The city, state, and country where the company is located.
224
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Select Server Authentication Server Certificate under the Intended Purpose section. Set the following options under the Key Options section:
z z z z z
CSP
Select the Client Authentication Certificate option from the drop down box. Select Both Set the key size to 1024 Select Check use local machine store option
Key Usage Key Size Create new key set Use local machine store
Click Submit after you have correctly entered all the information. You may see the warning text box pictured below appear on the screen, click Yes.
802.1x Configuration
225
The web page shown below should appear in your browser window.
Click the Install this certificate button. You may see the warning text box pictured below appear on the screen, Click Yes.
226
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
802.1x Configuration
227
To install the certificate authority, simply tap on the certificate file. The system will ask for confirmation before installing the certificate. Select Yes. The certification path has now been installed. It can be verified by navigating on the Pocket PC device to Settings > System > Certificates > Root.
228
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Configuration of the Funk Odyssey client can be performed either on the host PC or on the Pocket PC device. All permanent configuration should be done on the host PC, which will then push the configuration to the mobile device. This document will describe configuration on the host PC.
Certificate Configuration
During the operation of 802.1x authentication, a digital certificate will be passed from the authentication server to the client. This certificate will be used by the client to authenticate the network infrastructure, so that connections to untrusted networks are not made. To authenticate the network, the client checks the certification path of the server certificate and compares it with trusted root certification authorities for which the client has been configured. Microsoft Windows and Pocket PC come with a number of large public certification authorities pre-installed, including authorities such as VeriSign, SecureSign, GTE, C&W, and others. An organization may also use a self-signed server certificate, generated by a local certificate server. The Funk Odyssey client will automatically push required certificates to the mobile device. However, this assumes that the certificate information including trusted certification paths is already available on the host PC. If a server certificates certification path includes of these pre-installed certificate authorities, no further action is required on the client. If a self-signed certificate is used, the organizations certificate authority server must be configured on the client device so that it is trusted. For instructions on installing a certification authority (CA) certificate on the host PC, please consult the Aruba AirOS Users Guide and look for the section entitled Obtaining a Certification Authority (CA) Certificate.
802.1x Configuration
229
recommended if the CA is a public CA, since the client would then trust any certificate that was also signed by that same CA. To configure this method, click Advanced. The second and more secure method specifies the domain name of the authentication server. Only servers with this domain name that send a valid trusted certificate will be authorized. To configure a trusted server, click Add on the Trusted Servers screen.
Profile Configuration
To use 802.1x authentication, a profile must be created to configure the appropriate EAP type, as well as other authentication details. Profiles are configured in the Profiles screen. The first step of profile configuration is to establish the user information and type of authentication credentials. In this example, a username and password is required to access the network. The password can be saved on the device, if desired. Next, the authentication EAP type must be selected. In this case, PEAP is used in this network. The Validate server certificate option should always be enabled for security reasons. Finally, settings for PEAP must be configured. MS-CHAP v2 is used to hash the users password. This is the default PEAP mode of operation for most RADIUS servers, including Microsoft IAS.
Networks Configuration
Once a profile has been configured, the SSID with which the device should connect must be configured. This is done in the Networks screen. In the example below, the SSID WLAN-01 will be used. Open authentication is used with WEP encryption. The previously-created WLAN authentication profile will be used to authenticate to the network, and WEP keys will be generated automatically during 802.1x authentication.
Connection Configuration
Finally, the default network should be specified. Although multiple networks may be configured under the Networks screen, only one of them will be the default network.
230
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 9
Push to Device
After all configuration has been completed in the Funk Odyssey Configuration Manager, the configuration must be pushed out to the mobile device. After establishing an ActiveSync connection, select Commands > Push To Device from the Odyssey Configuration Manager.
z z
2. The very last intermediate certificate must be signed by the CA that is present on the client.
All certificates are formatted x509 PEM unencrypted.
802.1x Configuration
231
232
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
z Secure guest access z Link-layer encryption using per-user dynamic WEP keys
The school system has deployed a wireless network consisting of an Aruba 5000 Wireless LAN system, over two hundred laptops with integrated 802.11 network interface cards running Microsoft Windows XP , several dozen HP iPAQ 2215 PDAs running Microsoft PocketPC 2003, and a Microsoft server infrastructure. The laptops are shared by students during the instructional day to provide Internet access and access to central storage on a Windows 2003 Server machine. PDAs are used by the faculty only. Approximately one hundred Aruba 52 Access Points have been deployed throughout the initial building to provide wireless coverage. The building is several decades old and constructed with concrete interior walls, so a higher than required number of APs was deployed to ensure both coverage and performance. 802.1x authentication based on PEAP is used to provide both computer and user authentication. Domain credentials are used for computer authentication, and the users Windows login and
802.1x Solution Cookbook 233
password are used for user authentication. A single user sign-on facilitates both authentication to the wireless network and access to the Windows server resources. WEP is used as a link-layer encryption technology, with dynamic per-user WEP keys being provided through the 802.1x authentication process. A migration to either WPA or 802.11i is planned for this network, which will be automated through group policy objects.
Physical Topology
A map of the network, excluding individual APs, is shown below. The Aruba 5000 switch has been deployed in the main server room, with half of the APs directly attached to the switch via Cat5 cabling from the classrooms. The Aruba switch provides power over Ethernet (POE) for these APs. The rest of the APs are home run to a wiring closet on the second floor, where they connect to a standard Ethernet switch supporting POE. The second floor wiring closet connects to the first floor server room through a fiber link connected to a router port. The Aruba 5000 switch connects to the rest of the network through a port on the main routing switch. This port is part of the 10.1.1.0 subnet, on which most of the servers also exist. Redundancy was not a primary design concern in the wireless network, since other parts of the network are not redundant.
Wireless Laptops
1. Wireless laptop boots Windows XP and comes up with a Windows domain login screen. 2 In order to gain network connectivity to the domain controller, the Windows laptop associates and authenticates to the wireless network.
234
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
The laptop searches for the wireless ESSID WLAN-01, chooses the AP with the best signal strength, and attempts to associate to it.
zi. The laptop will send 802.11 broadcast probe-requests to search for
any ESSID.
zii. All APs in range will respond with probe-responses containing the
ESSID WLAN-01. A load balancing feature has been enabled on the Aruba switch that will limit the number of users on a single AP to 20. If the load-balancing high watermark has been reached on a given AP , this AP will not respond to probe-responses. From the laptops perspective, it appears as though the AP does not exist.
ziii. The laptop will choose the best AP among the list of responses. This
decision is typically based on measured signal strength.
ziv. The laptop will initiate an 802.11 association process with the chosen
AP . b The laptop will initiate 802.1x authentication by transmitting an EAPOL-Start message to the AP . An 802.1x authentication sequence using PEAP will follow. The Aruba switch will convert all 802.1x EAPOL messages on the wireless network into EAPOL-over-RADIUS messages on the wired network, and will transmit them to the Microsoft IAS server. All 802.1x communication is between the client and the IAS server, with the Aruba components acting as pass-through devices.
zii. The IAS server will compare the transmitted username with a list of
computers and users in the Active Directory database. Because the username represents a computer in the domain, the IAS server will process the authentication request according to a policy matching all domain computers.
ziii. The IAS server will transmit a digital certificate to the client. This digital certificate was issued and signed by the local Windows certificate authority. Each laptop has been configured to trust the local certificate authority. Because of this trust relationship, the client accepts the certificate and allows authentication to proceed. If an invalid certificate were presented (for example, from an intruder attempting to gain access to the network by running a separate AP and authentication server), the client would halt the authentication process at this point.
ziv. During the encrypted PEAP exchange, the client will again transmit a
username corresponding to its computer name. Using MS-CHAP v2, the computer will next transmit a password. In this case, the password is the domain SID (security identifier) previously exchanged between the laptop and the domain controller the first time the laptop joined the domain. The SID is stored on each laptop automatically.
zv. If the computer name and SID match those stored in the Active Directory database, authentication is granted. The IAS server transmits a RADIUS Accept message to the Aruba switch. The Aruba switch transmits an EAPOL Success message to the wireless client. This concludes 802.1x authentication.
235
The IAS server has also been configured to transmit an RADIUS attribute called Class to the Aruba switch. The value of this attribute is set to computer to identify the authenticated device as a computer. The Aruba switch is configured to recognize this RADIUS attribute, and maps the wireless client to a computer role.
zvi. Using information from the 802.1x authentication exchange, the wireless client and Aruba switch derive dynamic keys for use in the encryption process. After key derivation, both the client and the Aruba switch begin using the WEP encryption protocol to encrypt data on the wireless network. c The laptop transmits a DHCP request. The Aruba switch intercepts this DHCP request and forwards it to an external DHCP server running on a Windows server. The server assigns an IP address to the wireless laptop and issues a DHCP response. The Aruba switch learns the IP address assigned to the client and stores this information in an internal table. The wireless laptop now has IP connectivity to the network, and can contact the domain controller for authentication requests and group policy updates. At this point, the laptop is still displaying a Windows domain login screen.
A user enters a username and password in the Windows domain login screen on the wireless laptop. A standard Windows authentication procedure follows between the client and the domain controller. If the Windows logon is successful, the laptop will perform another 802.1x re-authentication to the wireless network using the users authentication credentials. This behavior is the default for Windows, and is configurable through a registry setting or through group policy.
236
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
The laptop will transmit an EAPOL-Start message to the Aruba switch. The Aruba switch will then proceed with 802.1x authentication by transmitting an EAPOL Request identity message to the laptop. b. The laptop will transmit the users username. The Aruba switch will recognize the username information, record it, and map it to the MAC address of the client in an internal table. The new username will replace the previously-learned computer name. The IAS server will compare the transmitted username with a list of computers and users on the Active Directory server. Because the username represents a user in the domain, the IAS server will process the authentication request according to a policy matching the group to which the user belongs (faculty, student, or system administrator.) The IAS server will transmit a digital certificate to the client. This digital certificate was issued and signed by the local Windows certificate authority. Each laptop has been configured to trust the local certificate authority. Because of this trust relationship, the client accepts the certificate and allows authentication to proceed. If an invalid certificate were presented (for example, from an intruder attempting to gain access to the network by running a separate AP and authentication server), the client would halt the authentication process at this point. During the encrypted PEAP exchange, the client will again transmit a username. Using MS-CHAP v2, the computer will next transmit the users password entered during the Windows logon process. Note that this exchange is MS-CHAP v2, so the actual password is not transmitted. If the username and password match those stored in the Active Directory database, authentication is granted. The IAS server transmits a RADIUS Accept message to the Aruba switch. The Aruba switch transmits an EAPOL Success message to the wireless client. This concludes 802.1x authentication.
zi. The IAS server has also been configured to transmit an RADIUS
attribute called Class to the Aruba switch. The value of this attribute is set to either student, faculty, or sysadmin to identify the users group. The Aruba switch is configured to recognize this RADIUS attribute, and maps the wireless client to the appropriate role. Different firewall policies are configured for different groups on the Aruba switch, primarily to limit student access to approved uses of the network. g h The wireless laptop and Aruba switch derive new encryption keys for WEP . The wireless laptop maintains the same IP address.
5 6
The user now has network access consistent with the users group privileges. If the user moves to another room where the wireless association can no longer be maintained, the laptop will search for a new AP and re-initiate the association process. After each association, the 802.1x authentication process will repeat. While a user is logged in to the laptop, the 802.1x authentication will be performed using the users credentials. If 802.1x
237
authentication takes place when a user is not logged in to the laptop, the computers authentication credentials will be used to perform the authentication process. 7 When a user logs out of Windows, the laptop will again perform 802.1x authentication using computer credentials, as described in 2(b) above. This places the wireless device back into the computer role in the Aruba switch.
Printers
Separate to the process above, support for wireless-attached printers is also provided. The printers connect to the wireless network using a hidden ESSID of WLAN-01-printer. Because the wireless adapters for the printers do not support strong authentication or encryption, this ESSID utilizes WEP encryption with no authentication. For security reasons, printers are automatically mapped to a special printer role in the Aruba switch, are placed into a special VLAN, and have restricted access to the network. In the event that the printer WEP key were compromised, the potential damage an attacker could do would be very limited, and the breach would be quickly discovered by the network administrator.
Firewall Policies
Several firewall policies have been configured in the Aruba switch, and are mapped to user roles. These firewall policies are designed to control access only to the internal network. The school district implements other firewall technology for the connection to the Internet to further limit district-wide Internet traffic.
238
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
Student Policy
The policy below prevents students from using telnet, POP3, FTP , SMTP , SNMP , or SSH to the wired portion of the network. Telnet, FTP , SNMP , and SSH are used by the IT staff to maintain network devices, but are not permitted for other classes of users. POP3 and SMTP are permitted for faculty and staff members to access email. All students use Microsoft Exchange to access email.
ip access-list session student user alias district-network svc-telnet deny user alias district-network svc-pop3 deny user alias district-network svc-ftp deny user alias district-network svc-smtp deny user alias district-network svc-snmp deny user alias district-network svc-ssh deny
Faculty Policy
The faculty policy is similar to the student policy above in restricting use of maintenance protocols to the internal network. However, faculty members are allowed the use of POP3 and SMTP . Faculty laptops have email clients configured to use these protocols as they were deemed more efficient than the Exchange protocol when laptops were taken home and used with VPN remote access. Students did not have this same requirement, since they are not permitted to use VPN remote access.
ip access-list session faculty user alias district-network svc-telnet deny user alias district-network svc-ftp deny user alias district-network svc-snmp deny user alias district-network svc-ssh deny
239
Printer Policy
The following policy is used for the printer role. It restricts printers to communicating only with the print server, and only on specific port numbers. Any violation of the printer policy will trigger a log message, notifying the system administrator that a possible network security breach had occurred.
ip access-list session printer-acl user host 172.16.31.26 svc-windows-printing permit user host 172.16.31.27 svc-windows-printing permit any any any deny log
Guest Policy
The following policies permit guest access only to the Internet, and only during daytime working hours.
time-range working-hours periodic weekday 07:30 to 17:00 ip access-list session guest user host 10.1.1.25 svc-dhcp permit time-range working-hours user host 10.1.1.25 svc-dns permit time-range working-hours user alias district-network any deny user any svc-http permit time-range working-hours user any svc-https permit time-range working-hours user any any deny
Chapter 10
session-acl student session-acl allowall ! user-role sysadmin session-acl allowall ! user-role faculty session-acl faculty session-acl allowall ! user-role computer session-acl allowall ! user-role guest session-acl guest bandwidth-contract guest-1M
Authentication Parameters
The following configuration statements are related to user authentication.
RADIUS Configuration
The following statements configure the available RADIUS servers, including the IP address of the RADIUS server and the key.
aaa radius-server IAS1 host 10.1.1.21 key |*a^t%183923! aaa radius-server IAS2 host 10.1.1.25 key |*a^t%312213!
241
aaa derivation-rules user set role condition essid equals "WLAN-01-printer" setThe third statement instructs the switch to place any clients associating with the ESSID Guest into the guest role. Guests are not required to authenticate, but are only permitted very limited network access and only during daytime working hours.
aaa derivation-rules user set role condition essid equals "Guest" set-value guest
For more information on the role derivation process, refer to:Setting Access Rights on page 415.
802.1x Configuration
The following statements enable 802.1x authentication. It also establishes which RADIUS server to use for 802.1x authentication, and determines the default role that an 802.1x client will get in the absence of a Class attribute from the RADIUS server.
aaa dot1x enforce-machine-authentication mode enable machine-authentication default-role computer user-authentication default-role guest
242
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
vlan 60 vlan 61 vlan 62 vlan 63 ! interface vlan 1 ip address 10.1.1.251 255.255.255.0 ! interface vlan 60 ip address 10.1.60.1 255.255.255.0 ip helper-address 10.1.1.25 ! interface vlan 61 ip address 10.1.61.1 255.255.255.0 ip helper-address 10.1.1.25 ! interface vlan 62 ip address 10.1.62.1 255.255.255.0 ip helper-address 10.1.1.25 ! interface vlan 63 ip address 10.1.63.1 255.255.255.0 ip helper-address 10.1.1.25 ! ip default-gateway 10.1.1.254
Wireless Configuration
The following statements set up the default AP parameters for the entire network. This establishes the encryption mode as dynamic TKIP (WPA) and the default ESSID as WLAN-01. In addition, a second ESSID called WLAN-01-printer is established with the encryption mode set to static WEP ,
243
and the static WEP key is defined. The WLAN-01-printer ESSID does not respond to broadcast probe requests, preventing clients from seeing it. Note that a hidden ESSID name is used for convenience and to reduce confusion among the users not as a security mechanism. Simple attack tools are available that will quickly reveal a hidden ESSID name.
ap location 0.0.0 weptxkey 1 wepkey1 c4f32001f1c25ab20f838312f2 phy-type a opmode dynamicWep essid "WLAN-01" virtual-ap "WLAN-01-printer" vlan-id staticWep deny-bcast enable virtual-ap Guest vlan-id 63 opmode bcast disable phy-type g opmode dynamicWep essid "WLAN-01" virtual-ap "WLAN-01-printer" vlan-id staticWep deny-bcast enable virtual-ap Guest vlan-id 63 opmode bcast disable
AP Configuration
Users associating to each AP are mapped into a VLAN. For scalability purposes and to prevent broadcast issues caused by too many users on a single network, two different user VLANs have been set up. Membership in the VLAN is determined by the initial AP to which the user associates. As users roams between different APs, they will keep their original VLAN assignment regardless of which AP they are currently associated with. Currently, APs are mapped to VLANs based on the floor on which the AP has been deployed. Guest users have an ESSID-specific VLAN configuration which overrides the default config below. Guest users will be mapped into VLAN 63.
244
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
z Student this group is used for all student users z Faculty this group is used for all faculty users z Sysadmin this group is used for system administrators
245
z Specifies that each client should check for policy updates every 60 minutes. z Clients should only connect to Access Points. Clients should not connect
to or form ad-hoc networks.
z Clients will use the built-in Wireless Zero Configuration service to configure
wireless settings.
z The ESSID name is WLAN-01. z The encryption type is WEP z Open authentication should be used (this refers to 802.11 basic authentication, not to 802.1x)
z Each client will use a dynamically-generated WEP key that will be automatically derived during the 802.1x process.
z Enables 802.1x z Specifies that the client will initiate the 802.1x exchange (default) z Establishes default timing parameters for 802.1x z Specifies the EAP type as PEAP z Clients will not attempt to authenticate as a guest
246
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
z Clients will perform computer authentication when a user is not logged in. z After a user logs in, clients will re-authenticate to the wireless network
Sets up client PEAP properties
z Server certificate will be validated. This option instructs the client to check
the validity of the server certificate from an expiration, identity, and trust perspective.
z The District-CA certificate authority is the only trusted CA that can issue
server certificates for the wireless network.
z Fast reconnect has not been enabled on the client. This option can speed
up authentication in some cases. Sets up the behavior of MS-CHAP v2 within PEAP.
247
Policy Configuration
The heart of IAS configuration is the policy configuration screen. From this screen, all policies related to wireless access can be defined including time of day restrictions, session length, authentication type, and group-related policies. The essential policy settings for wireless access are described here for detailed explanations of all IAS policy settings, please see Microsofts official documentation.
z The Wireless-Student policy matches the Student group. z The Wireless-Faculty policy matches the Faculty group. z The Wireless-Sysadmin policy matches the Sysadmin group.
In addition to matching the group, the policy also specifies that the request must be from an 802.11 wireless device. The policy above instructs IAS to grant remote access permission if all the conditions specified in the policy match, a valid username/password was supplied, and the users or computers remote access permission was set to Allow. By clicking Edit Profile in the policy screen above, additional authentication parameters can be selected. Two such parameters are of interest: the authentication method, which is common to all policies, and the advanced attributes, which are different for each policy.
Authentication Methods
To enable 802.1x authentication, an appropriate EAP type must be selected under the Authentication tab.
248
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
The only EAP method that should be selected is Protected EAP (PEAP). By click Edit in the screen above, additional properties for PEAP can be selected. On this screen, a server certificate must be chosen, and the inner authentication method must be chosen. The list of available certificates is taken from the computer certificate store on which IAS is running. In this case, a self-signed certificate was generated by the local certificate authority and installed on the IAS machine. The local certificate authority has been added as a trusted certificate authority on each wireless client device, thus allowing this certificate to be trusted. The authentication method shown here is MS-CHAP v2. Because password authentication is being used on this network, this is the only EAP authentication type that should be selected. Fast reconnect can be enabled in this screen also. If fast reconnect is enabled here and also on client devices, additional time can be saved when multiple authentications take place (such as when clients are roaming between APs often) because the server will keep alive the PEAP encrypted tunnel. For this application, fast reconnect was not desired.
Advanced Attributes
One of the principles in this network is that the Aruba switch will restrict network access privileges based on the group membership of the computer or user. In order for this to work, the Aruba switch must be told to which group the user belongs. This is accomplished using RADIUS attributes. To configure these attributes, select the Advanced tab from the policy profile. An attribute called Class has been added here. The Aruba switch has been configured to interpret the Class attribute and use it to determine group membership. The example above is for the Wireless-Computers policy, and upon successful completion will return the Class attribute to the Aruba switch containing the value computer. The Wireless-Student policy for example will return a RADIUS attribute called Class containing the value student upon successful completion.
249
Windows will connect to preferred networks in the order in which they appear in this list. By clicking Advanced, the Networks to access screen is displayed. This screen determines what types of wireless networks can be accessed. By default, Windows will connect to any type of wireless network. In the configuration at the left, Windows has been configured to connect only with Access Points. Sets up general network properties for the ESSID.
z The ESSID name is WLAN-01. z Open authentication should be used. z The encryption type is WEP z Each client will use a dynamically-generated WEP key that will be automatically derived during the 802.1x process.
z Enables 802.1x z Specifies the EAP type as PEAP z Clients will not attempt to authenticate as a guest z Clients will perform computer authentication when a user is not logged in.
Sets up client PEAP properties
z Server certificate will be validated. This option instructs the client to check
the validity of the server certificate from an expiration, identity, and trust perspective.
z The District-CA certificate authority is the only trusted CA that can issue
server certificates for the wireless network.
z Fast reconnect has not been enabled on the client. This option can speed
up authentication in some cases. Sets up the behavior of MS-CHAP v2 within PEAP.
250
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
251
Windows Explorer, and a folder entitled <mobile device name> My Documents should appear on the Windows desktop. Copy the X.509 certificate file from the host computer to the My Documents directory on the PocketPC device. Next, install the certification authority in the PocketPC devices certificate store. To do this, run the PocketPC File Explorer and navigate to My Documents. To install the certificate authority, simply tap on the certificate file. The system will ask for confirmation before installing the certificate. Select Yes. The certification path has now been installed. It can be verified by navigating on the PocketPC device to Settings > System > Certificates > Root.
252
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 10
Microsoft Requirement
For 802.1x, Microsoft requires that you specify the subject Alt Name.
253
254
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
System Name is an alpha-numeric string with a maximum length of 32 characters. System Contact is an alpha-numeric string with a maximum length of 32 characters. System location is an alpha-numeric string with a maximum length of 128 characters. Read Community Strings are alpha-numeric strings with a maximum length of 16 characters. You may enter an unlimited number of strings.
255
Navigate to the Configuration > Management > SNMP page. Add system information in the System Group section of the SNMP page.
2 3
Type a user friendly name in the System Name field. Type a name or system administrator contact information in the System Contact field. Type the location of the Aruba switch in the System Location field.
256
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 11
3 4 5 6
Enter the IP address of the SNMP server host in the IP Address field. Chose the appropriate SNMP version from the Version pull-down menu. Enter a valid SNMP Community String in the SNMP community String field. Enter the UDP port for the trap in the UDP Port field.
(Aruba5000) (config) #hostname UrsaMinor (UrsaMinor) > (Note that you are now in the immediate mode.)
257
NOTEThe console will revert to the immediate (non-privileged mode) when you change the system name. You will need to re-execute the enable and configure terminal commands before you can proceed. 2 Create a System Contact entry using the syscontact <name> command.
258
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 11
259
You can view, add, delete, or edit Management Users and Roles from this page.
260
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 11
Add a Management user by clicking on Add in the Management Users portion of the Access Control page. The Add User page appears. 1 Enter a name in the User Name field. The name you enter must be 1 - 16 alpha-numeric characters in length. Enter a password in the Password field. The password you enter must be 1 16 alpha-numeric characters in length. Retype the password in the Confirm Password field. Choose a role from the Role pull-down menu. Click Add Role to apply the selected role to the user. Click Apply to activate the new entries. Click on Save Configuration near the top of the page to save the changes to the configuration file.
3 4 5 6 7
261
2 3 4
Select a Management Module using the pull-down menu. Select an Access Permission using the pull-down menu. Click Add, the Add Role page is again displayed and shows the added module and permission. Click the Apply button to activate the new entries. Click the Save Configuration button near the top of the page to save the changes to the configuration file.
NOTEThe Web GUI includes a View only Role. When a role is made view-only, all module permission information is ignored.
5 6
262
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 11
Adding and Changing Administrative Access Using the CLI Viewing Management Users
You may view currently configured management users and their assigned roles by executing the show mgmt-users command from the CLI.
(Aruba) (config) #show mgmt-user Management User Table --------------------USER PASSWD ROLE --------- ---admin ***** root administrator ***** root role ***** root sean ***** root (Aruba) (config) #
(Aruba) (config) #mgmt-user test_manager temp_mgr passwd:****** Re-Type passwd:****** (Aruba) (config) #
263
(Aruba) (config) #show mgmt-role Role: guest Description: Permit List ----------MGMT-MODULE ACCESS ----------- -----Role: root Description: This is Default Super User Role Permit List ----------MGMT-MODULE ACCESS ----------- -----super-user READ_WRITE
(Aruba) (config) #
264
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 11
1.VSA stands for Vendor Specific Attribute. RADIUS protocol allows the sending RADIUS server to send VSAs to the entity that is performing authentication (for example, an Aruba switch). The VSA are published by vendors for there specific use and are used in addition to standard attributes that are part of RADIUS protocol. Switch Management Configuration 265
Logging
The logging feature in Aruba AirOS allows permanent system logs to be stored externally on one or more logging servers.
266
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 11
Enter the address of a logging server and click the Add button next to the text field. Select a check box of a module for which you want to do logging. The logging level menu appears.
Select the appropriate logging level and click on the apply button.
There are a total of eight logging levels, each having its own distinct characteristics:
Panic conditions that occur when the system becomes unstable. Any condition requiring immediate attention and correction. Any critical conditions such as, hard drive errors. Error conditions Warning messages. Significant events of a non-critical and normal nature.
267
z Informational z Debug
Messages of general interest to system users. Messages containing information useful for debugging purposes.
268
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 11
(Aruba) (config) #show logging level LOGGING LEVELS -------------Application Level ----------- ----arubaauth informational crypto informational l2tp informational pptp informational wms informational mmgr informational mobagent informational master informational stm informational localdb informational sapm informational fpapps informational cfgm informational suser informational intuser informational aaa informational traffic informational dhcpd informational processes informational publisher informational (Aruba) (config) #
269
270
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
WLAN Configuration
This WLAN configuration chapter explains setup and configuration of all standard 802.11 settings, including SSID, radio parameters, and encryption. This guide also explains how to configure system-wide parameters, per-building AP parameters, per-floor AP parameters, and per-AP parameters.
271
272
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 12
Radio Type SSIDs may appear on only 802.11a radios, only 802.11b/g radios or on both types of radios. SSID Default VLAN If desired, a given SSID may be mapped to a particular VLAN. See the VLAN Mapping section below for more details. Ignore Broadcast Probe-Request When a client sends a broadcast probe-request frame to search for all available SSIDs, controls whether or not the system will respond for this SSID. When enabled, no response will be sent clients will have to know the SSID in order to associate. When disabled, a probe-response frame will be sent for this SSID. NOTEWhen using multiple SSIDs on Aruba Access Points, the 802.11a radio may respond with multiple probe responses using the same BSSID (MAC address). Some clients will report only a single ESSID per BSSID and may not be able to associate. If this problem occurs, enable this option to suppress responses to broadcast probe requests. Encryption Type Specify open, WEP , TKIP , AES-CCM, or Mixed TKIP/AES-CCM. See below for discussion on each type.
VLAN Mapping
AirOS supports a concept known as crypto-VLANs whereby clients may access the same network using different encryption types. Good security practices require that different L2 encryption types be mapped to different L2 subnets otherwise, broadcast and multicast frames from a less secure encryption such as static WEP may lead to the compromise of a more secure encryption type such as TKIP . When using multiple encryption types on separate SSIDs, make sure that each SSID is mapped to a different VLAN inside the Aruba switch. SSID-based VLAN mapping may also be used for separation of traffic. For example, traffic from a guest SSID may be mapped to a guest VLAN, while traffic from employee SSIDs may be mapped to an internal network.
WEP Encryption
Two types of WEP encryption are available: static WEP and dynamic WEP . When static WEP is used, one WEP key will be configured for the SSID. All users on the network must use the same key, and no key rotation is possible. Static WEP is generally considered to provide less-than-ideal security and should be supplemented with Arubas built-in firewall protection when used.
273
Dynamic WEP (used with 802.1x) provides somewhat better protection, particularly when combined with AirOS Wireless Intrusion Detection features. When using dynamic WEP , the authentication server provides an individual encryption key to each client at the time of 802.1x authentication. The 802.1x framework also allows the encryption key to be rotated at specific intervals. By allowing each user to have a different key, and by allowing key rotation, dynamic WEP provides a much better level of security than static WEP . Dynamic WEP (used with 802.1x) provides somewhat better protection, particularly when combined with AirOS Wireless Intrusion Detection features. When using dynamic WEP , the authentication server provides an individual encryption key to each client at the time of 802.1x authentication. The 802.1x framework also allows the encryption key to be rotated at specific intervals. By allowing each user to have a different key, and by allowing key rotation, dynamic WEP provides a much better level of security than static WEP . . Clients NOTE802.1x authentication is required when using dynamic WEP using dynamic WEP will not be able to access the network until 802.1x configuration is also completed. To configure WEP encryption, click on the WEP radio button in the Add SSID screen as shown in the figure below.
274
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 12
The equivalent CLI configuration to add the SSID shown above is:
ap location 0.0.0 phy-type a virtual-ap "NewSSID" vlan-id 0 opmode staticWep,dynamicWep deny-bcast enable ap location 0.0.0 phy-type g virtual-ap "NewSSID" vlan-id 0 opmode staticWep,dynamicWep deny-bcast enable
275
If PSK TKIP is selected, fill in the pre-shared key. To enter the key directly in hex, enter 64 hex characters. To enter the key as a passphrase, select PSK Passphrase from the drop-down menu and enter a passphrase between 8 and 63 characters in the box on the left. When configuring clients, enter the same key or passphrase. If WPA TKIP is selected, no further configuration is required. All key generation will be done by the authentication server. NOTE802.1x authentication is required when using WPA TKIP . Clients using WPA TKIP will not be able to access the network until 802.1x configuration is also completed.
The equivalent CLI configuration to add the SSID shown above is:
ap location 0.0.0 phy-type a virtual-ap "NewSSID" vlan-id 0 opmode staticTkip deny-bcast enable ap location 0.0.0 phy-type g virtual-ap "NewSSID" vlan-id 0 opmode staticTkip deny-bcast enable ap location 0.0.0 wpa-hexkey abc123abc123abcdefabcdef12345678abc123abc123abcdefabcdef12345678
NOTEAirOS versions 2.2.1.0 and later support different staticWep and staticTkip keys per SSID. In earliers releases, the staticWep and staticTkip keys applied to each Access Point. Information TBC
Chapter 12
277
278
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 12
NOTENote: These parameters affect all APs in the network, unless a more specific configuration applies. Configuration in this section corresponds to the CLI configuration for ap location 0.0.0. Available parameters are: RTS Threshold Wireless clients transmitting frames larger than this threshold will issue Request to Send (RTS) and wait for the AP to respond with Clear to Send (CTS). This helps prevent mid-air collisions for wireless clients that are not within wireless peer range and cannot detect when other wireless clients are transmitting. An Aruba network normally consists of a larger number of APs with a smaller footprint, reducing the likelihood of this hidden node problem. The default is 2333 bytes. Ageout Specifies the amount of time a client is allowed to remain idle before being aged out. The default is 1000 seconds. Hide SSID Enables or disables hiding of the SSID name in beacon frames. Note that hiding the SSID does very little to increase security. Deny Broadcast When a client sends a broadcast probe-request frame to search for all available SSIDs, this option controls whether or not the system will respond for this SSID. When enabled, no response will be sent clients will have to know the SSID in order to associate. When disabled, a probe-response frame will be sent for this SSID. Max Retries Specifies the maximum number of retries allowed for the AP to send a frame. The recommended range is between 3 and 7. The default is 3. DTIM Period Specifies the interval between sending DTIMs in the beacon. This is the maximum number of beacon cycles before unacknowledged network broadcasts are flushed. When using wireless clients that employ power management features to sleep, the client must revive at least once during the DTIM period to received broadcasts. The default is 2. Max Clients Specifies the maximum number of wireless clients for a radio on an AP . The default is 0, but is set to 64 if the initial setup dialog is used to configure the switch. Beacon Period Specifies the time between successive beacons being transmitted. The default is 100 ms. Initial Radio State Used to enable or disable the radio. Mode Specifies whether the AP should act as an access point or an air monitor. The default is AP .
279
Default Channel Sets the default channel on which the AP will operate, unless a better choice is available either from calibration or from RF Plan. Initial Transmit Power - Sets the initial transmit power on which the AP will operate, unless a better choice is available either from calibration or from RF Plan. LMS IP Specifies the Local Management Switch that the AP will use in multi-switch networks. The LMS is responsible for terminating user traffic from the APs, processing it, and forwarding it to the wired network. Setting the option in this screen will set an LMS for the entire network, which is probably not desirable.
When using redundant switches as the LMS, set this parameter to be the VRRP IP address. This will ensure that APs always have an active IP address with which to terminate sessions.
Short Preamble Enables or disables short preamble for 802.11b/g radios. In mixed radio environments, some 802.11b wireless client stations may experience difficulty associating with the AP using short preamble. To use only long preamble, disable short preamble. Network performance is higher when short preamble is enabled. Legacy client devices that use only long preamble can generally be updated to support short preamble. The default is enabled. Basic Rates Specifies the a list of supported rates that will be advertised in beacon frames and probe responses. Supported Rates Specifies the set of rates at which the AP is allowed to send data. The actual transmit rate depends on what the client is able to handle, based on information sent at the time of association and on the current error/loss rate of the client. The default CLI configuration for ap location 0.0.0 is:
(Aruba5000) (config) # ap location 0.0.0 (Aruba5000) (sap-config location 0.0.0) #? ageout Seconds of inactivity after which client is aged out ap-enable One of enable or disable ap-logging Set logging levels for AP facilities arm Adaptive Radio Management configuration authalgo Only opensystem is supported. No support for sharedkey beacon-period Beacon Period for the AP. Typically 100 bkplms-ip The IP addr of the backup LMS for APs at this location
280
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 12
bootstrap-threshold deny deny-bcast disable dns-name double-encrypt dtim-period dump-server enable essid hide-ssid hostname lms-ip local-probe-response max-clients max-retries max-tx-fail mode mtu no opmode phy-type power-mgmt radio-off-threshold restore-default rf-band rts-threshhold snmp-server
Number of heartbeat misses before AP re-bootstraps Deny wireless access according to timerange argument enable to suppress responses to probe requests with broadcast SSID disable this feature or mode DNS Name for the AP. Can contain a $L substring that is replaced with the location of the AP Encrypt 802.11 data frames using IPSec Interval between sending DTIMs in beacon Core dump server (for debugging) enable this feature or mode ESSID for the AP. Should be a string of max. 32 characters enable or disable hiding the SSID in beacons Change the system name The IP addr of the LMS that should be assigned to APs at this location The AP (not the switch) generates probe response Max Wireless CLients for AP. 0 thru 256 Maximum number of retries allowed for AP to send a packet Maximum transmit failures before client gives up One of am_mode or ap_mode (air monitor or access point) The MTU on the wired link for the AP (1024-1576 bytes) Delete Command Can be a comma separated list of opensystem,staticWep,dynamicWep,staticTkip,dy namicTkip,wpa2-aes,wpa2-aes-psk Specify either .a or .g for physical layer type, or enet1 for ethernet port 1 'enable': Enable power management Number of heartbeat misses before radio is turned off Restore default configs for this location The RF Band that the AP should operate in (g=2.4GHz, a=5GHz) The RTS threshold. Packets bigger than this use RTS and CTS Enable SNMP; Modify SNMP parameters
Wireless LAN Configuration 281
syscontact syslocation telnet tx-power virtual-ap vlan-id wepkey1 wepkey2 wepkey3 wepkey4 weptxkey wpa-hexkey wpa-passphrase wpa2-preauth wps
Change the system contact Change the system location Enable or disable telnet to the AP A number from 0 thru 4 Configure a virtual AP with its own essid The ID of the VLAN assigned to this AP's or virtual AP's associating clients (valid range: 0-4094) Specify static WEP key 1 of 4 (length 5 or 13 bytes) Specify static WEP key 2 of 4 (length 5 or 13 bytes) Specify static WEP key 3 of 4 (length 5 or 13 bytes) Specify static WEP key 4 of 4 (length 5 or 13 bytes) Specify an index from 1 thru 4 Set a WPA Pre-Shared Key (PSK) Set a WPA passphrase to generate PSK Help not defined Enable Windows Provisioning Service
Using ARM
If you enable ARM in AirOS 2.3 and later, disable healing based on calibration. To do this, enter:
(host) #configure terminal (host) (config) #wms (host) (wms) #site-survey ha-compute-time 0 (host) (config) #
282
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 12
283
284
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 12
z SSIDEquivalent to Configuration > WLAN > Network > SSID. z 802.11b/gSee Figure 12-7. z 802.11aSee Figure 12-8. z GeneralEquivalent to Configuration > WLAN > Network > General.
285
286
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
CHAPTER 13
Introduction
The goal of RF Management is to initially configure and calibrate radio settings for the network. After the radio network is operational, the goal of RF Management is to tune and adjust radio parameters to ensure that performance remains acceptable for users. RF Management is largely automatic in an Aruba network, requiring little configuration or intervention from the administrator.
Calibration
Calibration is a process generally run once at the time of network installation and at additional times if the physical environment changes significantly. Calibration is run on a per-building, per-radio type basis, so that all 802.11a radios in a given building are calibrated at the same time, and all 802.11g radios are calibrated at the same time. Calibration is an active process, requiring all APs and Air Monitors (AMs) in a building to shut down temporarily while the calibration process takes place. During calibration, all APs and AMs communicate with each other at different data rates and different transmit power levels. This process allows the Aruba switch to build an RF-based map of the
Radio Resource Management 287
network topology, learning about environmental characteristics such as attenuation, interference, and reflection. When calibration has completed, the switch will automatically configure AP/AM mode of the APs, transmit power levels, and channel selection to minimize interference and maximize coverage and throughput. To initiate calibration from the GUI, navigate to Configuration > RF Management > Calibration. Two parameters can be set from this screen, as shown in the figure below.
288
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 13
Optimization
Self-Healing
After calibration has taken place, the Aruba switch has an RF-based topology map of the entire wireless network. This allows the switch to understand which APs are within range of each other. In the event that an AP fails, surrounding APs will increase their transmit power level to fill in any gaps. Self-healing is enabled by default, and can be configured in the GUI by navigating to Configuration > RF Management > Optimization > Self Healing.
289
Maximum neighbors to participate in self-healing The maximum number of neighboring APs that will increase their power level after a failure. Maximum power level increase The number of power levels a neighbor AP will increase after a failure. Self-Healing Wait Time The time after a failure, in milliseconds, after which the self-healing algorithm will begin. This should be set sufficiently high so that an AP reboot, rather than a failure, will not trigger the self-healing algorithm. The equivalent CLI configuration for the above example is:
Load Balancing
When multiple APs are available to service users in the same area, load balancing ensures that a single AP does not become overloaded. Load balancing works by keeping track of user count and bandwidth utilization for each AP in the network. If an AP reaches a configured performance threshold, that AP will attempt to force new clients to a different AP by temporarily rejecting association attempts. If no other AP is able to pick up the load, eventually the client will be allowed to associate after a configured interval has passed. To configure load balancing in the GUI, navigate to ConfigurationRF ManagementOptimizationLoad Balancing, as shown in the figure below.
290
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 13
ap-policy ap-load-balancing disable ap-policy ap-lb-max-retries 8 ap-policy ap-lb-util-high-wm 90 ap-policy ap-lb-util-low-wm 80 ap-policy ap-lb-user-high-wm 255 ap-policy ap-lb-user-low-wm 230
292
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 13
DoS Client Block Time Specifies the number of seconds a client will be quarantined from the network after a deauth attack against the client has been detected. This is used to prevent man-in-the-middle attacks. The equivalent CLI configuration for the above example is:
Configuration of RF Monitoring
293
Chapter 13
Interference Detection
Interference detection notifies the administrator when localized interference becomes sufficient to cause performance degradation. Enable interference detection in the GUI by navigating to Configuration > RF Management > Monitoring > Interference Detection as shown in the figure below.
296
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 13
297
Frame Error Rate High Watermark If the frame error rate, as a percentage of total frames, in an AP exceeds this value, a frame error rate exceeded condition exists. The recommended value is 16%. Frame Error Rate Low Watermark After a frame error rate exceeded condition exists, the condition will persist until the frame error rate drops below this value. The recommended value is 8%. Frame Fragmentation Rate High Watermark If the frame fragmentation rate, as a percentage of total frames, in an AP exceeds this value, a frame fragmentation rate exceeded condition exists. The recommended value is 16%. Frame Fragmentation Rate Low Watermark After a frame fragmentation rate exceeded condition exists, the condition will persist until the frame fragmentation rate drops below this value. The recommended value is 8%. Frame Low Speed Rate High Watermark If the rate of low-speed frames, as a percentage of total frames, in an AP exceeds this value, a low-speed rate exceeded condition exists. This could indicate a coverage hole. The recommended value is 16%. Frame Low Speed Rate Low Watermark After a low-speed rate exceeded condition exists, the condition will persist until the percentage of low-speed frames drops below this value. The recommended value is 8%. Frame Non-Unicast Rate High Watermark If the non-unicast rate, as a percentage of total frames, in an AP exceeds this value, a non-unicast rate exceeded condition exists. The default value for this parameter is 0, indicating that it is disabled. This value largely depends on applications used on the network. Frame Non-Unicast Rate Low Watermark After a non-unicast rate exceeded condition exists, the condition will persist until the non-unicast rate drops below this value. The default value for this parameter is 0, indicating that it is disabled. Frame Receive Error Rate High Watermark If the frame receive error rate, as a percentage of total frames, in an AP exceeds this value, a frame receive error rate exceeded condition exists. The recommended value is 16%. Frame Receive Error Rate Low Watermark After a frame receive error rate exceeded condition exists, the condition will persist until the frame receive error rate drops below this value. The recommended value is 8% Frame Retry Rate High Watermark If the frame retry rate, as a percentage of total frames, in an AP exceeds this value, a frame retry rate exceeded condition exists. The recommended value is 16%.
298
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 13
Frame Retry Rate Low Watermark After a frame retry rate exceeded condition exists, the condition will persist until the frame retry rate drops below this value. The recommended value is 8%. The equivalent CLI configuration for the above example is:
wms event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold event-threshold
fer-high-wm 16 fer-low-wm 8 frr-high-wm 16 frr-low-wm 8 flsr-high-wm 16 flsr-low-wm 8 fnur-high-wm 0 fnur-low-wm 0 frer-high-wm 16 frer-low-wm 8 ffr-high-wm 16 ffr-low-wm 8 bwr-high-wm 0 bwr-low-wm 0
Advanced Parameters
To access RF management advanced parameters, navigate to Configuration > RF Management > Advanced. The advanced RF management parameters are shown in the figure below.
299
300
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 13
auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra auto-rra
scan-interval 10 scan-time 110 beacon-discovered-ageout 4 data-discovered-ageout 8 error-rate-threshold 0 good-channel-index 75 channel-update-trigger-interval 60 channel-update-dampen-interval 300 compute-tree-depth 1 min-scan-time 4 scanning disable
301
302
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
z z z z z z
Probing and Network Discovery Denial of Service (DoS) Surveillance Impersonation Client Intrusion Network Intrusion
303
z Surveillance
Surveillance allows an attacker to monitor and capture data from a wireless network. The primary means of overcoming the risk of surveillance is the use of encryption either link-layer encryption such as WEP or TKIP , or network-layer encryption such as IPSec.
z Impersonation
Impersonation attacks in a wireless network typically involve an attacker taking on the address of a valid client or AP and trying to obtain access or services typically reserved for those valid clients or APs. Because wireless devices are not at the end of a physical cable, it can be difficult to detect such an attack taking place. In a worst-case scenario, an impersonating AP could fool a client into connecting with it, and then obtain that clients authentication credentials.
z Client Intrusion
Client intrusion attacks attempt to exploit vulnerabilities in client devices to gain access to a network resource. Often the attacks involve a combination of DoS and impersonation.
z Network Intrusion
A network intrusion attack implies that an attacker is able to gain full access to enterprise network resources. The following sections explain configuration of the WLAN intrusion detection and prevention of Aruba AirOS.
Rogue AP
Rogue APs represent perhaps the largest threat to enterprise network security because they bypass all other security provisions and open a network up to the outside world. Rogue APs are normally placed by employees who do not understand the risks their actions represent. A rogue AP is defined as one that is a) unauthorized, and b) plugged into the wired side of the network. Any other AP seen in the RF environment that is not part of the valid enterprise network is considered interfering it has the potential to cause RF interference, but is not connected to the enterprise wired
304
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 14
network and thus does not represent a direct threat. Aruba is unique in providing the classification function to ensure that valid, interfering, and rogue APs are accurately and automatically classified.
To configure rogue AP detection and protection capabilities, navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Rogue AP as shown in the figure below.
305
NOTENote: Use caution when enabling both Mark Unknown APs as Rogue and Disable Users from Connecting to Rogue APs. If the system is installed in an area where APs from neighboring locations can be detected, these two options will disable all APs in the area. The equivalent CLI configuration for the able example is:
wms ap-policy protect-unsecure-ap enable wms ap-policy learn-ap disable wms ap-policy classification enable
Denial of Service
Denial of Service attack detection encompasses both rate analysis and detection of a specific DoS attack known as FakeAP .
Rate Analysis
Many DoS attacks flood an AP or multiple APs with 802.11 management frames. These can include authenticate/associate frames, designed to fill up the association table of an AP . Other management frame floods, such as probe request floods, can consume excess processing power on the AP . To configure rate analysis, navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Denial Of Service > Rate Analysis as shown in the figure below.
306
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 14
307
ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy ids-policy
rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param rate-frame-type-param
assoc channel-quiet-time 900 assoc node-threshold 30 assoc node-time-interval 60 assoc node-quiet-time 900 disassoc channel-threshold 30 disassoc channel-inc-time 3 disassoc channel-quiet-time 900 disassoc node-threshold 30 disassoc node-time-interval 60 disassoc node-quiet-time 900 deauth channel-threshold 30 deauth channel-inc-time 3 deauth channel-quiet-time 900 deauth node-threshold 150 deauth node-time-interval 15 deauth node-quiet-time 900 probe-request channel-threshold 30 probe-request channel-inc-time 3 probe-request channel-quiet-time 900 probe-request node-threshold 60 probe-request node-time-interval 60 probe-request node-quiet-time 900 probe-response channel-threshold 30 probe-response channel-inc-time 3 probe-response channel-quiet-time 900 probe-response node-threshold 60 probe-response node-time-interval 60 probe-response node-quiet-time 900 auth channel-threshold 30 auth channel-inc-time 3 auth channel-quiet-time 900 auth node-threshold 30 auth node-time-interval 60 auth node-quiet-time 900
FakeAP Detection
FakeAP is a tool originally created to thwart wardrivers by flooding beacon frames containing hundreds of different addresses. This would appear to a wardriver as though there were hundreds of different APs in the area, thus concealing the real AP . While the tool is still effective for this purpose, a newer purpose is to flood public hotspots or enterprises with fake AP beacons to confuse legitimate users and to increase the amount of processing client operating systems must do.
308 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 14
To configure detection of FakeAP , navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Denial of Service > FakeAP as shown in the figure below.
Man-in-the-Middle
A successful man-in-the-middle attack will insert an attacker into the data path between the client and the AP . In such a position, the attacker can delete, add, or modify data, provided he has access to the encryption keys. Such an attack also enables other attacks that can learn a users authentication credentials. Man-in-the-middle attacks often rely on a number of different vulnerabilities.
Intrusion Detection Configuration 309
MAC Spoofing
MAC address spoofing is a typical attack on a wireless LAN in which an attacker will spoof the MAC address of a currently active valid client in an attempt to be granted that clients access privileges. The AirJack driver for Linux allows easy access to such an attack. To configure detection of MAC address spoofing, navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Man-in-the-Middle > MAC Spoofing as shown in the figure below.
310
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 14
311
312
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 14
between sequence numbers seen in frames in the air. To configure sequence number analysis, navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Man-in-the-Middle > Sequence Number, as shown in the figure below.
313
AP Impersonation Protection
AP impersonation attacks can be done for several purposes, including as a Man-In-the-Middle attack, as a rogue AP attempting to bypass detection, and as a possible honeypot attack. In such an attack, the attacker sets up an AP that assumes the BSSID and ESSID of a valid AP . To configure AP Impersonation Detection and Protection, navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Man-in-the-Middle > AP Impersonation as shown in the figure below.
Signature Detection
Many WLAN intrusion and attack tools generate characteristic signatures that can be detected by the Aruba network. The system comes pre-configured with several known signatures, and also includes the ability for network managers
314
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 14
to create and edit new signatures. To configure signature detection, navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Signatures, as shown in Figure 14-10.
315
Pre-Defined Signatures
Pre-defined signatures as of AirOS 2.0 are listed below. These signatures may be supplemented or changed as additional software versions are released. Null-Probe-Response - An attack with the potential to crash or lock up the firmware of many 802.11 NICs. In this attack, a client probe-request frame will be answered by a probe response containing a null SSID. A number of popular NIC cards will lock up upon receiving such a probe response. AirJack Airjack is a popular NIC driver for Linux that allows manipulation of many 802.11 parameters. Airjack also includes AP functionality that by default generates beacons with an ESSID of AirJack. This signature detects the AP functionality using the default configuration. NetStumbler Generic NetStumbler is a popular wardriving application used to locate 802.11 networks. When used with certain NICs (such as Orinoco), NetStumbler generates a characteristic frame that can be detected. NetStumbler 3.3.0x Version 3.3.0 of NetStumbler changed the characteristic frame slightly. This signature detects the updated frame. Deauth-broadcast A deauth broadcast attempts to disconnect all stations in range rather than sending a spoofed deauth to a specific MAC address, this attack sends the frame to a broadcast address. CLI configuration for the pre-defined signatures is:
wms ids-signature "Null-Probe-Response" mode enable frame-type probe-response ssid-length 0 ! ids-signature "AirJack" mode enable frame-type beacon ssid AirJack ! ids-signature "NetStumbler Generic" mode enable payload 0x00601d 3 payload 0x0001 6 ! ids-signature "NetStumbler Version 3.3.0x" mode enable payload 0x00601d 3 payload 0x000102 12
316 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 14
WLAN Policies
wms ids-policy adhoc-check enable ap-policy protect-ibss enable ids-policy adhoc-quiet-time 900
318
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 14
Misconfigured AP Protection
If desired, a list of parameters can be configured that defines the characteristics of a valid AP . This is primarily used when non-Aruba APs are being used in the network, since the WLAN switch cannot configure the 3rd-party APs. These parameters can include preamble type, WEP configuration, OUI of valid MAC addresses, valid channels, DCF/PCF configuration, and ESSID. The system can also be configured to detect an AP using a weak WEP key. If a valid AP is detected as misconfigured, the system will deny access to the misconfigured AP . In cases where someone gains
Intrusion Detection Configuration 319
configuration access to a 3rd-party AP and changes the configuration, this policy is useful in blocking access to that AP until the configuration can be fixed. To configure protection of misconfigured APs, navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Policies > Misconfigured AP , as shown in Figure 14-14.
Disable Misconfigured Access Points When valid APs are found that violate the list of allowable parameters, prevents clients from associating to those APs using a denial of service attack. Valid Enterprise 802.11 b/g Channels Defines the list of valid 802.11b/g channels that 3rd-party APs are allowed to use. Valid Enterprise 802.11a ChannelsDefines the list of valid 802.11a channels that 3rd-party APs are allowed to use. Enforce Short Preamble as invalid AP configurationTBC Prevent valid clients from roaming to interfering APs If a valid enterprise client attempts to associate with an AP classified as interfering, the system will break the association using a denial of service attack.
320
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 14
Enforce WEP Encryption for all Traffic Any valid AP not using WEP will be flagged as misconfigured. Enforce WPA Encryption for all Traffic Any valid AP not using WPA will be flagged as misconfigured. Valid Access Point Manufacturers OUI List A list of MAC address OUIs that define valid AP manufacturers. Any valid AP with a differing OUI will be flagged as misconfigured. Equivalent CLI configuration for the example above is:
wms ap-policy protect-misconfigured-ap enable valid-11b-channel 6 mode enable valid-11b-channel 1 mode enable valid-11b-channel 11 mode enable valid-11a-channel 36 mode enable valid-11a-channel 60 mode enable valid-11a-channel 52 mode enable valid-11a-channel 64 mode enable valid-11a-channel 48 mode enable valid-11a-channel 44 mode enable valid-11a-channel 40 mode enable valid-11a-channel 56 mode enable station-policy protect-valid-sta enable ap-config privacy enable ap-config wpa disable
xx:xx:xx:ff:ff:ff
where xx:xx:xx is the desired OUI.
reports for the administrator of which devices require upgrades. To configure detection of weak WEP implementations, navigate to Configuration > WLAN Intrusion Detection > Policies > Weak WEP , as shown in the figure below.
322
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 14
wms ap-policy protect-mt-ssid enable valid-ssid OurSSID mode enable ap-policy protect-mt-channel-split enable reserved-11b-channel 1 mode enable
324
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
325
Sets the maximum time, in seconds, that a user may be idle before the user is deauthenticated and dropped from the system. The default is 5 minutes. Sets the maximum amount of time, in minutes, that an authentication server may remain unresponsive before it is considered down.
z Authentication Server
Deat Time
The RADIUS Servers page displays all the currently configured RADIUS servers. You may use the Edit and Delete buttons to change the configuration or delete it all together.
326
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
The Add RADIUS Server page appears. Enter information about a RADIUS server on this page then click Apply and Save configuration when you are finished.
The following parameters and options may be configured through Web UI. Server Name IP Address Shared Secret Verify Shared Secret Authentication Port A plain language meaningful name for the RADIUS server. The IP address of the RADIUS server. The secret work (password) shared between the client and the server. TBC Specifies the UDP port used for RADIUS exchanges.
327
Specifies the UDP port used for RADIUS accounting, when it is enabled. The maximum number the Aruba switch will issue authentication requests without receiving a reply. The maximum time, in seconds, that the switch will wait for a response from the RADIUS server after each authentication request is transmitted. TBC TBC TBC This parameter enables or disables the RADIUS server.
Timeout
Server Rules
Server rules may be defined for each server to determine role and VLAN assignments. Multiple rules may be defined for each server and each is executed in order. Server rules are displayed at the bottom of the Edit RADIUS Server page.
328
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
The following parameters may be configured for server rules using Web UI: Rule Type Attribute Condition Sets the rule type to either a role assignment or a VLAN assignment rule. Specifies which RADIUS attribute to examine for the value. Specifies how the rule will match the attribute information to the specified value. Specifies the value for which the rule will test the specified attribute. Specifies the role or VLAN to be assigned to the user if the rule tests true.
Value Role/VLAN
Configuring Attributes
To add an attribute, from the Add Server Rule page click Add Attribute. The following screen appears.
329
where: Attribute Name TBC Attribute ID TBC Attribute Type TBC Vendor Name TBC Vendor ID TBC
330
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
You may add, edit, or delete an LDAP server from the LDAP page. When the Add or Edit button is clicked the following page is displayed.
Server Name
331
TBC The IP address of the LDAP server. The port on which the server is configured. Default=389. The Distinguished Name of the node containing the entire user database to be used for user authentication. The name of the user who has read/search privileges across all entries in the LDAP database. The password for the Admin defined in Admin DN. Reenter the password entered for Admin Password. The attribute containing the unique key for the LDAP object. The filter to apply to searches for users in the LDAP database. The amount of time, in seconds, an LDAP may go unanswered before the server is considered down. Enables or disables the server.
Admin DN
Mode
332
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
where: Rule type is Role Assignment or Vlan Assignment.TBC Attribute is TBC Condition is TBC Value is TBC Role/Vlan is TBC
333
The internal database enables you to store information for user name, password, role, and email. You may also allow the switch to configure the role or you may create additional role or VLAN assignments using the interface on this page. Maintenance information TBC
334
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
Add configured servers by clicking Add then selecting a server from the pull-down menu.
335
You may choose to enable 802.1x Authentication with a minimum of effort. Follow the steps below. 1 2 3
Click the Enable Authentication checkbox. Select a default role from the pull-down menu Add an authentication server using the ADD button at the bottom of the page.
Part 0500055-03 May 2005
336
Chapter 15
The following options/features may be configured for 802.1x authentication using Web UI: Default Role The default role assigned to an 802.1x authenticated client if the role is not provided by the server. Enables/disables 802.1x authentication. TBC TBC TBC TBC Specifies the number of time a station may fail 802.1x authentication before it is placed on a blacklist and not allowed to authenticate. Enter 0 to disable blacklisting.
Enable authentication Enable Opportunistic Key Caching (WPA2) Enforce Machine Authentication Machine Authentication Default Role User Authentication Default Role Authentication Failure Threshold for Station Blacklisting
337
You may configure the following VPN options and parameters using Web UI. Authentication Enabled Default Role Check or uncheck this box to enable or disable VLAN Authentication. Use this pull-down menu to select the default role for the client when authenticated. This role is assigned if the authentication server does not provide role information. Specifies the number of time a station may fail authentication before it is placed on a blacklist and not allowed to authenticate. Enter 0 to disable blacklisting. Authentication Servers Use the Add button to create ordered list of authentication servers.
338
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
The following options and parameters may be configured using Web UI. Authentication Enabled Default Role Check or uncheck this box to enable or disable Captive Portal Authentication. Use this pull-down menu to select the default role for the client when authenticated. This role is assigned if the authentication server does not provide role information.
339
When selected, this option enables the display of a guest user field where the user may enter their email address as a user ID. The email address is not authenticated or validated, but it is tracked. When selected, this option enables the display of a registered user field wherein the user may enter their user ID and Password. When selected, this option enables a second small browser window to appear, facilitating a single click logout by the user. Use the radio buttons to select the browser protocol type, HTTP or HTTPS. If HTTP is selected user names and passwords are NOT encrypted. Default = HTTPS
The length of time in seconds during which the browser will display the Authorization Succeeded page containing additional options do download the VPN dialer. After the pause the browser will be redirected to the originally requested URL. This parameter specifies the maximum time the logon process will be delayed if the CPU is occupied with a large load of high priority traffic. This parameter specifies the CPU load which must be exceeded before a captive portal delay takes effect. Specifies the number of time a station may fail authentication before it is placed on a blacklist and not allowed to authenticate. Enter 0 to disable blacklisting.
Use the Add button to create ordered list of authentication servers. TBC
340
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
The following options and parameters may be configured with Web UI. Authentication Enabled Default Role Check or uncheck this box to enable or disable MAC Address Role Mapping. Use this pull-down menu to select the default role for the client when authenticated. This role is assigned if the authentication server does not provide role information. Specifies the number of time a station may fail authentication before it is placed on a blacklist and not allowed to authenticate. Enter 0 to disable blacklisting. Authentication Servers Use the Add button to create ordered list of authentication servers.
341
The following options and parameters may be configured with Web UI. Authentication Enabled Default Role Check or uncheck this box to enable or disable stateful 802.1x authentication. Use this pull-down menu to select the default role for the client when authenticated. This role is assigned if the authentication server does not provide role information. Specifies the maximum wait time for a response from the RADIUS server after seeing a RADIUS request from the AP . Use the Add button to create ordered list of authentication servers.
342
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
Role Mapping
From the Web UI, you can perform role mapping based on SSID and encryption. These two methods are discussed in the following sections. From the CLI, you can perform role mapping on BSSID, location, and MAC address in addition to SSID and encryption. To access role mapping from the CLI, enter:
(A5000) (config) #aaa derivation-rules user (A5000) (user-rule) #? no Delete Command set The action for the rule (A5000) (user-rule) #set ? role The action of the rule is to set to role vlan The action of the rule is to set to vlan (A5000) (user-rule) #set role condition ? bssid BSSID of access point encryption-type Encryption method used by station essid ESSID of access point location location of user in building.floor.location format macaddr MAC address of user
343
Click Add. Select a match condition from the Condition pull-down menu box. Enter a value for the ESSID you wish to match to a role. Select a role from the Role Name pull-down menu box.
3 4
344
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
Adding a Condition
TBC
where: Rule Typespecifies what rule will apply such as on MAC addresses, BSSIDs, or location. Conditionspecifies how the rule type is treated, for example a MAC address equal to a value. Valuespecifies the value of the condition, for example when location is not equal to Headquarters. Role Name is the name of the role affected by the condition. When you finish defining the condition, click Apply.
345
View the general authentication server settings using the show aaa timers command.
(Aruba) (config) #show aaa timers User idle timeout = 5 minutes Auth Server dead time = 10 minutes
Server Rules
Define server rules for deriving roles or VLANS using the aaa derivation-rules command from the CLI.
346
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
Enter the server-rule sub-mode using the aaa derivation-rules <ServerName> command.
z z z z z z
(Aruba) (server-rule) #set role condition User-Name contains foo set-value foo-user
You may view the rule you create using the show aaa derivation-rules command from the CLI.
(Aruba) (config) #show aaa derivation-rules server rad2-radius-server Server Rule Table ----------------Priority Attribute Operation Operand Action Value Total Hits New Hits -------- --------- --------- ------- ------ ----- ---------- ------1 User-Name contains foo set role foo-user 0 0
Enter the config-ldapserver submode by executing the aaa ldap-server command with the name of the server you wish to configure as the argument.
(Aruba) (config) #aaa ldap-server horseradish_2_ldap (Aruba) (config-ldapserver-horseradish_2_ldap)#
347
Specify a base distinguished name under which the server to search for all users.
(Aruba) (config-ldapserver-horseradish_2_ldap)#base-dn "cn=Users, dc=lm, dc=arubanetworks, dc=com"
Specify an admin distinguished name to establish the user with administrative rights.
(Aruba) (config-ldapserver-horseradish_2_ldap)#admin-dn "cn=Users, dc=lm, dc=arubanetworks, dc=com"
Specify the key attribute to use when searching for the server.
(Aruba) (config-ldapserver-horseradish_2_ldap)#key-attribute sAMAaccountName
Select a filter
(Aruba) (config-ldapserver-horseradish-2-ldap)#filter "(objectclass=*)"
10
348
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
View the LDAP server settings using the show aaa ldap-server <Name> command from the CLI.
(Aruba) (config) # show aaa ldap-server horseradish_2_ldap LDAP Server Table ----------------LDAP Server Attribute Value --------------------- ----Priority 5 Name horseradish_2_ldap Hostname 192.168.200.251 AuthPort 389 Retries 3 Timeout 20 AdminDN cn=Users, dc=lm, dc=arubanetworks, dc=com AdminPasswd ***** BaseDN cn=Users, cd=lm, dc=arubanetworks, dc=com KeyAttribute sAMAaccountName Filter (objectclass=*) Status Enabled InService no InitDone no AdminBound no Marked For Delete no In Use Callback Set no RefCount 0 RebindTimerSet yes RebindCount 19
Server Rules
The steps and commands for deriving roles and VLANs for LDAP are exactly the same as for RADIUS servers, above.
349
(Aruba) #show local-userdb User Details -----------Name Password Role ----------- ---NewGuy ******** foo-user OldGuy ******** foo-user BIGGuy ******** foo-user Peonski ******** foo-user User Entries: 4
Chapter 15
Select a default role for users authenticating through 802.1x. This is the role that will be assigned unless the authentication server provides another role for the user.
(Aruba) (config) #aaa dot1x default-role foo-user
351
Set the reauthentication time interval, in seconds (60-2147483647). You may also specify that the interval provided by the server be used.
352
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
You may view the 802.1x configuration settings using the show aaa dot1x command from the CLI.
(Aruba) (config) #show aaa dot1x Mode = 'Enabled' Default Role = 'foo-user' Max authentication failures = 0 Auth Server Table ----------------Pri Name Type IP addr AuthPort Status Inservice Applied Users --- ---- ---- ------- -------- ------ --------- ------- ----(Aruba) (config) #show dot1x ? ap-table Show 802.1X AP Table config Show 802.1X Authenticator Configuration supplicant-info Show details about supplicant(s) (Aruba) (config) #show dot1x config Authentication Server Timeout: 30 Seconds Client Response Timeout: 30 Seconds Fail Timeout: 30 Seconds Client Retry Count: 5 Server Retry Count: 3 Key Retry Count: 1 Reauthentication: Disabled Reauthentication Time Interval: 3600 Seconds Multicast Key Rotation: Enabled Multicast Key Rotation Time Interval: 1200 Seconds Unicast Key Rotation: Enabled Unicast Key Rotation Time Interval: 240 Seconds Countermeasure: Disabled Wired Clients: Disabled Enforce Machine Authentication: Disabled Machine Auth Cache Timeout: 24 Hours Machine Auth Default Role: guest User Auth Default Role: guest
353
354
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
Set the default role. This is the role which will be assigned to the client if the authentication server provides no role information about the client when they authenticate.
355
356
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
(Aruba) (config) #aaa stateful-authentication dot1x ap-config foo ap-ipaddr 192.168.150.1 radius-server-name rad2-radius-server key fooword
Role Mapping
(Aruba) (user-rule) #set role condition essid equals foo set-value foo-user
357
Specify the rule for assigning a role based on the client SSID
(Aruba) (user-rule) #set role condition encryption-type equals open set-value foo-user
z Per-SSID selection of authentication server for wireless networks z Domain and realm selection of authentication server z Dynamic authorization and authentication API using RFC 3576
The Problem
Most enterprise networks have a single authentication infrastructure, typically based on directory services such as Microsoft Active Directory or Novell NDS. For these enterprise networks, the standard authentication capabilities of AirOS are sufficient because all users on the system can be found in the same authentication database. However, a number of occasions arise where multiple distinct authentication infrastructures must be supported. For example, when two companies merge it often takes months or even years for the IT infrastructure to consolidate, meaning that user identity is often contained in multiple different user databases. For these networks, the ability to support multiple authentication systems is critical. For service providers, there also exists a requirement for multiple authentication systems. Service providers often provide wholesale access service for many different companies for example, a virtual hotspot service provider that resells service for three different national ISPs. Service providers also typically offer roaming agreements with other service providers, whereby customers of one service provider are able to connect to the networks of other service providers using their own access credentials. For these service providers, the ability to authenticate against multiple databases is essential. Finally, some enterprise networks also require the ability to provide fine-grained authorization (meaning what a user is permitted to do on the network) control on a per-user basis, where that authorization may change dynamically during a session. For example, an enterprise may wish to enable guest access to the network, but have the ability to shut off guest access to a given user as soon as that user checks out with the front lobby receptionist. In this situation, the
358
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
lobby receptionist would log the user out through visitor log software, which would then dynamically instruct the Aruba mobility controller to disconnect the user. For this application, a standard API (Application Programming Interface) is required to interface the mobility controller to a number of different software packages.
359
360
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 15
In service provider networks, the same access wholesaling described in the previous section can be enabled by this feature with much greater scalability. SSID-based authentication server selection described above permits up to 16 services on a given AP , limited by AP hardware. Domain or realm based authentication server selection, on the other hand, allows nearly an unlimited number of different services to be provided. All users can connect to the network using the same method, and the domain name supplied when the user authenticates will be used to determine which ISP has authentication data for that user. This method has the additional benefit of applying to wired networks as well as wireless networks.
Programming Interface) that allows fine-grained control of users by the authentication server. This control of users includes disconnection from the network, role re-assignment, and dynamic updates of user policies. One application for this API is in providing guest access. Nearly all corporate locations receive visitors, in the form of meeting attendees, vendors, customers, training class attendees, and so on. These visitors are increasingly equipped with mobile computing devices such as laptops, and often request or require access to their home office network or to the Internet. Corporate IT managers wish to be flexible in providing such access, but at the same time want to minimize the risk of unauthorized access because of concerns over legal liability. The ideal goal is to provide customized guest access, allowing only those services required by each individual visitor and only for the exact period of time the access is actually required. One of Arubas financial services customers has implemented this customized access approach using the RFC 3576 API. The company has visitor log software running at computers used by lobby receptionists. Each visitor to the office is issued an electronically-printed visitor badge that must be worn in the building. When the software prints the visitor badge, it dynamically provisions a RADIUS server with a temporary username and password, and prints this information on the visitors badge. The visitor can access either the wireless network through a guest SSID, or the wired network through any conference room or public area Ethernet jack. The visitor enters the username and password provided through a Web-based captive portal page, and is granted restricted access to the Internet. When the visitor leaves the office, the visitor badge must be returned to the lobby receptionist. The lobby receptionist logs the time the visitor left, and the visitor log software dynamically deletes the user from the RADIUS server. As soon as this happens, the RADIUS server signals the Aruba mobility controller using the RFC 3576 API and causes the user to be disconnected from the network.
362
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
z z z z
Starting the IAS Server Creating NAS clients Remote Access Policies Adding Users
363
Click the General tab at the top of the IAS Properties dialog box.
364
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 16
365
Click Start on the task bar, click Programs, then Administrative Tools, and then Internet Authentication Service. The Internet Authentication Service (IAS) window appears.
366
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 16
Enter a meaningful name in the Friendly name box. 4 5 Use the Protocol pull-down menu to select RADIUS for the protocol. Click Next. The Add RADIUS client dialog appears.
Enter the IP address of the RADIUS client. Select the appropriate vendor from the Client-Vendor pull-down box.
367
Enter a word in the Shared secret text box, then re-enter the same word in the Confirm shared secret text box. A shared secret is a text string that serves as a password between client and server, client and proxy, or a proxy and a server. Observe the following conventions when creating a shared secret:
z The shared secret must be the same case-sensitive text string on both z Use any standard alphanumeric and special characters. z Limit the length of the shared secret to 128 or less characters. z Create shared secrets of at least 22 characters and include numbers and z Use difference shared secrets for each radius server/client pair.
NOTEAdditional information regarding security and shared secrets, go to the Microsoft TechNet website.
http://www.microsoft.com/technet
devices.
Click Finish.
z Naming the policy z Setting the remote access policies and granting permission z Creating/editing a user profile
368
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 16
Remote access policies are created using the IAS Administration Tool. If the IAS Administration Tool is not already open, open it by Clicking Start on the task bar, then Programs, then Administrative Tools, and then Internet Authentication Service.
1 2
Right-click on the Remote Access Policies icon in the IAS window. Click on New Remote Access Policy. The Add Remote Access Policy dialog appears.
Type a name for the policy in the Policy friendly name text box.
369
Click the Add button. The Select Attribute list window appears.
Select the attributes (s) to add to the policy, then click the Add button. The NAS-IP-Address dialog box appears.
Type the NAS-IP-Address in the text box and click OK. NOTEAdd additional conditions by clicking the Add button, just below the conditions list, at the bottom of the Add Remote Access Policy window. Repeat the step above.
370 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 16
When finished adding conditions, click the Next button on Add Remote Access Policy dialog. 6 Select the Grant remote access permission radio box.
Click Next. The Add Remote Access Policy User Profile dialog appears.
371
Click the Edit Profile button. The Edit Dial-In Profile window appears.
Click on the Authentication tab. Check the Extensible Authentication Protocol check box. If the authentication server needs to be configured for EAP-TLS, then select either Smart Card or Other Certificate from the EAP drop-down menu. If the authentication servers needs to be configured for Protected EAP (PEAP), then select Protected EAP (PEAP) from the EAP drop-down dialog After the EAP type is selected, click OK and the Finish to set the properties.
Adding a User
Adding users to the active directory is accomplished in the following manner.
372
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 16
Click Start, then Run, then type mmc and press Enter. The Console window appears.
Click Console and select Add/Remove Snap-in. The Add/Remove Snap-In dialog appears.
373
Select the Active Directory User and Computer item in the Add Standalone Snap-in list window. Click Add, then the Close at the bottom of the list window.
Right-click the Users folder in the tree pane of the Console window. NOTEYou may find the Users folder along the path Console Root/Active Director Users and Computers/network name/Users. 4 Click New, then User. The New Object - User dialog appears
374
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 16
Type the users name information in the appropriate text fields., then click Next.
Enter the password in the Password text field and re-enter it in the Confirm Password text field. 5 Click Next. The New Object - User dialog below appears, then click Finish.
Configuring ACS
TBC
375
Configuring SBR
TBC
Configuring Funk
TBC
376
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Aliases
Aliases are a convenient way to associate a human understandable name with a specific object. AirOS enables administrators to assign easily understandable names to network ports (services) and specific IP Addresses or groups of IP Addresses
Firewall Configuration
377
Navigate to the Configuration > Security > Advanced > Services page.
Add a new Service Alias. Click Add. The Add Service page appears.
The options and parameters available for configuration on the Add Service page are: Service Name A plane language name that identifies the alias. NOTEDefault service aliases begin with svc- followed by the name of the protocol.
378
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 17
Protocol
Specify the protocol, either by using the radio buttons or by entering the protocol number (0 - 255). Sets the lower port number of a protocol port range. Sets the upper port number of a protocol port range. NOTEIf the service uses a single port, enter the starting port number here also.
1 2 3 4
Enter a name in the Service Name text field. Check the appropriate Protocol radio button. Enter the Starting Port. Enter the End Port (If this service uses only a single port, enter the starting port number here). Click Apply and Save Configuration
Firewall Configuration
379
You may add, delete, or modify source and destination aliases on this page. Aruba provides 3 pre-defined aliases which should not be altered or deleted. User When applied to an authenticated user the alias is replaced by an IP Addressed assigned to that user. Represents the IP Address, loopback address, or VLAN 1 address of the switch upon which the policy is running. Represents any IP Address
Mswitch
Any
Add a new alias by clicking Add, the Add Destinations page appears.
Click Add to expand the page and expose the Add Rule section, near the bottom. Enter a name for the new destination in the Destination Name text box.
380
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 17
Host
Use this selection to specify a single address. Do not enter anything in the Network Mask/Range field. Use this selection when specifying an IP subnet. It comprises a Use this selection when specifying an sequential range of IP Addresses. When specifying a range enter the upper address in the Network Mask/Range field. The maximum number of addresses is 16 when specifying a range.
Network Range
4 5
Enter an IP Address in the IP Address field. Enter a netmask or upper address of an IP range in the Network Mask/Range field.
NOTEIf you wish to specify a range with more than 16 addresses, select the Network Rule Type then enter network number and subnet mask in the IP Address and Network Mask fields.
Firewall Policies
Aruba AirOS firewall policies are stateful and bi-directional. Stateful policies mean that when a packet matches a rule, they must match exactly, the policy will create a session entry so that the session may continue in both directions. Firewall policies consist of a set of rules that are applied in a specific order against network traffic presented at the firewall. The rule at the top of the list is applied first. Rules are organized in top-down lists where the first rule applied to the traffic is at the top of the list. Traffic is tested against each rule in order until a match is found. When a match occurs the rule is applied and no other testing occurs. Policies can be applied to physical ports or to user roles.
Firewall Configuration
381
From the Firewall Policies page you may Edit, Delete, or Add policies.
2. user
382
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 17
3. host 4. network
This option will test true only for traffic to or from a specific IP Address. This option will test true only for traffic to or from a network specified by a network address and subnet mask This option will test true only for traffic to or from the address or addresses defined in a specified alias, see Defining Source and Destination Aliaseson page 379.
5. alias
The Service element of a rule has 5 options. Those options are: 1. any This option will test true for any type of traffic. This option will test true for only tcp traffic. This option will test true for only udp traffic. This option will test true for only traffic to or from a specified service alias. This option will test true for only traffic with a specified protocol number.
The Action element of a rule has 5 options. Those options are: 1. Permit Forward the packet without modification. Drop the packet with no notification. Change the source IP address of the packet and forward it. If no source NAT pool is specified the IP address of the Aruba switch will be substituted for the original source address. Change the destination IP address of the packed and to the switch IP address and forward it.
2. Deny 3. src-nat
4. dst-net
5. redirect
Firewall Configuration
383
Add a policy by clicking Add, the Add New Policy page appears.
The Add New Policy page is where you name your new policy and define rules for that policy. 1
Enter a meaningful name in the Policy Name field at the right hand side of the page. Select a traffic source from the Source pull-down menu. Select a traffic destination from the Destination pull-down menu. Select an action from the Action pull-down menu. Select Log in you wish each packet matching this rule to be recorded in the system logfile. Set a queue priority, high or low by selecting the corresponding Queue radio button.
Queue priority sets the priority of outbound wireless traffic.
2 3 4 5
7 8
Click Add. When you are done adding rules, click Apply and Save Configuration.
384
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 17
Select the port to which you wish to apply a policy, then use the pull-down menu to select a policy to apply. Click Apply and Save Configuration. More information TBC
Firewall Configuration
385
Role Design
A role is assigned to a user when they connect to the network, and possibly again after they are authenticated. Roles determine what network resources the user may access. Roles may be very broad-based, allowing access to many resources or they may be very narrow in scope, allowing access to very limited resources. Sometimes, a role is used to grant a particular user, or group of users, access to a specific resource that other users are not.
Configuring Roles
Navigate to the Configuration > Security > Roles page to view roles.
386
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 17
Click Add to begin adding a new role to the list. The Add Role page appears.
Firewall Configuration
387
z Specify an existing policy. z Create a new policy using an existing policy as a model. z Create a new policy from scratch.
Select the Choose from Configured Policies radio box. Specify a particular AP (if you wish to apply this policy only when using the specified AP) by entering the its location in the Location text box. Click Done.
Chapter 17
Create a new policy in exactly the same way you would in Firewall Policies on page 381.
Select the Create New Policy radio button. Click Create. The Add New Policy page appears. Create a new policy in exactly the same way you would in Firewall Policies on page 381.
z Role VLAN ID
Firewall Configuration
389
This option applies a bandwidth contract to the role. Use this option to assign a specific VPN dialer to a user role. For more information about configuring VPN dialers, see VPN Configurationon page 501. Use this option to specify the address pool from which a VPN user will be assigned an IP address when the user negotiates an L2TP/IPSec session. For more information see VPN Configurationon page 501. Use this option to specify the address pool from which a VPN user will be assigned an IP address when that user negotiates a PPTP session. For more information see VPN Configurationon page 501.
z L2TP Pool
z PPTP Pool
390
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 17
TCP
Use this option to specify TCP as the service. Specify a port for the service by including a single value after the UDP specifier or a range of ports by including two values representing startAddr and endAddr. The valid range for ports is 0-65535. Use this option to specify the service by its protocol number. No port or port range may be specified when using this option.
Protocol Number
(Aruba) (config) #show netservice Services -------Name Protocol Ports ----------- ----svc-snmp-trap udp 162 svc-syslog udp 514 svc-l2tp udp 1701 svc-ike udp 500 svc-https tcp 443 svc-smb-tcp tcp 445 svc-dhcp udp 67 68 . . .
Firewall Configuration
391
After entering the config-dest mode you may specify one of 3 types of destinations for your alias: host network Use this command to specify a specific host IP address for the alias. Use this command to specify a network or sub-net as a source or destination. Specify a network number followed by a subnet mask. Use this command to specify a range of valid IP addresses. Specify the lower address followed by the higher.
range
Enter the config-dest mode and define the name for the alias
(Aruba) (config) #netdestination dest-foo-any
Firewall Policies
Firewall policies are configured using the ip access-list session <name> command from the CLI. 1 Enter the config-sess-aclname mode.
392
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 17
If you wish to change the position of a rule in the list, use the position option to move the rule to a specific line.
(Aruba) (config) #show access-list brief Access list table ----------------Name Type Use Count --------------control session 4 captiveportal session 1 allowall session 1 vpnlogon session 1 cplogout session 1 guest session 0 stateful-dot1x session 0 ap-acl session 1 stateful-kerberos session 0
Roles ----logon ap-role stateful guest logon trusted-ap logon guest ap-role
Assign a policy to a the port used when entering the config-if mode.
(Aruba) (config-if)#ip access-group guest session
Firewall Configuration
393
Configuring Roles
Roles are configured in the CLI using the config-role mode commands.
Standard ACLs
Create standard ACLs using the standard option of the access-list command.
(Aruba) (config-std-foo-1)# permit 192.168.10.0 255.255.255 (Aruba) (config-std-foo-1)# permit host 192.168.20.15 (Aruba) (config-std-foo-1)# deny any
Chapter 17
Extended ACLs
Create extended ACLs using the extended option of the access-list command.
(Aruba) (config) #ip access-list extended foo-ext-1 (Aruba) (config-ext-foo-ext-1)# permit tcp any host 1.1.1.1 range 67 69 (Aruba) (config-ext-foo-ext-1)#permit icmp 1.1.1.0 0.0.0.255 any echo-reply
MAC ACLs
Create MAC ACLs using the mac option of the access-list command.
(Aruba) (config) #ip access-list mac foo-mac-1 (Aruba) (config-mac-foo-mac-1)# permit host 00:01:01:03:04:05 (Aruba) (config-mac-foo-mac-1)# permit 00:0a:ff:02:ad:01 ff:ff:ff:00:00:00
Ethertype ACLs
Create Ethertype ACLs using the eth option of the access-list command.
(Aruba) (config) #ip access-list eth foo-eth-1 (Aruba) (config-eth-foo-eth-1)# permit 2048
Firewall Configuration
395
396
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Add users to the authentication database. Configure the server information on WLAN switch. Apply an authentication server for captive portal authentication. Customize the logon role.
Identify what traffic is to be permitted to authenticate the user.
If guest access is to be allowed, enable the guest login and customize the guest role. Configure other user roles as needed. Configure server rules to derive the role for various users. Import a server certificate Customize the captive portal login screen, if desired.
6 7
8 9
397
z An internal database on the WLAN switch z An external RADIUS server attached to your network
If using an external RADIUS server, refer to your server documentation for adding users and skip to the next section. Otherwise, users must be added to the WLAN switch internal database. The internal database includes a default guest account. If no other specialized accounts are needed, no further server configuration is required and you can skip to the next section. If specialized accounts are needed, use the following CLI configuration commands:
398
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 18
(config) # aaa radius-server <name> [host <IP address>] [key <shared secret>] [authport <port number>] [acctport <port-number>] [timeout <seconds>] [inservice] [retransmit <retries>] [mode {enable|disable}]
Parameters: <name> host <IP address> key <shared key> Specify the name assigned to the RADIUS server. Specify the IP address of the remote RADIUS server host. Specify the shared secret text string used between the WLAN switch and the RADIUS server. Optional. Specify the authentication destination port number. The default is 1812. Optional. Specify the accounting destination port number. The default is 1813. Optional. Specify the length of time to wait for a reply from the RADIUS server before retransmitting the request. The default is 5 seconds. Optional. If the server has timed out, this option will set it a back in service immediately. Optional. Specify the number of times the WLAN switch transmits an unacknowledged RADIUS request to the server. The default is 3. Optional. Enable or disable the server. The default is enabled.
mode {enable|disable}
For example:
399
Use the no prefix to remove the server information from the database. For example:
z If using an external RADIUS server, use the name specified in the aaa
radius-server command. For example:
400
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 18
(aruba) # show ip access-list control ip access-list session control control ------Priority Source Destination Service Action Opcode Log Queue -------- ------ ----------- ------------ ------ --- ----1 any any svc-dhcp permit Low 2 user any svc-nbns permit Low 3 user any svc-dns permit Low 4 user any svc-tftp permit Low 5 user any svc-gre permit Low 6 any any svc-bootp permit Low 7 user any svc-icmp permit Low
NOTENetbios Name Server Lookup (NBNS), shown as rule 2 above, is required if using a WINS server with Microsoft Windows. You can add rules to the control ACL as follows:
(aruba) # configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CTRL/Z (aruba) (config) # ip access-list session control (aruba) (config-sess-control) # <source> <destination> <service> <action>
You can remove rules using the no form of the same command
401
(aruba) # show ip access-list captiveportal ip access-list session captiveportal captiveportal ------------Priority Source Destination Service Action Opcode Log Queue -------- ------ ----------- ----------------- --- ----1 user mswitch svc-https permit Low 2 user any svc-http dst-nat 8080 Low 3 user any svc-https dst-nat 8081 Low
Normally, the captive portal ACL need not be modified. However, you can add rules to ACL the if necessary:
(aruba) # configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CTRL/Z (aruba) (config) # ip access-list session captiveportal (aruba) (config-sess-captiveportal) # <source> <destination> <service> <action>
You can remove rules using the no form of the same command:
402
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 18
(aruba) # show rights RoleTable --------Name ACL Bandwidth ACL List ------ --------- -------ap-role 3 No Limit control trusted-ap 5 No Limit allowall guest 2 No Limit allowall stateful-dot1x 4 No Limit stateful-dot1x control logon 1 No Limit control vpnlogon captiveportal
In this case, the logon role shown at the bottom of the list has three ACLs: control, vpnlogon, and captiveportal. The vpnlogon ACL should be removed:
(aruba) # configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CTRL/Z (aruba) (config) # user-role logon (aruba) (config-role) # no session-acl vpnlogon
403
(config) # ip access-list session guest (config-sess-guest) # user network 172.5.0.0 255.255.255 deny (config-sess-guest) # user any any permit (config-sess-guest) # exit (config) # user-role guest (config-role) # session-acl guest
In the example above, the guest ACL denies internal network access and allows all else. The guest ACL is then assigned to the guest role. Another way to achieve the same results is as follows:
(aruba) (config) # destination internet network 172.5.0.0 255.255.0.0 invert (aruba) (config) # ip access-list session guest (config-sess-guest) # user alias internet permit
404
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 18
In the example above, a destination alias is created that represents all IP addresses except the internal network (by selecting the internal network and using the invert option). The guest user is then permitted access to the resources in the alias.
ip access-list session noilabs (This policy denies access to the iLabs network) any network 45.128.0.0 255.128.0.0 any deny exit (This policy denies access to the NOC network) ip access-list session nonoc user host 45.0.12.20 dns permit any network 45.0.0.0 255.255.0.0 any deny any network 45.2.0.0 255.255.0.0 any deny any network 45.125.0.0 255.255.0.0 any deny any network 45.120.0.0 255.255.0.0 any deny any network 192.16.170.0 255.255.255.0 any deny exit (iLabs users do not have access to the NOC network) user-role ilabs session-acl nonoc session-acl allowall exit (Guest users do not have access to either NOC or iLabs) user-role guest no session-acl control no session-acl guest session-acl nonoc session-acl noilabs session-acl allowall exit (NOC users have complete access) user-role noc session-acl allowall
405
If using the WLAN switch internal database, define the role condition:
If using an external RADIUS server, skip this step. Otherwise, if the internal database is used and the role configured in the database is to be used as the role after authentication, the following server rule must be configured:
(config)# aaa server-rule Internal (server-rule) # set role condition Role value-of
This means that if the Role attribute is present, its value is used for the role. 3
(config)# aaa server-rule IAS (server-rule) # set role condition Filter-Id value-of
This means that if the Role attribute is present, its value is used for the role. There are various other operators in addition to value-of such as contains, equals and not-equals which can be used in the commands above. If no role value is found, the default role for the captive portal will remain guest.
406
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 18
For more information on how role derivation works, refer to Setting Access Rights on page 415.
z A WLAN switch configured with a management interface IP address. z A PC with a standard Web browser and access to the WLAN switch IP
address. To access the certificate import page, enter the following URL in your Web browser:
http://<switch IP address or hostname>/screens/certificate_import.html
If your PC has access to the appropriate interface, you will be prompted to login.
407
408
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 18
If your PC has access to the appropriate interface, you will be prompted to login. 2
409
NOTETo revert to the default image, use the CLI del command to remove the cp_image file.
Sample Configuration
Listed below are the commands relevant to the captive portal configuration on an actual Mobility Controller places on an N+I network:
ip access-list session noilabs any network 45.128.0.0 255.128.0.0 any deny exit ip access-list session nonoc user host 45.0.12.20 dns permit any network 45.0.0.0 255.255.0.0 any deny any network 45.2.0.0 255.255.0.0 any deny any network 45.125.0.0 255.255.0.0 any deny any network 45.120.0.0 255.255.0.0 any deny any network 192.16.170.0 255.255.255.0 any deny exit ip access-list session captiveportal user any http dst-nat 8080 user host 45.1.14.1 https permit user any https dst-nat 8081 exit user-role ilabs session-acl nonoc session-acl allowall exit user-role guest no session-acl control no session-acl guest session-acl nonoc session-acl noilabs session-acl allowall exit user-role noc no session-acl noc session-acl allowall exit user-role logon no session-acl control no session-acl logon session-acl nonoc session-acl noilabs
410 Part 0500059-02 May 2005
Chapter 18
session-acl captiveportal session-acl allowall exit user-role ap session-acl nonoc session-acl noilabs exit aaa captive-portal default-role noc aaa captive-portal auth-server infoblox priority 1 aaa captive-portal auth-server infoblox aaa radius-server infoblox host 45.0.12.60 key infoblox aaa server-rule server infoblox set role condition User-Name starts-with ilab set-value ilabs exit interface vlan 1 ip address 45.1.14.1 255.255.0.0 exit ip default-gateway 45.1.0.1
Show Commands
The following show commands will help you obtain information important for configuring and debugging captive portal features.
show rights
This command gives an overview of all configured roles. It shows the component session ACL of each role.
(aruba) # show rights RoleTable --------Name Bandwidth -----------ap No Limit employee No Limit guest No Limit stateful No Limit logon No Limit
ACL List -------allowall employee control guest stateful allowall control logon
411
(aruba) # show rights employee Derived Role = 'employee' Bandwidth = No Limit Session ACL count = 1 Session ACL List = employee ACL = 11 VPN Dialer name = default-dialer employee -------Source Destination Service Action Opcode TimeRange Log Expired ------ ----------- ------- ------ ------ --------- --- ------any any any permit Expired Policies (due to time constraints) = 0
(aruba) # show aaa captive-portal Default Role = 'employee' Guest logon = enabled Auto Redirect delay = 5 seconds Auth Server List ---------------Pri Name Type Status Inservice Applied --- -------------------- ------1 ARUBA RADIUS Enabled Yes 1
412
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Chapter 18
show user-table
This command shows all the users currently known to the system:
(A5000) # show user-table Users ----IP ---------10.2.15.4 6:80:60:78/a (A5000) #
MAC -----------00:01:24:60:03:99
Name -----pdedhia
Role ---employee
Age(d:h:m) ---------00:09:52
Auth ---VPN
location -------52.1.3
Roaming ------Associated
Essid/Bssid/Phy --------------aruba-alpha-ap/00:0b:8
z IP: IP address of the user z MAC: MAC address of the user z Name: Name of the user z Role: Role assigned to the user z Age: How long the user has been known to the switch (days:hours:mins) z Auth: Authentication method (Web, VPN, 802.1x, MAC) z VPN link: Cross reference between inner and outer IP address of VPN user. z Location: The location code (building.floor.device) for the AP being used for
the connection.
413
414
Part 0500059-02
May 2005
Introduction
User rights are controlled by the ACL assigned to the users role. User roles are derived from information about the user obtained through the authentication process. A session ACL is comprised of one or more traffic filtering rules. The process of setting access rights involves the following 5 basic steps: 1 2 3 4 5 Define service and destination Alias Create one or more session ACLs Define a role(s) and apply a session ACL Configure a default role for authentication. Configure rules from which to derive roles.
415
Defining Alias
416
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 19
Predefined ACLs
A predefined session ACL named control, the predefined filters for the default control ACL are shown below:
z z z z z z
If a WINS server is configured then the following filter should be added to the control ACL:
svc-nbns
Another predefined ACL named captive portal allows only that traffic necessary for captive portal authentication. The filters associated with this ACL are:
z z z
A separate ACL(s) should be created for use after the user has been authenticated and assigned a role.
417
After a Session ACL has been created it must be assigned to a role(s) using the user-role command. See Role Sub-Mode on page 819.
Role Derivation
The simplest way to assign a role is to create a default role for the authentication method being used, then assign that role to all or most of the users when they are authenticated. Create a role using the aaa captive-portal command. See AAA Commands on page 823.
418
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 19
419
Show Commands
The Show Commands associated with user rights are:
z z z z z z
show rights show rights rolename show rights derive-role authentication_method show access-list aclname show aaa captive-portal show user-table
A full description of the Show Commands may be found in the Show Commands chapter.
420
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
421
System Overview
Components
The Aruba WLAN solution consists of the three major components:
z The Aruba Wireless Access Point. This is a next-generation wireless transceiver which functions as AP or Air Monitor (AM). Although third-party APs can be used with the Aruba WLAN system, the Aruba AP provides the best features and easiest integration.
z The Aruba AirOS Switch Software. This software intelligently integrates the
WLAN switch and APs to provide load balancing, rate limiting, self healing, authentication, mobility, security, centralization for monitoring and upgrades, and more.
LAN
Aruba AP (Switch via LAN) Trusted (Internal) Network
Wireless Clients
Direct Connection
The Aruba AP can be connected directly to one of the FE ports on Mobility Controller. In this topology, the port on which the AP is connected is considered untrusted; all users associating with the AP are untrusted and must be authenticated, and all traffic is checked against per-user firewall rules.
422
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
APs with a direct connection to the WLAN switch can also utilize optional Serial and Power Over Ethernet (SPOE) and support the WLAN switch Access Point Status LEDs .(When multiple APs are connected to a port indirectly, the LEDs provide information about the aggregate connection, not about a specific AP .) NOTETo use SPOE, the AP must be connected to the Mobility Controller without any intervening hubs, routers, or other networking equipment.
Indirect Connection
The Aruba AP can be also be connected to the Mobility Controller through a Layer 2/Layer 3 network. In this topology, the WLAN switch port connected to the network is considered trusted; the traffic is verified to ensure it is a recognized part of the internal network. Indirect deployment results in minimal disruption to existing infrastructure. Indirect deployment requires that there are no Network Address Translation (NAT) devices in the path between the AP and the Mobility Controller. Also, if there is a firewall between AP and switch, the following protocols/ports should be allowed to pass between them:
z z z z z
Requirements
You must have the following:
423
AP Provisioning
There are several methods for setting up and configuring Aruba APs for use with the WLAN switch. Depending on your network configuration, the following methods are available, each of which is explained in greater detail below:
z Plug and PlayA limited situation where APs can be connected to the
WLAN switch and brought into operation with only default configuration settings.
z DHCP must be available on your network. z The Aruba AP must begin with factory default values.
If the AP and your network meet these requirements, you can connect the AP to the switch with no further configuration. When the AP boots, it will be assigned a default location ID of 255.255.65535. NOTEIf the AP has been previously used in another network and configured with settings compatible to the new WLAN switch, plug and play may function correctly. However, if the AP uses settings incompatible with the new network (wrong hostname or static IP address), plug and play will fail. If the AP does not work with the new WLAN switch, return the AP to its original network and reset the AP to its factory defaults before moving it again, or perform manual provisioning.
424
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
Simplified AP Provisioning
This is a streamlined example of the AP Programming Mode. This procedure represents the most typical customization: setting the master WLAN switch IP address on the AP . In this example, DNS is not required. NOTEIf you would like more control over AP configuration settings, or for more details on any of the commands in the procedure, see AP Programming Mode on page 426. To perform simplified AP provisioning through the CLI, use the following procedure: 1
3 4
Connect the target APs to the specified AP programming ports on the switch and power up the APs. Verify that all target APs are detected by the switch.
(aruba) (program-ap) # show provisioning-ap-list
Detected APs will be shown on the provisioning list. It may take a couple minutes for all APs to be detected. Repeat the command until all expected APs appear on the list.
Configure the IP address of the host (master WLAN switch) for the AP .
(aruba) (program-ap) # hostip <WLAN switch IP address> (aruba) (program-ap) # masterip <WLAN switch IP address>
425
Once the settings are correct, push the configuration to the APs.
(aruba) (program-ap) # config all
AP Programming Mode
The AP Programming Mode offers extended provisioning for adding Aruba APs to a highly customized network. To perform extended provisioning through the CLI, use the following procedure: 1
Enable AP programming mode on the port(s) you will use for configuring Aruba APs:
Any switch port (or range) can be placed in AP Programming Mode. While in AP Programming Mode, normal network traffic on the designated ports is suspended. When AP configuration is complete, the AP Programming Mode must be disabled so that the ports can resume their normal network functions. NOTEBefore enabling AP programming mode on any port, make sure that the port is available and is not connected to working APs or other networking equipment. The CLI command to set a port or port range for AP provisioning is as follows:
port-range <Physical Switch Slot>/<Port>[-<End port of range)>]
(aruba) (program-ap) # port-range 2/1(Specify an AP Programming port) (aruba) (program-ap) # enable(Enable AP programming on the port)
Or to set a range of ports (slot 2 ports 1 through 3):
(aruba) (program-ap) # port-range 2/1-3(Specify a port range) (aruba) (program-ap) # enable(Enable AP programming on the range)
426
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
Connect the Aruba APs that require configuration to one of the specified AP programming ports on the switch.
NOTEAlthough a direct Ethernet connection between the AP and WLAN switch is preferred, a Layer 2 hub can be used to connect more than one Aruba AP to any specific AP programming port.
4 5
Power up the connected APs. Verify that the APs connected to the AP programming ports are detected by the switch.
Use the following command to list the APs detected on the AP programming ports:
If expected APs do not appear on the list, check the following troubleshooting points:
z Make sure there is no Layer 3 routing device between the AP and WLAN
switch.
z Make sure that the correct WLAN switch ports are set for AP programming
mode and that the enable command has been executed (see Step 2).
z Make sure that the AP is powered on and connected to the correct WLAN
switch port.
427
z Disconnect and reconnect the AP from the switch port. If the AP list had
previously been cleared using the clear-provisioning-ap-list command, the AP should now reappear.
428
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
z Does your network use direct IP addresses or DNS with host names? z If using host names, is aruba-master acceptable for the master WLAN
switch, or do you need to define a different name? Depending on your answers, select one of the following lettered steps.
A
My network uses DNS. The aruba-master host name is acceptable. This is the default. This requires that your DNS be configured to resolve the aruba-master host name to the IP address of the master Mobility Controller. Unless your system has been previously configured for different settings, you can skip to Step 3 on page 440. Otherwise, if your system was previously configured for a different setup, you should manually set the host name to its default value:
My network uses DNS, but I want to use a different host name for the WLAN switch. This requires that the hostname setting be configured with your chosen host name for the master Mobility Controller and that your DNS be configured to resolve the specified host name to the IP address of the master Mobility Controller. To change the host name, use the following command:
My network uses direct IP addresses instead of DNS. If using direct IP addresses in your network, use the following commands:
(aruba) (program-ap) # hostip <WLAN switch IP address> (aruba) (program-ap) # masterip <WLAN switch IP address>
NOTEIf the hostname setting is configured in this scenario, it will be ignored.
429
, if necessary. 7Ste Specify an IP address for a specific AP If using DHCP , the AP will obtain its IP address automatically and you can skip this step. Otherwise, configure the AP with a static IP address using the following commands:
(aruba) (program-ap) # netmask <static IP address mask> (aruba) (program-ap) # gateway <default gateway IP address>
8Ste
z Default Locations
If you wish all APs to be treated as a single entity for configuration and accounting purposes, you can use the default location profile (255.255.65535) and skip to Step 11 on page 432.
z Specific Locations
By setting specific location IDs for each AP , you can later apply configuration changes or collect statistics and information for specific groups of APs (for example, all APs on a particular floor in a particular building). To set a specific location for an individual AP , the following command is used:
A unique number (1-254) is required for each building in your campus. Within any building, a unique number (1-254) is required for each floor. Within any floor, a unique number (1-65534) is required for each access point or air monitor.
If you performed the recommended site survey using the Aruba RF Plan tool, the location data for all access points and air monitors can be found on the tools deployment screen.
430
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
If you prefer to manually generate the location data, record the location you set for each access point and air monitor along with the following:
Note the intended function of the device (access point or dedicated air monitor) and a brief description of its service location. For each access point and air monitor, measure its X and Y position (in feet) relative to the bottom-left corner of the building plan as seen from overhead. For example:
262 ft. 98
0,0
126
X 418 ft.
Use the same fixed point and orientation for all floors in a building. 10
431
11St
If configuring specific settings for individual APs, repeat Step 6 through Step 11 of this procedure for each Aruba AP that requires configuration. If configuring multiple sets of APs, prepare for the next set.
Disconnect the provisioned APs from the WLAN switch, set them aside for deployment, and use the following command to clear the AP provisioning list:
14
432
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
This will return all AP programming ports to their previously defined network settings. NOTEIf the AP programming mode is not disabled after provisioning is complete, the affected switch ports will not work properly for normal network operations.
Manual AP Provisioning
APs can be individually provisioned using a terminal connected directly to the AP serial port. This method should be used only as a last resort, as it provides no command error feedback and can result in misconfiguring the AP if not performed correctly. Details on manually performing initial setup and configuration of the AP can be found in the Aruba AP Installation Guide and the Aruba AirOS Users Guide.
AP Reprovisioning
The following reprovisioning commands can be used to make configuration changes to APs which are already configured and deployed. NOTEReprovisioning does not require AP programming mode to be enabled on the WLAN switch ports. Do not use the AP programming sub-mode port-range or enable commands for reprovisioning, as this will disrupt normal network operation. 1
Read the current information from the deployed APs you wish to reprovision.
(aruba) (program-ap) # read-bootinfo <AP IP address>
You can repeat this command for as many deployed APs as you wish. The configuration information for each AP will be added to the AP provisioning list, which can be displayed using show provisioning-ap-list command.
433
NOTEThe reset-bootinfo command takes effect immediately and does not require use of the AP programming mode config or reprovision commands. 4
Data Bits
8
Parity
None
Stop Bits
1
Flow Control
None
Once attached, press <Enter> a few times to establish communication between the AP and the terminal. Proceed to Step 3 on page 436.
2St If using Telnet to connect to the AP remotely, access the AP through the WLAN switch Serial and Power Over Ethernet (SPOE) interface.
434 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 20
NOTEIf using a terminal directly connected to the AP , see Step 1 on page 434 instead. By default, the WLAN switch does not permit Telnet access to the serial portion of the SPOE interface. To enable the serial interface for remote access to APs, log in to the Aruba WLAN Switch as the administrator and perform the following configuration command:
Available commands: baud [9600|19200|38400|57600|115200] connect <slot/port> exit (no args) soe>
Connect to the Mobility Controller port to which the ArubaOS 2.4 is physically attached:
435
AS
If the AP is initializing after power up. When power is first connected, the AP will begin its initialization process. At any time before the autoboot timer expires, you can press any key to interrupt this process. For example:
APBoot 1.0.1 (Mar 7 2003 - 16:20:28) CPU: MPC8245 Revision 16.20 at 192 MHz: Watchdog enabled Board: ASAP Local Bus at 96 MHz DRAM: 16 MB POST: passed FLASH: 4 MB PCI: scanning bus0 ... dev fn venID devID class rev MBAR0 00 00 1057 0006 060000 12 00000008 12 00 1260 3873 028000 01 f0000008 13 00 1317 0985 020000 11 fe000001 14 00 168c 0012 020000 01 f0010000 In: serial Out: serial Err: serial Net: an983b#0 16 kB I-Cache 16 kB D-Cache
apboot> apboot>
436
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
If the AP has completed booting. If no key is pressed before the autoboot timer expires (default of 3 seconds), the AP will resume normal software loading and initialization functions:
ARP broadcast 1 for 10.3.3.1 TFTP from server 10.3.3.1; our IP address is 10.3.3.3 Filename 'sap.bin'. Load address: 0x100000 Loading: T ################################################################ ################################################################ ################################################################ ### Done Bytes transferred = 1622016 (18c000 hex) Automatic boot of image at addr 0x00100000 ... vendor : Aruba Wireless Networks Inc.
#
Once the AP has booted and the # prompt appears, you must turn the AP off and back on, and then press any key while the AP is initializing (see Step 3-A on page 436). To turn the AP off, disconnect its power by either unplugging its power adapter (if used) or disconnecting the FE cable (if Power Over Ethernet is used).
C
If the AP is in a continual boot cycle. If the AP cannot connect to the WLAN switch, the AP will remain in a boot cycle looking for a switch from which to download its software and configuration:
BOOTP broadcast 1 DHCP IP address: 10.3.9.172 DHCP subnet mask: 255.255.255.0 DHCP def gateway: 10.3.9.254 DHCP DNS server: 10.1.1.2 ARP broadcast 1 for 10.3.9.254 TFTP from server 10.10.10.10; our IP address is 10.3.9.172; sending through gateway 10.3.9.254 Filename 'sap.bin'. Load address: 0x100000 Loading: T T T T T T T T T Retry count exceeded; starting again
Press <Control-C> at any time to interrupt the boot cycle. You will be presented with the AP boot prompt (apboot>). From the AP boot prompt, proceed to Initial Configuration on page 438.
437
Initial Configuration
The Aruba AP requires some initial configuration before it will operate. All direct configuration of the AP is done using the AP boot prompt (see page 434). Once connected to the AP boot prompt, configure the AP as follows: 1
From the AP boot prompt, set the intended location for the AP: apboot> setenv location <building number>.<floor number>.<device number>
If you performed the recommended site survey using the built-in RF Plan tool, the location data for all access points and air monitors can be found on the tools deployment screen. If you plan to manually generate the location data, record the following information for each access point and air monitor. It will be required when configuring the Mobility Controller. Building Number Floor Number Device Number Device Description X, Y Coordinates A unique number (1-254) is required for each building in your campus. Within any building, a unique number (1-254) is required for each floor. Within any floor, a unique number (1-65534) is required for each access point or air monitor. Note the intended function of the device (access point or dedicated air monitor) and a brief description of its service location. For each access point and air monitor, measure its X and Y position (in feet) relative to the bottom-left corner of the building plan as seen from overhead. For example:
262 ft. 98
0,0
126
X 418 ft.
Use the same fixed point and orientation for all floors in a building.
438
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
z Does your network use DNS with host names, or direct IP addresses? z If using host names, is aruba-master acceptable for the master WLAN
switch, or do you want to define a different name? Depending on your answers, select one of the following lettered steps.
A
My network uses DNS. The aruba-master host name is acceptable. This is the default. This requires that your DNS be configured to resolve the aruba-master host name to the IP address of the master Mobility Controller. By default, the AP is configured to use the aruba-master host name. However, if the AP was previously configured for a different setup, you should manually set the host name on the AP to its default value:
My network uses DNS. I want to use a different host name for the WLAN switch. This requires that the servername environment variable be configured with your chosen host name for the master Mobility Controller and that your DNS be configured to resolve the specified host name to the IP address of the master Mobility Controller. To change the host name, configure the AP as follows:
My network uses direct IP addresses instead of DNS. If using direct IP addresses in your network, use the following commands:
apboot> setenv serverip <WLAN switch IP address> apboot> setenv master <WLAN switch IP address>
439
NOTEIf the servername environment variable is configured in this scenario, it will be ignored.
3Step Specify an IP address, if necessary. If using DHCP , the ArubaOS 2.4 will obtain its IP address automatically and this step can be skipped. Otherwise, the AP must be manually configured with a static IP address using the following commands:
apboot> setenv ipaddr <static IP address for the AP> apboot> setenv netmask <static IP address mask> apboot> setenv gatewayip <default gateway IP address>
4
440
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
Advanced AP Configuration
The following sections cover the following:
z How to access the Aruba AP configuration prompt z Commands and settings that can be configured z Example configurations for common scenarios
APBoot Commands
The following commands are available from the apboot prompt:
z help
List the available commands and a brief explanation of each.
z printenv
List the environment variables and their current settings. The environmental variables represent the APs configurable parameters See page 442 for a list of variables.
z saveenv
Save the environment variables to persistent storage. Make sure to save configuration changes before rebooting the AP .
z boot
Boot the AP using the currently saved environmental variables. Any unsaved changes to the variables will be lost.
z reset
Restart the AP . This is similar to cycling the power on the AP .
441
Description
The length of time (in seconds) of the autoboot timer. This is the delay during which the user can interrupt the boot process and access the apboot prompt (see page 434). Default = 3
location
The location specifies which configuration profile will be downloaded to the AP from the WLAN switch. See page 447 for more location information. Default = -1.-1.-1 (unconfigured) master This is the IP address or hostname of the Mobility Controller that controls the AP . The AP downloads its configuration from the specified switch. If a hostname is specified, your DNS server must be configured to resolve the hostname to the master Mobility Controller. The master variable overrides the value of serverip and servername (below) if configured.
442
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
Description
This is the hostname of the Mobility Controller (or TFTP server) that holds the AP software image and/or configuration files. When using this variable, your DNS server must be configured to resolve the specified hostname to the appropriate location. The default value is aruba-master. If not using DNS, use the master and serverip variables instead. The servername variable overrides the value of serverip (for both software and configuration) and is overridden by the master variable (for configuration only) if configured.
serverip
This is the IP address of the Mobility Controller (or TFTP server) where the AP software and/or configuration files are stored. This variable is usually set when DNS is not used. The serverip variable is overridden by the servername variable (for both software and configuration) and the master variable (for configuration only) if configured.
ipaddr
This is the IP address of the AP , specified in dotted decimal notation. If specified, the AP uses this address instead of obtaining one using DHCP . This is the IP address mask of the AP . This is used in conjunction with the ipaddr variable to define the subnet of the AP . This is the IP address of the default gateway for the IP . This is used in conjunction with ipaddr when using static addresses instead of DHCP .
netmask
gatewayip
The following environmental variables should be kept at their default values unless directed otherwise by Aruba support:
Description
Default = yes Default = 9600 Default = localflash
443
Description
This is the file name of the AP image. Default = sap.bin
This is the MAC address of the Ethernet interface in the AP . This is unique for each AP . Default = serial Default = serial Default = serial
AP Configuration Examples
Factory Default Values
By default, the environmental variables are as follows:
apboot> printenv bootcmd=localflasha bootdelay=2 baudrate=9600 servername=aruba-master bootfile=sap.bin autostart=yes ethaddr=00:30:f1:71:d6:1d stdin=serial stdout=serial stderr=serial Environment size: 165/131068 bytes apboot>
a.As of AirOS 2.2.1, after an Access Point loads a local image, it will compare that image with the booted image. It the images differ, the AP will attempt to download the latest image using FTP. If FTP fails, the AP will attempt to download the latest image using TFTP.
NOTEVariables not listed have no effect on this configuration. With these settings:
z DHCP is used to obtain the APs IP address. z DNS is used to resolve aruba-master for the Aruba 5000 IP address.
444 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 20
z The AP location is set to -1.-1.-1 (unconfigured) and uses the default location profile.
apboot> setenv servername mytftp apboot> saveenv apboot> printenv bootcmd=tftpboot bootdelay=2 baudrate=9600 servername=mytftp bootfile=sap.bin autostart=yes ethaddr=00:30:f1:71:d6:1d stdin=serial stdout=serial stderr=serial Environment size: 178/131068 bytes apboot>
445
When booted normally (without entering APBoot mode), the AP will use the new settings and the AP console will display the following kind of information:
apboot> boot
ARP broadcast 1 for 10.3.3.1 TFTP from server 10.3.3.1; our IP address is 10.3.3.3 Filename 'sap.bin'. Load address: 0x100000 Loading: T ################################################################ ################################################################ ################################################################ ### Done Bytes transferred = 1622016 (18c000 hex) Automatic boot of image at addr 0x00100000 ... vendor : Aruba Wireless Networks Inc.
#
If DNS is not used or if you need to assign different TFTP servers for the software and configuration files, the following environment variables can be configured:
servername
DNS name of the TFTP server that holds the AP software image. Usually resolves to the WLAN switch. Highest priority. Overrides serverip.
DNS name of TFTP server that holds the AP configuration. Usually resolves to the WLAN switch. Overridden by master. Overrides serverip. IP address of the TFTP configuration server. For use instead of DNS. Lowest priority. If master and servername are not configured, serverip is used.
serverip
IP address of the TFTP software server. For use instead of DNS. Overridden by servername.
446
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
NOTESpelling is critical when defining environment variables. The AP may not function properly if environment variables are misspelled or misconfigured.
setenv ipaddr 10.3.3.3 setenv netmask 255.255.255.0 setenv gatewayip 10.3.3.254 saveenv
z Building number
A unique number (1-255) is required for each building in your campus.
z Floor number
Within any building, a unique number (1-255) is required for each floor.
447
z Device number
Within any floor, a unique number (1-65535) is required for each access point or air monitor.
z Device description
Although not strictly required, we recommend that you note the intended function of the device (access point or dedicated air monitor) and a brief description of its service location.
z X, Y coordinates
For each access point and air monitor, measure its X and Y position (in feet) relative to the bottom-left corner of the building plan as seen from overhead. Use the same fixed point and orientation for all floors in a building.
GRE Tunnels
Regardless of the network topology between the AP and the WLAN switch, the AP will open one GRE tunnel per radio interface to the WLAN switch. One end of the GRE tunnel will be the IP address of the AP . The other end of the GRE tunnel is specified (in descending order of priority) by the master, servername, and then serverip variables. If these variables are left to default values, the AP will use DNS to look up the well known name aruba-master to discover the Aruba 5000 WLAN Switch.
448
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
Once the IP address is discovered, the AP uses its closest address (in terms of router hops) as the GRE tunnel end point at the WLAN switch. You can determine the WLAN switch tunnel end-point using the following AP console commands:
# enable (Enter the AP privileged command mode) Password: <privileged password> (Same as WLAN switch enable password) # Spawning Enable Shell. Type Ctrl-D to exit enable mode. # show config 11G config essid piyer-wep-ap channel 6 txpower 0 rates 0x0 bssid 00:30:f1:70:49:70 beacon_interval 0 dtim_period 0 mode monitor sensitivity 0 frag_threshold 0 rts_threshold 0 retry 255 lms_address 10.3.3.1 status 1 short_preamble 0 power_mgmt 0 calibrate 0 encryption 0 location 1.2.1 walkabout 0 mtu 1564 ageout 300 heartbeat 40 ...
(Displayed first for 802.11g and then 802.11a) (ESSID) (Channel that the AP is on) (Transmit power set on the interface) (MAC address of the WLAN interface) (monitor for air monitor, or master for AP)
(IP address of the Aruba 5000 GRE endpoint) (shown for 802.11g only) (Set to 1 if power management is enabled on the interface) (Set to 1 if calibration is in progress) (Location configured for the AP) (Set to 1 if walkabout is in progress) (Result of MTU discovery) (Ageout for inactive STA in seconds) (Number of successful heartbeats on tunnel to the switch)
The value of lms_address is the WLAN switch tunnel end point in use by AP .
1 2
Log in as the administrator and access the switch configuration mode. Configure a tunnel interface.
The tunnel interface defines the local and remote end-points for the GRE tunnel, as well as the IP address (or range) of the tunnel network. The following commands are used to configure a tunnel on the WLAN switch:
(config) # interface tunnel <tunnel ID> (config-if) # ip address <tunnel IP address> <tunnel netmask> (config-if) # tunnel source <local end-point> (config-if) # tunnel destination <remote end-point> (config-if) # tunnel mode gre ip
where the following parameters apply: tunnel ID tunnel IP address The local ID (1-2147483647) of the tunnel being defined on the switch. The base IP address of the tunnel. This represents the entrance to the tunnel. Static routes direct traffic into the tunnel through this address. The subnet mask used with the tunnel IP address to create a tunnel network range. The local end-point of the tunnel on the Aruba WLAN switch. The local end-point can be one of the following:
destination address
The base IP address of the destination on the other side of the tunnel.
450
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
destination netmask
The subnet mask used with the destination address to create an address range.
tunnel IP address An IP address on the tunnel network defined in the previous step. This is used as the next hop for traffic destined for the remote network.
(config) # ip access-list session redirguest (config-sess-redirguest) # user any any redirect tunnel 1 (config-sess-redirguest) # any user any permit (config-sess-redirguest) # user-role guest (config-role) # session-acl redirguest (config-role) # no session-acl control (config-role) # no session-acl cplogout
NOTEThis example assumes that the guest user-role has already been defined.
z The different types of AP configuration profiles stored on the WLAN z Commands and settings that can be configured z Example configurations for common scenarios
switch
Configuration Profiles
Many AP attributes are configured and stored in profiles on the WLAN switch. The profiles can be based on location index or BSSID.
Location-Based Profiles
AP configuration profiles can be based on the unique location index (building.floor.device) assigned to each AP during its initial setup (see page 447). These location-based configuration profiles are stored on the WLAN switch and are downloaded to the appropriate APs during their startup process.
451
(Aruba) # configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z (Aruba) (config) # ap location <building>.<floor>.<device>
Once in the location configuration sub-mode, use the AP Attribute Commands (see page 456) to set AP attributes.
452
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
z Building Profiles
A building profile uses the location index <building>.0.0 (wildcards for floor and device). Attributes configured in building profiles override those in the base profile. Unless overridden by floor or individual profiles, these attributes affect all APs in the specified building.
z Floor Profiles
A floor profile uses the location index <building>.<floor>.0 (wildcard for device). Attributes configured in floor profiles override those in the base and building profiles. Unless overridden by individual profiles, these attributes affect all APs on the specified floor.
z Individual AP Profiles
Attributes configured for an individual AP (no wildcards) always override those in the base, building, and floor profiles.
453
Attributes in the various profiles are treated individually. Only the attributes which are specifically configured in one profile will override the more generic profiles. For example:
System Default
ageout 1000 ap-enable enable beacon-period 100 dtim-period 2 essid (blank) max-clients 0 max-retries 3 mode ap-mode opmode opensystem power-mgmt enable rts-threshhold 2333 short-preamble enable tx-power 2 phy-type a: channel 36 rates 6,9,12,18,24,36,48,5 4 phy-type g: channel 1 rates 1,2,5,11
AP 1.2.1 Profile
beacon-period 300 dtim-period 0 essid lab1b max-clients 15 max-retries 3 mode ap-mode opmode opensystem power-mgmt enable rts-threshhold 2333 short-preamble enable tx-power 2 phy-type a: channel 36 rates 6,9,12,18,24,36,48,5 4 phy-type g: channel 1 rates 1,2,5,11
The highlighted attributes override those in the other profiles. Also, when an attribute in a more specific profile is cleared (see the no command on page 457), the result configuration uses value from the next more generic profile. For example, if the max-clients value in the AP 1.2.1 profile above is cleared (no max-clients), the base profile value would be usednot the system default.
454
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
BSSID-Based Profiles
AP profiles can also be specified for a BSSID. There is no hierarchical lookup for BSSID-based profiles. Each specific BSSID profile is applied to the AP radio interface with a matching BSSID. The following WLAN switch commands are issued to enter the AP BSSID configuration sub-mode:
(Aruba) # configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z (Aruba) (config) # ap bssid <BSSID>
455
z ap-enable {enable|disable}
Enable or disable the AP . The default is enabled.
456
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
z mode {ap_mode|am_mode}
Specify the mode for the AP:
ap_mode
The AP provides transparent, secure, high-speed data communications between wireless network devices and the wired LAN. This is the default. The device behaves as an air monitor to collect statistics, monitor traffic, detect intrusions, enforce security policies, balance traffic load, self-heal coverage gaps, etc.
am_mode
z no <command>
Clear the specified command attributes in the current profile.
NOTEIf using location-based profiles, any specific AP will use the first defined (non-cleared) attribute in profile hierarchy: favoring AP , floor, building, base, or system default profile (in order of descending priority).
opensystem staticWep
No encryption. Traffic is sent in the clear. This is the default. Use Wireless Equivalent Privacy (WEP) protocol for encryption with administratively defined keys. See the wep-key commands. Use WEP with keys negotiated when joining the network.
dynamicWep
z phy-type {a|g}
Enter the configuration sub-mode for either the 802.11a or 802.11g physical layer type. Subsequent configuration commands apply only the selected physical layer type. In addition to the regular location and BSSID mode commands, channel and rate can be set (see page 459).
z power-mgmt {enable|disable}
Enable or disable power management. The default is enabled. Disabling power management can provide a slight increase in network performance, but should be done only in networks where power management is disabled on all wireless clients.
457
458
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
z z
For 80211.a: 36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, 64, 149, 153, 157, or 161. The default is 36. For 80211.g: 1 through 11. The default is 1.
z z
For 802.11a: Specify from a comma separate list of 6, 9, 12, 18, 24, 36, 48, and 54. For 802.11g: Specify from a comma separate list of 1, 2, 5 and 11.
z short-preamble {enable|disable}
For 802.11g. Enable or disable short preamble. The default is enabled. In a mixed radio environment, some wireless client stations operating 802.11g radios in 802.11b mode may experience difficulty associating with the AP using short preamble. To use only long preamble, disable short preamble.
(Aruba) (config) # stm ? dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance (Aruba) (config) # stm dos-prevention {enable|disable} (Aruba) (config) # stm strict-compliance {enable|disable}
459
Matching BSSID specific profile Matching location specific profile (exact match, without any wildcards) Results of a site survey stored in the WMS database. Result from initial AP placement configuration in the WMS database. Hierarchical lookup to find the closest match between the AP location and profile.
Mode
The AP can operate in three modes:
z ap - Operating as an access point for wireless clients z am - Operating as a dedicated air monitor z apm - Operating as an air monitor which can transition to an access point if a
neighboring AP goes down The setting for the AP mode is obtained using the following priorities (highest to lowest): 1 2 3
Matching BSSID specific profile Matching location specific profile (exact match, without any wildcards) Results of a site survey stored in the WMS database. If an AP is initially configured to be off (due to overbuilding the network coverage for example), the device will operate in apm mode instead. Result from initial AP placement configuration in the WMS database. Hierarchical lookup to find the closest match between the AP location and profile.
4 5
460
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
Other Attributes
The setting for all other AP attributes is obtained using the following priorities (highest to lowest): 1 2
Matching BSSID specific profile Hierarchical lookup to find the closest match between the AP location and profile.
461
462
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
463
(Aruba) (sap-config location 1.0.0) # opmode staticwep (Aruba) (sap-config location 1.0.0) # wep-key1 12345612345612345612345612 (Aruba) (sap-config location 1.0.0) # wep-transmitkey 1
464
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
CONFIG_AP_RESULT ---------------PARAMETER 802.11b/g 802.11a ----------------------Location (Bldg.Flr.Loc) 1.0.0 1.0.0 BSSID N/A N/A Channel 1 36 ESSID alpha-guest alpha-guest Encryption staticWep staticWep Device Type ap_mode ap_mode Authentication opensystem opensystem Short Preamble Enabled N/A RTS Threshold (Bytes) 2333 2333 Transmit Power (Level) 2 2 Retry Limit 8 8 DTIM Interval (beacon periods) 1 1 Max Associations 64 64 Beacon Period (millisecs) 100 100 Basic Rates 1,2 6,9,12,18,24,36,48,54 Transmit Rates 1,2,5,11 6,9,12,18,24,36,48,54 AP Radio Enabled Enabled Power Management Enabled Enabled Station Ageout Time (secs) 1000 1000 VLAN ID 7 7 Hidden SSID Disabled Disabled Deny_Broadcast Probes Disabled Disabled b/g Mode mixed N/A Country Code US US WPA Hexkey N/A N/A WPA Passphrase N/A N/A LMS IP N/A N/A Backup LMS 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0
NOTEChannel and transmit power values are determined as described on page 460.
465
CONFIG_AP_RESULT ---------------LOC PHYTYPE WEPKEY1 --------- ------0.0.0 802.11a ********************** 0.0.0 802.11g **********************
NOTEFor security, passwords and keys are encrypted by default. Where displayed in show commands, encrypted items appear only as asterisks (*). To turn the encryption feature off and display passwords and keys as plain text, the encrypt disable command is available in the configuration mode.
466
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
(Aruba) (config) # stm ? dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance (Aruba) (config) # stm dos-prevention {enable|disable} (Aruba) (config) # stm strict-compliance {enable|disable}
To view the station management configuration:
467
STATE -----
For STATE, the expected value is 2 (sent tunnel response) or 7 (steady state)
468
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
s/p ip ---2/23 10.1.1.56 g 2/2 10.3.25.237 g 2/2 10.3.25.237 a 2/15 10.2.13.194 a 2/12 10.2.12.253 g
phy type max-cl loc + --- ---- ------ --+ ap 42 1.1.3 + am 42 1.2.2 + am 42 1.2.2 + ap 42 1.1.1 + apm 42 1.1.2 +
auth ---y y y y
469
reason -----unsecure ap found unsecure ap found unsecure ap found no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected unsecure ap found no ap connected ok ok no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected no ap connected ok
470
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
471
472
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
Aruba Wireless Networks Model AP52 AirOS Version 2.2.1.0 (build 8041 / label #8041) Built by p4build@speedy on 2004-06-25 at 19:22:19 PDT (gcc version 3.2) 0: offset=0x0,size=0x20000,blocks=32 Linux Tulip driver version 0.9.15-pre9 (Nov 6, 2001) eth0: ADMtek Comet rev 17 at 0xc240dc00, 00:0B:86:C0:06:B5, IRQ 18. wifi0: Atheros AR5212 PCI (v3): 00:0b:86:80:6b:50, irq 19, mode G wifi1: Atheros AR5211 PCI: 00:0b:86:80:6b:58, irq 17 Aruba AP (c) 2002-2004 Aruba Wireless Networks, Inc. Registering handlers for Atheros_abg Atheros_a Process Table ------------PID Size State Command ---------- ------1 1096 kB S init 44 552 kB S udhcpc 61 424 kB S utelnetd 62 652 kB S boa 73 568 kB S nanny 76 536 kB S wdg 77 588 kB R msgHandler 79 1524 kB S sapd 85 1352 kB S snmpd_sap 96 1096 kB S init 416 1236 kB R am 1599 1100 kB S syslogd Memory Usage -----------total: used: free: shared: buffers: cached: ----------------------------------------------------------Mem: 14995456 14401536 593920 0 323584 7233536 Swap: 0 0 0 MemTotal: 14644 kB MemFree: 580 kB MemShared: 0 kB Buffers: 316 kB Cached: 7064 kB SwapCached: 0 kB Active: 6688 kB Inactive: 2492 kB HighTotal: 0 kB HighFree: 0 kB LowTotal: 14644 kB LowFree: 580 kB SwapTotal: 0 kB SwapFree: 0 kB (A5000) #
473
474
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
AP Reprovisioning
If the AP is already configured and you want to change the AP parameters, use the Reprovisioning option. (You must have a network connection between the AP and the configured Aruba WLAN Switch.
2. Click Reprovisioning
This page displays all the APs currently configured DHCP pool of the Aruba WLAN Switch.
4. Click Enable.
The selected AP should be seen in the Provisioning list.
475
6. After configuring the required parameters, select the entry from the list (the AP to which the configuration is to be applied) and click Apply.
476
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 20
7. Click the Refresh link after 10 seconds and the State is changed to Provisioned.
The Configured Parameters should be reflect in the AP list entry.
9. Reboot the AP to allow the AP to come up with the new configured parameters.
The AP should not be connected to any ports on which provisioning is currently active, or it will come up with the newly configured parameters.
477
478
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Wireless connection Direct Connection Access Point Wireless user WLAN Switch Layer 3 Connection
Layer 3 Connection
Prerequisites
You will need to make sure the following prerequisites are met before attempting to setup your VPN.
VPN Setup
479
z z z
Obtain a valid RADIUS server IP Address (if you are not using an internal database) RADIUS password and access port number, typically UDP port 1645 A routable IP Pool for VPN.
The pool must not conflict with any other VLAN subnet. This item is not required if you are using source NAT. Contact Aruba support to setup source NAT.
z z
VLAN topology and switch loopback IP . Windows 2000 or Windows XP are required to run the VPN Dialer.
Network Setup
If your network is already setup, SKIP this section and GO TO the appropriate authentication server setup (RADIUS or Internal Database). The process involves the following 4 steps:
z z z z
1
Creating the VLAN Configuring the port the VLAN will use Setting the default gateway Testing the connectivity to the default gateway and RADIUS server
(Aruba) (config-subif) # ip address 3.3.3.1 255.255.255.0 <Enter> [Sets the IP address and subnet mask for VLAN 1] (Aruba) (config-subif) # exit <Enter>
480
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
(Aruba) (config) # interface fastethernet 2/0 <Enter> [Makes port 2/0 a Fast Ethernet (10/100 Mbps) port] (Aruba) (config-if) # trusted <Enter> [Makes the port 2/0 a trusted port] (Aruba) (config-if) # switchport access vlan 1 <Enter>[Puts port 2/0 on VLAN 1] (Aruba) (config-if) # exit <Enter>
(Aruba) (config) # ping 3.3.3.254 <Enter> (Aruba) (config) # ping 4.4.4.1 <Enter>
(Aruba) (config) #aaa radius-server name authport 1645 host 4.4.4.1 key aruba <Enter>
2 Set a named server as the VPN authentication server.
VPN Setup
481
z z z z z
Connectivity - ping the RADIUS server Confirm that the RADIUS server key from above is correct Confirm that the RADIUS authport was set correctly Username and password Verify that the Aruba switch is allowed to access the RADIUS server (NAS IP on RADIUS)
(Aruba)# local-userdb add username name password pwd role rolename <Enter>
482
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
(Aruba) (config) #crypto isakmp key KeyString address 0.0.0.0 netmask 0.0.0.0 <Enter>
5 Specify the range of IP addresses to use an a VPN address pool. The n.n.n.n and x.x.x.x arguments specify the starting and ending IP addresses for the pool.
VPN Setup
483
Turn off the default mschapv2 authentication using the following CLI command.
484
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
Enter the role sub-mode and create a role using the following CLI command.
VPN Setup
485
VPN Dialer
486
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
Enter your username and password, then click the Log In button. NOTEYou might see a Security Alert Dialog appear. If this happens it probably means that the server certificate is either expired or not signed. The client is shipped with a self-signed certificate. You will need to purchase a certificate for your server that is signed by a well known CA.
After you have been authenticated two browser windows appears, the larger will remain for approximately 10 seconds to allow you to download the VPN Dialer. The smaller of the two appears in the lower right corner of your screen and has a link that allows you to log out of the switch.
VPN Setup
487
NOTEIf you close the Aruba Logout window you can access it again to logout of the switch by opening a browser and going to the following URL https://switch IP Address/logout.html. The File Download dialog box appears. 4 Click the Open button.
488
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
The download process will begin and installation will begin automatically.
VPN Setup
489
Installation
When the setup file is finished downloading the Dialer Setup Wizard will open. 1 Click the Next button.
The License Agreement dialog appears. 2 Select I accept and click on the Next button.
490
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
VPN Setup
491
The Installation Progress dialog appears, when the installation is finished the Completing the Aruba VPN Setup Wizard dialog appears.
Click the Finish button. The Aruba VPN Dialer dialog will launch and the dialog appears.
492
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
You may launch the VPN Dialer by double-clicking on the icon or you may launch it from the Windows Start Menu. The VPN Dialer window appears as soon as the application is launched. 1 Type your username and password in the text boxes on the VPN Dialer dialog and click the Connect button.
VPN Setup
493
z z z z z
Launch at Boot-Up Connect at Launch Wait For Wireless Hide After Connect. Network Info
Launch at Boot-up
When selected, this feature will cause the VPN Dialer to launch automatically each time you start or restart your computer.
Connect at Launch
When selected, this feature allows the Dialer to automatically connect every time the application is launched. When you select this feature the Save Password check box will be automatically checked, however you may elect to enter your password manually each time you login by unchecking the Save Password box.
494
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
Network Info
This feature will display a static window showing important network information.
VPN Setup
495
496
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
Common Problems
Dialer does not connect to server
If the dialer seems to stall while attempting to connect (as indicated by a persistent Connecting status, are several possible causes for the failure. The following steps will help you to identify and correct the problem. Those causes include:
z z z z z
Make sure you have the latest dialer. You can download the latest dialer from your switch by going to the captive portal login (http:// switchIP/login.html). Make sure connectivity is in place by pinging the switch. The ISAKMP shared key may be misconfigured on the client. The client may be failing to encrypt properly. The VPN IP Address pool may be exhausted.
VPN Setup
497
Use the show crypto isakmp sa command on the switch to make sure the user is authenticating.
(Aruba) (config) #show crypto isakmp sa Responder IP 10.1.1.158 Initiator IP 10.1.1.122 Initiator cookie ce91845e68f75026 Responder cookie 9635499cf2dad66e Life secs 28800 transform: 3DES - Secure Hash Standard Authentication method: Pre-Shared Key
If the initiator and client IP match, then the client has successfully started IPSec authentication. Otherwise, make sure that the pre-shared keys in the vpn-default dialer. You may see the key by using the vpn-dialer command, page 833. Be sure that the encrypt feature is disabled, page 446.
(Aruba)(config) #show vpn-dialer default-dialer -------------Attribute Value ------------PPTP disabled
. .
IKEPASSWD ********
. .
IPSecAUTH
2
ESP-SHA-HMAC
Use the show crypto ipsec sa command on the switch to make sure the user is doing IPSec encryption correctly.
(Aruba)(config) #show crypto ipsec sa Responder IP 10.1.1.158 Initiator IP 10.1.1.122 Initiator cookie ce91845e68f75026 Responder cookie 9635499cf2dad66e Life secs 7200 transform: esp-3des esp-sha-hmac
If the initiator IP matches the client IP, then IPSec encryption is good.
498
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 21
Use the show vpdn l2tp pool command on the switch to check the availability of VPN IP addresses.
(Aruba) #show vpdn l2tp local pool IP addresses used in pool vpn-pool-1 10.5.10.8 1 IPs used - 198 IPs free
http://rsasecurity.agora.com/rsasecured/detail.asp?product_id=1404
2. In the same directory where dialer.Msi has been uncompressed, create a file named config.htm with the following contents:
"DIALER_NAME"="Company Name" "PPTP"=DWORD:0 "L2TP"=DWORD:1 "DNETCLEAR"=DWORD:0 "MSCHAPV2"=DWORD:0 "CACHE-SECURID"=DWORD:1 "IKESECS"=DWORD:28800 "IKEENC"="3DES" "IKEGROUP"="TWO"
VPN Setup 499
"IKEHASH"="SHA" "IPSECSECS"=DWORD:7200 "IPSECGROUP"="GROUP2" "IPSECENC"="ESP-3DES" "IPSECAUTH"="ESP-SHA-HMAC" "PAP"=DWORD:1 "CHAP"=DWORD:0 "MSCHAP"=DWORD:0 "IKEPASSWD"="changeme" "IKEAUTH"="PRE-SHARE" "WIREDNOWIFI"=DWORD:1 "SETUPIP"="1.1.1.1" "NovellLogin"=DWORD:0
3. Modify IKEPASSWD to the pre-shared key you use and SETUPIP to the IP address of the switch. Quotes below are important. "DIALER_NAM" will be the name displayed on the window title bar. 4. After creating config.htm,zip all the files including the new config.htm into a self-extracting package. Maintain the directory structure as the .msi file expects the same directory hierarchy.
NOTEThe WIRENOWIFI option configures the dialer to automatically enable/disable wireless when the wired port is plugged in and is functional on the laptop.
500
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
VPN Configuration
501
The following parameters and options may be configured through Web UI.
Enable or disable L2TP authentication functionality Use these check boxes to select the Specify the IP address of the Primary DNS server in the text box. DNS server in the text box.
z Secondary DNS Server Specify the IP address of the Secondary z Primary WINS Server
Specify the IP address of the Primary WINS server in the text box.
502
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
z Secondary WINS
Server
Specify the IP address of the Secondary WINS server in the text box. IPSec tunnel endpoints are assigned discrete IP addresses. The client is assigned an address from one of the pools specified in this option. The IP address at the switch endpoint will always be either one of the IP address on the switch or the Emulate Server IP address. Enable or disable NAT (Network Address Translation). When selected, a traffic policy is created for the VPN default role. Source NAT may be enabled when the address range in the VPN address pool is not routable by the remainder of the network. When Source NAT is enabled the source address of packets from the client will be changed to that of the switch as they pass outbound from the switch to the server.
z Address Pools
(Only required for third party VPNs) Enter the name of the IKE Aggressive Group when XAUTH is used. The group name must exactly match the group name configured on each client.
Specify the IKE pre-shared keys for various IP address ranges. Keys may be from 1 to 64 characters in length.
z IKE Policies
VPN Configuration
503
The Configuration > VPN Settings > IPSec > Add Address Pool page appears.
1 2 3 4
Enter a unique name for the address pool you are defining. Enter the start and end addresses for the pool. Click done. Click Save configuration on the Configuration > VPN Settings IPSec page.
504
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
The Configuration> Security > VPN Settings > IPSec > Add IKE Secret page appears.
1 2 3
Type the secret in the IKE Shared Secret field. Re-type the secret in the Verify Shared Secret field. Enter a subnet and subnet mask if you are using multiple keys.
The Configuration> Security > VPN Settings > IPSec > Add Policy page appears.
1 2 3
Specify a priority. Select an encryption type from the Encryption pull-down box. Select a hash algorithm from the Hash Algorithm pull-down box.
VPN Configuration 505
4 5
Select an authentication type from the Authentication pull-down box. Select a Diffie-Hellman group from the Diffie Hellman pull-down box. Specify a lifetime (in seconds).
L2TP
The following parameters and options may be configured through Web UI.
Enables and disables PPTP client termination. The period of time, in seconds, the system for a PPTP echo response from a client before dropping the client. Determines the PPTP authentication protocol. At this time only MS-CHAPv2 is supported.
506
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
z Secondary DNS Server Specify the Secondary DNS server IP z Primary WINS Server z Secondary WINS
Server Specify the Primary WINS server IP Address Specify the Secondary WINS server IP Address Add address pools using this section of the page.
z Address Pools
Add address pools by clicking Add in the Address Pools section of the PPTP page. The PPTP > Add Address Pool page appears.
VPN Configuration
507
Add a new dialer by clicking Add. The Configuration > VPN Settings > Dialers > Add Dialers page appears.
The following parameters and options may be configured through Web UI.
Specify a name for the dialer. Enable PPTP tunneling to the Aruba switch. NOTEYou may check both PPTP and L2TP , however they will not run simultaneously. When both are checked, the client will attempt the more secure method, L2TP , first.
z Enable L2TP
Enable L2TP tunneling to the Aruba switch. NOTEYou may check both PPTP and L2TP , however they will not run simultaneously. When both are checked, the client will attempt the more secure method, L2TP , first.
508
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
This option enables Split Tunneling. Split Tunneling tunnels traffic destined for the internal network while allowing internet bound traffic to travel outside the secure tunnel. NOTEFor reasons of security this option is not recommended.
z Disable Wireless
Devices When Client is Wired
When enabled, this option allows the dialer to detect a wired connection and shut down the wired connection. This option allows you to specify a list of protocols to be supported by the dialer. The list should match the IPSec or PPTP configuration on the switch and contain a minimum of one protocol supported by the authentication server. The value entered specifies the length of the IKE security association, in seconds. Specifies the IKE encryption protocol to be used for the dialer. The choice in the dialer must match the protocol specified in the IPSec IKE policy on the switch. Specifies which Diffie-Hellman grout IKE will use. The choice in the dialer must match the D-H group specified in the IPSec IKE policy on the switch. The default is Group 2. Specifies which hash algorithm will be used by IKE. The choice in the dialer must match the algorithm specified in the IPSec IKE policy on the switch. The default is SHA. Specifies wither RSA signatures or a Pre-shared key for IKE authentication and must match that specified in the IPSec IKE policy on the switch. The shared secret must match that specified in the IKE share secret policy on the switch.
z Authentication
z IKE Authentication
The value entered specifies the length of the IPCEC security association, in seconds. The default is 7200 (2 hours).
VPN Configuration
509
Choose the IPSEDC Perfect Forward Secrecy (PFS) mode. The default is Group 2. Specifies the encryption type for IPSec. The default is ESP-3DES. Specifies which hash algorithm will be used by IKE. The choice in the dialer must match the algorithm specified in the IPSec IKE policy on the switch. The default is SHA.
510
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
Type the IP Address in the text box. Click the Add button again. Click the Save Configuration tab near the top of the page.
VPN Configuration
511
SecureID Token Ring Caching may be configured by navigating to the Configuration > Security > VPN Settings > Advanced page.
1 2
Check the SECUREID Token Persistence Enabled check box. Set the SECUREID Token Persistence Timeout in minutes by typing a value in the text box.
Chapter 22
Define an address pool for VPN users. This is done from the config prompt. If the CLI is still in the config-vpdn-l2tp submode, type exit to return to the config prompt.
Define a crypto policy and assign it a priority. Begin by entering the config-isakmp submode.
Enter the config-vpdn-pptp submode using the vpdn group pptp command from the CLI
(Aruba) (config) #vpdn group pptp (Aruba) (config-vpdn-pptp)#
VPN Configuration
513
(Aruba) (config-vpdn-pptp)#
5
exit
Chapter 22
(Aruba)(config-sess-vpn-dst-nat)#any host 192.68.8.1 svc-ike dst-nat (Aruba)(config-sess-vpn-dst-nat)#any host 192.68.8.1 svc-esp dst-nat (Aruba)(config-sess-vpn-dst-nat)#any host 192.68.8.1 svc-l2tp dst-nat
3 Return to the config prompt.
(Aruba) (config-sess-vpn-dst-nat)#!
VPN Configuration 515
NOTEWhen testing securID caching on a VPN with multiple laptops, be sure the same PIN+token is used on all the laptops. If more than one PIN+token is used, only the last one will work properly.
z RADIUS server IP (if not using internal database) z RADIUS password and access port number (typically UDP port 1645) z Routable IP pool for VPN. Pool MUST NOT conflict with any other VLAN
subnet (may skip if using source NAT, contact support to setup source NAT)
z Desired IPSec pre-shared key (global, not per user), use something long
with capital letters and numbers.
z VLAN topology and switch loopback IP . z This document only covers Win2k and WinXP .
516
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
z 2.2.2.x is the pool of private addresses for VPN (2.2.2.1 2.2.2.254) z 3.3.3.x is the trusted side of the network going to the router, assume port
2/0 vlan 1
z Default routers IP: 3.3.3.254 z RADIUS server IP: 4.4.4.1, authport is 1812, password is aruba z Valid user and passwords in radius server: user: foo, password: bar z IPSec pre-shared key is f00xYz123BcA z DNS and WINS servers for VPN users: 10.1.1.2, 10.1.1.3
Setting Up a VPN
Perform the following steps:
1 2 3 4 5
Set up network Set up and test RADIUS Server Set up VPN server on Aruba Switch Set up roles and VPN Dialer on Aruba Switch Set up client
1. Set up Network
The steps necessary to set up a network are:
(Aruba5000) (config) # vlan 1 (Aruba5000) (config) # interface vlan 1 (Aruba5000) (config-subif) # ip address 3.3.3.1 255.255.255.0 (Aruba5000) (config-subif) # exit (Aruba5000) (config) # interface fastethernet 2/0 (Aruba5000) (config-if) # trusted (Aruba5000) (config-if) # switchport access vlan 1 (Aruba5000) (config-if) # exit (Aruba5000) (config) # ip default-gateway 3.3.3.254 (test connectivity to default gateway and RADIUS)
VPN Configuration 517
(Aruba5000) (config) # ping 3.3.3.254 Success rate is 100 percent (5/5), round-trip min/avg/max = 0/0/0 ms (Aruba5000) (config) # ping 4.4.4.1 Success rate is 100 percent (5/5), round-trip min/avg/max = 0/0/0 ms
(Aruba5000) (config) 4.4.4.1 key aruba (Aruba5000) (config) (Aruba5000) (config) (Aruba5000) (config)
# # # #
1812 host
z Connectivity problem, try pinging radius server z RADIUS server key is wrong z RADIUS server authport is wrong z Username and/or password is wrong z Aruba switch is not allowed to access RADIUS server (NAS IP on RADIUS)
(Aruba5000)
Chapter 22
(Aruba5000) (config) # crypto isakmp policy 10 (Aruba5000) (config-isakmp) # authentication pre-share (Aruba5000) (config-isakmp) # exit
Set up IKE with a customer provided pre-shared key, keep 0.0.0.0 as is:
(Aruba5000) (config) #
Set up L2TP:
(Aruba5000) (config) #
PAP will work with most RADIUS servers, use CACHE-SECURID if using RSA SecurID):
# # # # #
ppp authentication PAP no ppp authentication mschapv2 client configuration dns 10.1.1.2 client configuration wins 10.1.1.2 exit
(Aruba5000) (config) # vpn-dialer Default-dialer (Aruba5000) (config-vpn-dialer) # ike authentication pre-share f00xYz123BcA
For RSA SecurID only enter:
VPN Configuration
519
(Aruba5000) (config) #
exit
Set up a role (here the role is called employee) for VPN and the captive portal:
(config) # user-role employee (config-role) # dialer Default-dialer (config-role) # session-acl allowall (config-role) # exit
2. Quit VPN dialer if theres already one running. 3. Open browser, user should be redirected to switchs captive portal which should look like this, if user is not for whatever reason, type URL: https://switchip/auth/index.html
520
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
Type in username foo, password bar. You should see a page with the link to download VPN-dialer. Select that link and open setup.exe. Follow the onscreen instructions:
VPN Configuration
521
522
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
If the laptop receives a notice to reboot, comply. Once the laptop is back and the dialer is running, type in username foo and password bar. The user should connect.
VPN Configuration
523
Initiator IP 1.1.1.1 Initiator cookie 5ea3c79a7492a65d Responder cookie 506acc2482185e1c Life secs 7200 transform: esp-3des esp-sha-hmac
If there is an initiator IP that matches the clients IP , it means the client successfully started IPSec authentication. Otherwise, check the IKE pre-shared key on the crypto isakmp key command and vpn-dialer default-dialer command. The two must match. On the switch, enter:
(Aruba5000) #show crypto ipsec sa Responder IP 10.1.1.158 Initiator IP 10.1.1.103 Initiator cookie 0a6c4974a8538522 Responder cookie dc42860c619f3ac4 Life secs 7200 transform: esp-3des esp-sha-hmac
If there is an initiator IP that matches the clients IP , then that means the client is successfully doing IPSec encryption but may have trouble authenticating the actual user foo.) On the switch, enter:
(Aruba5000) #show vpdn l2tp pool IP addresses used in pool vpnaddr 2.2.2.1 1 IPs used - 253 IPs free
If there are no IP addresses free, then youve run out of IP addresses for VPN. If the dialer continues Logging On but then fails, the username/password is either incorrect or the RADIUS server is unreachable. If you are using a RSA SecurID, then the users ID may have been locked out. Check the RSA SecurID server. If the dialer connects, but no traffic goes through from applications, make sure the inner IP pool is routable. The only way to check this is to sniff between the router and switch. NOTEJust because the switch IP can ping the default router doesnt mean the VPN IP pool is routable. Check the router. There may be OSPF or other issues.
524
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
The laptop is connected through a wired link. Uncheck Wait for Wireless if thats how you want to connect, or disconnect the wire.
No Aruba switches detectedwill retry
The laptop cannot automatically detect the presence of an Aruba switch. Uncheck Wait for Wireless if you think this is an error.
Wired. Wireless disabledwill retry
Verifications:
Use the following commands to verify functionality: (Aruba5000) (config) #show aaa vpn-authentication
Mode = Enabled Default Role = 'employee' Dialer download location = /auth/dialer.html Auth Server List ---------------Pri --1 Name ---ias Type ---RADIUS Status -----Enabled Inservice --------Yes Applied ------3 IMPORTANT LINE
Default role .................. Guest logon ................... User logon .................... Auto redirect delay ........... Welcome page location ......... Logout popup window ...........
Authentication protocol ....... https Logon page Theme .................... default1 Logon wait range ............. 5-10 seconds CPU utilization threshold .... 60 Auth Server List ---------------Pri --1 Name ---ias Type ---RADIUS Status -----Enabled Inservice --------Yes Applied ------3 IMPORTANT LINE
ISAKMP ENABLED Protection suite priority 10 encryption algorithm: 3DES - Triple Data Encryption Standard (168 bit keys) hash algorithm: Secure Hash Algorithm authentication method: Pre-Shared Key IMPORTANT Diffie-Hellman Group: #2 (1024 bit) lifetime: [300 - 86400] seconds, no volume limit Default protection suite encryption algorithm: 3DES - Triple Data Encryption Standard (168 bit keys) hash algorithm: Secure Hash Algorithm authentication method: Rivest-Shamir-Adelman Signature Diffie-Hellman Group: #2 (1024 bit) lifetime: [300 - 86400] seconds, no volume limit
(Aruba5000) (config) #encrypt disable (Aruba5000) (config) #show crypto isakmp key ISAKMP Pre-Shared keys configured by Address -------------------------------------------IP address of the host Subnet Mask Length Key ---------------------- ------------------ --f00xYz123BcA IMPORTANT 0.0.0.0 0
526
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
Enabled Hello timeout: 60 seconds DNS primary server: 10.1.1.2 DNS secondary server: 30.0.0.0 WINS primary server: 10.1.1. WINS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 PPP client authentication methods: PAP IMPORTANT IP LOCAL POOLS: vpnaddr: 2.2.2.1 2.2.2.254
IMPORTANT
default-dialer -------------Attribute --------PPTP L2TP DNETCLEAR WIREDNOWIFI PAP CHAP MSCHAP MSCHAPV2 CACHE-SECURID IKESECS IKEENC IKEGROUP IKEHASH IKEAUTH IKEPASSWD IPSecSECS IPSecGROUP IPSecENC IPSecAUTH
Value ----disabled enabled disabled disabled enabled enabled enabled disabled disabled 28800 3DES TWO SHA PRE-SHARE f00xYz123BcA 7200 GROUP2 ESP-3DES ESP-SHA-HMAC
IMPORTANT IMPORTANT
VPN Configuration
527
Requirements
The following requirements apply to Cisco VPN clients terminating on Aruba WLAN switches.
z Release 2.0.2.x and higher will support Cisco VPN client, version 4.0.2b z Native Cisco profiles, (151.151.1.1 is your Cisco VPN concentrator) z Direct Cisco VPN termination, (10.10.1.1 is your Aruba loopback IP
address) NOTEThe DNS server and the DHCP server can not be the same host. If you are using the native Cisco VPN profile, Aruba can emulate the Cisco concentrator. When you select Emulate VPN Servers, as shown below, a vpn-dst-nat ACL is added to your logon role.
528
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
VPN Configuration
529
530
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
VPN Configuration
531
Default Values
The following figures show the default values for the Cisco dialog box Transport, Backup Servers and Dial Up tabs
532
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
VPN Configuration
533
534
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
z Configure the Aruba GUI for basic VPN connection z Configure the VPN client wizard (if applicable) z Logon using the VPN client dialog box
VPN Configuration
535
536
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
VPN Configuration
537
538
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 22
VPN Configuration
539
z Verify the ACL groups in the logon role. z Verify that TCP port 17 is allowed (this solves a banner problem). z Verify the IKE key is matching. z Verify that Group ID is defined. z Verify that the IKE policy is pre-shared key.
If you need further assistance, call 1-800-WiFi-LAN for support. The setup for Cisco is actually the same as for Aruba VPN (w/o dialer). You can ignore input of the XAuth groupname (that's just for show). To include AES-256, you need to (assuming GUI): 1. Navigate to Configuration->Security->VPN Settings->IPSEC:
2. Add an IKE policy with AES-256, pre-share, and SHA. 3. Navigate to Configuration->Security->VPN Settings->Advanced. 4. Add or change the IPSec transform to AES-256 and SHA.
NOTECisco does not support AES-192 (only 128 and 256.
540
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
z Image Management z Reboot Switch z Reboot Peer Supervisor Card z Clear Config z Boot Parameters
Image Management
Navigate to Maintenance > Switch > Image Management to access the image management screen:
Switch Maintenance
541
Image management options are. Upgrade using Specify how you are going to copy an image onto the server. Both TFTP and FTP are supported. Specify the IP address of the TFTP or FTP server which contains the image to download onto the switch. Enter the name of the image file. You can copy the image into Partition 0 or 1. Specify the location here. Specify which partition the switch will use when it reboots. To use the new image once it has been downloaded, specify Yes to reboot the switch. To keep using the current boot image, click No. Click Yes to write the current configuration to file so changes will not be lost upon reboot. Click No to leave the configuration file unchanged.
Server IP Address
Image File Name Partition to Upgrade Boot Partition Reboot Switch After Upgrade
542
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 23
Reboot Switch
Switch > Reboot Switch.
To reboot the switch, typically after an image update, click Maintenance >
To save any changes to the current switch configuration, click Yes. To leave the configuration file unchanged, click No. To proceed with the switch reboot, click Continue and follow any prompts.
Clear Config
To reset the switch configuration to factory default settings, use the Maintenance > Switch > Clear Config option.
Switch Maintenance
543
The current configuration is erased and the factory default configuration is set as the boot configuration. This option forces the switch to reboot using the factory default configuration. (The persistent state data maintained in the switch is preserved.) When ready to revert to the original, factory configuration, click Continue and follow any prompts. From the CLI, enter:
Synchronize
This feature is only valid in redundant Master-Master configurations. To synchronize the database with the other master, use the Maintenance >
The system will prompt you to confirm that you want to synchronize the database.
Boot Parameters
The boot parameters are the name of the boot file and its boot partition location. Access these parameters by accessing Maintenance > Switch > Boot Parameters.
544
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 23
The following parameters and options may be configured through Web UI. Boot Partition Configuration File Specify which partition the switch will use when it reboots. Select the name of the saved configuration file from the drop down menu.
File Maintenance
The four options available in the Maintenance > File menu are:
Copy Files
You can copy files on the switch to off-switch locations by selecting Maintenance > File > Copy Files.
Switch Maintenance
545
The options are. Source Selection Select Flash File System and select the name of a file from the drop-down menu. To use a TFTP server, click TFTP and enter the IP address of the TFTP server. To copy the running configuration, click
Running Configuration.
To copy the startup configuration, click
Startup Configuration.
To use a use an FTP server, click FTP and enter the IP address of the FTP server
546
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 23
Destination Selection
If you are copying a flash file system, select Flash File System and specify the name of a file. To use a TFTP server, click TFTP and enter the IP address of the TFTP server. To use a use an FTP server, click FTP and enter the IP address of the FTP server.
Copy Logs
Copy Logs.
To copy logs from the switch to another system, go to Maintenance > File >
You can copy the logs using an FTP server or TFTP server. Once you have specified the transfer protocol, specify the IP address and file name to be used for the log file.
Switch Maintenance
547
You can copy the crash files using an FTP server or TFTP server. Once you have specified the transfer protocol, specify the IP address and file name to be used for the crashfile.
Backup Flash
To copy the files in flash, go to Maintenance > File > Backup Flash.
Click Create Backup to start the backup process. The system will report the backup being created when finished. Clicking Copy Backup is the same as selecting Copy Files.
Restore Flash
> File > Restore Flash.
To restore Flash files which have previously been backed up, go to Maintenance
548
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 23
The system must reboot before it can use the restored Flash files.
Delete Files
To keep from running out of flash file space, you should delete files you no longer need. You can also delete files that you have copied off the switch. To remove unwanted or no longer needed files, go to Maintenance > File > Delete
Files.
Click the file(s) to be deleted, and click Delete. To select multiple files: Shift-click file names that form a continuos block of file names. Ctrl-click individual file names that are not continuous.
WLAN Maintenance
The maintenance-level commands that you can perform on an Aruba WLAN switch are:
Switch Maintenance 549
z Calibrate the Radio NetworkSee Calibration on page 287. z Program Access PointsSee AP Reprovisioning on page 475. z Reboot Access PointsSee below. z WMS DatabaseSee below.
, Click the Access Point(s) you want to reboot, and click Reboot. To find an AP click Search and enter any information you have (such as location, IP or MAC address). To organize the display to make finding APs easier, you can sort (ascending or descending) on location, IP and MAC address. The display is limited to ten APs per page. Use the page navigator to scroll through the listings of APs controlled by this switch.
Chapter 23
Switch Maintenance
551
552
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 23
From this screen you can select a background login page or upload your own login page. You can also edit your policy for guests. When you are finished customizing the login page, click Submit. To erase any changes without saving them, click Reset. To see what the captive portal will look like with the changes you have made, click the View CaptivePortal link.
Switch Maintenance
553
Upload Certificate
To manually upload a authentication certificate for the captive portal, go to Maintenance > Captive Portal > Upload Certificate.
Specify the name of the certificate file to be imported in the File to be imported field. You can click Browse to search for the file. When ready, click Upload. As the onscreen notice advises, the switch expects the certificate file to be an X.509 PEM file. The onscreen notice also warns that the uploading of a new certificate will cause the switch to shutdown all Web Server connections while the certificate is being installed.
TBC
554
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 23
Switch Maintenance
555
556
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Part
557
558
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
559
Network Monitoring
To see a summary of the status of the wireless network, click Monitoring. Network Summary is displayed by default. WLAN Network Status shows the number of operational WLAN switches, Access Points, Air Monitors, unprovisioned APs, enterprise clients, RADIUS servers, and LDAP servers. WLAN Performance Summary shows throughput metrics (the last five minutes, the past hours, and overall) for Load Balancing Events, Interference Events, Bandwidth Exceeded, and Error Threshold Exceeded. The Security Summary statistics shows the last five minutes, last hour, and overall summaries for WLAN Attack statistics, Rogue AP Classification Summary, and Client Classification Summary data. WLAN Attack Summary data includes: Denial of Service Attacks, Man in the Middle Attacks, Signature Pattern Matches, and Policy Violations statistics. Rogue AP Classification Summary statistics include: Rogue APs Detected, Rogue APs Disabled, Interfering APs Detected, and Known Interfering APs. Client Classification Summary statistics include: Valid Clients, Interfering Clients, and Disabled Rogue Clients. Select Monitoring > Network > All WLAN Switches to see details about each WLAN switch. Details include IP address, location (from RF Plan), Type (Master or local), and AirOS version running. Select Monitoring > Network > All Access Points to see details about each Access Point. Details include Name, Location, IP Address, Type, IP address of the WLAN switch, number of, and channels used by, 802.11b and g clients, and number of 802.11a clients and the channels they are using. Select Monitoring > Network > All Air Monitors to see details about air monitors. Details include Name, Location, IP Address, Type, Switch IP , Last Seen, and Status. Select Monitoring > Network > All WLAN Clients to see details about wireless clients. Details include MAC Address, Name, IP Address, Role, Authentication Method, Home Switch, and Current Switch. Select Monitoring > Network > Global Events to see details about wireless activity. Event details include Event ID, Type, Info(mation), Device type, MAC Address, Count (which is a count of how many times the event has occurred), and Occurred Time. Selecting Global Events is the same as clicking Events on the toolbar.
560
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
Switch Monitoring
The Monitoring > Switch screens provide details about the WLANs in the wireless network. Select Monitoring > Switch Summary to see details about the WLAN switch including its Model, AirOS Version, IP Address, and MAC Address. Select Monitoring > Switch > Access Points to see details about the APs connected to this WLAN switch. Details include Name, Location, IP address, Type, 802.11b and g Clients, 802.11a clients, the Channel Power Levels for these a, b, and g client, and the uptime for each AP . Click:
To display dynamic data including number of packets and number of associated clients. To show static data such as AP configurations. To show overall AP status. To display the packet capture screen. To display the RF Plan page and perform a triangulation. Issues a ping.
Select Monitoring > Switch > Air Monitors to see details about air monitors connected to this WLAN switch. Details include NAme, Location, IP address, Type, and Uptime for each AM. Click Overview, Channel, APs, Clients, and Packet Capture for additional information. Select Monitoring > Switch > Clients to see details about wireless clients. Details include User Name, MAC Address, Client IP address, User Role, Access Method, Age, and Status. Select Monitoring > Switch > Blacklist Clients to see details about users who are not welcome. Details include Client MAC address, Reason, and Block Time. (Block Time is the time in seconds that a blacklisted user is blocked from attempting to connect.) Click Enable to turn on DoS prevention. Click Remove from Blacklist to allow the selected user to access the wireless network without restriction. Select Monitoring > Switch > Firewall Hits to see details about attacks on the switch. Details include User Role Hits (including Role, Policy, source and destination addresses, Service, Action, Dest/Opcode, New Hits, Total Hits, and Index), Port Based Session ACL Hits (including Policy, source and destination addresses, Action, Dest/OPcode, New Hits, Total Hits, and Index),
Monitoring the Wireless Environment 561
and Port ACL Hits (including ACL, ACE, New Hits, Total Hits, and Index. ACE is the individual permit or deny rule that makes up an ACL. The index number is the priority of each ACE starting with 1.) Select Monitoring > Switch >Ports to see details about port activity. Details include Admin State, Operational State, Port Mode, VLAN Association, Trusted or untrusted. Click Status, Profile, Activity, or Diagnostics for additional information. Select Monitoring > Switch > Inventory to see details about switch components, software, and environment. Details for Supervisor cards include Status, FPGA Revision TBC, SC Assembly Number, SC Serial Number, Crypto Assembly Number, Crypto Serial Number, management Port NW MAC Address, Switch Base MAC Address, Peer Supervisor Card. Details for line cards are reported for each slot occupied by a line card and include: FPGA Revision Number, Gigabitethernet Daughter Card, SPOE1 Daughter Card, Supervisor Card 0, and Supervisor Card 1. Fan and Power Supply details include status for Fan 0, Fan 1, and Fan 2 as well as for Power Supply 0, Power Supply 1, and Power Supply 2. Environmental Readings includes Internal Temperature, System 5.0V status, System 3.3V status, System 2.5V status, and CPU 2.0V status. Software Information includes General information on Switch Model, AirOS Version, Complied date and build number, ROM version, Switch Uptime, and Aruba Firmware versions. Information on Licenses includes Max AP Limit, Max Mux Limit, WLAN Switch, WLAN IDS, Web UI, and VPN/Firewalls. Select Monitoring > Switch to see the switch log. Selecting the Events tab displays the same screen. (See Events below.)
Chapter 24
z Overviewsee Figure 24-3. z Channelsee Figure 24-4 and Figure 24-5. z APssee Figure 24-6. z Clientssee Figure 24-7 z Packet Capturesee Figure 24-8.
563
Overview Information
Click Overview to see the following information.
564
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
Channel Information
Click Channel to see the following information.
565
The details on the selected change are shown in the figure below.
566
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
AP Information
Click APs to see the following information.
Client Information
Click Clients to see the following information.
567
568
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
569
570
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
Status Information
Click Status to see the following types of information.
Events
As mentioned above, selecting Monitoring > Switch is equivalent to selecting the Events tab.
571
The type of device involved in the event. The MAC address of the device. The number of packets involved in the event. The timestamp when the event occurred.
You can sort the events on any of these categories by using the Group By drop-down menu. Click Search to find a specific event, or use the page navigation links to display additional pages of events. To manage the number of events reported, you can delete events that are no longer of interest. To delete unwanted events, click the selection box to the left of each event to be removed, and click Delete Selected Events.
572
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
573
WLAN Monitoring
Displays network information for each WLAN based on the SSID of each WLAN. Info TBC
Debug Information
You can set debugging levels on an Aruba WLAN switch to capture information on local clients. To enable this feature, select Monitoring > Debug > Local Clients. Wireless users will have their MAC Address, IP Address, and User Name recorded To view the resulting debug activity, select Monitoring > Debug > Process Logs. Log details are shown in Figure 24-17.
574
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
Reports
The reporting capability of AirOS is located in the Reports tab. The most commonly used types of reports are prepackaged and include:
z Active rogue Access Points (Active Rogue APs) z All rogue Access Points (All Rogue APs) z All active and valid Access Points (Active Valid APs) z All inactive and valid Access Points (Inactive Valid APs) z All valid Access Points - active and inactive (All Valid APs) z All Access Points that are interfering with other Access Points (Active Interfering APs)
z All Access Points that are causing interference (All Interfering APs) z All active interfering Access Points (Active Known Interfering APs) z All known interfering Access Points (All Known Interfering APs) z The most congested Access Points (Top Congested APs) z Active interfering wireless clients (Active Interfering Clients) z All interfering wireless clients active or not (All Interfering Clients) z All valid and active wireless clients (Active Valid Clients) z All valid wireless client active or not (All Valid Clients) z The wireless clients using the most bandwidth (Top Talker Clients)
A typical report screen looks like:
575
576
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
AP Reports
To see a typical AP report, select Reports > AP > Active Valid APs. The following type of report displays.
Status
To get details on a specific device on a report, click the checkbox to the left of the device and click Status. Detailed information for this device displays as shown in Figure 24-20.
577
Custom Reports
You can customize reports to suit your needs. Go to Reports > Create AP Report to create a custom Access Point report. Go to Reports > Create Client Report to create a custom wireless client report as shown below.
578
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 24
579
580
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
access-list <name> {created | edited | deleted }, type = {standard | extended | eth | mac | session }
The possible dispositions are:
z z z
Firewall Logging
581
Authentication failed for User <username> : src ip <IPaddr>src port <portnum> dst ip <IPaddr>dst port <portnum> connection type TELNET
This entry is issued when a user connected through TELNET fails to authenticate. Information about the source and destination IP addresses and ports is provided.
Authentication succeeded for User <username> : src ip <IPaddr> src port <portnum>dst ip<IPaddr> dst port <portnum> connection type TELNET
This entry is issued when a user connected through TELNET successfully authenticates. Information about the source and destination IP addresses and ports is provided.
indicates the source IP address of the packet. indicates the destination IP address of the packet. indicates the ICMP type number. indicates the ICMP code number. indicates the sequence number. indicates the ID number if the packet is an ICMP echo request or response packet. indicates the disposition of the packet, which will be one of the following: deny: The packet was dropped. permit: The packet was forwarded.
582
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 25
The packet was forwarded with the source IP address modified. The packet was forwarded with the destination IP address modified. The packet was forwarded without modifying the address fields, but through an interface other than that indicated in the IP routing table.
policy
indicates which firewall policy was matched in order to generate the log message.
z z z
z z z
z z z
Firewall Logging
583
indicates the source IP address of the packet. indicates the source TCP or UDP port number of the packet.
srcport dstip
indicates the destination IP address of the packet. indicates the destination TCP or UDP port number of the packet.
dstport action
indicates the disposition of the packet, which will be one of the following:
deny: The packet was dropped. permit: The packet was forwarded. src-nat: dst-nat:
The packet was forwarded with the source IP address modified. The packet was forwarded with the destination IP address modified.
redirect: The packet was forwarded without modifying the address fields, but through an interface other than that indicated in the IP routing table. policy
indicates which firewall policy was matched in order to generate the log message.
584
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
585
Configure L2/L3
Wireless Access
Wireless Monitoring
Define user roles Define access permissions for roles Config access policies Config user roles and associate them with policies Configure Access Policies User Roles
Config Auth Servers Config Auth Servers Config Auth Servers ...
Add Auth Method Add Auth Method Add Auth Method ...
Verify
586
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
General
The Wi-Fi Alliance has made great strides in testing interoperability between 802.11 devices from many different manufacturers. Despite these efforts, however, client incompatibility remains the primary complaint from network managers deploying wireless LANs. A wide range of wireless hardware and software is in use, with a corresponding wide range of quality a given client adapter card may work fine with one revision of driver software, but experience numerous problems with another. A given operating system may perform poorly on a wireless network until specific vendor patches are applied. For this reason, Aruba recommends that enterprise network managers develop standard supported configurations for their deployment. This configuration should consist of:
z Device type and model (laptops, PDAs, handheld devices, voice handsets,
etc.)
z Operating system (Windows 2000, Windows XP , MacOS X, Linux, etc.) z Wireless NIC hardware manufacturer and model z Wireless NIC software driver z Wireless NIC firmware revision, if required z Wireless NIC client utility or radio manager, if needed z Authentication and encryption software (VPN client, 802.1x supplicant,
etc.) Spending the time up front to develop and test such configurations will greatly reduce troubleshooting time and effort after the network is deployed and operational. A table of configurations tested by Aruba appears in the Design Guide, but this testing cannot take into account all possibilities. Network managers can use these recommendations but should always perform testing in their own environments with their own applications.
587
Broadcast Probe Request In a broadcast probe request, a client looks for any available ESSID. It does so by leaving the ESSID field empty in the probe-request frame. Normally, all APs receiving the probe-request, regardless of ESSID, will answer. This is how Windows XP , for example, populates the list of available wireless networks. Specific Probe Request In this type of probe-request, the client is only interested in one particular ESSID. It will include this ESSID in the request, and only APs supporting this ESSID will respond. It is possible in an Aruba deployment to disable responses to broadcast probe-requests, and require a specific probe-request with the correct ESSID before an AP will answer. If a client does not find an AP to associate with, there are a number of possible causes. A packet capture of a normal probe-request/probe-response sequence is shown in the figure below. Detailed packet capture data can be found in Appendix A.
588
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
z Make sure the clients wireless adapter is enabled. Some newer laptops
with built-in wireless hardware have a physical switch that enables and disables the radio. NIC client utilities often contain similar software switches. Finally, the adapter may be disabled by the operating system.
z Enable client debugging for the client device in question. From the Aruba
CLI, use the command aaa user debug mac <MAC address of client>. Log output from the debug process can be viewed by issuing the command show log intuser 30 (to display the last 30 lines of the log file). Verify that the switch is receiving probe requests from the client.
z Perform a wireless packet capture through the Aruba system for the
appropriate area where the user is located. Filter the capture for the users MAC address. A packet capture is a sure way to find out if the client is transmitting probe-requests, if the probe-requests contain the correct ESSID, and if an AP is answering probe-requests.
z Reset the client NIC or operating system. In the case of malfunctioning client software, this does not fix the underlying problem but is often the fastest way to get the user back on the network.
z Replace the client NIC. If a packet capture appears normal and client
mis-configuration has been ruled out, it is possible that the client NIC has failed.
Clients list of available networks contains some entries, but not the correct ESSID
Consider the following possible fixes:
589
z Perform a wireless packet capture through the Aruba system for the appropriate area where the user is located. Filter the capture for the users MAC address. A packet capture is a sure way to find out if the client is transmitting probe-requests, if the probe-requests contain the correct ESSID, and if an AP is answering probe-requests.
z Reset the client NIC. In the case of malfunctioning client software, this
does not fix the underlying problem but is often the fastest way to get the user back on the network.
590
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
If the client and AP are configured differently, association will typically fail. Very little information is given to the user when an association fails, so most troubleshooting must be done from the network side. The most likely cause for an authentication or association failure is client misconfiguration.
z Enable client debugging for the client device in question. From the Aruba
CLI, use the command aaa user debug mac <MAC address of client>. Log output from the debug process can be viewed by issuing the command show log intuser 30 (to display the last 30 lines of the log file). The log file should indicate the reason for a failed authentication or association. Often the cause is a capability mismatch between the client and AP .
z If the authenticate process fails, it is likely because the client has been configured for shared-key authentication. Shared-key authentication opens a security vulnerability and should never be used - the Aruba system does not support shared-key authentication. The client should be configured for either open system or WPA authentication, but never shared-key.
z Reset the client NIC. In the case of malfunctioning client software, this
does not fix the underlying problem but is often the fastest way to get the user back on the network. NOTEIt is not possible to set authentication to 'fall-through' to another method or server if the first authentication fails. If a user fails authentication to a server, it just "fails". For networks with more than one authentication server for each authentication method, a secondary server will kick-in only if the primary server fails (the whole server, not an authentication fail).
591
Association Fails
During the association request/response exchange, a number of capabilities are exchanged. If there is a mismatch between the client and network configuration, the association will often be rejected by the AP . On the client, there is often no indication that an association has failed other than a lack of association. For example, under Windows XP using the built-in Zero Configuration service, Windows will continually display One or more wireless networks are available
z Enable client debugging for the client device in question. From the Aruba
CLI, use the command aaa user debug mac <MAC address of client>. Log output from the debug process can be viewed by issuing the command show log intuser 30 (to display the last 30 lines of the log file). The log should indicate the reason for a failed authentication or association. Often the cause is a capability mismatch between the client and AP .
z Verify that the AP has not reached the maximum number of users. If the
system has been configured to allow only 20 associations per AP , the 21st client will be rejected. A simple way to do this is using the show ap-leds command to view the status of AP LEDs on the switch. An AP that is full will indicate such via the AP LEDs. the network has been configured for WPA and TKIP encryption, and the client has been configured for open system and WEP encryption, association will fail.
z Reset the client NIC. In the case of malfunctioning client software, this
does not fix the underlying problem but is often the fastest way to get the user back on the network.
592
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
z Verify that no denial of service attack is underway. From the client perspective, a successful association followed by an immediate disassociation appears the same as an unsuccessful association. Examine the Wireless Management System (WMS) log files on the Aruba switch by navigating in the management GUI to the Events tab. A packet capture will also reveal the presence of a denial of service attack.
z Reset the client NIC. If association is successful a second or third time but
authentication continues to fail, it is unlikely that a basic connectivity problem is causing the issue. See the Authentication section of this guide for more details on troubleshooting higher-layer authentication problems.
z Static WEP Key mismatch: If the client and AP are configured for static
WEP , it is likely that the WEP keys do not match. This symptom commonly manifests itself when a client configured for DHCP fails to obtain an IP address. Check the clients WEP key and ensure that it matches the WEP key configured in the Aruba system.
z Dynamic WEP Key Exchange Failure: If the network uses 802.1x with
automatically-assigned WEP keys (dynamic WEP), it is possible that the key exchange process failed. Because this key exchange is non-standard and does not involve a verified handshake, the process sometimes fails without an error message being generated. Resetting the client NIC or rebooting the client operating system often restores connectivity in this situation.
593
z Once association and higher-layer authentication have succeeded, it is analogous to the link light turning on in a wired Ethernet network. Troubleshoot the problem using traditional tools such as ping and traceroute. Problems such as this often indicate faults in the wired network or in client network settings. For example, the client may be configured for a static IP address, the default gateway for the network may be down, or there may be a routing problem.
z If the client is configured for DHCP and does not obtain an IP address, it
may indicate a problem with the DHCP server or the uplink network from the Aruba switch. Enable client debugging for the client device in question. From the Aruba CLI, use the command aaa user debug mac <MAC address of client>. Log output from the debug process can be viewed by issuing the command show log intuser 30 (to display the last 30 lines of the log file). DHCP activity appears in the log file.
z If multiple users on the same AP are experiencing problems, examine statistics on the AP . It is possible that the network is extremely busy, is experiencing interference, or is experiencing a denial of service attack. Perform a wireless packet capture when in doubt.
z Ensure that a higher-layer network failure has not taken place. Use tools
such as ping and traceroute to verify. If an attempt to ping the Aruba switch from the client fails, the problem can be isolated to the wireless network.
594
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
z If the failure took place while the user was moving, it is possible that roaming failed. Examine the clients current signal strength and data rate. If they are low, compare the users physical location with the location of the currently associated AP . This is sometimes caused by an issue known as client stickiness the tendency for a client to maintain an existing association and ignore closer APs even when signal strength has significantly degraded. Ideally, pre-deployment testing will identify client NICs and drivers that exhibit this problem so that they can be excluded from the deployment.
z Dynamic WEP Key Exchange Failure: If the network uses 802.1x with
automatically-assigned WEP keys (dynamic WEP), it is possible that the key exchange process failed. Because this key exchange is non-standard and does not involve a verified handshake, the process sometimes fails without an error message being generated. Resetting the client NIC or rebooting the client operating system often restores connectivity in this situation.
z If multiple users on the same AP are experiencing problems, examine statistics on the AP . It is possible that the network is extremely busy, is experiencing interference, or is experiencing a denial of service attack. Perform a wireless packet capture when in doubt.
z If the failure took place while the user was moving, it is possible that the
user roamed to an area with no radio coverage and cannot re-associate.
z If the problem repeats often, debug may be enabled for the client experiencing the problem. If the Aruba switch is dropping the association, this will be indicated in the log file. To enable client debug in the Aruba CLI, use the command aaa user debug mac <MAC address of client>. Log output from the debug process can be viewed by issuing the command show log intuser 30 (to display the last 30 lines of the log file).
595
z The cause for the dropped association may have been a denial of service
attack specifically a deauth or disconnect station attack. View the Aruba Wireless Management System log file by navigating in the management GUI to the Events tab to see if this is the case. A wireless packet capture will also verify this situation.
z Reset the client NIC. If an internal error has caused the dropped association, a reset of the NIC may restore connectivity.
z If the performance problems began while the user was moving, it is possible that roaming failed. Examine the clients current signal strength and data rate. If they are low, compare the users physical location with the location of the currently associated AP . This is sometimes caused by an issue known as client stickiness the tendency for a client to maintain an existing association and ignore closer APs even when signal strength has significantly degraded. Ideally, pre-deployment testing will identify client NICs and drivers that exhibit this problem so that they can be excluded from the deployment.
Monitoring > Clients > Enterprise Clients, select the affected client, and click on z z
If RSSI also known as signal strength - is low (below 20), the client has poor signal strength to the nearest AP . This may indicate a roaming failure, described above. If transmit retries is high, the client is sending frames that are not being acknowledged by the AP . The client is then forced to re-transmit these frames, reducing performance. The cause may be interference or low signal strength.
596
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
z z z
If receive retries is high, the AP is sending frames that are not being acknowledged by the client. The AP is then forced to re-transmit these frames, reducing performance. The cause may be interference or low signal strength. If the transmit or receive data rate is low, it indicates that the client or APs rate adaptation algorithm has detected errors at higher data rates and is forcing a lower rate. This could indicate interference or low signal strength. If signal strength is high, retry rate is high, and data rate is low, the cause may be localized interference. These symptoms indicate a client that is close to the AP with good signal strength, but with poor communication between the AP and client. Examine the Events tab in the GUI and look for any indications of detected interference. If the above parameters are within acceptable ranges, but throughput is still low, it may indicate a congested AP . Perform activity monitoring on the entire AP rather than on the individual client to examine how much bandwidth is being consumed on the AP . If there are too many clients connected to a given AP , performance may be increased by reducing the maximum number of clients allowed on the AP . (The theoretical maximum number of clients allowed per AP is 255. A real world maximum may well be closer to 10.)
597
Observations
Proper
configuration. If this configuration causes problem, verify that the NIC is operating as configured. Link is good but the switch will not see any autonegotiatio n information from the NIC. So the WLAN switches (which only support full-duplex operation with 1000 Mbps), will default to full-duplex. Proper configuration. If this configuration causes problem, verify that the NIC is operating as configured.
1000Mbps/Full-d uplex
Auto
1000Mbps/F ull-duplex
1000Mbps/F ull-duplex
1000Mbps/Full-d uplex
1000Mbps/Fullduplex
1000Mbps/F ull-duplex
1000Mbps/F ull-duplex
598
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
Observations
Because the speeds do not match, no link is established.
100Mbps/Full-du plex
Auto
100Mbps/Fu ll-duplex
100Mbps/Ha lf-duplex
There is a duplex mismatch (half and full) which may provide connectivity, but there will likely be performance problems and poor quality, intermittent connectivity. There is a duplex mismatch (half and full) which may provide connectivity, but there will likely be performance problems and poor quality, intermittent connectivity.
Auto
100Mbps/Full-d uplex
599
Observations
Proper configuration. If this configuration causes problem, verify that the NIC is operating as configured.
100Mbps/Half-d uplex
Auto
100Mbps/Ha 100Mbps/Ha The switch, lf-duplex lf-duplex which is configured for Auto, will default to half duplex for 10/100Mbps settings. 10Mbps/Half 10Mbps/Half The switch, -duplex -duplex which is configured for Auto, will default to half duplex for 10Mbps settings.
10Mbps/Half-du plex
Auto
600
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
Observations
Because the speeds do not match, no link is established.
Auto
100Mbps/Halfduplex
100Mbps/Ha 100Mbps/Ha The switch, lf-duplex lf-duplex which is configured for Auto, will default to half duplex for 100Mbps settings. 10Mbps/Half 10Mbps/Half The switch, -duplex -duplex which is configured for Auto, will default to half duplex for 10Mbps settings.
Auto
10Mbps/Half-d uplex
Authentication
Most enterprise wireless networks make use of some form of secure authentication. This typically means 802.1x or VPN, although other choices are possible. The troubleshooting process is different depending on which authentication scheme is in use.
802.1x
Authentication using 802.1x may be accomplished in combination with dynamic WEP key exchange, WPA with TKIP , or 802.11i with AES. The troubleshooting process for the authentication portion is identical in all cases.
601
z Check the RADIUS server. The first line of troubleshooting for authentication problems should always involve the authentication server. Because the actual authentication exchange in 802.1x happens between the client and the authentication server, the server is the most accurate entity for examining logging information. Server log messages will often indicate what triggered the failure.
602
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
z Verify that the client configuration matches the standard enterprise client
configuration. Most 802.1x problems are caused by a misconfigured client. For example, the wrong certificate authority or wrong server domain name may have been selected, or password authentication may be selected when one-time token use is required by the authentication server.
z Examine the RADIUS server log files. In most cases, the RADIUS server
will provide necessary clues to troubleshoot the problem.
z Verify that the client certificate has not expired by examining the certificate
Valid to date.
z Verify that the client certificate has not been revoked. The certification
authority Certificate Revocation List (CRL) contains all revoked certificates.
603
z The client may not provide useful information on which type of PEAP is in
use. However, a clue may be to examine the PEAP inner authentication protocol. Microsoft PEAP allows MS-CHAP v2 and a smart card/certificate as the inner authentication protocol. Cisco PEAP also supports one-time passwords or token cards as the inner authentication protocol. If a one-time password or secure token is available in the clients PEAP configuration, Cisco PEAP is most likely being used.
z Verify that the RADIUS server and client are configured for the same 802.1x
authentication method. For example, if the RADIUS server is configured to use PEAP , the client must also be configured this way. Microsoft clients default to EAP-TLS (Smart card or other certificate).
z This problem has been seen with Proxim Orinoco A/B/G cards with driver
version 2.4.2.17. After roaming to a new AP , the client will generate MIC (Message Integrity Check) failures during phase 2 of the 4-way WPA key exchange handshake.
604
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
z If there is no IP address on the interface, verify that the interface is configured to obtain an address via DHCP .
z Verify that the DHCP server is active. If the Aruba internal DHCP server is
in use, the command show log dhcp will provide information on DHCP server activity.
z Configure the DHCP server so that it supplies clients with a DNS server
address.
z Statically configure the client with the address of a DNS server. z In the Aruba VPN dialer, turn off the option labeled Wait for wireless.
Note that with this option disabled, the VPN dialer will try to establish a connection any time the wireless NIC is connected to a network and has an IP address.
605
z Examine log files on the Aruba switch. First, examine the output of show
log crypto. The following error messages are common:
z z z
NO_PROPOSAL_CHOSEN: Indicates the client and switch are not configured in a like manner. If using the Aruba dialer, verify that the lifetime, encryption, and hash for both IKE and IPSec match. INVALID_HASH_INFORMATION: Indicates that the client and switch's IKE pre-shared keys do not match. If using a 3rd-party VPN client, the IKE pre-shared key is sometimes called the "group key" or "group password". INVALID_PAYLOAD_TYPE, INVALID_COOKIE, and PAYLOAD_MALFORMED: May indicate that the IKE pre-shared key does not match between the client and switch.
z Examine the output of show crypto isakmp sa. This command will list all
IKE security associations (SAs) currently active in the switch. If no SA appears for the client in question, it is likely that the IKE pre-shared keys do not match between the client and switch.
z Examine the output of show crypto ipsec sa. Once IKE negotiation has
succeeded (an IKE SA appears for the client), this command will list all IPSec security associations (SAs) currently active in the switch. If no SA appears for the client in question, it is likely that the client and switch have mismatching lifetimes, encryption types, or hash configuration.
z Another possible cause of this problem is that the Windows IPSec service
is not running. Bring up the Windows Services control panel by navigating to StartSettingsControl PanelAdministrative ToolsServices. Look for the IPSec service, and verify it is configured as the following figure shows. Note that the IPSec service in turn depends on the Remote Procedure Call (RPC) service verify that both are enabled.
606
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
z Verify the diagnosis by examining the output of show crypto ipsec sa. If a
security association exists for the client, IPSec was successful. Examine the output of show vpdn tunnel l2tp. If L2TP has failed, no tunnel will exist for the client in question.
607
z Examine the output of show vpdn l2tp local pool. Verify that there are IP
addresses free. If there are not, it will be necessary to configure an additional IP address pool.
608
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
System
609
1 Supported Rates 8 1.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 2.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 5.5 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 11.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 6.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 12.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 24.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 36.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate)
Extended Supported Rates Element ID: 50 Extended Supported Rates Length: 4 Supported Rate: 9.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) Supported Rate: 18.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) Supported Rate: 48.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) Supported Rate: 54.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate)
610
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
-42 0%
System
Supported Rate:
36.0
Extended Supported Rates Element ID: 50 Extended Supported Rates Length: 4 Supported Rate: 9.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) Supported Rate: 18.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) Supported Rate: 48.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) Supported Rate: 54.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate)
612
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
.... ..0. Not an Exit from the Distribution System .... ...0 Not to the Distribution System Duration: Destination: Source: BSSID: Seq. Number: Frag. Number: 0 Microseconds FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF 00:0B:86:80:48:80 00:0B:86:80:48:80 3635 0 Ethernet Broadcast Aruba Net:80:48:80 Aruba Net:80:48:80
Disabled
SSID
Element ID: Length: SSID: 0 SSID 16 wireless-network
613
Supported Rates
Element ID: Length: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: 1 Supported Rates 4 1.0 (BSS Basic Rate) 2.0 (BSS Basic Rate) 5.5 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 11.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate)
ERP Information
Element ID: Length: ERP Flags: 42 ERP Information 1 %00000010 x... .... Reserved .x.. .... Reserved ..x. .... Reserved ...x .... Reserved .... x... Reserved .... .0.. Not Barker Preamble Mode .... ..1. Use Protection .... ...0 Non-ERP Not Present
614
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
Reserved 171
Element ID: Length: Value: 171 Reserved 171 11 0x000B86080400010A040026
Non-strict order WEP Not Enabled No More Data Power Management - active mode This is not a Re-Transmission Last or Unfragmented Frame Not an Exit from the Distribution
.... ...0 Not to the Distribution System Duration: Destination: Source: BSSID: Seq. Number: Frag. Number: 11547 Microseconds 00:04:E2:64:BE:08 SMC Net:64:BE:08 00:0B:86:80:18:00 Aruba Net:80:18:00 00:0B:86:80:18:00 Aruba Net:80:18:00 2948 0
Disabled
616
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
SSID
Element ID: Length: SSID: 0 SSID 4 air1
Supported Rates
Element ID: Length: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: 1 Supported Rates 4 1.0 (BSS Basic Rate) 2.0 (BSS Basic Rate) 5.5 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 11.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate)
617
System
Chapter 26
System
619
System
%0000010000110001
May 2005
Chapter 26
x....... .x...... ..0..... ...x.... ....0... Disabled microseconds] ......x. .......x ........ ........ ........ ........ ........ ........ ........ ........ Listen Interval: 1
.....1.. ........ G Mode Short Slot Time [9 ........ ........ 0....... .0...... ..1..... ...1.... ....0... .....0.. ......0. .......1 Reserved Reserved Channel Agility Not Used PBCC Not Allowed Short Preamble Privacy Enabled CF Poll Not Requested CF Not Pollable Not an IBSS Type Network ESS Type Network
SSID
Element ID: Length: SSID: 0 SSID 4 air1
Supported Rates
Element ID: Length: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: 1 Supported Rates 8 1.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 2.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 5.5 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 11.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 6.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 9.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 12.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 24.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate)
WPA
Element ID: 221 WPA Length: 24 OUI: 0x00-0x50-0xF2-0x01 Version: 1 Multicast cipher OUI: 0x00-0x50-0xF2-02 TKIP Number of Unicast 1 Unicast cipher OUI: 0x00-0x50-0xF2-02 TKIP Number of Auths 1 Auth OUI: 0x00-0x50-0xF2-01 SSN Extra bytes (Padding): .. 00 00
622
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
System
Disabled .....1.. ........ G Mode Short Slot Time [9 microseconds] ......x. .......x ........ ........ ........ ........ ........ ........ ........ ........ 0....... .0...... ..1..... ...1.... ....0... .....0.. Reserved Reserved Channel Agility Not Used PBCC Not Allowed Short Preamble Privacy Enabled CF Poll Not Requested CF Not Pollable
Troubleshooting AirOS Environments 623
........ ......0. Not an IBSS Type Network ........ .......1 ESS Type Network Status Code: Association ID: 0 Successful 0xC001
Supported Rates
Element ID: Length: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: Supported Rate: 1 Supported Rates 4 1.0 (BSS Basic Rate) 2.0 (BSS Basic Rate) 5.5 (Not BSS Basic Rate) 11.0 (Not BSS Basic Rate)
Packet Sniffing
As of AirOS 2.3 and later, two types of packet sniffing have been added to existing remote sniffing from APs and IKE (VPN) sniffing:
Packet Capture
This CLI utility allows sniffing of all control path packets. This is useful for sniffing RADIUS, 802.1x, VPN control path (IKE is encrypted, L2TP is not), station up/down opcodes, mobility, DHCP , and virtually any other packets that traverse the control path CPU. To invoke the command as an action (not saved), enter:
624
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 26
To invoke the command as a config option which can be saved across switches in the running configuration, enter:
(config)# packet-capture-defaults tcp <all|disable|ports> udp <all|disable|ports> arubamsg <all|disable|opcodes> other <enable|disable>
These commands create a file named filter.pcap in the logs directory that can then be extracted using tar logs. The file is also copied into the crash directory in the event of a crash. The file is limited to 1.5MB and will be backed up to filter.1.pcap if filled. So up to 3MB of captured packets can be retained for future inspection. These commands allow a complete playback of what happened. NOTEBe careful when using these commands as use passwords and keys may be stored inside filter.pcap. To see the results of these commands, enter:
# show packet-capture
or
# show packet-capture-defaults
You can enable/disable sniffing on TCP , UDP , Aruba messages, or any other types of packets. Note that "ports" and "opcodes" are comma separated values and you can sniff up to 10 of them. Whenever they're present, only those ports or opcodes are captured. The following types of packets are always skipped:
z z z
Aruba message hellos Aruba message BPDUs TCP cli ports (default ones)
Examples
Debugging a wireless WEP station doing VPN would typically require:
z z z z z
Enter:
station up/down: aruba msg opcode 30 wep key plumbing: aruba msg opcode 29 DHCP: aruba msg opcode 90 (not udp 67 as that won't catch mobility packets) ike: udp port 500 & 4500 l2tp: udp port 1701
625
packet-capture arubamsg 30,29,90 udp 500,4500,1701,1812,1645 Debugging 802.1x with TKIP would typically require:
z z z z z z
Enter:
station up/down: aruba msg opcode 30 802.1x opcode: aruba msg opcode 13 forward dot1x: aruba msg opcode 71 tkip key plumbing: aruba msg opcode 70 DHCP: aruba msg opcode 90 radius: 1812 typically or 1645
packet-capture arubamsg 30,13,71,70,90 udp 1812,1645 NOTEThese examples give you all the messaging plus timestamps associated to them. This is useful for seeing whyfor example, users got associated but took 2 minutes to get an IP .
SESSION MIRRORING
As of AirOS 2.3.0.0 and later code you can mirror Ethernet packets on a per session basis. This feature is only accessible from the CLI. For each ACL you want to be able to mirror, add the mirror flag and destination IP . For example, to see L2TP control packets unencrypted, enter:
firewall session-mirror-destination 1.2.3.4 ip access-list session vpnlogon any any svc-l2tp permit mirror
Use ethereal on the target machine, in the above example, that's 1.2.3.4. It does not require an Aruba specific ethereal as the packet format is GRE w/ Ethernet bridging. The target does not need to be trusted, the packet will be sent to the target regardless of being trusted or untrusted.
626
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Network Utilities
Ping
Diagnostic Tools
627
Traceroute
628
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 27
General Information
Received Configuration
Diagnostic Tools
629
Software Status
Debug Log
630
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 27
Detailed Statistics
Web Diagnostic
Diagnostic Tools
631
632
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Part
5
Command Reference
This command reference includes commonly used commands. It does not include all CLI commands nor does it explain all the options of all commands.
633
634
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
AirOS Commands
635
To return to the previous mode, use the Exit command or specific termination command listed for that mode (for example, Ctrl-Z exits Config Terminal mode). Exit will always work for any mode.
Getting Help
Online help is available for all commands by pressing ?. There are two levels of help. To see what other command strings match what you have entered, type ? at the end of the string (no space) for which you want information. For example: (switch) #reload? reload reload-peer-SC Coldstart the switch Coldstart the peer Supervisor Card (A5000)
shows you what commands start with the string reload. To see help text for a command, enter the command for which you want help, enter a space, then type ?. For example: (switch) #ping ? <ipaddr> Send ICMP echo packets to a specified IP address.
Tips
To save time in entering commands, you only need to enter the first unique characters, then press Tab. The CLI will complete the rest of the command string. The following sections explain the commands that are available at each mode. Notice that AirOS WLAN Switch commands are not listed alphabetically as one might expect in a reference manual. Because commands only apply in the mode, or context, in which they are executed, this chapter lists commands alphabetically by mode. This is intended to help you understand the difference, for example, of a aaa command in Privileged mode versus a aaa command in Configuration Terminal mode. Commands that function the same across all modes, (exit or traceroute, for example) are defined once and cross referenced.
636
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Commands
enable exit
Description
Turn on Privileged commands (switch)# End this session. Any unsaved changes are lost. Same as the logout command. End this session. Any unsaved changes are lost. Same as the exit command. Send ICMP echo packets to a specified IP address. Map the path the packets took to get to the specified address.
logout
ping
traceroute
enable
Changes the CLI mode from the current Exec mode to Privileged mode. Privileged mode commands allow users to perform basic file management and system management functions.
Example
(switch)> enable (switch)#
exit
Typically leaves the current mode and returns the previous mode. In the case, since the Exec mode is the entry-level mode, entering this command terminates the connection to the switch.
AirOS Commands
637
Example
(switch)> exit _
See logout.
logout
Terminates the session.
Example
(switch)> logout _
See exit.
ping
Equivalent to the Unix ping command (with default options). This command issues a query to the specified device such that if the specified device is active and online, that device will respond back to the device issuing the ping. Useful for determining network connectivity between devices.
Syntax
ping <ipaddr> where ipaddr is the IP address of the device to send ping (or ICMP echo) packets.
Example
(switch)> ping 10.1.1.1 Press 'q' to abort. Sending 5, 100-byte ICMP Echos to 10.1.1.1, timeout is 2 seconds: !!!!! Success rate is 100 percent (5/5), round-trip min/avg/max = 56.73/61.485/75.943 ms (switch)>
638
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
traceroute
Equivalent to the Unix traceroute command (with default options). This command traces the path packets take to go from the switch to the specified device.
Syntax
traceroute <ipaddr>
where ipaddr is the IP address of the destination device. The path to be traced is that between the switch and the specified device.
Example
(switch)#traceroute 10.1.2.3 Press 'q' to abort. Tracing the route to 10.1.2.3 1 2 3 4 ... 20 21 10.4.21.254 * * * * * * * * * * * * * 0.788 msec 0.564 msec 0.56 msec
(switch) #
AirOS Commands
639
Commands
aaa
Description
Accesses Triple-A (authentication, authorization, accounting) commands. Accesses Air Monitor commands. Updates existing 802.11b configurations to use 802.11g. Reboots all the specified Access Points. Reflashes the specified AP . Enables Audit Trail. Backs up files in flash. Restarts the switch. Accesses clear commands. Sets the system clock. Accesses the configuration commands. (Aruba) (config) # Copies the specified files. Manages the database. Access the debug commands. Removes files.
am ap-upgrade-config
640
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Description
Displays directories in flash. Manages the local user database. Specifies the no form of commands that support this syntax. Access the Page command. Specifies output paging. Accesses the system panic information commands. Accesses the packet capture commands. The ICMP command. Executes a cold boot of the switch. Contrasts with the boot command which warm starts the switch. Changes the specified file name. Restores the directories on flash. Commands reserved for Aruba engineering. Do not access these commands with Aruba tech support assistance. Access the show commands. Accesses the site survey commands. Accesses the Station Management commands.
AirOS Commands
641
Description
Accesses licensing controls. Creates a tar file of the specified directory. Traces the route a packet has taken to the specified IP address. Displays the name of the user who is logged on. Accesses the WLAN Management System commands. Saves the running configuration file to the specified location.
whoami
wms
write
aaa Commands
The Privileged mode aaa commands include:
(switch) #aaa ? inservice Bring authentication server into service stateful-authentication test-server Test authentication server user User commands
See also the aaa commands in Configure mode.
Syntax
aaa inservice <string> where string is the name of the authentication server to be enabled.
642
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(switch)# aaa inservice aruba.com
See also:
aaa test-server
Syntax
[no] aaa inservice stateful-authentication
Example
(switch)# aaa inservice stateful-authentication
To disable stateful-authentication, enter:
Syntax
aaa stateful-authentication dot1x delete-all
Example
TBC
AirOS Commands
643
Example
The following example verifies that the authentication server Aruba is enabled and working. (switch)# aaa test-server Aruba
Syntax
add <ipaddr> clear-sessions <ipaddr> debug <ipaddr|mac|name <string>> Adds the IP address of a user Clears the specified user session. Debugs user by users IP address, MAC address, or name. Deletes specified user. Use all to delete all connected users. Logs the specified user out
Examples
The following examples show a user being added, their sessions being cleared, a user being debugged, a user being deleted, and a user being logged out.
(switch) #aaa user (switch) #aaa user (switch) #aaa user (switch) #aaa user 1 user deleted
644
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
ads netad learn <anomaly-id>
where anomaly-id is the ID of the anomaly reported by the show command .
Example
(switch) #ads netad learn
am
Configures scanning on the specified channel for the specified Air Monitor.
Syntax
am scan <am-ip> <channel> <bssid>
where: <am-ip)> is the IP address of the Air Monitor to be scanned. <channel> is the channel to tune to. Set this to 0 to start scanning. <bssid> is the MAC Address of the Air Monitor
Example
(switch) #am scan 10.4.4.4 11 Module AM is busy. Please try later
ap-upgrade-config
Allows you to convert your existing 802.11b configurations to support 802.11g as well.
Example
(switch) #ap-upgrade-config (switch) #
apflash
Reflashes the specified Access Point.
AirOS Commands
645
Syntax
(switch) #apflash <ipaddr>
Example
(switch) #apflash 192.10.10.1
audit-trail
TBC
Example
(switch) #audit-trail
backup
Backs up and compresses critical files to flashbackup.tar.gz.
Example
(switch) #backup flash See also restore.
boot
Specifies the configuration file and the partition the switch uses to boot.
Syntax
boot <config-file> <filename> | <system> <0|1>
Example
The following example directs the switch to boot from config file 9147.
646
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
clear Commands
The clear command resets counters to zero for:
Parameter
ads arp counters crypto ip loginsession mobile rap-wml site-survey stm vpdn wms
Description
Anomaly Detection System Commands Clear arp table Clear counters on one or all interfaces Clear crypto state TBC Login Session mobility manager Rogue AP Wired MAC Lookup Commands Site Survey Clear Commands Station Management commands Clear vpdn state WLAN Management system commands
Parameter
all id
Description
Resets all NETAD anomaly counters to zero. Resets the specified NETAD anomaly counter to zero.
Example
(switch) #clear ads netad anomaly all
AirOS Commands
647
clear arp
Clears the Address Resolution Protocol statistics.
Example
Syntax
clear counters fastethernet <slot/port>
where the <slot>/<port> specifies which card and which port is to be reset.
Example
(switch) #clear counters fastethernet 1/1
Syntax
clear counters fastethernet <slot/port>
where the <slot>/<port> specifies which card and which port is to be reset.
Example
(switch) #clear counters gigabitethernet 1/1
Syntax
clear counters vrrp <id>
where <id> is the Virtual Router ID. Valid ID range is 1-255.
Example
(switch) #clear counters vrrp 1 (switch) #clear arp
648 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
clear crypto
Turns off cryptographic state.
Syntax
dp ipsec isakmp {sa | <peer> <ipaddr>} Clear crypto latest DP packets Clear crypto isakmp state Clear crypto isakmp state
Example
To clear dp packets, enter:
clear loginsession
Clears the specified logging session.
Syntax
clear loginsession <id>
where:
<id>
Session id 2-6
Example
To clear login session 2, enter:
packet-counters
650
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) #clear stm hole ? all bssid Clear all flagged coverage holes BSSID for the flagged AP to clear hole
AirOS Commands
651
(switch) #clear vpdn tunnel ? l2tp pptp Clear vpdn all L2TP tunnel Clear vpdn all PPTP tunnel, not supported
(switch) #clear vpdn tunnel pptp ? id <cr> Tunnel ID to clear, not supported
652
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) #
clock
TBC See also the clock commands in Configuration mode.
Syntax
clock set <year> <month> <day> <hour> <min> <sec>
AirOS Commands
653
where <year> is the four-digit year, <month> is the name of the month, <day> is the number of the day (1-31), hour is the time in hours (0-24) , <min> is the number of minutes in the hour (0-60), and <sec> is the number of seconds in the minute (0-60).
Example
To set the time to be 5 January 2005 at 11:23:00 PM, enter:
configure terminal
Accesses the switch configuration mode.
Example
(switch)#configure terminal (switch)(config)#
copy
Duplicates files.
Syntax
flash: ftp: log running-config startup-config system: tftp: ftp file system Logging Running Configuration Startup Configuration System Partition Tftp file system
copy flash
Copies the flash file to a backup file on the switch or to an external host using TFTP .
654 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
copy flash <srcfilename> <flash:destfilename> |<tftp:tftphost>
Examples
(switch) #copy flash: 9147 tftp:10.1.1.55 (switch) #copy flash: 9147 flash: copy9147
copy system
Copies the system from one partition to the other.
Syntax
copy system: <source partition 0|1> <destination partition 0|1>
Example
(switch) #copy system: partition 1 0
copy log
Copies the specified log file to the specified location.
Syntax
copy <module> <destination>
where modules are:
aaa ads all arubaauth cfgm crypto dhcpd errorlog fpapps intuser l2tp localdb
Logging for administrator authentication Logging for Anomaly Detection Copy All the log files Logging for user authentication Logging for Configuration Manager Logging for VPN (IKE/IPSEC) Logging for DHCP packets Errors logged in the system Logging for Layer 2,3 control Logging for User Information (Internal) Logging for L2TP Logging for local database
AirOS Commands
655
master switch only) mmgr mobagent packetfilter and control frames pim pptp processes publisher sapm snmp ssi stm suser traffic wms only)
Logging for Mobility Master Database (Master Logging for Mobility Manager Logging for Mobility Agent Logging for packet filtering of aruba messaging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging for for for for for for for for for for for Protocol Independent Multicast PPTP run-time processes publish subscribe service AP Manager (Master switch only) SNMP agent Secure Service Interface Station Management User Information traffic Wireless Management (Master switch
copy running-config
Copies the running-config file to the specified location.
Syntax
copy running-config <flash:destfilename> |<tftp:tftphost>
copy startup-config
Copies the startup-config file to the specified location.
Syntax
copy startup-config <flash:destfilename> |<tftp:tftphost>
copy tftp
Copies the specified file to the specified location using TFTP .
656
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
copy tftp: <tftphost> <filename> <flash | system partition> where: <tftphost> Is the TFTP server host name or IP address. <filename> Is the name of the file to be copied. flash Specifies that the file be copied to the flash file system. system Specifies the System Partition number, 0 or 1.
Example
The following example specifies that the file main be copied to system partition 1 using TFTP .
copy ftp
Copies the specified file to the specified location using FTP .
Syntax
copy ftp: where: <filename> <flash | system partition>
<filename> Is the name of the file to be copied. flash Specifies that the file be copied to the flash file system. system Specifies the System Partition number, 0 or 1.
Example
The following example specifies that the file main be copied to system partition 1 using FTP .
crypto
Configures IKE.
AirOS Commands
657
Syntax
cyrpto isakmp
Example
(switch) #crypto isakmp
database
Syncs the database.
Example
(switch) #database synchronize
debug
Enables debugging for the following switch features:
aaa ads all arubaauth cfgm crypto dhcpd fpapps intuser l2tp localdb master
Debugging for administrator authentication Debugging for Anomaly Detection Enable all debug Debugging for user authentication Debugging for Configuration Manager Debugging for VPN (IKE/IPSEC) Debugging for DHCP packets Debugging for Layer 2,3 control Debugging for User Information (Internal) Debugging for L2TP Debugging for local database Debugging for Mobility Master Database (Master switch only)
658
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Debugging for Mobility Manager Debugging for Mobility Agent Debugging for packet filtering of aruba messaging and control frames Debugging for Protocol Independent Multicast Debugging for PPTP Debugging for run-time processes Debugging for publish subscribe service Debugging for AP Manager (Master switch only) Debugging for SNMP agent Debugging for Secure Service Interface Debugging for Station Management Debugging for User Information Debugging for traffic Debugging for Wireless Management (Master switch
pim pptp processes publisher sapm snmp ssi stm suser traffic wms only)
Example
The following examples turns on debugging for all aaa module functions.
delete
Removes the specified file name from flash. The file must exist in flash and be correctly specified before the delete command can remove it.
Syntax
delete <filename>
where <filename> is the name of the file in flash that is to be erased.
AirOS Commands 659
Example
The following example removes the file named test from flash.
dir
Displays a listing of all the files in flash. This command is the same as the DOS dir command (similar to the Unix ls command).
Example
The following example lists all the files in the root directory of flash.
(switch) #dir -rw-r--r--rw-r--r--rw-r--r--rw-r--r-------xr--rw-r--r--rw-r--r--rw------1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 root root root root root root root root root root root root root root root root 50 18383 252928 294896 25431 27515 28221 136 Dec Dec Dec Dec Nov Nov Nov Nov 3 13 13 1 17 18 16 17 18:55 09:42 10:49 14:47 17:33 18:11 16:00 18:04 db_dump.sql default.cfg logs.tar rfplan.js run2.0.8 run2.2.4 runconfig2.2.3 webtrace
(switch) #
halt
Gracefully stops all processes on the switch. Uses should halt the switch before rebooting or shutting down to avoid interrupting processes underway.
Example
(switch) #halt (switch) #
local-userdb
Manages the user database.
660
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
local-userdb {add <username> | del | del-all | export | fix-database | import | modify} where
add Add a user del Delete a user del-all Delete all users export Export the Local User Database to a file fix-database Use this command with CAUTION, it will wipe out the whole database. To save existing data use the export command. import Use this command with CAUTION, it will Replace the existing users with the user entries from the imported file. modify Modify the User Attributes.
Example
The following example illustrates adding the user Vipin to the local user database.
no
Disables the feature specified.
Syntax
(switch) #no ? aaa audit-trail crypto debug paging Authentication commands Enable Audit Trail Configure IPSec, IKE, and CA Debugging Functions Output paging
Example
To disable IKE, enter:
packet-capture
Configures monitoring the specified types of traffic. This is useful for diagnostic purposes.
Syntax
packet-capture {arubamsg <opcodes> | other <enable | disable> | tcp <ports> | udp <ports>}
where: arubamsg Enables or disables Aruba internal messaging packet cap turing. For debugging only. opcodesSpecifies opcodes to capture. You can specify up ten opcodes, separated by commas. otherEnables or disables all other types of packets. tcp Enables or disables TCP packet capturing. udpEnables or disables TCP packet capturing. portsSpecifies the ports to which packets are addressed. Specify up to ten ports, separated by commas. To specify all ports, enter all.
Example
(switch) #packet-capture arubamsg all tcp all
page
TBD
Syntax
page <length>
where <length> specifies the size of the page. Valid range is 24 - 100.
Example
The following example sets the page size to 80
662
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
paging
TBD
Example
TBD (switch) #paging (switch) #
panic
Manages files created during a system crash.
Syntax
panic {clear | info <file filename nvram> | save filename}
where: clear removes the panic files from flash. info prints out the specified panic file information from either NVRAM or flash. list displays all the flash or NVRAM panic files. save saves the panic file with the specified file name.
| nvram symbolfile>
| list <file |
Example
The following example shows how to display any panic files in NVRAM. (There are no panic files.)
ver
built by
Process
pcap
Starts or stops packet capture sessions. Info TBC
AirOS Commands
663
Syntax
pcap {<start | stop | resume> | clear | interactive ipaddr | raw-start <ipaddr> <target-ipaddr> <target-port> <format> [bssid | channel]}
where:
startStart New Packet Capture session stopStop a Packet Capture session clearTBC interactiveTBC raw-startTBC bssid BSSID of AM interface to start PCAP on channel Channel to tune into to capture packets
Example
The following example starts a raw packet capture session for the AM at 10.100.100.1 and sends the frames to the target IP address 192.168.22.44 on port 604 with pcap format .
ping
Syntax
ping <ipaddr> where ipaddr is the IP address of the device to send ping (or ICMP echo) packets.
Example
(switch)> ping 10.1.1.1 Press 'q' to abort. Sending 5, 100-byte ICMP Echos to 10.1.1.1, timeout is 2 seconds: !!!!! Success rate is 100 percent (5/5), round-trip min/avg/max = 56.73/61.485/75.943 ms (switch)>
reload
Resets the system to boot to the configuration file.
664 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(switch) #reload Do you really want to reset the system(y/n) : y System will now restart! ... Restarting system.
reload-peer-sc
TBC
Example
TBC
(switch) #reload-peer-SC
rename
Changes the specified file name to a new file name.
Syntax
(switch) #rename <filename> <newfilename>
Example
The following example changes the file named bud to pub.
restore
Reinstates the backed up flash directories in flashbackup.tar.gz. The tar backup file is untarred and uncompressed.
Syntax
restore flash
Example
(switch) #restore flash
AirOS Commands
665
secret
These commands are intended for use by authorized support personnel. Do not use these command unless directed to do so by Aruba Support.
show
The show commands display information on the following modules:
(switch) #show ? aaa access-list acl adp ads am ap ap-leds ap-params arp audit-trail banner boot clock configuration country cpuload crypto database datapath debugging destination dot1x firewall hostname image interface inventory ip keys local-switches
Show AAA configuration Show access-lists Show internal ACL tables ADP related commands Show Anomaly Detection System state Air Monitor commands Access Point commands Show AP LED array state for a slot AP environment variables to be programmed ARP information Show Audit Trail Log TBC Display boot parameters TBC Show saved configuration Displays the country code setting Display CPU Load Show crypto configuration Database management Datapath statistics State of each debugging option Show network destination information Show 802.1X Information Show global firewall configuration Display the host name Show System image version information Interface Status and Configuration Show hardware inventory IP information Show optional keys/features enabled Local switches connected to the master
666
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
local-userdb location log logging loginsessions mac-address-table master-redundancy memory mgmt-modules mgmt-role mgmt-user mobile mux netdestination netservice netstat ntp packet-capture packet-capture-defaul.. config pcap port processes provisioning-ap-list rap-wml rfsm rights roleinfo routerid running-config sapm session-access-list site-survey slots snmp spanning-tree spantree ssi startup-config station-table stm storage switch
User's in the Local User DataBase Show the switch location Show the contents of the logging buffers Show Logging Levels for applications Show administrator login sessions MAC Forwarding Table Master Switch Redundancy Configuration Display the memory information Show the predefined Management Modules Management Role Definition Show Management User Information Displays mobility information Show MUX Information Show network destinations Show network services Show current active network connections NTP Server Info Show packet-capture settings. Show packet-capture default settings (saved in file). Packet Capture commands Show switch port configuration Show system processes TBC Rogue AP Wired MAC Lookup Commands Show RF Spectrum Management Information Show access rights for user roles Show the switch role Router Id of the Switch Show running configuration TBC Show session access-list Show Site Survey information Slots which have line cards in them. Display the SNMP Configured Spanning tree topology Global spanning tree topology Show Security Service Interface information Show saved configuration Show internal station table Show 802.11 station management information Display the switch storage information Switch Configuration
AirOS Commands 667
switches included switchinfo syscontact syslocation tech-support time-range trunk un-provisioned user user-table users version virt-ap vlan vpdn vpn-dialer vrrp wlan wms (switch) #
M-switches connected to the master and the master Display the switch system information Display the system contact Display the system location Display the general switch information Show time-range Vlan Trunk Port Information TBC TBC Show internal user table Show administrative users Show System version Show virtual APs configured at a location VLAN IP Interface Show vpdn state Show VPN dialers VRRP configuration information Show WLAN Information Commands for viewing Wireless IDS configuration
site-survey
See also the site-survey commands in Configuration mode.
Syntax
Example
(switch) #site-survey ?
668
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
calibrate channel-plan
Start site survey calibration and channel assignment Start channel assignment Update channel plan for specific AP
update-channel-plan
stm
Manages the station manager commands. See also the stm commands in Configuration mode.
Syntax
TBC
Example
TBC
(switch) #stm ? add-dos-sta kick-off-sta remove-dos-sta start-trace stop-trace Add a STA to DoS list Kick off an STA Remove a STA from DoS list Start tracing probe request/probe response from mac Stop tracing probe request/probe response from mac
670
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
<mac>
TBC
(switch) #
swkey
The software licenses key. Enables the specified feature.
Syntax
swkey <softwareKey>
where <softwareKey> is the Software activation Key.
Example
TBD
tar
Creates a file in Unix tar file format.
Syntax
tar {clean | crash | flash | logs}
where:
672
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
cleanRemoves a tar file crashtar the crash directory to crash.tar flashtar and compress the /flash directory to flash.tar.gz logstar the logs directory to logs.tar
Example
To create a tar file for the directories in flash, enter:
traceroute
Equivalent to the Unix traceroute command (with default options). This command traces the path packets take to go from the switch to the specified device.
Syntax
traceroute <ipaddr>
where ipaddr is the IP address of the destination device. The path to be traced is that between the switch and the specified device.
Example
(switch)#traceroute 10.1.2.3 Press 'q' to abort. Tracing the route to 10.1.2.3 1 2 3 4 ... 20 21 10.4.21.254 * * * * * * * * * * * * * 0.788 msec 0.564 msec 0.56 msec
(switch) #
See also the traceroute command in Configuration mode and Exec mode.
whoami
This command returns the name of the user who is logged in to this session. It is the same as the Unix command of the same name.
AirOS Commands
673
Example
(switch) #whoami user admin - role root
wms
TBC See also the wms commands in Configuration mode.
Syntax
Example
(switch) #wms ? ap clean-db export-db import-db reinit-db station configure AP mode Clean Database Export DB to a file Import DB from a file Reinitialize Database configure station mode
674
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
<mac>
(switch) #
write
Saves the running configuration to memory or to the terminal computer. Can also be used to erase the running configuration and return the switch to factory defaults.
Syntax
write {erase all | memory | terminal}
Example
To delete the running configuration and databases and return the switch to factory default settings, enter:
676
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Description
Configure Authentication Aruba Discovery Protocol Commands Configure Anomaly Detection System Specify configuration of an AP by location or by BSSID Adaptive Radio Management Add arp entry Auto Radio Resource Allocation Configuration Define a banner Configure time-of-day clock Configure IPSec, IKE, and CA Database management Configure network destination (deprecated; use netdestination) Configure IEEE 802.1X Authenticator Modify the enable password Enable Encryption Configure global Firewall policies Accesses local commands for foreign agent Accesses local commands for home agent Change the Hostname Select an interface to configure interface Internet Protocol config commands Configure the switch location
AirOS Commands 677
Description
Modify Message Logging Facilities Login Session Configure the MAC address table Accesses Master Switch Redundancy Configuration commands Configure the master ip address for the switch Management Role Definition Configure a management user. Accesses configuration global parameters for mobility agent Accesses configuration mobility manager commands Accesses configuration commands for local mobility manager Set MUX Server IP Address. 0.0.0.0 to disable Enable MUX functionality on a VLAN Configure network destination Configure a network service Specify Newbury Locate Server Information Delete Command Configure NTP Send ICMP echo packets to a specified IP address. Configure IP information for PPTP Provision APs by plugging them into the switch Provision APs by plugging them into the switch Wired MAC Lookup for AP Classification commands Router Mobile Help not defined
678
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Description
Configure services Shut down interface Site Survey configuration commands Enable SNMP; Modify SNMP parameters Spanning Tree Subsystem Configure Security Service Interface 802.11 station management configuration Change the system contact Change the system location Enable telnet port Configure a time range Trace route to specified IP address. Make this a trusted port Configure user role Create Switch VLAN Virtual Interface Configure Virtual Private Dial-In Networking Configure the VPN dialer Virtual Router Redundancy Protocol Configuration Accesses WLAN Management System Commands
aaa Commands
This command controls user authorization and authentication for the switch. Use the no form of this command to disable AAA functions.
AirOS Commands
679
Syntax
aaa {bandwidth-contract | captive-portal | derivation-rules | dot1x | kerberos | ldap-server | mac-authentication | mgmt-authentication | pubcookie-authentication | radius-accounting | radius-attributes | radius-server | stateful-authentication | timers | trusted-ap | vpn-authentication | web}
aaa bandwidth-contract
Configures the bandwith contract.
Syntax
aaa bandwidth-contract <STRING> <kbits | mbits> <bandwidth>
Where: STRING is the name of the bandwidth contract kbits specifies the bandwith in kbits/second mbits specifies the bandwith in mbits/second <bandwidth> is the amount of bandwidth. Valid range is either 0-64 mbits/second or 0-65536 kbits/second
Example
The following example sets the amount of bandwidth for the bandwidth contract named test to 48 mbits per second.
aaa captive-portal
Configures the Captive Portal.
680
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
aaa captive-portal {auth-server <string> <position> <range> | default-role <string> | guest-logon | login-page <string> | logon-wait <cpu-utilization> <%> | <range> <value> | logout-popup-window | max-authentication-failures <value> | protocol-http | redirect-pause <time> | show-fqdn |sygate-on-demand <enable> <remediation-failure {role <name> | url <name>} | theme <name> | user-logon | welcome-page <string>} where: auth-serverAssigns the specified authentication server the order in which it is used. To assign highest order (position) enter 1. default-roleSpecifies the default role. guest-logonAllows guest log ins login-page Specifies the name of the alternate login page HTML file. logon-wait Configures a logon wait when the CPU is overloaded. Specify either the percentage of CPU utilization when a logon wait is to be enforced, or specify a number of seconds (range) to wait for captive portal logons. The minimum wait is one second. logout-popup-windowOpens a popup window for logout after authentication. max-authentication-failuresConfigures the maximum number of authentication failures before the user is blacklisted. protocol-httpSpecifies the use of HTTP for authentication. The default is HTTPS. redirect-pause Specifies the pause time in seconds for automatic redirect. show-fqdnAllows the user to see and select the fully qualified domain name (FQDN). sygate-on-demandConfigures the Sygate-on-demand agent. themeSelected the theme for the captive portal page. Specify default1, default2, default3, or custom. user-logonAllows registered users to log in. welcome-pageSpecifies the complete URL to an alternate welcome page to show after authentication.
Example
The following example shows how to blacklist any user unsuccessfully attempting more than three times to log onto the captive portal.
AirOS Commands
681
Syntax
aaa derivation-rules server <STRING>
where STRING is the name of the authentication server. (The server must have already been configured.)
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa derivation-rules server aruba
Syntax
aaa derivation-rules user
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa derivation-rules server user
Syntax
aaa dot1x auth-server <name>
where name is the name of the authentication server.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa dot1x auth-server aruba
Syntax
aaa dot1x default-role STRING
682 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa dot1x default-role guest
Syntax
none
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa dot1x enforce-machine-authentication
Syntax
aaa dot1x max-authentication-failures NUMBER
where NUMBER is the number of times a user can attempt to authenticate before being blacklisted. Valid range is TBC.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa dot1x max-authentication-failures 4
Syntax
aaa dot1x mode <disable> <enable>
where disable turns of 802.1x authentication and enable turns it on.
AirOS Commands
683
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa dot1x mode enable (Aruba5000) (config) #aaa dot1x mode disable
Syntax
aaa kerberos <name> <domain-name> <host> <mode> <timeout>
where name is the name of the KDC., domain-name is the fully qualified domain name, host is the address of the KDC, mode enables or disables Kerberos authentication, timeout configures the time period allowed between Kerberos requests and responses. The valid range is 0-60 seconds.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa kerberos aruba.com domain-name aruba.com host paul mode enable timeout 30
aaa ldap-server
Configures an LDAP server.
Syntax
aaa ldap-server STRING
where STRING is the name of the LDAP server
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa ldap-server paul (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
684
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
admin-dn STRING where STRING is the Distinguished Name.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#admin-dn pauldn (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
Syntax
admin-passwd [STRING] <cr > where STRING is the password for the Admin user who can search for the LDAP user. and <cr>
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#admin-passwd paul (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
Syntax
[no] allow-noencrypt
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#allow-noencrypt (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#allow-noencrypt
AirOS Commands
685
Syntax
[no] authport INTEGER where INTEGER is the port number to be used for authentication.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#authport 65000 (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
Syntax
base-dn STRING where STRING is the Base Distinguished Name for searching the LDAP server. limits, length, etc TBD.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#base-dn paulbase (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
Syntax
[no] filter STRING where STRING is the filter that is used as a key when searching the LDAP server. See also aaa ldap-server key-attribute
686
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#filter filter (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
Syntax
host STRING where STRING is the IP address of the LDAP server.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#host 192.11.2.0 (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
Syntax
[no] inservice
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#inservice (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
Syntax
key-attribute keyattribute STRING where STRING is the name of the attribute to be used as the key when searching the LDAP server.
AirOS Commands 687
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#key-attribute keyattribute (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
Syntax
inservice
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#inservice (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
aaa ldap-server no
Disables the following commands: allow-noencrypt authport filter inservice timeout See individual commands for more information.
688
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
[no] timeout <seconds> where seconds is the timeout value in seconds. Valid range is 1-30 seconds.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#timeout 25 (Aruba5000) (config-ldapserver-paul)#
syntax
aaa mac-authentication auth-server STRING position
where STRING is the name of the authentication server and position is the server priority. Valid range is TBC. Specify 1 for the highest position. The default is lowest position.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa mac-authentication auth-server internal-db 5
syntax
aaa mac-authentication default-role STRING
where STRING is the name of the default role.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa mac-authentication default-role guest
AirOS Commands
689
syntax
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa mac-authentication max-authentication-failures NUMBER
where NUMBER is the number of times a user can attempt unsuccessfully to login before the system blocks them out by blacklisting them.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa mac-authentication max-authentication-failures 4
syntax
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa mac-authentication mode <disable | enable>
where enable turns MAC-based authentication on, and disable turns it off.
Example
To turn MAC-based authentication on, enter:
syntax
aaa mgmt-authentication auth-server STRING position
where STRING is the name of the authentication server and position is the server priority . Valid range is TBC. Specify 1 for the highest position. The default is lowest position.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa mgmt-authentication auth-server internal-db 5
690
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
syntax
aaa mgmt-authentication default-role STRING
where STRING is the name of the default role.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa mgmt-authentication default-role guest
syntax
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa mgmt-authentication mode <disable | enable>
where enable turns MAC-based authentication on, and disable turns it off.
Example
To turn MAC-based authentication on, enter:
aaa pubcookie-authentication
Configures pubcookie authentication.
Syntax
aaa pubcookie-authentication
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa pubcookie-authentication
aaa radius-accounting
Configures RADIUS accounting.
Syntax
aaa radius-accounting
AirOS Commands
691
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa radius-accounting
aaa radius-attributes
Configure RADIUS attribute
Syntax
aaa radius-attributes add STRING INT <date | integer | ipaddr | string> [vendor <STRING > <INTEGER>] where STRING is the name of the attribute to be added, INT is the attribute type of: date Attribute type is Date integer ipaddr string Attribute type is Integer Attribute type is IP address Attribute type is String
vendor STRING is the name of the vendor specific attribute, and INTEGER is the vendor Identifier.
Example
The following example adds the RADIUS name-value pair: employee-type-admin. (Aruba5000) (config) #aaa radius-attributes add employee-type INT admin
aaa radius-server
Configures a RADIUS server.
Syntax
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa radius-server STRING [acctport <port_num> | authport <port_num> | host <hostname> | inservice | key <key_name> | match-essid <essid> | match-fqdn <fqdn> | mode <disable|enable> | nas-identifier <nas_ID> | retransmit <retransmit_num> | timeout <timeout_value> | trim-fqdn]
692
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
where the options to this command are: STRING specifies the name of RADIUS server. acctport specifies the port number used for accounting authport specifies the port number used for authentication (default is port 1812) host specifies the IP address of the RADIUS server inservice enables the server into service immediately key specifies the shared secret text string match-essid requires a match the specified ESSID match-fqdn requires a match to the specified FQDN mode enables or disables the use of the RADIUS server
nas-identifier configures the NAS-Identifier attribute in RADIUS packets retransmit specifies the maximum number of times a RADIUS request is retried timeout specifies the timeout period for RADIUS request. The default is 10 seconds. trim-fqdn trims the FQDN from the user name before sending to server <cr>
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa radius-server bigboy acctport 2550 authport 88 host 10.200.200.20 inservice key blue match-essid COFFEE match-fqdn ARUBA.COM mode enable nas-identifier 254 retransmit 3 timeout 30 trim-fqdn
AirOS Commands
693
Syntax
aaa stateful-authentication dot1x ap-config <name> ap-ipaddr radius-server-name <name> [key <keyvalue>] Where <name> is the configuration name IP Address of AP (NAS) configured for 802.1X stateful
radius-server-name is the name of the RADIUS Server used for stateful 802.1X Authentication key is the optional secret shared between AP and RADIUS Server
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa stateful-authentication dot1x ap-config paulconfig ap-ipaddr 1.1.2.3 radius-server-name paulserver key boo
Syntax
aaa stateful-authentication dot1x auth-server <auth-server-name>
Where <auth-server-name> is the name of the Backend Authentication server for stateful 802.1x authentication.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa stateful-authentication dot1x auth-server paulauthser (Aruba5000) (config) #
694
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
aaa stateful-authentication dot1x default-role STRING Where STRING is the label for the default role.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa stateful-authentication dot1x default-role pauldefrole (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax
aaa stateful-authentication dot1x mode <disable | enable > Where: disable turns this feature off enable turns this feature on <cr>
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa stateful-authentication dot1x mode enable (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax
aaa stateful-authentication dot1x timeout <0-20> Where <0-20> is the valid range of time that can elapse in the reply
AirOS Commands
695
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa stateful-authentication dot1x timeout 10 (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax
aaa stateful-authentication kerberos enable
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa stateful-authentication kerberos enable (Aruba5000) (config) #
696
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa timers idle-timeout ? <0-255> Minutes. Value of 0 disables idle timeout.
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa timers logon-lifetime ? <1-255> . Minutes. Default is 5 minutes. 0 disables the timeout
AirOS Commands
697
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa timers idle-timeout ? <0-255> Minutes. Value of 0 disables idle timeout.
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa timers logon-lifetime ? <1-255> . Minutes. Default is 5 minutes. 0 disables the timeout
698
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa timers idle-timeout ? <0-255> Minutes. Value of 0 disables idle timeout.
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa timers logon-lifetime ? <1-255> . Minutes. Default is 5 minutes. 0 disables the timeout
AirOS Commands
699
aaa trusted-ap
Configure trusted third party APs. Syntax aaa trusted-ap <mac-addr> where <mac-addr> is the MAC address of the AP in A:B:C:D:E:F notation. Example (Aruba5000) (config) #aaa trusted-ap 43:a:4:1:a:0 (Aruba5000) (config) #
700
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa vpn-authentication auth-server paul ? position <cr> Server Position. Default is lowest. 1 is highest.
Example
AirOS Commands
701
aaa web
Web server configuration
Syntax
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa web admin-port https port number where : admin-port configures a port for Web administration https specifies HTTPS protocol for the port Port Number is the number of the HTTPS port. Valid range is 0-65535.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa web admin-port https 6500 (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax
aaa xml-api client IPaddress where: client A.B.C.D Configure external XML API client IP address of external client
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #aaa xml-api client 1.2.3.4 (Aruba5000) (config) #
702
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
adp Commands
These commands control Access Point configuration and management using the Aruba Discovery Protocol.
adp
Enables the Automatic Discovery Protocol commands.
adp discovery
Enables or disables ADP . Syntax (Aruba5000) (config) # adp [discovery<disable | enable> | igmp-join <disable | enable> | igmp-vlan <vlanid>] Where: discovery enables or disables ADP igmp-joine enables or disables IGMP Join for ADP IP Multicast addresses igmp-vlan specifies which VLAN to send IGMP Reports to. Default 0. Uses default route VLAN.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # adp discovery enable igmp-join enable igmp-vlan 565 (Aruba5000) (config) #
ads Commands
AirOS Commands
703
(Aruba5000) (config) #ads netad mode ? detect detection mode disable learn mode Run NETAD in anomaly
704
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config) #ads netad mode disable ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #ads netad mode disable ap Commands
Configures Access Points either by BSSID or by location.
ap bssid
Configures APs by their MAC address (BSSID).
AirOS Commands
705
Syntax
ap bssid <bssid> Where: <bssid> specifies the BSSID in typical MAC address format: AA:BB:CC:DD:EE:FF
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #ap bssid 00:00:00:01:02:ff (Aruba5000) (config) #ap bssid 00:00:00:01:02:ff (Aruba5000) (sap-config bssid 00:00:00:01:02:ff) #? ageout Seconds of inactivity after which client is aged out ap-enable One of enable or disable authalgo Only opensystem is supported. No support for sharedkey beacon-period Beacon Period for the AP. Typically 100 bg-mode One of b-only, g-only or mixed channel Use the show ap allowed-channels command to get a list of allowed channels deny-bcast enable to suppress responses to probe requests with broadcast SSID dtim-period Interval between sending DTIMs in beacon essid ESSID for the AP. Should be a string of max. 32 characters hide-ssid enable or disable hiding the SSID in beacons local-probe-response The AP (not the switch) generates probe response max-clients Max Wireless CLients for AP. 0 thru 256 max-retries Maximum number of retries allowed for AP to send a packet max-tx-fail Maximum transmit failures before client gives up. mode One of am_mode or ap_mode (air monitor or access point) no Delete Command opmode Can be a comma separated list of opensystem,staticWep ,dynamicWep,staticTkip and dynamicTkip,wpa2-aes,wpa2-aes-psk power-mgmt 'enable': Enable power management rates For 802.11b/g a comma separated list of 1,2,5,6,9,11, 12,18,24,36,48,54. For 802.11a a comma separated list
706 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
rts-threshhold RTS a short-preamble tx-power txrates 1,2,5,6,9,11, list vlan-id associating weptxkey wpa2-preauth
of 6,9,12,18,24,36,48 and 54 The RTS threshold. Packets bigger than this use nd CTS Can be one of enable or disable A number from 0 thru 4 For 802.11b/g a comma separated list of 12,18,24,36,48,54. For 802.11a a comma separated of 6,9,12,18,24,36,48 and 54 The ID of the VLAN assigned to this AP's clients Specify an index from 1 thru 4 TBC
(Aruba5000) (sap-config bssid 00:00:00:01:02:ff) # (Aruba5000) (config) #ap location ? <location> Specify location as bldg.floor.location(0 is wildcard )
ap location
Accesses the AP location mode. TBC
<cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #ap location 0.0.0 (Aruba5000) (sap-config location 0.0.0) #? ageout Seconds of inactivity after which client is aged out ap-enable One of enable or disable ap-logging Set logging levels for AP facilities arm Adaptive Radio Management configuration authalgo Only opensystem is supported. No support for sharedke y beacon-period Beacon Period for the AP. Typically 100
AirOS Commands
707
bkplms-ip location bootstrap-threshold re-bootstraps deny deny-bcast with b disable dns-name that double-encrypt dtim-period dump-server enable essid characters hide-ssid hostname lms-ip APs local-probe-response max-clients max-retries a packet max-tx-fail mode poin mtu bytes no opmode opensystem,staticWep
The IP addr of the backup LMS for APs at this Number of heartbeat misses before AP TBC enable to suppress responses to probe requests roadcast SSID disable this feature or mode DNS Name for the AP. Can contain a $L substring is replaced with the location of the AP Encrypt 802.11 data frames using IPSec Interval between sending DTIMs in beacon Core dump server (for debugging) enable this feature or mode ESSID for the AP. Should be a string of max. 32 enable or disable hiding the SSID in beacons Change the system name The IP addr of the LMS that should be assigned to at this location The AP (not the switch) generates probe response Max Wireless CLients for AP. 0 thru 256 Maximum number of retries allowed for AP to send Maximum transmit failures before client gives up. One of am_mode or ap_mode (air monitor or access t) The MTU on the wired link for the AP (1024-1576 ) Delete Command Can be a comma separated list of
,dynamicWep,staticTkip,dynamicTkip,wpa2-aes,wpa2-aes-psk phy-type Specify either .a or .g for physical layer type, or e net1 for ethernet port 1 power-mgmt 'enable': Enable power management
708
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
radio-off-threshold turned off restore-default rf-band (g=2.4GHz, rts-threshhold RTS a snmp-server syscontact syslocation telnet tx-power virtual-ap vlan-id associating wepkey1 bytes) wepkey2 bytes) wepkey3 bytes) wepkey4 bytes) weptxkey wpa-hexkey wpa-passphrase wpa2-preauth
Number of heartbeat misses before radio is Restore default configs for this location The RF Band that the AP should operate in a=5GHz) The RTS threshold. Packets bigger than this use nd CTS Enable SNMP; Modify SNMP parameters Change the system contact Change the system location Enable or disable telnet to the AP A number from 0 thru 4 Configure a virtual AP with its own essid The ID of the VLAN assigned to this AP's clients Specify static WEP key 1 of 4 (length 5 or 13 Specify static WEP key 2 of 4 (length 5 or 13 Specify static WEP key 3 of 4 (length 5 or 13 Specify static WEP key 4 of 4 (length 5 or 13 Specify an index from 1 thru 4 Set a WPA Pre-Shared Key (PSK) Set a WPA passphrase to generate PSK TBC
arm Commands
Configures the Adaptive Radio Management commands.
AirOS Commands
709
Syntax
arm [acceptable-coverage-index <index> | backoff-time <backoff time> | error-rate-threshold <threshold value> | error-rate-wait-time <wait time> | free-channel-index <free channel index value> | ideal-coverage-index <coverage index value> | min-scan-time <scan time> | wait-time <wait time value> ] <cr>] Where: Option Description
acceptable-covera This specifies to the AP how good the coverage in on ge-index <index> this channel should be. The range is TBC. The default is 2. In general, the more APs there are in a given area, the lower this number should be. backoff-time <backoff time> Specifies how long (in seconds) the AP should wait after asking for a new channel or power setting. The default is 230 seconds. Range TBC.
specifies the minimum percentage of errors in traffic on error-rate-threshol a channel the AP experiences before it should change d <threshold channels. The default is 0% but Aruba recommends a value> setting of 50%. Range is 0-100%. error-rate-wait-tim Specifies how long the AP experiences high error rates. e <wait time> Specifies how much better the new channel must be (in free-channel-index terms of interference) before the AP will switch to the <free channel new channel. index value> The higher the value, the lower the likelihood that an AP will move to the new channel. The default is 25. Specifies what the ideal coverage (as opposed to the ideal-coverage-ind acceptable coverage) should be for a channel. The ex <coverage denser the AP deployment, lower this value should be. index value> The default is 5. In general, the more APs there are in a given area, the lower this number should be. min-scan-time <scan time> Specifies the least amount of time an AP must scan a channel before determining if it is suitable to switch to
noise-threshold
Specifies how much noise can exist on a channel before the AP must switch to another channel. The default is 0 but Aruba recommends 80
710
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Option
Description
acceptable-covera This specifies to the AP how good the coverage in on ge-index <index> this channel should be. The range is TBC. The default is 2. In general, the more APs there are in a given area, the lower this number should be. noise wait-time <wait time value> wait-time Specifies how long a channel can be noisy before the AP must find a better channel. The default is 120. Specifies how long (in seconds) the AP must wait after a channel or power change before passing traffic. The default is 15 seconds.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #arm acceptable-coverage-index 2 arm backoff-time 230 arm error-rate-threshold 3 arm error-rate-wait-time 50 arm free-channel-index 30 arm ideal-coverage-index 2 arm min-scan-time 30 arm wait-time 40
arp
Adds a static Address Resolution Protocol entry to the routing table.
Syntax
arp <ipaddr> <mac> where: <ipaddr> is the IP address of the device to be added to the ARP table. <mac> is the 48-bit hardware address of the device, entered in the following format: xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #arp 64.121.71.218 00:00:01:01:02:ae
AirOS Commands
711
NOTE If the IP address does not belong to a valid IP subnet, the ARP entry will not be added. If the IP interface that defines the subnet for the static ARP entry is deleted, you will be unable to use the arp command to overwrite the entrys current values. Do a no arp a.b.c.d, and then issue the new arp command.
banner motd
Creates a message (the Message Of The Day, or motd) that all users see when logging into the CLI.
Syntax
banner motd <delimiter> <message body>
where: delimiter is a character that ends the message creation session and returns to the prompt.
Example
In the following example, the letter E (capital E) terminates the entering of the message text and returns to the CLI prompt.
(Aruba5000) (config) #banner motd E Enter TEXT message. End with the character 'E'. Hello TuesdayE (Aruba5000) (config) #
clock Commands
Configures the WLAN Switchs clock to show the Switchs timezone and to toggle to Daylight Saving Time as appropriate for the timezone setting.
clock summer-time
Configures the start of summer (daylight saving) time.
712
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
clock summer-time <WORD> recurring [<1-4>|first|last>] [day] [month] {hh:mm] [<1-4>|first|last>] [day] [month] {hh:mm] [<-23-23] [<0-59>] <cr>
where: <WORD> is the label of the timezone. This label should be no less than three and no more than five characters long and should not start with a colon (:).' recurring specifies that the Switch should start daylight saving time every time the starting specifications are met.
Example
The following example specifies that daylight saving time should start the first Sunday in April at 2 AM and end the last Sunday in October also at 2 AM. The timezone is Pacific Standard Time and the offset from Greenwich time is -8 hours.
(Aruba5000) (config) # clock summer-time PST recurring 1 Sunday April 02:00 4 Sunday )October 02:00 -8 0 (Aruba5000) (config) #
NOTEBe sure to configure clock timezone when configuring summer-time.
clock timezone
Configures the time zone in which the Switch is located.
AirOS Commands
713
Syntax
clock summer-time <WORD> [<-23-23] [<0-59>] <cr>
where: <WORD> is the label of the timezone. This label should be no less than three and no more than five characters long and should not start with a colon (:).' <-23 - 23> is the number of hours offset from UTC. <0-59> is the number of minutes of offset from UTC.
Example
The following example configures the timezone label to show PST and sets this timezone to be 8 hours behind Greenwich time.
crypto Commands
Configures the cryptographic settings including IPSec tunnels, ISAKMP keys, and dynamic maps.
crypto dynamic-map
Configure Dynamic Maps commands in crypto dynamic-map mode.
714
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
syntax
dynamic-map <dynamic-map-name> <dynamic-map-number> <no|set<pfs> <group>|secrity-association <lifetime> <seconds> |transform-set >>
where: <dynamic-map-name> <dynamic-map-number> is the name of the dynamic-map to create or modify is the priority of the map. Valid range is 1 - 10000
pfs enables Perfect Forward Secrecy mode for group 1 (768-bit Diffie Hellman prime modulus group) or group2 (1024-bit Diffie Hellman prime modulus group). security-association configures the Security Association by specifying the lifetime with a valid range of 300 to 86400 seconds. transform-set configures a Transform Set for this dynamic map. Specify up to four transform sets.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto dynamic-map PAULMAP 6655 (Aruba5000) (config-crypto-map)# (Aruba5000) (config-crypto-map)# set pfs group2 (Aruba5000) (config-crypto-map)# set security-association lifetime seconds 300 (Aruba5000) (config-crypto-map)# set transform-set PAULTransform PaulTransform2 trans3 tras4 ? The following command disable dynamic-map configurations: (Aruba5000) (config-crypto-map)# no set pfs (Aruba5000) (config-crypto-map)# no set transform-set (Aruba5000) (config-crypto-map)# no set security-association lifetime
crypto ipsec
Configure IPSec parameters.
AirOS Commands
715
Syntax
crypto ipsec <mtu> <size> | < transform-set> <transform-set-name> <encryption> <auth> Where: mtu configures the IPSec MTU transform-set configures a transform set to support: ESP with 168-bit Triple DES encryption, or ESP with 128-bit AES encryption, or ESP with 192-bit AES encryption, or ESP with 256-bit AES encryption, or ESP with 56-bit DES encryption and ESP with the MD5 (HMAC variant) authentication algorithm, or ESP with the SHA (HMAC variant) authentication algorithm (Aruba5000) (config) #crypto ipsec transform-set PaulTrans esp-3des esp-sha-hmac (Aruba5000) (config) #
isakmp
Configures the IETFs Internet Security Association and Key Management Protocol.
Syntax
crypto isakmp <address> <disable> <enable> <groupname> <key> <policy> Where: address disable enable groupname key policy Configure the IP for the group key Disable the IKE processing Enable the IKE processing Configure IKE Aggressive group name Configure the IKE PRE-SHARED key Configure an IKE policy mode commands.
716
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp ? address disable enable groupname key policy Configure the IP for the group key Disable the IKE processing Enable the IKE processing Configure IKE Aggressive group name Configure the IKE PRE-SHARED key Configure an IKE policy
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp address ? <peer-address> Configure the IP for the group key
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp address 10.25.5.34 ? netmask Configure the IP netmask for the group key
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp address 10.25.5.34 netmask 255.255.255.0 Key:******************** Re-Type Key:******************** Mismatch between mask and network address
(Aruba5000) (config) # (Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp address 10.25.5.34 netmask 255.255.255.255 Key:********** Re-Type Key:********** Not Supported
AirOS Commands 717
(Aruba5000) (config) # (Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp ? address disable enable groupname key policy Configure the IP for the group key Disable the IKE processing Enable the IKE processing Configure IKE Aggressive group name Configure the IKE PRE-SHARED key Configure an IKE policy
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp ? address disable enable groupname key policy Configure the IP for the group key Disable the IKE processing Enable the IKE processing Configure IKE Aggressive group name Configure the IKE PRE-SHARED key Configure an IKE policy
718
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp groupname ? <name> Configure IKE Aggressive group name
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key ? <keystring> Configure the value of the IKE PRE-SHARED key, must b e between 6-64 characters
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key 1111111111 ? address Configure the IP for the group key
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key 1111111111 10.100.101.102 ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker.
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key 1111111111 ? address Configure the IP for the group key
AirOS Commands
719
<peer-address>
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key 1111111111 address 100.100.100.1 % Incomplete command.
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key 1111111111 address 100.100.100.1 ? netmask Configure the IP netmask for the group key
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key 1111111111 address 100.100.100.1 netmask ? <mask> Configure the IP netmask for the group key
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key 1111111111 address 100.100.100.1 netmask 255.255.255.255 ? <cr>
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp key 1111111111 address 100.100.100.1 netmask 255.255.255.255
(Aruba5000) (config) #
(Aruba5000) (config) #crypto isakmp policy 6655 (Aruba5000) (config-isakmp)# ? authentication encryption group hash lifetime Configure the IKE authentication method Configure the IKE encryption algorithm Configure the IKE Diffie Hellman group Configure the IKE hash algorithm Configure the IKE lifetime in seconds
Chapter 28
rsa-sig
(Aruba5000) (config-isakmp)# encryption ? 3DES AES128 AES192 AES256 DES Use 168-bit 3DES-CBC encryption algorithm Use 128-bit AES-CBC encryption algorithm Use 192-bit AES-CBC encryption algorithm Use 256-bit AES-CBC encryption algorithm Use 56-bit DES-CBC encryption algorithm
(Aruba5000) (config-isakmp)# group ? 1 2 Use the 768-bit Diffie Hellman prime modulus group Use the 1024-bit Diffie Hellman prime modulus group
(Aruba5000) (config-isakmp)# hash ? md5 sha Use MD5 (HMAC variant) as the hash algorithm Use SHA-1 (HMAC variant) as the hash algorithm
AirOS Commands
721
(Aruba5000) (config-isakmp)# ? authentication encryption group hash lifetime Configure the IKE authentication method Configure the IKE encryption algorithm Configure the IKE Diffie Hellman group Configure the IKE hash algorithm Configure the IKE lifetime in seconds
(Aruba5000) (config-isakmp)#
map
Configures the crypto map.
syntax
crypto map <global-map > <map-number> <ipsec-isakmp> <dynamic> <dynamic-map-name>
722
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Where:
<global map> configures the default global map <map-number> defines the priority of the map ipsec-isakmp specifies the IPSec map dynamic specifies the use of a dynamic map
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # crypto map global-map 5 ipsec-isakmp dynamic Paulmap (Aruba5000) (config) #
database synchronize
Synchronizes the internal database or RF Plan data on redundant master switches. (Aruba5000) (config) #database ?
Syntax
database synchronize <period> <interval> | rf-plan-data Where: <period> Specifies that the synchronization with standby (Master-Master Communication) should happen every <time> seconds. Valid interval range is 1-25200 minutes. rf-plan-data Include RF Plan data when synchronizing with standby
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #database synchronize period 60 (Aruba5000) (config) #
AirOS Commands
723
destination
TBC
Syntax
destination STRING <IP address><subnet mask> [invert | <cr>]
Where: STRING is the name of destination host or subnet IP address is the IP Address of destination host or subnet <subnet mask> is the subnet mask of the destination host invert Specifies to use all destinations EXCEPT this destination
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #destination tester2 10.121.71.218 (Aruba5000) (config) #destination tester2 10.121.71.218 invert (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x Commands
Controls the 802.1x configuration which includes the following commands:
default Set global 802.1X parameters to default values framed-mtu Set the Framed-MTU attribute sent to the authentication server key-retries Set the number of retries for the unicast and multicast key rotation message key-size Set the Dynamic WEP Key Size, Default Key Size is 128 -Bit max-req Set maximum number of identity requests multicast-keyrotation Enable Multicast WEP Key Rotation
724 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
opp-key-caching re-authentication reauth-max server timeout unicast-keyrotation use-session-key use-static-key wired-clients wpa-key-retries handshake xSec-MTU
Enable Opportunistic Key Caching Enable periodic 802.1X authentication Maximum number of reauthentication attempts Set authentication server parameters Set 802.1X timeout values Enable Unicast Key Rotation Use Radius Session Key as the Unicast WEP key Use static key Enable 802.1x for wired supplicants Set the number of retries for the wpa key xSec MTU
dot1x default
Sets global 802.1X parameters to their default values.
Syntax
dot1x default
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x default (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x framed-mtu
Sets the Framed-MTU attribute that is sent to the authentication server,
Syntax
dot1x framed-mtu <mtu-size>
where <mtu-size> is the size of the Frame MTU. Valid range is 400 to 1500 bytes.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x framed-mtu 555 (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x key-retries
Sets the number of retries for the unicast and multicast key rotation message
AirOS Commands 725
Syntax
dot1x key-retries <number> where <number> is the number of times the system will TBC. Valid range is 1-3.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x key-retries 3 (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x key-size
Set the Dynamic WEP Key Size.
Syntax
dot1x key-size <128> |<40> where 128 specifies the 128-bit key (the default) 40 specifies the 40-bit key
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x key-size 40 (Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x key-size 128 (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x max-req
Sets the maximum number of identity requests.
Syntax
dot1x max-req <retry> where <retry> is the number of retries. Valid range is 1-10.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x max-req 5
726 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x multicast-keyrotation
Enable Multicast WEP Key Rotation
Syntax
dot1x multicast-keyrotation
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x multicast-keyrotation (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x opp-key-caching
Enable Opportunistic Key Caching
Syntax
dot1x opp-key-caching ?
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x opp-key-caching (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x re-authentication
Enables periodic 802.1X authentication.
Syntax
dot1x opp-key-caching
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x opp-key-caching (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x reauth-max
Maximum number of reauthentication attempts
AirOS Commands
727
Syntax
ot1x reauth-max <auth-count> where <auth-count> specifies the value of maximum authentication count.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x reauth-max 3 (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x server
Sets authentication server parameters.
Syntax
dot1x server <server-retry><number> |<server-timeout> <timeout> where: <server-retry> Set the maximum number of authentication requests
<number> is the number of retries. Valid rage is 0-3. server-timeout Set the authentication server timeout
Example
(Aruba5000) (Aruba5000) (Aruba5000) (Aruba5000) (config) (config) (config) (config) # dot1x server server-retry 3 # # dot1x server server-timeout 244 #
Syntax
dot1x timeout idrequest-period <1-65535> where <1-65535> is the number of seconds between requests.
728
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x timeout idrequest-period (Aruba5000) (config) # 2
Syntax
dot1x timeout mcastkey-rotation-period <period> where: <period> is the rotation period in seconds. Valid range is 60-2147483647 seconds.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x timeout mcastkey-rotation-period 333 (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax
#dot1x timeout quiet-period <period> where: <period> is the number of seconds the quiet period lasts. Valid range is 1-65535 seconds.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x timeout quiet-period (Aruba5000) (config) # 22
AirOS Commands
729
Syntax
dot1x timeout reauthperiod <period | server> where: <period> is the length of the reauthentiation period in seconds. Valid range is 60-2147483647 seconds. server specifies the use of the server provided reauthentication interval
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x timeout reauthperiod server (Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x timeout reauthperiod 500 (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax
dot1x timeout ucastkey-rotation-period <period> where: <period> is the number of seconds between unicast key rotations. Valid range is 60-2147483647 seconds.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x timeout ucastkey-rotation-period (Aruba5000) (config) # 232
Syntax
dot1x timeout wpa-key-timeout <period> where: <period> is the timeout in seconds for each WPA key exchange. Valid range is 1-5 seconds.
730
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x timeout wpa-key-timeout (Aruba5000) (config) # 4
dot1x unicast-keyrotation
Enables Unicast Key Rotation.
Syntax
dot1x unicast-keyrotation
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x unicast-keyrotation (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x use-session-key
Use Radius Session Key as the Unicast WEP key.
Syntax
dot1x use-session-key
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x use-session-key (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x use-static-key
Uses a static key.
Syntax
dot1x use-static-key
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x use-static-key (Aruba5000) (config) #
AirOS Commands
731
dot1x wired-clients
Enable 802.1x for wired supplicants
Syntax
dot1x wired-clients
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x wired-clients (Aruba5000) (config) #
dot1x wpa-key-retries
Set the number of retries for the WPA key handshake.
Syntax
dot1x wpa-key-retries <number> where: <number> is the WPA Key Retry Count. Valid range is 1-5.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x wired-clients 5 (Aruba5000) (config) #
xSec-MTU
Specifies the xSec MTU.
Syntax
dot1x xSec-MTU <number> where: <number> is the size of the xSEC MTU. Valid MTU sizes are from 1024-1500 bytes.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # dot1x xSec-MTU 1200 (Aruba5000) (config) #
732
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
enable
Configures the enable-level password.
Syntax
enable <password:> <re-typed password> where <password> and <re-typed password> is the new enable-level password.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) # enable Password:****** Re-Type password:****** (Aruba5000) (config) #
encrypt
Enables encryption on the switch.
Syntax
encrypt <disable | enable>
Example
To turn on encryption, enter:
firewall Commands
Use these commands to configure the firewall.
firewall allow-tri-session
Allow three way session when performing destination NAT.
AirOS Commands
733
Syntax
firewall allow-tri-session
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall allow-tri-session (Aruba2400) (config) #
Syntax
firewall attack-rate ping <number> where <number> is the number of pings per second allowed. Higher number of pings per second are deemed to be an attack. Valid range is 1-255 pings per second.
Example
Syntax
firewall attack-rate session <number> where <number> is the limit of the number of IP sessions that can occur. Higher numbers of IP sessions than this limit are considered an attack. Valid range is 1-255 IP sessions per second.
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall attack-rate session 33 (Aruba2400) (config) #
734
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
firewall attack-rate tcp-syn <number> where <number> is the threshold above which incoming TCP SYN traffic will be considered an attack. Valid range is 1-255 SYN messages per second.
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall attack-rate tcp-syn 44 (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall deny-inter-user-bridging
Disallow forwarding non-IP frames between untrusted users .
Syntax
firewall deny-inter-user-bridging
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall deny-inter-user-bridging (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall disable-ftp-server
Disables the FTP server.
Syntax
(firewall disable-ftp-server
AirOS Commands
735
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) # firewall disable-ftp-server (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall disable-stateful-sip-processing
Disable stateful SIP processing. Default is enabled.
Syntax
firewall disable-stateful-sip-processing
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) # firewall disable-stateful-sip-processing (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall drop-ip-fragments
Drops all IP fragments.
Syntax
firewall drop-ip-fragments
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) # firewall drop-ip-fragments (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall enable-per-packet-logging
Enable per-packet logging. Default is per-session logging.
Syntax
firewall enable-per-packet-logging
736
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall enable-per-packet-logging
(Aruba2400) (config) #f
firewall enforce-tcp-handshake
Enforce TCP handshake before allowing data
Syntax
firewall enforce-tcp-handshake
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall enforce-tcp-handshake (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall log-icmp-error
Log all received ICMP errors.
Syntax
firewall log-icmp-error
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall log-icmp-error (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall prohibit-ip-spoofing
Prohibits IP spoofing.
Syntax
firewall prohibit-ip-spoofing
AirOS Commands
737
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall prohibit-ip-spoofing (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall prohibit-rst-replay
Prohibits TCP RST replay attack.
Syntax
firewall prohibit-rst-replay
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) #firewall prohibit-rst-replay (Aruba2400) (config) #
firewall session-mirror-destination
Configures a destination for a mirrored session.
Syntax
firewall session-mirror-destination ip-address <ipaddr> where <ipaddr> is the IP address of the device acting as the mirror destination
Example
(Aruba2400) (config) # firewall session-mirror-destination ip-address 1.1.1.1
(Aruba2400) (config) #
foreign-agent
Accesses the foreign-agent mode commands ((Aruba5000) (config-fa) #).
738
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
secure delete
Removes the specified Foreign-agent Home-agent security association.
Syntax
secure delete <spi_value> where <spi_value> is the Security Parameter Index greater than 256.
Example
(Aruba2400) (config-fa) #secure delete 400 (Aruba2400) (config-fa) #exit (Aruba2400) (config) #
secure host
Configures the security association parameters between the foreign agent and the home agent
Syntax
secure host <ip> spi <spi_value> shared-secret <shared_secret> where: <ip> is the IP address of the home agent <spi_value> <shared_secret> long Is the SPI number - an integer greater than 256. Is the shared secret, a string no more than 32 characters
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-fa) # secure host 192.168.1.10 spi 5500 shared-secret paul
AirOS Commands
739
home-agent
Accesses the home-agent command mode ((Aruba5000) (config-ha)).
secure-foreign delete
Deletes the home-agent-foreign-agent security association.
Syntax
home-agent delete <spi_value>
where: <spi_value> is the number of the Security Parameter Index. This is an integer greater than 256.
Example
(OAW-4324) (config-ha) #secure-foreign delete 400
secure-foreign spi
Configures the security association parameters between the home agent and the foreign agent.
Syntax
secure-foreign spi <spi_value> host <ipaddr> shared_secret <secret>
where: <spi_value> is the number of the Security Parameter Index. This is an integer greater than 256. host <ipaddr> specifies the IP address of foreign agent shared-secret is the shared secret between the HA and FA and is a string no longer than 32 characters.
740
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ha) #secure-foreign spi 5500 host 192.168.2.2 shared-secret paul (Aruba5000) (config-ha) #exit (Aruba5000) (config)#
hostname
Configures the name string that appears in the system prompt.
Syntax
hostname <hostname> where: <hostname> Specifies the hostname
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-ha) #hostname labtest (labtest) > NOTE When you change the hostname you are returned to Exec mode and must log back in.
Interface Commands
Allows access to the interface type commands. This release supports the following interfaces:
Accesses the FastEthernet mode which allows you to configure the Fastethernet interface for the specified port on the specified slot.
Syntax
interface fastethernet <slot/port>
where:
slot is the chassis slot of the module to be configured Range is TBC port is the specific port on the module to be configured. Range is: TBC
Example
(switch) (config) # interface fastethernet 1/1 (switch) (config-if) #
description
Syntax
description <text>
where <line> is a text label. Lables can be up to TBC
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)# description this_is_a test (Aruba5000) (config-if)#
duplex
Configures the interface to support duplex and half duplex traffic.
Syntax
duplex <auto | full | half>
where auto configures the interface to automatically adjust to full or half duplex transmissions based on the traffic requirements. full configures the interface to support full duplex traffic. half configures the interface to support half-duplex traffic.
742
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)# duplex auto (Aruba5000) (config-if)#
ip
Configures the IP parameters for this FastEthernet port.
Syntax
ip access-group <name> <in | out | session>
where <name> is the name of this access control list (ACL). . in|out|session applies the ACL to incoming, outgoing, or this session only traffic.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)# ip access-group test session (Aruba5000) (config-if)#
muxport
Configures Mux functionality on the port.
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
AirOS Commands
743
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
interface fastethe
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
rnet <slot/port>
poe
Chapter 28
port
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
AirOS Commands
745
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
746
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
AirOS Commands
747
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
Syntax
where
Example
(Aruba5000) (config-if)#
interface gigabitethernet
GigabitEthernet Interface
Syntax
748
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
interface loopback
Loopback Interface
interface mgmt
Management Ethernet Interface
Syntax Example
interface port-channel
Ethernet channel of interfaces
Syntax Example
interface range
Interface range
interface tunnel
TBC
Syntax
AirOS Commands
749
Example
interface vlan
Switch VLAN Virtual Interface
(switch) (config-if)# (Aruba5000) (config) #interface gigabitethernet ? <slot/port> GigabitEthernet Interface is <slot>/<port> format
(Aruba5000) (config) #interface loopback (Aruba5000) (config-loop)#? ip Interface Internet Protocol config commands
(Aruba5000) (config-loop)#ip ? address Set the IP address of loopback interface, to be used as switch ip.
750
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) (config) # interface loopback (switch) (config) # interface loopback (switch) (config-loop)#? ip Interface Internet Protocol config commands
(switch) (config-loop)# ip ? address Set the IP address of loopback interface, to be used as switch ip.
<cr>
(switch) (config-loop)# ip address 10.4.21.29 255.255.255.0 Switch IP Address is Modified. Switch should be rebooted now
(switch) (config-loop)#
IP Commands
These commands configure the Internet Protocol attributes of the WLAN switch, including: Access-list which configures access-lists. Default-gateway which specifies the default gateway (if not routing IP). DHCP which configures the DHCP Server. Local which configures local IP information for L2TP . NAT which configures Network Address Translation. RADIUS which configures RADIUS authentication. Route which specifies static routes. Router which enables a routing process. Each command is described below.
ip access-list eth
Configures an Ethernet type access list.
752
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
ip access-list eth <accname>
where <accname> is the access list name or number. If you specify a number it must be between 200 and 299.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip access-list eth 209 (hostswitch) (config) #
ip access-list extended
Configures an extended access list.
Syntax
ip access-list extended STRING
where STRING is a name or number. If you specify a number, the valid ranges are between 100 and 199 and between 2000 and 2699.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip access-list extended 109 (hostswitch) (config) #
ip access-list mac
Configures a MAC type access list.
Syntax
ip access-list mac STRING
Where: STRING is the access-list name or number. If you specify a number, valid ranges are between 700 and 799 and between 1200 and 1299.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip access-list mac 709 (hostswitch) (config) #
AirOS Commands
753
ip access-list session
Configures a session access list.
Syntax
ip access-list session <accname>
Where: <accname> is the Access-list name.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip access-list session corporate (hostswitch) (config) #
ip access-list standard
Configures a standard access list.
Syntax
ip access-list standard STRING
Where: STRING is the access list name or number.If you specify a number is must be between 1 and 99, or between 1300 and 1399.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip access-list standard 9 (hostswitch) (config) #
ip default-gateway
Specifies the default gateway. Specify the default gateway if you are not routing IP .
Syntax
ip default-gateway <nexthop> [mgmt] Where: <nexthop> is the IP address of the default gateway
754
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
mgmt identifies this as the default gateway for the Management port.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip default-gateway 1.1.1.1 mgmt (hostswitch) (config) #
ip dhcp excluded-address
Configures the DHCP servers excluded address range.
Syntax
ip dhcp excluded-address
Where:
<low-address> [var2]
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip dhcp excluded-address 1.1.1.1 20.2.2.2 (hostswitch) (config) #
ip dhcp pool
Configures the name of the DHCP address pool.
Syntax
ip dhcp pool <pool_name>
Where: <pool_name> is the label of the DHCP pool.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip dhcp pool Lab_pool (hostswitch) (config) # (hostswitch) (config-dhcp)#? authoritative DHCP server will NAK for DHCP discovers and requests
AirOS Commands 755
not valid on the configured subnet Configure DHCP default router Configure DHCP DNS server Configure DHCP Domain Name Configure DHCP lease time Configure DHCP NETBIOS server Configure DHCP network number Delete Command Configure client specific options
ip igmp
Configure Internet Group Management Protocol
Syntax
TBC
Example
ip local
Configures the local address pool for L2TP .
Syntax
[no] ip local pool <pool_name> <pool_start_address> <pool_end_address> Where: pool configures a local IP pool for L2TP <pool_name> is the local IP pool's name <pool_start_address> specifies the starting address of the local pool <pool_end_address> specifies the ending address of the local pool
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip local pool lab_Pool_Tunnel 1.1.1.1 2.2.2.2 ? (hostswitch) (config) #
ip nat
Configure the NAT address pool and specifies the name of the pool.
756 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax
ip nat pool STRING A.B.C.D A.B.C.D Where: [no] STRING is the pool name A.B.C.D specifies the starting IP address in the pool A.B.C.D specifies the ending IP address in the pool.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip nat pool natpool_lab 1.2.3.4 6.6.6.6 (hostswitch) (config) #
ip radius dynamic-authorization
Configures a RFC-3576 compliant RADIUS client.
Syntax
ip radius dynamic-authorization client A.B.C.D Where: A.B.C.D is the IP address of the RADIUS client.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip radius dynamic-authorization client 3.3.3.3 (hostswitch) (config) #
ip radius nas-ip
Configures the NAS IP address sent in RADIUS packets.
Syntax
ip radius nas-ip
Where: A.B.C.D is the NAS IP address.
A.B.C.D
Example
(hostswitch) (config) # ip radius nas-ip 30.30.30.0 (hostswitch) (config)
AirOS Commands 757
ip radius source-interface
Selects the source address of outgoing RADIUS requests.
Syntax
ip radius source-interface <loopback | <vlan><vlanid>
Where: loopback specifies the use of the IP address of the loopback interface vlan specifies the use of the IP address of the specified VLAN
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip radius source-interface loopback (hostswitch) (config) # (hostswitch) (config) #ip radius source-interface vlan 3030 (hostswitch) (config) #
ip route
Establishes static routes.
Syntax
ip route <destip> <destmask> <nexthop> [cost] Where: <destip> is the IP address of the destination host <destmask> is the subnet mask of the destination host <nexthop> is the IP address of the forwarding router <cost> is the distance metric for this route info-TBC
Example
The following example establishes a static route to the host at 1.1.1.1 and specifies that the route has a cost of 4.
758
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
ip router
Enables RIP (Routing Information Protocol).routing protocol.
Syntax
ip router rip
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #ip router rip (hostswitch) (config) #
key TBC
(switch) (config) # key ? <client_key> Shared secret (text string)
(switch) (config) #
location
Specifies the switch location.
Syntax
location <switchlocation> Where:
AirOS Commands 759
Example
(switch) (config) # location 10.4.21.1 ? (switch) (config) #
logging Commands
(switch) (config) # logging ?
logging <A.B.C.D>
Set Remote logging Server
Syntax Example
logging console
Set Console Logging level
Syntax Example
logging level
Set Facility Logging level
760
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
logging monitor
Set Terminal Line (monitor) logging level
(switch) (config) # logging 1.2.3.4 ? <cr> (switch) (config) # logging console ? alerts Immediate action needed critical Critical Conditions debugging Debugging Messages emergencies System is unusable errors Error Conditions informational Informational Messages notifications Normal but significant conditions warnings Warning conditions <cr> (switch) (config) # logging console alerts ? aaa Logging for administrator authentication ads Logging for Anomaly Detection arubaauth Logging for user authentication cfgm Logging for Configuration Manager crypto Logging for VPN (IKE/IPSEC) dhcpd Logging for DHCP packets fpapps Logging for Layer 2,3 control gsi Logging for Grid Service Interface l2tp Logging for L2TP localdb Logging for local database master Logging for Mobility Master Database (Master switch o nly) mmgr Logging for Mobility Manager mobagent Logging for Mobility Agent packetfilter Logging for packet filtering of aruba messaging and c ontrol frames pim Logging for Protocol Independent Multicast pptp Logging for PPTP processes Logging for run-time processes publisher Logging for publish subscribe service sapm Logging for AP Manager (Master switch only) snmp Logging for SNMP agent
AirOS Commands
761
Logging for Station Management Logging for traffic Logging for Wireless Management (Master switch
(switch) (config) # logging console critical ? aaa Logging for administrator authentication ads Logging for Anomaly Detection arubaauth Logging for user authentication cfgm Logging for Configuration Manager crypto Logging for VPN (IKE/IPSEC) dhcpd Logging for DHCP packets fpapps Logging for Layer 2,3 control gsi Logging for Grid Service Interface l2tp Logging for L2TP localdb Logging for local database master Logging for Mobility Master Database (Master switch o nly) mmgr Logging for Mobility Manager mobagent Logging for Mobility Agent packetfilter Logging for packet filtering of aruba messaging and c ontrol frames pim Logging for Protocol Independent Multicast pptp Logging for PPTP processes Logging for run-time processes publisher Logging for publish subscribe service sapm Logging for AP Manager (Master switch only) snmp Logging for SNMP agent stm Logging for Station Management traffic Logging for traffic wms Logging for Wireless Management (Master switch only) <cr> (switch) (config) # logging console aaa Logging for ads Logging for arubaauth Logging for cfgm Logging for crypto Logging for dhcpd Logging for
762 Part 0500055-03
debugging ? administrator authentication Anomaly Detection user authentication Configuration Manager VPN (IKE/IPSEC) DHCP packets
May 2005
Chapter 28
fpapps gsi l2tp localdb master switch o mmgr mobagent packetfilter and c pim pptp processes publisher sapm snmp stm traffic wms only) <cr> (switch) (config) # (switch) (config) # (switch) (config) #
Layer 2,3 control Grid Service Interface L2TP local database Mobility Master Database (Master
nly) Logging for Mobility Manager Logging for Mobility Agent Logging for packet filtering of aruba messaging ontrol frames Logging for Protocol Independent Multicast Logging for PPTP Logging for run-time processes Logging for publish subscribe service Logging for AP Manager (Master switch only) Logging for SNMP agent Logging for Station Management Logging for traffic Logging for Wireless Management (Master switch
(switch) (config) #logging level ? <cat> TBC alerts Immediate action needed critical Critical Conditions debugging Debugging Messages emergencies System is unusable errors Error Conditions informational Informational Messages notifications Normal but significant conditions warnings Warning conditions (switch) (config) #logging level alerts ?
AirOS Commands 763
aaa ads arubaauth cfgm crypto dhcpd fpapps gsi l2tp localdb master switch o mmgr mobagent packetfilter and c pim pptp processes publisher sapm snmp stm traffic wms only) <cr>
Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging Logging
for for for for for for for for for for for
administrator authentication Anomaly Detection user authentication Configuration Manager VPN (IKE/IPSEC) DHCP packets Layer 2,3 control Grid Service Interface L2TP local database Mobility Master Database (Master
nly) Logging for Mobility Manager Logging for Mobility Agent Logging for packet filtering of aruba messaging ontrol frames Logging for Protocol Independent Multicast Logging for PPTP Logging for run-time processes Logging for publish subscribe service Logging for AP Manager (Master switch only) Logging for SNMP agent Logging for Station Management Logging for traffic Logging for Wireless Management (Master switch
(switch) (config) #logging level alerts aaa ? <cr> (switch) (config) #logging monitor ? alerts Immediate action needed critical Critical Conditions debugging Debugging Messages emergencies System is unusable errors Error Conditions informational Informational Messages notifications Normal but significant conditions warnings Warning conditions <cr>
764
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) (config) #logging monitor alerts ? aaa Logging for administrator authentication ads Logging for Anomaly Detection arubaauth Logging for user authentication cfgm Logging for Configuration Manager crypto Logging for VPN (IKE/IPSEC) dhcpd Logging for DHCP packets fpapps Logging for Layer 2,3 control gsi Logging for Grid Service Interface l2tp Logging for L2TP localdb Logging for local database master Logging for Mobility Master Database (Master switch o nly) mmgr Logging for Mobility Manager mobagent Logging for Mobility Agent packetfilter Logging for packet filtering of aruba messaging and c ontrol frames pim Logging for Protocol Independent Multicast pptp Logging for PPTP processes Logging for run-time processes publisher Logging for publish subscribe service sapm Logging for AP Manager (Master switch only) snmp Logging for SNMP agent stm Logging for Station Management traffic Logging for traffic wms Logging for Wireless Management (Master switch only) <cr> (switch) (config) #logging monitor alerts
loginsession timeout
Specifies how long a session will stay active without activity.
Syntax
loginsession timeout <val> Where:
AirOS Commands
765
<val> is the time out value in minutes. Specify from 5 to 60 minutes. The default is 15 minutes.
Example:
(hostswitch) (config) # loginsession timeout 30 (hostswitch) (config) #
mac-address-table static
Configures the MAC address table for Fastethernet and Gigabitethnet.
Syntax
mac-address-table static <macaddr> <fastethernet | gigabitethent> <slot/port> <vlan><vlanid> Where: <macaddr> is the MAC address fastethernet specifies FastEthernet per the IEEE 802.3 specification gigabitethernet specifies Gigabit Ethernet per the IEEE 802.3 specification <slot/port> specifies the module slot and port number on that module vlan <vlanid> specifies the VLAN name.
Example
(hostswitch) (config) # mac-address-table static 00:00:00:1:2:3 fastethernet 3/4 vlan (hostswitch) (config) #
master-redundancy
Accesses the commands that configure redundancy (VRRP) on the Master Switch.
766
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
master-vrrp
Configures the VRRP router ID.
Syntax
master-vrrp <id> Where: <id> specifies the Master Switch virtual router ID. Valid range is 1-255.
Example
(hostswitch) (config-master-redundancy)#master-vrrp 24 (hostswitch) (config-master-redundancy)#
no
Disables VRRP configurations.
Syntax
no <master-vrrp | peer-ip-address > Where: selecting master-vrrp disables the master switch virtual router ID, and selecting peer-ip-address disables the redundant host.
Example
(hostswitch) (hostswitch) (hostswitch) (hostswitch) (config-master-redundancy)# no master-vrrp (config-master-redundancy)# (config-master-redundancy)# no peer-ip-address (config-master-redundancy)#
peer-ip-address
Configures the redundant host.
Syntax
peer-ip-address A.B.C.D
AirOS Commands 767
Example
(hostswitch) (config-master-redundancy)#peer-ip-address 10.1.1.1 (Aruba5000) (config-master-redundancy)#
masterip
Specifies the IP address of the WLAN Switch configured as the Master Switch.
Syntax
masterip <masterip> Where: <masterip> is the IP address of the switch configured as the master switch.
Example
(Aruba5000) (config) #masterip 10.10.10.1 (Aruba5000) (config) #
mgmt-role
Access the commands that define the Management Role.
Syntax
mgmt-role <rolename> Where: <rolename> is the name of the Management Role. Valid name length is 1-32 characters.
768
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
(hostswitch) (config) #mgmt-role (Aruba5000) (mgmt-role)# bigboss
Description
Describes the Management Role.
Syntax
description TBC
Example
tbc
no
Disables the Management Role definition.
Syntax
no
Example
Tbd
permit
Defines which modules the Management Role can control.
Syntax
permit TBC
Example
TBD
AirOS Commands
769
mgmt-user
(Aruba5000) (config) #mgmt-user ? <username> Name of the user.
(Aruba5000) (config) #mgmt-user pauluser paulrole ERROR: Configuring the Password. (Aruba5000) (config) #mgmt-user pauluser paulrole paul (Aruba5000) (config) #no mgmt-user ? <username> Name of the user.
(Aruba5000) (config) #no mgmt-user pauluser Error Deleting the User Entry
770
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
<cr>
(Aruba5000) (config) #no mgmt-user pauluser Error Deleting the User Entry
(Aruba5000) (config) #
mobagent
Accesses mobility agent mode commands.
foreign-agent
Foreign Agent Global Configuration
home-agent
Home Agent Global Configuration
secure-mobile
Configure the security association parameters between
mobility
Accesses the mobility mode commands.
AirOS Commands
771
event-threshold
TBC
Syntax Example
ignore-l2-broadcast
Ignore layer 2 broadcasts for making mobility decisions. Default disabled.
Syntax Example
inter-essid
Enable/disable mobility across different essids
Syntax Example
ip-release
Quit proxy dhcp for client
772
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
manager
Enables/disables mobility management for the mswitch
Syntax Example
max-dhcp-requests
Maximum number of DHCP DISCOVERS/REQUESTS after which Proxy DHCP should quit
Syntax Example
no
Delete Command
Syntax Example
AirOS Commands
773
on-association
Enable/disable mobility to trigger on station association
Syntax Example
parameters
Set the global parameters for the mobility manager
Syntax Example
proxy-dhcp
Enables/disables proxy dhcp support for the mswitch
secure
Configure the global security association parameters for the mobility manager.
Syntax Example
station-masquerade
Enable/disable station masquerading. Enable this if uplink routers do not accept Gratuitous ARPs
774
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
trusted-roaming
Mobility handles roam from untrusted to trusted. Default disabled.
(Aruba5000) (config-mob) #
Syntax Example
mobility-local
Accesses the mobility manager mode commands for the local switch.
exclude-vlan
Quit mobility management for users moving to/from this VLAN
Syntax Example
AirOS Commands
775
ha-priority
Set Home Agent priority for this VLAN
Syntax Example
local-ha
If enabled, sets mswitch as HA for all subnet it owns else accepts HA designated by master
Syntax Example
no
Delete Command
(Aruba5000) (config-mob-local) #
mobmaster primary-subnet
Syntax Example
776
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
mux-address
(Aruba5000) (config) #mux-address ? <mux-ip-address> A.B.C.D IP address (Aruba5000) (config) #mux-address 10.100.101.30 ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #mux-address 10.100.101.30 (Aruba5000) (config) #no mux-address ^
mux-vlan
(Aruba5000) (config) #mux-vlan ? <mux-vlan-id> VLAN ID to enable MUX termination on
AirOS Commands
777
(Aruba5000) (config) #
netdestination
(Aruba5000) (config) #netdestination ? STRING Name of destination host or subnet
778
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config-dest) #? host invert network no range Configure a single host Use all destinations EXCEPT this destination Configure a subnet Delete Command Configure a range of IP addresses
(Aruba5000) (config-dest) #exit (Aruba5000) (config) #show netdestination ? STRING <cr> Name of destination
-------
network 255.255.255.255
-------
---------255.255.255.0
network 6.1.1.0
abcd abcd --------Position Type IP addr Mask/Range -------- ---- ------- ----------
----------
host 10.4.21.21
any
780 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
-------
---------0.0.0.0
network 0.0.0.0
-------
---------255.255.255.0
network 3.1.1.0
-------
network 255.255.255.255
IP addr
Mask/Range
-------
---------255.255.255.0
network 6.1.1.0
abcd abcd --------Position Type IP addr Mask/Range -------- ---- ------- ----------
----------
host 10.4.21.21
IP addr
Mask/Range
-------
---------May 2005
Chapter 28
network 0.0.0.0
0.0.0.0
-------
---------255.255.255.0
network 3.1.1.0
(Aruba5000) (config) #
netservice
(Aruba5000) (config) #netservice ? STRING Name of network service
(Aruba5000) (config) #netservice paulservice ? <0..255> tcp udp IP protocol TCP protocol UDP protocol
(Aruba5000) (config) #netservice paulservice tcp ? <0-65535> Single port used by service or start of range.
AirOS Commands
783
<0-65535> <cr>
paulservice tcp
784
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Services -------Name ---Protocol Ports -------- ----162 514 1701 500 443 445 67 68 1723 23 5060 69 88 8200 110 135 139 53 80 5060 1026 1028 8211
AirOS Commands 785
svc-snmp-trap udp svc-syslog svc-l2tp svc-ike svc-https svc-smb-tcp svc-dhcp svc-pptp svc-telnet svc-sip-tcp svc-tftp udp udp udp tcp tcp udp tcp tcp tcp udp udp udp tcp
svc-msrpc-tcp tcp svc-dns svc-http svc-sip-udp svc-nterm svc-papi udp tcp udp tcp udp
svc-msrpc-udp udp svc-ntp svc-icmp svc-ssh any sas udp icmp tcp any tcp
(Aruba5000) (config) #
newbury
(Aruba5000) (config) # newbury ? <ip-addr> Specify IP Address of Locate Server A.B.C.D
786
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config) # newbury 10.100.101.30 6564 ? <frequency> Specify frequency of update in minutes
(Aruba5000) (config) #no newbury ? <ip-addr> Specify IP Address of Locate Server A.B.C.D
no
Disables the following actions: (Aruba5000) (config) #no ?
no aaa
Configure Authentication
Syntax Example
no ap
Specify configuration of an AP by location or by BSSID
Syntax Example
no arp
Configure ARP parameters.
Syntax
788
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
no cap
Cisco Access point
no clock
Configure time-of-day clock
Syntax Example
no crypto
Configure IPSec, IKE, and CA
Syntax Example
no database
Database management
no destination
Configure network destination (deprecated; use netdestination)
Syntax
AirOS Commands
789
Example
no dot1x
Configure IEEE 802.1X Authenticator
Syntax Example
no enable
Modify the enable password
Syntax Example
no firewall
Configure global firwall policies
Syntax Example
no interface
Select an interface to configure
790
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
no ip
Interface Internet Protocol config commands
Syntax Example
no logging
Modify Message Logging Facilities
Syntax Example
no loginsession
Login Session
Syntax Example
AirOS Commands
791
no mac-address-table
Configure the MAC address table
Syntax Example
no masterip
Configure the master ip address for the switch
Syntax Example
no mgmt-role
Management Role Definition
no mgmt-user
Configure a management user.
Syntax Example
no mux-vlan
Enable MUX functionality on a VLAN
792
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
no netdestination
Configure network destination
no netservice
Configure a network service
Syntax Example
no newbury
Specify Newbury Locate Server Information
Syntax Example
no ntp
Configure NTP
no pptp
Configure IP information for PPTP
AirOS Commands
793
Syntax Example
no rap-wml
Wired MAC Lookup for AP Classification commands
Syntax Example
no router
Router Mobile
Syntax Example
no service
Configure services
Syntax Example
794
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
no shutdown
Shut down interface
Syntax Example
no snmp-server
Enable SNMP; Modify SNMP parameters
Syntax Example
no spanning-tree
Spanning Tree Subsystem
Syntax Example
no telnet
Enable telnet port
Syntax
AirOS Commands
795
Example
no time-range
Configure a time range
Syntax Example
no trusted
Make this a trusted port
Syntax Example
no udp-port
Configure the UDP port to receive Disconnect-Requests. Default is 3999.
no user-role
Configure user role
Syntax Example
796
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
no vlan
Create Switch VLAN Virtual Interface
Syntax Example
no vpn-dialer
Configure the VPN dialer
Syntax Example
no vrrp
Virtual Router Redundancy Protocol Configuration
Syntax Example
ntp server
(Aruba5000) (config) #ntp ?
AirOS Commands 797
server
Syntax Example
packet-capture-defaults
(Aruba5000) (config) #packet-capture-defaults (Aruba5000) (config) # (Aruba5000) (config) #packet-capture-defaults ?
Syntax Example
798
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
packet-capture-defaults arubamsg
Enable or disable Aruba internal messaging packet capturing. For debugging only.
Syntax Example
packet-capture-defaults other
Enable or disable all other types of packets.
Syntax Example
packet-capture-defaults tcp
Enable or disable TCP packet capturing.
Syntax Example
packet-capture-defaults udp
Enable or disable TCP packet capturing.
(Aruba5000) (config) #packet-capture-defaults arubamsg ? <opcodes> Up to 10 comma separated opcodes to capture. Use [al
AirOS Commands 799
l] to sniff all opcodes or [disable] to bypass all. (Aruba5000) (config) #packet-capture-defaults other ? disable Disable all other types of packets. enable Enable all other types of packets. (Aruba5000) (config) #packet-capture-defaults tcp ? ports Up to 10 comma separated ports to capture. Use [all] to sniff all tcp ports or [disable] to bypass all. All CLI ports are always skipped. (Aruba5000) (config) #packet-capture-defaults udp ? ports Up to 10 comma separated ports to capture. Use [all] to sniff all udp ports or [disable] to bypass all. (Aruba5000) (config) #packet-capture-defaults udp % Incomplete command. (Aruba5000) (config) #packet-capture-defaults (Aruba5000) (config) #show packet-capture-defaults ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #show packet-capture-defaults Current Active Packet Capture Actions(current switch) ===================================================== Packet filtering for TCP ports disabled. Packet filtering for UDP ports disabled. Packet filtering for Aruba messaging opcodes disabled. Packet filtering for all other packets disabled. Packet Capture Defaults(across switches and reboots if saved) ============================================================ Packet filtering for TCP ports disabled. Packet filtering for UDP ports disabled. Packet filtering for Aruba messaging opcodes disabled. Packet filtering for all other packets disabled.
800 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
(Aruba5000) (config) #no packet-capture-defaults ? (Aruba5000) (config) #no packet-capture-defaults ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax Example
ping
(Aruba5000) (config) #ping ? <ipaddr> Send ICMP echo packets to a specified IP address. (Aruba5000) (config) #ping 10.100.101.30 Press 'q' to abort. Sending 5, 100-byte ICMP Echos to 10.100.101.30, timeout is 2 seconds: !!!!! Success rate is 100 percent (5/5), round-trip min/avg/max = 1.032/1.1152/1.432 ms (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax Example
pptp
(Aruba5000) (config) #pptp ? ip Configure IP information for PPTP
AirOS Commands 801
(Aruba5000) (config) #pptp ip ? local Configure local IP information for PPTP (Aruba5000) (config) #pptp ip local ? pool Configure a local IP pool for PPTP (Aruba5000) (config) #pptp ip local pool ? <pool_name> Configure local IP pool's name (Aruba5000) (config) #pptp ip local pool paulpool ? <pool_start_address> Configure the start address of the local pool (Aruba5000) (config) #pptp ip local pool paulpool 192.168.1.1 192.168.1.255 (Aruba5000) (config) #show pptp ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (Aruba5000) (config) #no pptp ? ip Configure IP information for PPTP (Aruba5000) (config) #no pptp ip ? local Configure local IP information for PPTP (Aruba5000) (config) #no pptp ip local ? pool Configure a local IP pool for PPTP (Aruba5000) (config) #no pptp ip local pool ? <pool_name> Configure local IP pool's name (Aruba5000) (config) #no pptp ip local pool paulpool ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #no pptp ip local pool paulpool (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax
802
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
Syntax Example
program-ap
(Aruba5000) (config) # program-ap ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) # program-ap (Aruba5000) (program-ap) #? ant-gain-a Gain for 5.2GHz (802.11a) Antenna ant-gain-g Gain for 2.4GHz (802.11b/g) Antenna antenna-a Antenna to use for 5.2GHz (802.11a) (1, 2, or auto) antenna-g Antenna to use for 2.4GHz (802.11b/g) (1, 2, or auto) ap70-antenna Choose internal or external antenna for AP-70 clear-provisioning-ap.. Clear APs from provisioning list config Program the AP specified using the index with the pro visioning variable values disable Disable AP provisioning on the ports specified dns-server-ip IP address of AP's DNS Server domainname DNS Domainname of the AP enable Enable AP provisioning on the ports specified gateway The default gateway IP address of the AP hostip The numeric IP address of the switch containing the A P image
AirOS Commands
803
hostname image ikepsk ipaddr location non-zero) masterip netmask of no password AP port-range Provisioning provisioning-subnet read-bootinfo reprovision reset-bootinfo username AP
The DNS name of the switch containing the AP The IKE Pre-shared Key The static IP address of the AP location (b.f.l) of the AP (fields must be The DNS name/IP address of the master switch The netmask associated with the static IP address the AP Delete Command The PAP password configured on the switch for the The port or port range to be used for AP The subnet to be used for provisioning TBC Send currently set ap-params to AP Restore factory default boot variables The PAP username configured on the switch for the
(Aruba5000) (program-ap) # (Aruba5000) (program-ap) # program-ap ap70-antenna ? external TBC internal TBC (Aruba5000) (program-ap) # program-ap ap70-antenna internal ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (program-ap) # program-ap ap70-antenna internal (Aruba5000) (config) #no program-ap ? (Aruba5000) (config) #no program-ap ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (Aruba5000) (config) #show program-ap ? (Aruba5000) (config) #show program-ap ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker.
804 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
prompt
(Aruba5000) (config) #prompt ? <prompt> Enter the new prompt (Aruba5000) (config) #prompt Aruba5050 ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #prompt Aruba5050 (Aruba5050) > (Aruba5050) >enable Password:****** (Aruba5050) #configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z (Aruba5050) (config) #show prompt ? (Aruba5050) (config) #show prompt ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (Aruba5050) (config) #no prompt ? (Aruba5050) (config) #no prompt ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (Aruba5050) (config) #prompt Aruba5000 (Aruba5000) >enable
AirOS Commands 805
Password:****** (Aruba5000) #configure terminal Enter Configuration commands, one per line. End with CNTL/Z (Aruba5000) (config) #
NOTEresetting prompt dumps you back to Exec mode.
Syntax Example
rap-wml
(Aruba5000) (config) # show rap-wml ? cache servers wired-mac Show Cache of all lookups for a DB Server Show DB Server State Show Wired MAC Discovered on traffic through AP
(Aruba5000) (config) # show rap-wml ? cache servers wired-mac Show Cache of all lookups for a DB Server Show DB Server State Show Wired MAC Discovered on traffic through AP
806
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
<cr>
WML DB Servers -------------name ip in-service ----type user password db-name cache ageout(sec)
----
server db table column timestamp-column lookup-time(sec) delimiter query-count ------ -- ----- ------ ---------------- ---------------- --------- -----------
(Aruba5000) (config) #no rap-wml ? <server-name> table Specify Name of MSSQL Server Specify Table Name for Lookup
WML DB Servers -------------name ip type user password db-name cache ageout(sec) in-service ---- -- ---- ---- -------- ------- ----- ----------- ---------WML DB Tables ------------server db table column timestamp-column lookup-time(sec) delimiter query-count ------ -- ----- ------ ---------------- ---------------- --------- -----------
(Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax Example
router
(Aruba5000) (config) #router ? mobile Enable Mobile IP (Aruba5000) (config) #router mobile ? <A.B.C.D> IP Address to be used for Mobile IP Service <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #router mobile
808
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Module Mobile IP is busy. Please try later (Aruba5000) (config) # (Aruba5000) (config) #
Syntax Example
sapm
(Aruba5000) (config) # (Aruba5000) (config) #sapm ? general TBC (Aruba5000) (config) #sapm general ? update-batchsize Number of APs to update in a single batch (Aruba5000) (config) #sapm general update-batchsize ? <batch> Number of APs to update in a single batch (Aruba5000) (config) #sapm general update-batchsize 10 ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #sapm general update-batchsize 10 (Aruba5000) (config) #show sapm ? ap-search Complex AP Listing config-sync TBC counters SAPM counters for debugging gw-list show TTL hops for each LMS to known AP gateways lms-list Shows the list of LMSs that sapm knows about (Aruba5000) (config) #show sapm counters ? bssid BSSID of wireless interface location Location in B.F.L notation (Aruba5000) (config) #show sapm counters location 0.0.0 ? <cr>
AirOS Commands 809
(Aruba5000) (config) #show sapm counters location 0.0.0 SAPM_COUNTERS_RESULT -------------------LOC SAP_IP Updates Sent ACKs Rcvd APBoots Sent APBoots Rcvd Bootstraps Reboots Calibration .g Calibration .a --- ------ ------------ --------- ------------ --------------------- ------- -------------- -------------Num APs:0
Syntax Example
service
Enable disable DHCP .
(Aruba5000) (config) # service ? dhcp Enable DHCP service (Aruba5000) (config) # service dhcp ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) # service dhcp (Aruba5000) (config) #show service ? (Aruba5000) (config) #show service ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (Aruba5000) (config) #no service ?
810
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
dhcp
(Aruba5000) (config) #no service dhcp ? <cr> (Aruba5000) (config) #no service dhcp
Syntax Example
shutdown
(switch) (config) # shutdown ? all All the physical interfaces in the switch (switch) (config) # shutdown all ? <cr> (switch) (config) # shutdown all
Syntax Example
site-survey
(switch) (config) #site-survey ? calibration-max-packe.. max packets to send per tx power and rate calibration-transmit-.. transmit rate of aruba ap ha-compute-time time in milliseconds when HA reconvergence algorithms are kicked off max-ha-neighbors max neighbor to increase to increase tx power for HA
AirOS Commands 811
recovery neighbor-tx-power-bump amount of increase in tx power for a neighbor for HA recovery rra-max-compute-time max time in seconds for RRA computation <cr> (switch) (config) #site-survey
Syntax Example
site-survey calibration-max-packets
(switch) (config) #site-survey calibration-max-packets ? <calibration-max-pack.. max packets to send per tx power and rate (switch) (config) #site-survey calibration-max-packets 10 ? calibration-transmit-rate transmit rate of aruba ap ha-compute-time time in milliseconds when HA reconvergence algorithms are kicked off max-ha-neighbors max neighbor to increase to increase tx power for HA recovery neighbor-tx-power-bump amount of increase in tx power for a neighbor for HA recovery rra-max-compute-time max time in seconds for RRA computation <cr>
Syntax Example
Chapter 28
(switch) (config) #site-survey calibration-transmit-rate ? <calibration-transmit.. transmit rate of aruba ap (switch) (config) #site-survey calibration-transmit-rate 20 ? calibration-max-packe.. max packets to send per tx power and rate ha-compute-time time in milliseconds when HA reconvergence algorithms are kicked off max-ha-neighbors max neighbor to increase to increase tx power for HA recovery neighbor-tx-power-bump amount of increase in tx power for a neighbor for HA recovery rra-max-compute-time max time in seconds for RRA computation <cr>
Syntax Example
site-survey ha compute-time
(switch) (config) #site-survey ha-compute-time ? <ha-compute-time> time in milliseconds when HA reconvergence algorithms are kicked off (switch) (config) #site-survey ha-compute-time 15 ? calibration-max-packe.. max packets to send per tx power and rate calibration-transmit-.. transmit rate of aruba ap max-ha-neighbors max neighbor to increase to increase tx power for HA recovery neighbor-tx-power-bump amount of increase in tx power for a neighbor for HA recovery rra-max-compute-time max time in seconds for RRA computation
AirOS Commands 813
<cr>
Syntax Example
site-survey max-ha-neighbors
(switch) (config) #site-survey max-ha-neighbors ? <max-ha-neighbors> max neighbor to increase to increase tx power for HA recovery (switch) (config) #site-survey max-ha-neighbors 25 ? calibration-max-packe.. max packets to send per tx power and rate calibration-transmit-.. transmit rate of aruba ap ha-compute-time time in milliseconds when HA reconvergence algorithms are kicked off neighbor-tx-power-bump amount of increase in tx power for a neighbor for HA recovery rra-max-compute-time max time in seconds for RRA computation <cr> (switch) (config) #site-survey neighbor-tx-power-bump ? <neighbor-tx-power-bu.. amount of increase in tx power for a neighbor for HA recovery
Syntax Example
site-survey neighbor-tx-power-bump
814 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) (config) #site-survey neighbor-tx-power-bump 30 ? calibration-max-packe.. max packets to send per tx power and rate calibration-transmit-.. transmit rate of aruba ap ha-compute-time time in milliseconds when HA reconvergence algorithms are kicked off max-ha-neighbors max neighbor to increase to increase tx power for HA recovery rra-max-compute-time max time in seconds for RRA computation <cr>
Syntax Example
site-survey rra-max-compute-time
(switch) (config) #site-survey rra-max-compute-time ? <rra-max-compute-time> max time in seconds for RRA computation (switch) (config) #site-survey rra-max-compute-time ? <rra-max-compute-time> max time in seconds for RRA computation (switch) (config) #site-survey rra-max-compute-time 40 ? calibration-max-packe.. max packets to send per tx power and rate calibration-transmit-.. transmit rate of aruba ap ha-compute-time time in milliseconds when HA reconvergence algorithms are kicked off max-ha-neighbors max neighbor to increase to increase tx power for HA recovery neighbor-tx-power-bump amount of increase in tx power for a neighbor for HA recovery <cr> (switch) (config) #
AirOS Commands
815
Syntax Example
snmp-server
(switch) (config) #snmp-server ? community set read-only community string enable TBC host Specify host address to receive SNMP notifications. new Traps defined in the new MIB's supported. user User Name configuration for the USM security model <cr> (switch) (config) #snmp-server (switch) (config) #no snmp-server (switch) (config) #show snmp ? community Display the configured snmp communities trap-hosts Display the configured trap hosts trap-queue Display the Trap Queue user-table TBC
Syntax Example
snmp-server community
(switch) (config) #snmp-server community ? WORD SNMP community string
816 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
snmp-server enable
(switch) (config) #snmp-server enable ? trap Enable SNMP Traps (switch) (config) #snmp-server enable trap ? <cr>
Syntax Example
snmp-server host
(switch) (config) #snmp-server host ? A.B.C.D IP address of SNMP notification host. ?? (switch) (config) #snmp-server new ? traps The system will generate new versions of the trap. (switch) (config) #snmp-server new traps ? <cr>
Syntax
AirOS Commands
817
Example
snmp-server user
(switch) (config) #snmp-server user ? WORD USM Security Model User Name (switch) (config) #snmp-server user
Syntax Example
spanning-tree
(switch) (config) #show span? spanning-tree Spanning tree topology spantree Global spanning tree topology (switch) (config) #show spanning-tree Spanning Tree is executing the IEEE compatible Spanning Tree protocol Bridge Identifier has priority 32768, address 00:0b:86:40:01:00 Configured hello time 2, max age 20, forward delay 15 We are the root of the spanning tree Topology change flag is set , detected flag set , changes 1 Times: hold 1, topology change 35 hello 2, max age 20, forward delay 15 Timers: hello 0, notification 0 Last topology change: 0 days, 0 hours, 0 mins, 24 secs (switch) (config) #no spanning-tree (switch) (config) #spanning-tree ? forward-time Set a Spanning hello-time Set a Spanning max-age Set a Spanning priority Set a Spanning <cr>
818 Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
spanning-tree forward-time
(switch) (config) #spanning-tree forward-time ? <value> Set a Spanning Tree FORWARD Interval <4-30> (switch) (config) #spanning-tree forward-time 15 ? <cr> (switch) (config) #spanning-tree forward-time 15
Syntax Example
spanning-tree hello-time
(switch) (config) #spanning-tree hello-time ? <value> Set a Spanning Tree HELLO Interval <1-10> (switch) (config) #spanning-tree hello-time 2 (switch) (config) #spanning-tree max-age ? <value> Set a Spanning Tree MAX AGE Interval <6-40>
Syntax Example
AirOS Commands
819
spanning-tree max-age
(switch) (config) #spanning-tree max-age 20
spanning-tree priority
(switch) (config) #spanning-tree priority ? <value> Set a Spanning Tree Priority <0 - 65535> (switch) (config) #spanning-tree priority ? <value> Set a Spanning Tree Priority <0 - 65535> (switch) (config) #spanning-tree priority 32768 (switch) (config) #show spann Spanning Tree is not currently active The following parameters have been configured Stp Status : Disabled Protocol : IEEE Max Age (sec) : 20 Hello Time (sec) : 2 Forward Delay (sec) : 15 Bridge Priority : 32768 (switch) (config) #show spanning-tree Spanning Tree is not currently active The following parameters have been configured Stp Status : Disabled Protocol : IEEE Max Age (sec) : 20 Hello Time (sec) : 2 Forward Delay (sec) : 15 Bridge Priority : 32768 (switch) (config) #spanning-tree enable ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (switch) (config) #spanning-tree
820
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
stm
(switch) (config) #stm ? ap-inactivity-timeout Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds idle-sta-ageout Amount of time after which STA with potential hole in fo with bad RSSI to one of the APs is aged out. in se conds poor-rssi-threshold kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value sta-dos-block-time Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr>
Syntax
AirOS Commands
821
Example
stm ap-inactivity-timeout
(switch) (config) #stm ap-inactivity-timeout ? <ap-inactivity-timeou.. Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds
(switch) (config) #stm ap-inactivity-timeout 10 ? auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds idle-sta-ageout Amount of time after which STA with potential hole in fo with bad RSSI to one of the APs is aged out. in se conds poor-rssi-threshold kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value sta-dos-block-time Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr> (switch) (config) #stm ap-inactivity-timeout 10 coverage-hole-detection ? disable Disable enable Enable (switch) (config) #stm ap-inactivity-timeout 10 coverage-hole-detection enable ? auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds
822
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds idle-sta-ageout Amount of time after which STA with potential hole in fo with bad RSSI to one of the APs is aged out. in se conds poor-rssi-threshold kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value sta-dos-block-time Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr> (switch) (config) #stm ap-inactivity-timeout 10 coverage-hole-detection enable auth-failure-block-time ? <auth-failure-block-t.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely (switch) (config) #stm ap-inactivity-timeout 10 coverage-hole-detection enable auth-failure-block-time 20 ? dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds idle-sta-ageout Amount of time after which STA with potential hole in fo with bad RSSI to one of the APs is aged out. in se conds poor-rssi-threshold kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value sta-dos-block-time Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr>
Syntax Example
AirOS Commands
823
stm auth-failure-block-time
TBC
Syntax Example
stm coverage-hole-detection
TBC
Syntax Example
stm dos-prevention
(switch) (config) # (switch) (config) #stm dos-prevention ? disable Disable enable Enable (switch) (config) #stm dos-prevention enable ? ap-inactivity-timeout Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds idle-sta-ageout Amount of time after which STA with potential hole in fo with bad RSSI to one of the APs is aged out. in se
824 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
conds kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance
Syntax Example
stm fast-roaming
(switch) (config) #stm dos-prevention enable fast-roaming ? disable Disable enable Enable (switch) (config) #stm dos-prevention enable fast-roaming enable ? ap-inactivity-timeout Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds idle-sta-ageout Amount of time after which STA with potential hole in fo with bad RSSI to one of the APs is aged out. in se conds poor-rssi-threshold kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value sta-dos-block-time Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr>
AirOS Commands
825
Syntax Example
stm good-rssi-threshold
(switch) (config) #stm dos-prevention enable fast-roaming enable good-rssi-threshold ? <good-rssi-threshold> stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value (switch) (config) #stm dos-prevention enable fast-roaming enable good-rssi-threshold 30 ? ap-inactivity-timeout Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds idle-sta-ageout Amount of time after which STA with potential hole in fo with bad RSSI to one of the APs is aged out. in se conds poor-rssi-threshold kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value sta-dos-block-time Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr>
Syntax Example
826
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
stm idle-sta-ageout
(switch) (config) # (switch) (config) # (switch) (config) #stm idle-sta-ageout ? <idle-sta-ageout> Amount of time after which STA with potential hole in fo with bad RSSI to one of the APs is aged out. in se conds (switch) (config) #stm idle-sta-ageout 35 ? ap-inactivity-timeout Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds poor-rssi-threshold kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value sta-dos-block-time Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr> (switch) (config) #stm idle-sta-ageout 35 poor-rssi-threshold ? <poor-rssi-threshold> kick off hole detection if RSSI from STA is less than this value (switch) (config) #stm idle-sta-ageout 35 poor-rssi-threshold 45 ? ap-inactivity-timeout Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds
AirOS Commands 827
hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds sta-dos-block-time Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr> (switch) (config) #stm idle-sta-ageout 35 poor-rssi-threshold 45 sta-dos-block-time ? <sta-dos-block-time> Amount of time to block a STA on with DoS is detected . In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely (switch) (config) #stm idle-sta-ageout 35 poor-rssi-threshold 45 sta-dos-block-time 50 ? ap-inactivity-timeout Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi s value good-sta-ageout Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. strict-compliance Enable/Disable strict WECA compliance <cr> (switch) (config) #stm idle-sta-ageout 35 poor-rssi-threshold 45 sta-dos-block-time 50 strict-compliance ? disable Disable enable Enable (switch) (config) #stm idle-sta-ageout 35 poor-rssi-threshold 45 sta-dos-block-time 50 strict-compliance enable ? ap-inactivity-timeout Amount of time after which AP is aged out. in seconds auth-failure-block-ti.. Amount of time to block a STA if it fails repeated au thentications. In seconds. 0 blocks indefinitely coverage-hole-detecti.. Enable/Disable STM coverage hole capabilities dos-prevention Enable/Disable STM DoS prevention capabilities fast-roaming Enable/Disable Fast Roaming good-rssi-threshold stop hole detection if RSSI from STA is more than thi
828 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
s value Amount of time after with STA with good RSSID to one of the APs is aged out. in seconds hole-detection-interv.. Amount of time after with hole detection event is gen erated. in seconds sta-dos-prevention Enable/Disable STA DoS prevention. <cr> good-sta-ageout
Syntax Example
stm hole-detection-interval
tbc
Syntax Example
stm idle-sta-ageout
tbc
Syntax Example
stm poor-rssi-threshold
tbc
AirOS Commands
829
Syntax Example
stm sta-dos-block-time
tbc
Syntax Example
stm sta-dos-prevention
tbc
Syntax Example
stm strict-compliance
tbc
Syntax Example
830
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
syscontact
(switch) (config) # syscontact ? <syscontact> Change the system contact (switch) (config) # syscontact rama ? <cr> (switch) (config) # show syscontact ? <cr> (switch) (config) # show syscontact Contact is not configured (switch) (config) #syscontact Rama (switch) (config) #show syscontact Rama
Syntax Example
syslocation
(switch) (config) #syslocation ? <syslocation> Change the system location (switch) (config) #syslocation Crossman main lab ? (switch) (config) #syslocation Crossman main lab ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker.
AirOS Commands
831
(switch) (config) #syslocation Crossman_Main_lab (switch) (config) #show syslocation Crossman_Main_lab (switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
telnet cli
(switch) (config) # telnet ? cli Enable telnet to Command Line Interface (CLI) port soe Enable telnet to Serial Over Ethernet (soe) port (switch) (config) # telnet cli ? <cr>
Syntax Example
telnet soe
(switch) (config) # telnet soe ? <cr> (switch) (config) # show telnet? (switch) (config) # show telnet ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker.
832 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) (config) #no telnet ? cli Enable telnet to Command Line Interface (CLI) port soe Enable telnet to Serial Over Ethernet (soe) port (switch) (config) #no telnet soe ? <cr> (switch) (config) #no telnet cli ? <cr> (switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
time-range
Informs the Switch when a time-restricted feature, like an access list, is to be used.
(switch) (config) #time-range ? STRING Name of time range (switch) (config) #time-range Side ? absolute Configure an absolute time-range periodic Configure a PERIODIC time-range (switch) (config) #time-range Side periodic ? <cr> (switch) (config) #time-range Side absolute ? end Specify end date of time-range start Specify start date of time-range <cr> (switch) (config) #time-range Side absolute start ? mm/dd/yyyy Starting day of time-range
AirOS Commands
833
(switch) (config) #time-range Side absolute start 12/20/2004 ? hh:mm Starting time in 24-hour clock (switch) (config) #time-range Side absolute start 12/20/2004 00:00 ? end Specify end date of time-range <cr> (switch) (config) #time-range Side absolute start 12/20/2004 00:00 end ? mm/dd/yyyy Day when time-range ends (switch) (config) #time-range Side absolute start 12/20/2004 00:00 end 12/30/2004 ? hh:mm Ending time in 24-hour clock (switch) (config) #time-range Side absolute start 12/20/2004 00:00 end 12/30/2004 24:00 ? <cr> (switch) (config) #show time-range ? STRING Name of time-range <cr> (switch) (config) #show time-range (switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
traceroute
(switch) (config) #traceroute ? <ipaddr> Trace route to specified IP address. (switch) (config) #traceroute 64.121.71.217 Press 'q' to abort. Tracing the route to 64.121.71.217
834
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
1 2 3
10.4.21.254 * * * *
0.783 msec
0.559 msec
0.565 msec
(switch) (config) #traceroute 64.121.71.217 ? <cr> (switch) (config) #traceroute 64.121.71.217 Press 'q' to abort. Tracing the route to 64.121.71.217 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 10.4.21.254 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 0.599 msec 0.556 msec 0.554 msec
AirOS Commands
835
(switch) (config) #show traceroute ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
trusted
(switch) (config) #trusted all ? <cr> (switch) (config) #show trusted ? (switch) (config) #show trusted ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
udp-port
Syntax Example
836
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
user
(switch) (config) # user ? <username> Enter a user name (switch) (config) # user paul ? <passwd> Enter the password for the user (switch) (config) # user paul paul ? <cr> (switch) (config) #show authentication-method bssid debug essid global-user-map internal ip location mac mobile name phy-type role rows <cr> user ? Match authentication method Match BSSID Show users that are currently being debugged Match ESSID Displays summary of all users currently in the system Show internal user entries Match IP address Match location Match MAC address Show mobile users Match name Match PHY type Match role Show certain rows
(switch) (config) #show user name ? STRING Name (switch) (config) #show user name paul Users ----IP MAC Roaming Essid/Bssid/Phy ---------- ------------------ --------------User Entries: 0/2
Name ------
Role ----
Age(d:h:m) ----------
Auth ----
location --------
AirOS Commands
837
<cr> (switch) (config) #show user name rama Users ----IP MAC location Roaming E ---------------------------- ------- 10.4.21.102 00:00:00:00:00:00 1/0 Wired 10.4.21.104 00:00:00:00:00:00 1/0 Wired User Entries: 2/2
(switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
user-role
(switch) (config) #user-role % Incomplete command. (switch) (config) #user-role ? STRING Name of user role (switch) (config) #user-role rama ? <cr> (switch) (config) #show user role % Incomplete command. (switch) (config) #show user role ? STRING Role name
838
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) (config) #show user role ap-role ? rows Show certain rows <cr> (switch) (config) #show user role ap-role Users ----IP MAC Name location Roaming E --------------------------------- ------- 10.4.21.102 00:00:00:00:00:00 rama 1/0 Wired 10.4.21.104 00:00:00:00:00:00 rama 1/0 Wired User Entries: 2/2
Age(d:h:m) Auth
VPN link
(switch) (config) #show user role guest ? rows Show certain rows <cr> (switch) (config) #show user role guest Users ----IP MAC Roaming Essid/Bssid/Phy ---------- ------------------ --------------User Entries: 0/0
Name ------
Role ----
Age(d:h:m) ----------
Auth ----
location --------
(switch) (config) #user-role ? STRING Name of user role (switch) (config) #user-role visitor ? <cr> (switch) (config) #user-role visitor (switch) (config-role) #show user ? authentication-method Match authentication method
AirOS Commands 839
bssid debug essid global-user-map internal ip location mac mobile name phy-type role rows <cr>
Match BSSID Show users that are currently being debugged Match ESSID Displays summary of all users currently in the system Show internal user entries Match IP address Match location Match MAC address Show mobile users Match name Match PHY type Match role Show certain rows
(switch) (config-role) #show user role % Incomplete command. (switch) (config-role) #show user role visitor Users ----IP MAC Roaming Essid/Bssid/Phy ---------- ------------------ --------------User Entries: 0/0
Name ------
Role ----
Age(d:h:m) ----------
Auth ----
location --------
(switch) (config-role) # (switch) (config-role) #no user-role visitor ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker.
Syntax Example
840
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
version
(switch) (config-role) #version ? <versionnum> TBC
(switch) (config) #show version Aruba Wireless Operating System Software. AirOS (MODEL: switch), Version 2.3.0.0 Website: http://www.arubanetworks.com
AirOS Commands
841
Copyright (c) 2003-2005 by Aruba Wireless Networks, Inc. Compiled on 2004-12-22 at 19:08:49 PST (build 9270) by p4build
Switch uptime is 23 hours 40 minutes 48 seconds Reboot Cause: User reboot. Aruba Supervisor Card Aruba Processor (revision 16.20 (pvr 8081 1014)) with 256M bytes of memory. 32K bytes of non-volatile configuration memory. 256M bytes of Supervisor Card System flash (model=256MB CHH).
(switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
vlan
(switch) (config) # vlan <id> tbc (switch) (config) #show vlan VLAN CONFIGURATION
842
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
-----------------VLAN Name Ports ---- -------1 Default Fa1/0-23 Gig1/24-25 Pc0-7 (switch) (config) #vlan 2 (switch) (config) #show vlan 2 VLAN CONFIGURATION -----------------VLAN Name Ports ---- -------2 VLAN0002 (switch) (config) #show vlan VLAN CONFIGURATION -----------------VLAN Name Ports ---- -------1 Default Fa1/0-23 Gig1/24-25 Pc0-7 2 VLAN0002 (switch) (config) #no vlan 2 (switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
vpdn
(switch) (config) #vpdn ? group Configure vpdn groups (switch) (config) #vpdn group ? l2tp Configure the L2TP group pptp Configure the PPTP group
AirOS Commands 843
(switch) (config) #vpdn group l2tp ? <cr> (switch) (config) #vpdn group pptp ? <cr> (switch) (config) #show vpdn ? l2tp Show vpdn L2TP state pptp Show pptp state tunnel Show vpdn tunnel state (switch) (config) #show vpdn l2tp % Incomplete command. (switch) (config) #show vpdn l2tp ? configuration Show L2TP configuration local Show l2tp local IP pool (switch) (config) #show vpdn l2tp configuration ? <cr> (switch) (config) #show vpdn l2tp configuration Enabled Hello timeout: 60 seconds DNS primary server: 0.0.0.0 DNS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS primary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 PPP client authentication methods: PAP CHAP MSCHAP MSCHAPv2 IP LOCAL POOLS: remoteappool: 10.4.21.101 - 10.4.21.110 (switch) (config) #show vpdn ? l2tp Show vpdn L2TP state pptp Show pptp state tunnel Show vpdn tunnel state (switch) (config) #show vpdn pptp ?
844 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
configuration local
(switch) (config) #show vpdn pptp configuration Enabled Hello timeout: 60 seconds DNS primary server: 0.0.0.0 DNS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS primary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 PPP client authentication methods: MSCHAPv2 MPPE Configuration 128 bit encryption enabled IP LOCAL POOLS: (switch) (config) #show vpdn ? l2tp Show vpdn L2TP state pptp Show pptp state tunnel Show vpdn tunnel state (switch) (config) #show vpdn tunnel ? l2tp Show l2tp state pptp Show pptp state (switch) (config) #show vpdn tunnel l2tp ? id Show tunnel state <cr> (switch) (config) #show vpdn tunnel l2tp L2TP Tunnel Information (Total tunnels = 2) Tunnel ID = 199 is up, remote id is 30821 Tunnel state is SCCCN: Connection Connected Remote Internet Address 10.4.21.229, port 1701 Tunnel ID = 4 is up, remote id is 61927 Tunnel state is SCCCN: Connection Connected Remote Internet Address 10.4.21.193, port 1701
(switch) (config) #show vpdn tunnel pptp Command obsolete. All PPTP Please use show user-table to get a list of users.
(switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
vpn-dialer
(switch) (config) #vpn-dialer ? STRING Configuration Name of the VPN dialer (switch) (config) #show vpn-dialer default-dialer -------------Attribute --------PPTP L2TP DNETCLEAR WIREDNOWIFI PAP CHAP MSCHAP MSCHAPV2 CACHE-SECURID IKESECS IKEENC IKEGROUP IKEHASH IKEAUTH IKEPASSWD
846 Part 0500055-03
Value ----disabled enabled disabled disabled enabled enabled enabled enabled disabled 28800 3DES TWO SHA PRE-SHARE ********
May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) (config) #vpn-dialer ? STRING Configuration Name of the VPN dialer (switch) (config) #vpn-dialer test ? <cr> (switch) (config) #vpn-dialer test (switch) (config-vpn-dialer)#show vpn-dialer default-dialer -------------Attribute --------PPTP L2TP DNETCLEAR WIREDNOWIFI PAP CHAP MSCHAP MSCHAPV2 CACHE-SECURID IKESECS IKEENC IKEGROUP IKEHASH IKEAUTH IKEPASSWD IPSECSECS IPSECGROUP IPSECENC IPSECAUTH SECURID_NEWPINMODE test ---Attribute --------PPTP
Value ----disabled enabled disabled disabled enabled enabled enabled enabled disabled 28800 3DES TWO SHA PRE-SHARE ******** 7200 GROUP2 ESP-3DES ESP-SHA-HMAC disabled Value ----disabled
AirOS Commands 847
L2TP DNETCLEAR WIREDNOWIFI PAP CHAP MSCHAP MSCHAPV2 CACHE-SECURID IKESECS IKEENC IKEGROUP IKEHASH IKEAUTH IKEPASSWD IPSECSECS IPSECGROUP IPSECENC IPSECAUTH SECURID_NEWPINMODE
enabled disabled disabled enabled enabled enabled enabled disabled 28800 3DES TWO SHA PRE-SHARE ******** 7200 GROUP2 ESP-3DES ESP-SHA-HMAC disabled
(switch) (config-vpn-dialer)#no vpn-dialer test ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (switch) (config-vpn-dialer)#no vpn-dialer ? (switch) (config-vpn-dialer)#no vpn-dialer test ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (switch) (config-vpn-dialer)# (switch) (config-vpn-dialer)#? auto-dial-wpn Bind the VPN dialer to the wireless link dialup Configure dialup information for the Dialer. enable Enable PPTP, L2TP, dnetclear, wirednowifi, or securid _newpinmode for the dialer ike Configure the IKE ipsec Configure the IPSEC lifetime in seconds no Delete Command ppp Configure PPP vpngateway Configure the VPN gateway
848
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) (config-vpn-dialer)#
Syntax Example
vrrp
(switch) (config) #vrrp ? <id> <1-255> Virtual Router ID intra-switch Intra-switch Virtual Router Redundancy Protocol Confi guration (switch) (config) #vrrp 25 ? <cr> (switch) (config) #show vrrp (switch) (config) #show vrrp ? <vrid> <1-255> Virtual Router ID statistics TBC <cr> (switch) (config) #show vrrp statistics ? <vrid> <1-255> Virtual Router ID (switch) (config) #show vrrp statistics % Incomplete command. (switch) (config) #show vrrp statistics 1
(switch) (config) #vrrp ? <id> <1-255> Virtual Router ID intra-switch Intra-switch Virtual Router Redundancy Protocol Confi guration
AirOS Commands 849
(switch) (config) #vrrp intra-switch ? <cr> (switch) (config) #vrrp intra-switch (switch) (config-vrrp)#show vrrp (switch) (config-vrrp)#no vrrp ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (switch) (config-vrrp)#no ? shutdown Disable VRRP intra-switch (switch) (config-vrrp)#no shutdown ? <cr> (switch) (config-vrrp)#no shutdown Can't start router: VR ID is not configured (switch) (config-vrrp)#? no Delete Command shutdown Disable VRRP intra-switch (switch) (config-vrrp)#
Syntax Example
web-server
(switch) (config) #web-server ? <cr> (switch) (config) #web-server
850
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
(switch) (config-webserver)#show web-server % Incomplete command. (switch) (config-webserver)#show web-server ? configuration Show web server configuration (switch) (config-webserver)#show web-server configuration ? <cr> (switch) (config-webserver)#show web-server configuration Web Server Settings: Security Protocol ...... sslv2 sslv3 tlsv1 Cipher Suite Strength .. high Admin HTTPS port ....... 4343 (switch) (config-webserver)#? admin-port Configure port for WEB administration ciphers Configure cipher suite strength. Default is high no Delete Command ssl-protocol Configure SSL/TLS protocol. Default is to use SSLv2, SSLv3 and TLSv1
Syntax Example
admin-port
(switch) (config-webserver)#admin-port ? https Specify https port (switch) (config-webserver)#admin-port https ? <0-65535> Port Number (switch) (config-webserver)#admin-port https 22 ? <cr>
AirOS Commands
851
Syntax Example
ciphers
(switch) (config-webserver)#ciphers ? high Cipher suite with encryption keys larger than 128 bit s low Cipher suite with 56 or 64 bit encryption keys medium Cipher suite with 128 bit encryption keys (switch) (config-webserver)#ciphers medium ? <cr> (switch) (config-webserver)#ciphers no ?
Syntax Example
no
(switch) (config-webserver)#no ? admin-port Configure ciphers Configure ssl-protocol Configure SSLv2, SSLv3 and port for WEB administration cipher suite strength. Default is high SSL/TLS protocol. Default is to use TLSv1
(switch) (config-webserver)#ssl-protocol ? sslv2 Use SSLv2 sslv3 Use SSLv3 tlsv1 Use TLSv1 <cr>
852
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
ssl-protocol
(switch) (config-webserver)#ssl-protocol tlsv1 ? sslv2 Use SSLv2 sslv3 Use SSLv3 <cr> (switch) (config-webserver)#ssl-protocol tlsv1 sslv2 ? sslv3 Use SSLv3 <cr> (switch) (config-webserver)#ssl-protocol tlsv1 sslv2 sslv3 ? <cr> (switch) (config-webserver)#
Syntax Example
web-ui
(switch) (config) # webui ? user Configure the web ui administrator password (switch) (config) # webui user ? administrator Configure the web ui administrator password (switch) (config) # webui user administrator ? <passwd> Enter web ui administrator password (switch) (config) # webui user administrator admin ?
AirOS Commands 853
<cr> (switch) (config) # show webui ? (switch) (config) # show webui ^ % Invalid input detected at '^' marker. (switch) (config) #
Syntax Example
wms
(switch) (config) #wms (switch) (wms) #? ap-config ap-policy event-threshold general global-policy ids-policy ids-signature no reserved-11a-channel reserved-11b-channel station-policy valid-11a-channel valid-11b-channel valid-oui valid-ssid wired-mac Setup Valid AP Configuration Configure ap policies Configure Statistics event thresholds Configure general attributes Configure global policy applied for AP and STA configure IDS Policy for AP and AM configure a signature for the IDS check Delete Command enable/disable 80211a channel as multi tenancy protec ted channel enable/disable 80211b channel as multi tenancy protec ted channel Configure Station Policy enable/disable 80211a channel as valid enable/disable 80211b channel as valid configure valid OUI for AP configure valid SSID for AP configure Wired MAC of router or server
Syntax
854
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
ap-config
(switch) (wms) #ap-config ? privacy enable/disable Encryption as valid ap configuration short-preamble enable/disable short preamble as valid ap configurati on wpa enable/disable WPA support as valid ap configuration <cr> (switch) (wms) #ap-config privacy ? disable TBC enable TBC (switch) (wms) #ap-config privacy enable ? short-preamble enable/disable short preamble as valid ap configurati on wpa enable/disable WPA support as valid ap configuration <cr> (switch) (wms) #ap-config privacy enable short-preamble ? disable TBC enable TBC (switch) (wms) #ap-config privacy enable short-preamble enable ? wpa enable/disable WPA support as valid ap configuration <cr> (switch) (wms) #ap-config privacy enable short-preamble enable wpa ? disable TBC enable TBC (switch) (wms) #ap-config privacy enable short-preamble enable wpa enable ? <cr>
Syntax Example
AirOS Commands
855
ap-policy
(switch) (wms) #ap-policy ? ap-lb-max-retries max tries to encourage STA to move to a unloaded AP ap-lb-user-high-wm High WM on max users that triggers enabling ap load b alancing ap-lb-user-low-wm Low WM on max users that triggers disabling ap load b alancing ap-lb-util-high-wm High WM on utilization that triggers enabling ap load balancing ap-lb-util-low-wm Low WM on utilization that triggers disabling ap load balancing ap-lb-util-wait-time Time in seconds to wait before enabling or disabling load balancing once threshold is hit ap-load-balancing enable/disable AP load balancing beacon-diff-threshold percent increase in beacon rate that should trigger a n ap impersonation event. Default 50 beacon-inc-wait-time Amount of time to wait in seconds before generating a n ap impersonation event when AP impersonation is sus pected. Default 3 classification enable/disable AP Classification. detect-ap-impersonati.. enable/disable AP Impersonation Detection detect-misconfigured-.. enable/disable detect misconfigured ap policy learn-ap enable/disable learn AP. min-pot-ap-beacon-rate Min beacon rate acceptable from a potential AP. In % of configured beacon interval min-pot-ap-monitor-ti.. Min time a potential AP has to be up before it is cla ssified as a real AP. In seconds protect-ap-impersonat.. enable/disable AP Impersonation Protection protect-ibss enable/disable protect Adhoc Network Policy protect-misconfigured.. enable/disable protect misconfigured ap policy protect-mt-channel-sp.. enable/disable protect multi tenancy channel split po licy protect-mt-ssid enable/disable multi tenancy ssid protection policy protect-unsecure-ap enable/disable protect unsecure ap policy <cr> (switch) (wms) #
(switch) (wms) #ap-policy ? ap-lb-max-retries max tries to encourage STA to move to a unloaded AP ap-lb-user-high-wm High WM on max users that triggers enabling ap load b alancing ap-lb-user-low-wm Low WM on max users that triggers disabling ap load b
856 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
ap-lb-util-high-wm load ap-lb-util-low-wm load ap-lb-util-wait-time disabling ap-load-balancing beacon-diff-threshold trigger a beacon-inc-wait-time generating a sus classification detect-ap-impersonati.. detect-misconfigured-.. learn-ap min-pot-ap-beacon-rate In %
alancing High WM on utilization that triggers enabling ap balancing Low WM on utilization that triggers disabling ap balancing Time in seconds to wait before enabling or load balancing once threshold is hit enable/disable AP load balancing percent increase in beacon rate that should n ap impersonation event. Default 50 Amount of time to wait in seconds before n ap impersonation event when AP impersonation is pected. Default 3 enable/disable AP Classification. enable/disable AP Impersonation Detection enable/disable detect misconfigured ap policy enable/disable learn AP. Min beacon rate acceptable from a potential AP.
of configured beacon interval min-pot-ap-monitor-ti.. Min time a potential AP has to be up before it is cla ssified as a real AP. In seconds protect-ap-impersonat.. enable/disable AP Impersonation Protection protect-ibss enable/disable protect Adhoc Network Policy protect-misconfigured.. enable/disable protect misconfigured ap policy protect-mt-channel-sp.. enable/disable protect multi tenancy channel split po licy protect-mt-ssid enable/disable multi tenancy ssid protection policy protect-unsecure-ap enable/disable protect unsecure ap policy <cr> (switch) (wms) #? ap-config ap-policy event-threshold Setup Valid AP Configuration Configure ap policies Configure Statistics event thresholds
AirOS Commands 857
general global-policy ids-policy ids-signature no reserved-11a-channel protec reserved-11b-channel protec station-policy valid-11a-channel valid-11b-channel valid-oui valid-ssid wired-mac
Configure general attributes Configure global policy applied for AP and STA configure IDS Policy for AP and AM configure a signature for the IDS check Delete Command enable/disable 80211a channel as multi tenancy ted channel enable/disable 80211b channel as multi tenancy ted channel Configure Station Policy enable/disable 80211a channel as valid enable/disable 80211b channel as valid configure valid OUI for AP configure valid SSID for AP configure Wired MAC of router or server
Syntax Example
event-threshold
(switch) (wms) #event-threshold ? bwr-high-wm Bandwidth Rate High Watermark in % bwr-low-wm Bandwidth Rate Low Watermark in % fer-high-wm Frame Error Rate High Watermark in % fer-low-wm Frame Error Rate Low Watermark in % ffr-high-wm Frame Fragmentation Rate High Watermark in % ffr-low-wm Frame Fragmentation Rate Low Watermark in % flsr-high-wm Frame Low Speed Rate High Watermark in % flsr-low-wm Frame Low Speed Rate Low Watermark in % fnur-high-wm Frame Non Unicast Rate High Watermark in % fnur-low-wm Frame Non Unicast Rate Low Watermark in % frer-high-wm Frame Receive Error Rate High Watermark in % frer-low-wm Frame Receive Error Rate Low Watermark in % frr-high-wm Frame Retry Rate High Watermark in % frr-low-wm Frame Retry Rate Low Watermark in % <cr>
858 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
general
(switch) (wms) #general ap-ageout-interval ap-inactivity-timeout grace-time laser-beam for policy enforcement laser-beam-debug poll-interval poll-retries sta-ageout-interval sta-inactivity-timeout stat-update wired-laser-beam <cr> ? AP ageout interval in minutes. 0 to disable AP inactivity timeout in scan seconds. am & wms comm. latency grace time in milliseconds enable or disable force station deauthentication enable or disable laser beam debug mode am poll interval in milliseconds # of retries before it is declared down STA ageout interval in minutes. 0 to disable STA inactivity timeout in scan seconds. enable or disable Stat update in DB enable or disable wired side protection
Syntax Example
global-policy
(switch) (wms) #global-policy ? detect-bad-wep enable or disable detect bad/weak WEP policy detect-interference enable or disable interference detection interference-inc-thre.. % increase in frame retry rate or frame receiver erro r rate after with interference is reported interference-inc-time.. Amount of time FRR or FRER interference-wait-time Amount of time in seconds air monitor should learn st
AirOS Commands 859
ate of link between AP and STA to create FRR and FRER baselines <cr>
Syntax Example
ids-policy
(switch) (wms) #ids-policy ? adhoc-check IDS Adhoc Network Detection adhoc-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting Adhoc activit y after which the check can be resumed ap-flood-check IDS Fake AP Flood Detection ap-flood-inc-time Number of consecutive seconds over which the AP count is more than the threshold ap-flood-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting an AP flood b efore continuing the check ap-flood-threshold The number of spurious APs in the system dsta-check IDS Disconnect Station Analysis dsta-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting disconnect st ation attack after which the check can be resumed eap-check IDS EAP Handshake Anomaly Detection eap-rate-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting an EAP handsh ake anomlay after which the check can be resumed eap-rate-threshold Number of EAP handshake packets over the time interva l that constitutes an anomaly eap-rate-time-interval Time interval in seconds over which the packet count should be checked. Maximum is 120 seconds. mac-oui-check IDS MAC OUI Validation
860
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Time to wait in seconds after detecting an C OUI after which the check can be resumed IDS Rate Analysis Type of frame for rate check IDS Sequence Analysis Difference between sequence numbers that will be idered an anomaly Time to wait in seconds after detecting a
mber anomaly after which the check can be resumed sequence-time-toleran.. Difference in the time between two packets that is co nsidered to be non-consecutive (in ms). signature-check IDS Signature Analysis signature-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting a signature m atch after which the check can be resumed wbridge-check IDS Wireless Bridge Detection wbridge-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting a wireless br idge after which the check can be resumed <cr> (switch) (wms) #ids(switch) (wms) #ids-? ids-policy ids-signature
configure IDS Policy for AP and AM configure a signature for the IDS check
(switch) (wms) #ids-policy ? adhoc-check IDS Adhoc Network Detection adhoc-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting Adhoc activit y after which the check can be resumed ap-flood-check IDS Fake AP Flood Detection ap-flood-inc-time Number of consecutive seconds over which the AP count is more than the threshold ap-flood-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting an AP flood b efore continuing the check ap-flood-threshold The number of spurious APs in the system dsta-check IDS Disconnect Station Analysis
AirOS Commands 861
dsta-quiet-time disconnect st eap-check eap-rate-quiet-time handsh eap-rate-threshold interva eap-rate-time-interval count mac-oui-check mac-oui-quiet-time invalid MA rate-check rate-frame-type-param sequence-check sequence-diff cons sequence-quiet-time sequence nu
Time to wait in seconds after detecting ation attack after which the check can be resumed IDS EAP Handshake Anomaly Detection Time to wait in seconds after detecting an EAP ake anomlay after which the check can be resumed Number of EAP handshake packets over the time l that constitutes an anomaly Time interval in seconds over which the packet should be checked. Maximum is 120 seconds. IDS MAC OUI Validation Time to wait in seconds after detecting an C OUI after which the check can be resumed IDS Rate Analysis Type of frame for rate check IDS Sequence Analysis Difference between sequence numbers that will be idered an anomaly Time to wait in seconds after detecting a
mber anomaly after which the check can be resumed sequence-time-toleran.. Difference in the time between two packets that is co nsidered to be non-consecutive (in ms). signature-check IDS Signature Analysis signature-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting a signature m atch after which the check can be resumed wbridge-check IDS Wireless Bridge Detection wbridge-quiet-time Time to wait in seconds after detecting a wireless br idge after which the check can be resumed <cr> (switch) (wms) #ids-? ids-policy ids-signature configure IDS Policy for AP and AM configure a signature for the IDS check
862
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Syntax Example
ids-signature
(switch) (wms) #ids-signature ? <name> name of signature (switch) (wms) #ids-signature paul ? <cr> (switch) (wms) # (switch) (wms) #? ap-config ap-policy event-threshold general global-policy ids-policy ids-signature no reserved-11a-channel protec reserved-11b-channel protec station-policy valid-11a-channel valid-11b-channel valid-oui valid-ssid wired-mac
Setup Valid AP Configuration Configure ap policies Configure Statistics event thresholds Configure general attributes Configure global policy applied for AP and STA configure IDS Policy for AP and AM configure a signature for the IDS check Delete Command enable/disable 80211a channel as multi tenancy ted channel enable/disable 80211b channel as multi tenancy ted channel Configure Station Policy enable/disable 80211a channel as valid enable/disable 80211b channel as valid configure valid OUI for AP configure valid SSID for AP configure Wired MAC of router or server
Syntax
AirOS Commands
863
Example
no
tbc
Syntax Example
reserved-11a-channel
(switch) (wms) #reserved-11a-channel ? <reserved-11a-channel> enable/disable 80211a channel as multi tenancy protec ted channel (switch) (wms) #reserved-11a-channel 4 ? mode enable/disable (switch) (wms) #reserved-11a-channel 4 mode ? disable TBC enable TBC (switch) (wms) #reserved-11a-channel 4 mode enable ? <cr>
Syntax Example
reserved-11b-channel
(switch) (wms) #reserved-11b-channel ?
864 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 28
<reserved-11b-channel> protec
(switch) (wms) #reserved-11b-channel 11 ? mode enable/disable (switch) (wms) #reserved-11b-channel 11 mode enable ? <cr>
Syntax Example
station-policy
(switch) (wms) #station-policy ? detect-association-fa.. enable/disable STA association failure detection detect-sta-impersonat.. enable/disable station impersonation detection handoff-assist enable/disable AP assisted handoff ista-detection-interv.. Impersonating station detection interval in milliseco nds ista-max-retries max retries to detect station impersonation low-rssi-threshold Min RSSI above with deauth should never be sent protect-valid-sta enable/disable protect valid station policy rssi-check-frequency How often in seconds to sample RSSI value rssi-falloff-wait-time Seconds(max 8) to wait with decreasing RSSI before de auth is sent to the client <cr>
NOTEThe handoff-assist option allows the switch to force a sticky client off of an AP when the RSSI drops below the defined minimum threshold. This is useful when a client will not let go of an AP as long as it was getting any Acks (even at 1 Mbps) and will only look for new AP after about 10 seconds of not getting Ack responses from the old AP .
Syntax
AirOS Commands
865
Example
valid-11a-channel
(switch) (wms) #valid-11a? valid-11a-channel enable/disable 80211a channel as valid (switch) (wms) #valid-11a-channel ? <valid-11a-channel> enable/disable 80211a channel as valid (switch) (wms) #valid-11a-channel 2 ? mode enable/disable (switch) (wms) #valid-11a-channel 2 mode enable ? <cr> (switch) (wms) #? ap-config Setup Valid AP Configuration ap-policy Configure ap policies event-threshold Configure Statistics event thresholds general Configure general attributes global-policy Configure global policy applied for AP and STA ids-policy configure IDS Policy for AP and AM ids-signature configure a signature for the IDS check no Delete Command reserved-11a-channel enable/disable 80211a channel as multi tenancy protec ted channel reserved-11b-channel enable/disable 80211b channel as multi tenancy protec ted channel station-policy Configure Station Policy valid-11a-channel enable/disable 80211a channel as valid valid-11b-channel enable/disable 80211b channel as valid valid-oui configure valid OUI for AP valid-ssid configure valid SSID for AP wired-mac configure Wired MAC of router or server
Syntax
866
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
Example
valid-11b-channel
(switch) (wms) #valid-11b-channel ? <valid-11b-channel> enable/disable 80211b channel as valid (switch) (wms) #valid-11b-channel 14 ? mode enable/disable (switch) (wms) #valid-11b-channel 14 mode enable ? <cr>
Syntax Example
valid-oui
(switch) (wms) #valid-oui ? <valid-oui> configure valid OUI for AP (switch) (wms) #valid-oui 4 ?
Syntax Example
valid-ssid
(switch) (wms) #valid-ssid ? <valid-ssid> configure valid SSID for AP (switch) (wms) #valid-ssid 3434 ?
AirOS Commands 867
mode
Syntax Example
wired-mac
(switch) (wms) #wired-mac ? <wired-mac> configure Wired MAC of router or server (switch) (wms) #wired-mac 00:00:01:00:00:11 ? mode enable disable a wired MAC (switch) (wms) #wired-mac 00:00:01:00:00:11 mode enable ? <cr> (switch) (wms) #wired-mac 00:00:01:00:00:11 mode enable
868
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 28
AirOS Commands
869
870
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Action Commands
871
logout
Close this CLI session. Any configuration changes which have not yet been saved are lost.
872
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 29
Set the name of the file used for the switch configuration data. The named file will be used when saving the configuration (see the write command on page 876) and will be loaded the next time the switch is booted. This command requires a valid file.
z
boot system {partition0|partition1}
Set the location of the switch software image to be used the next time the system is booted.
clock set
Parameters:
The current year, specified in YYYY format (2003, for example). The current month of the year (1-12). The current day of the month (1-31). The current hour of the day, specified in 24 hour format (0-23). The current minute of the hour (0-59). The current second of the minute (0-59).
Action Commands
873
configure terminal
Enter the configuration mode. This mode provides access to system configuration commands. The commands available depends on the switch mode. Local configuration commands (see page 445) are available on any switch. Master configuration commands (page 797) are only available on the master switch.
copy...
Copy file or image items from one location to another. Variations:
z z z z z
Copy the current configuration settings to the switch configuration file used the next time the system starts. This is the equivalent of the write memory command (see page 876).
z z z z
copy startup-config flash <dest filename>
Download a switch software image file into one of the switch image banks.
874
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 29
type
z z z z z z z z z
destination IP address user name password
z z z z z z z z z
The IP address of the FTP destination for the type.log file. If required, the name of a valid user account at the destination. If required, the password for the user account at the destination.
delete <filename>
Delete the specified file from the system. To view a list of files, use the dir command.
dir
List the system files.
exit
Exit the current mode or sub-mode and return to one above it. When entered from the privileged mode main prompt (#), this commend returns you to the user mode.
Action Commands
875
reload
Reboot the system after prompting the user to verify the command. If there are any unsaved configuration changes, you will be prompted whether you wish to save them first.
halt
Shuts down the switch (the switch will not reboot automatically).
show
Enter the Show mode (see page 885). The Show mode is used to display a variety of system information and statistics.
write...
Variations:
write erase
Erase the system configuration file. The next time the system boots, the configuration will be reset to factory defaults.
z z
write file <filename>
Save the current configuration to the system configuration file. Any configuration changes made during this session will be made permanent.
876 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
Chapter 29
write terminal
z z z z z z z z
pcap clear <air monitor IP address> <pcap ID> [bssid <MAC address>] pcap interactive <air monitor IP address> <filter> <target IP address> <target UDP port> [bssid <MAC address>] [channel <channel>] pcap pause <air monitor IP address> <pcap ID> [bssid <MAC address>] raw-start <target IP address> raw-start <air monitor IP address> pcap resume <air monitor IP address> <pcap ID> [bssid <MAC address>] pcap start <air monitor IP address> <filter> [bssid <MAC address>] [channel <channel>] [max-packet-size <size>] [max-packets <number>] pcap stop <air monitor IP address> <pcap ID> [bssid <MAC address>]
Action Commands
877
WMS Commands
wms ap <MAC address> [mode <type (dos |interfering| valid)>]
This command defines the access point specified by the MAC address argument as either an interfering, valid, or denial of service type access point.
CAUTIONAttempting to import a file not exported with the wms export-db or importing a modified file, may result in a serious malfunction of the switch.
wms reinit-db
This command re-initializes the WMS database to the factory defaults. No automatic backup of the current database is made.
878
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 29
z z z z z
site-survey calibrate <building ID> <type (a|b|G)> [channel <channel>] [max-per <number>] [overlap-factor <percent>] [post-process {0|1}] site-survey channel-plan <building ID> <type (a|b)> [max-per <number>] [overlap-factor <percent>] [post-process {0|1}] site-survey update-channel-plan <BSSID> <channel> <transmit power level> site-survey walkabout-start <building ID> <type (a|b)> site-survey walkabout-stop <building ID> <type (a|b)>
Action Commands
879
The name of the AAA server to test. The name of the user account to test. The password for the tested user account.
aaa user...
Variations:
z z z
aaa user add <IP address> [name <user name>] [role <role>] [mac <MAC address>] aaa user delete {<IP address>|all} aaa user logout <IP address>
880
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 29
local-userdb...
Variations:
local-userdb add username <user name> password <password> [disable] [email <address>] [role <role name>]
Add a user to the local user database. The user is initially enabled unless the disable option is used.
z z z
local-userdb del username <user name>
Save the local user database to the specified file. Once saved, the copy command can be used to transfer the file. to another location (see page 874).
z
local-userdb fix-database
This command deletes and re-initializes the local database. Use with caution, save the database using the local-userdb export command, see above.
z
local-userdb import <file name>
Import the named file for use as the new local user database. This requires a valid database file downloaded into the WLAN switch (see the copy command on page 874).
z
local-userdb modify username <user name> [disable|enable] [email <address>] [password <password>] [role <role name>]
Modify the properties of an existing user entry in the local user database. Use this to enable or disable the user, or to update the users e-mail address, password, or role.
Parameters:
Specify the login name for the user. Specify the login password for the user. Optional. Specify the e-mail address for the user. Specify the role applied to the user upon successful authentication. The role can be associated with various Access Control Lists (ACLs) to determine the privilege level of the user. The name of the database file to export or import.
file name
Action Commands
881
Clear Commands
clear arp
This command clears the ARP table.
clear crypto dp
This command displays the last few commands in the debug buffer that were sent from the control path to the data path, adding or deleting IPSec SAs and routes. The buffer is cleared after the stored commands have been displayed.
clear loginsessions <id> clear mobile [registration-statistics <IP Address>| messages|packet-counters] clear vpdn [l2tp|pptp] [id <tunnel ID>] clear wms [ap <bssid>|probe <bsid>|sta <MAC addr>]
This command removes the specified AP , Probe, or STA from the WMS database.
882
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 29
Debug Commands
debug...
Variations:
z z
Turn debugging off for the specified feature type and sub-type.
Parameters:
Type
arubaauth arubacert crypto fp ha l2tp localdb master mmgr mobagent ppp pptp sapm stm wms
Sub-type
[all] [acl] [config] [dot1xcfg] [dot1xeapol] [dot1xkeymgt] [dot1xsapmmsg] [dot1xsm] [messages] [mobility] [user] [all] [ipsec] [isakmp] [cli] [emweb] [nim] [api] [datapath] [dhcp] [flag] [info] [messages] [states] [timers] [packets] [all] [api] [datapath] [dhcp] [flag] [info] [messages] [states] [timers] [api] [datapath] [dhcp] [flag] [info] [messages] [states] [timers] [api] [datapath] [dhcp] [flag] [info] [messages] [states] [timers] [packets] [packets] [all] [all] [all]
Action Commands
883
Panic Commands
panic clear
This command Clears all panic information from NVRAM.
page <length>
This commands sets the number of lines of text the terminal will display when paging is turned on. Valid lengths are from 24 to 100 lines.
paging
This command turns paging on. Use the no form of this command to turn paging off.
884
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
show country
This command displays the configured country code for the switch.
Show Commands
885
show keys
This command displays the status of features on the Aruba switch.
(aruba) (config) #show keys Max Number of APs 24 Max Number of MUXs 3 -------------------------Feature Status -------------------------WLAN Switch ENABLED WLAN IDS ENABLED RFDirector ENABLED VPN/Firewall ENABLED --------------------------
show users
This command displays administrative users and their access modes.
(Aruba) # show users User Name Access Mode ---------- -----------admin Read/Write
Information returned by this command is:
z z
User Name: The users login name Access Mode: The users privileges
886
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
show loginsessions
This command displays information about current sessions.
(Aruba) # show loginsessions ID User Name -- --------------00 admin Connection From --------------10.1.1.70 Idle Time -----------00:00:00 Session Time -----------00:06:33
z z z z z
ID: Session ID User Name: The login name of the connected user Connection From: IP Address of the connected user Idle Time: The time the session has been idle Session Time: The total time the session has been running
show memory
This command shows the status of memory on the Aruba switch.
show mgmt-user
This command displays the management user table.
(aruba) (config) #show mgmt-user Management User Table --------------------USER PASSWD --------admin ***** administrator *****
show startup-config
This command displays a table with all the information about the startup configuration for the switch.
Show Commands
887
show station-table
This command displays information about the stations connected to the switch. Executing this command with no options will display all the stations on the switch. Options:
z mac <MACaddr>
show trunk
This command displays the Trunk Port table.
show version
This command shows the current versions of the boot code, processor, and assembly. It also displays the switch uptime, processor memory, and non-volatile configuration memory.
(Aruba) (config) #show ip radius source-interface RADIUS client source IP address = 0.0.0.0
show firewall
This command displays the current status of the firewall.
(Aruba) (config) #show firewall Global firewall policies -----------------------Policy -----Enforce TCP handshake before allowing data Prohibit RST replay attack Deny all IP fragments Send RST on denied TCP connection
888 Part 0500055-03
Chapter 30
show inventory
This commands shows the physical contents of the switch. It also shows the status of each power supply and fan.
(Aruba) # show inventory Supervisor Card slot : 0 Supervisor FPGA Rev : 0x6 ID 0x0 Assembly# : 00004A00 (Rev:02.08) Serial# : P00000016 (Date:03/14/03) Crypto Assembly : 00005A00 (Rev:02.00) Serial#: P00000041 Mgmt Port HW MAC Addr : 00:0B:86:FF:FF:D4 Line Card HW MAC Addr : 00:0B:86:00:15:80 to 00:0B:86:00:15:FF PEER Supervisor Card : Absent Line Card 2 : Present Line Card 2 FPGA : Rev 0x5 ID 0x1 Line Card 2 Mez Card : Present Line Card 2 SPOE : Present Line Card 2 Supervisor Card 0 : Present ( Active ) Line Card 2 Supervisor Card 1 : Absent Line Card 3 : Absent Line Card 1 : Absent Fan Tray : Present Fan 0 : OK Fan 1 : OK Fan 2 : OK Fan Speed : High Power Supply 0 : Absent Power Supply 1 : Absent Power Supply 2 : Absent Internal Temp : 30.00 degrees Celsius SYSTEM 5.00V : Current reading 5.00 Volts SYSTEM 3.30V : Current reading 3.28 Volts SYSTEM 2.50V : Current reading 2.51 Volts CPU 2.00V : Current reading 2.00 Volts
show processes
This command shows which processes are currently running and their command paths.
PID TTY 1 2 3 4 5 6 82 111 119 139 156 157 159 171 173 177
Uid root root root root root root root root root root root root root root root root
Size State Command 548 S init 0 S [keventd] 0 R [ksoftirqd_CPU0] 0 S [kswapd] 0 S [bdflush] 0 S [kupdated] 628 S /sbin/cardmgr 0 S [kjournald] 504 S /mswitch/bin/syslogd -x -r -f /mswitch/conf 568 S /bin/sh /mswitch/mysql/bin/safe_mysqld 11252 S /mswitch/mysql/libexec/mysqld --basedir=/ms 11252 S /mswitch/mysql/libexec/mysqld --basedir=/ms 11252 S /mswitch/mysql/libexec/mysqld --basedir=/ms 584 S /mswitch/bin/nanny /mswitch/bin/sbcon 1 0 704 S /mswitch/bin/sbConsoled 592 S /mswitch/bin/nanny /mswitch/bin/nanny_list
show clock
This command displays the current date and time.
show boot
This command displays the current configuration file name and the boot partition.
show hostname
This command displays the name of the switch, if one has been specified in the configuration file.
show switch ip
This command displays the switchs IP address.
890
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
show syslocation
This command displays the physical location of the switch, if it has been specified in the configuration file.
show local-switches
This command displays the IP Address and location of each local switch.
show location
This command displays the physical location of the switch.
show switches
This command displays the IP addresses and physical location of all the switches on the network segment.
(Aruba) # show switches All Switches -----------Ip Address Location ---------- -------10.3.25.1 Building1.floor1
Information returned by this command is:
z z
Ip Address: The IP address of the switch Location: The physical location of the switch
Show Commands
891
Layer 2 Commands
show mac-address-table
Displays the MAC addresses that have either been learned or that have been manually configured for each device.
(Aruba) # show mac-address-table Dynamic Address Count: 0 Static Address (User-defined) Count: System Self Address Count: Total MAC Addresses : 5 Maximum MAC addresses : MAC Address Table -----------------Destination Address Address Type VLAN ------------------- ------------ ---00:0b:86:00:15:80 Mgmt 1 00:0b:86:00:15:80 Mgmt 7 00:0b:86:00:15:80 Mgmt 99
Information returned by this command is:
z z z z z z z z z
Dynamic Address Count: The number of MAC addresses discovered dynamically by the switch. Static Address Count: The number of MAC addresses manually configured in the switch System Self Address Count Total MAC Addresses: The total number of addressed in the database. Maximum MAC addresses: The maximum number of MAC addresses allowed in the table. Destination Address: A specific MAC address that has been discovered or statically configured. Address Type: The method of creation of the MAC address, the options are; Mgmt for vlan entries, Static for manually created addresses, and Dynamic for address that the switch discovers automatically. VLAN: The numeric designation of a vlan created on the switch Destination Port: the destination port for packets containing the destination MAC address.
892
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
show spantree
This command display information about the status of spanning-tree ports. Execute this command with no options to view the spanning tree configuration for all the ports on the switch. Options:
z blocking z forwarding
Displays the ports in a blocking state. Displays the ports in a forwarding state.
show spanning-tree
This command displays information about the spanning tree topology.
(Aruba) # show spanning-tree interface fastethernet 2/0 Interface Fa 2/0 (port 1) in Spanning tree is FORWARDING Port path cost 19, Port priority 128 Designated root has priority 32768 address 00:0b:86:00:15:80 Designated bridge has priority 32768 address 00:0b:86:00:15:80 Designated port is 1, path cost 0 Timers: message age 0, forward delay 0, hold 0
Show Commands
893
(Aruba) # show vlan 213 VLAN CONFIGURATION -----------------VLAN Name Ports ---- -------213 VLAN0213 Fa2/13,Fa2/15
Information returned by this command is:
z z z
VLAN: The VLAN number Name: The name of the VLAN name Ports: The physical port type and port number on which the VLAN exists. Physical port types may include the following:
Fa Pc Gig
894
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
Layer 3 Commands
show ip route [static]
(Aruba) # show ip route Codes: C - connected, O - OSPF, R - RIP, S - static U - route usable, * - candidate default Gateway of last resort is 10.3.25.254 to network 0.0.0.0 S* C C C C 0.0.0.0/0 [0/0] via 10.3.25.254* 10.3.25.0 is directly connected, VLAN1 10.2.12.0 is directly connected, VLAN212 10.2.13.0 is directly connected, VLAN213 10.1.5.0 is directly connected, VLAN7
show routerid
This command displays the IP Address of the switch.
Show Commands
895
show arp
(Aruba) # show arp Protocol Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Internet Address 10.3.25.170 10.1.5.254 10.1.5.1 10.3.25.237 10.1.5.11 10.2.12.253 10.2.13.174 10.3.25.242 10.3.25.253 10.3.25.219 10.3.25.182 10.3.25.254 10.3.25.149 Hardware Address 00:80:C8:1F:9F:D3 00:04:E2:38:3F:E8 00:09:5B:06:3E:E1 00:30:F1:71:D5:BD 00:0B:86:FF:FF:B6 00:30:F1:71:D5:BF 00:30:F1:71:D5:CE 00:05:5D:79:85:FE 00:30:F1:71:D5:E2 00:20:E0:8E:08:29 00:30:F1:71:D6:26 00:0B:86:00:0B:00 00:0B:CD:15:11:29 Interface vlan1 vlan7 vlan7 vlan1 vlan7 vlan212 vlan213 vlan1 vlan1 vlan1 vlan1 vlan1 vlan1
896
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
DHCP Commands
show ip dhcp database
This command displays information about DHCP pools created using the ip dhcp pool command.
(Aruba) # show ip dhcp database # 212 subnet 10.2.12.0 netmask 255.255.255.0 { option domain-name "arubanetworks.com"; option domain-name-servers 10.1.1.2; option netbios-name-servers 10.1.1.2; option routers 10.2.12.254; range 10.2.12.21 10.2.12.253; } # 213 subnet 10.2.13.0 netmask 255.255.255.0 { option domain-name "arubanetworks.com"; option domain-name-servers 10.1.1.2; option netbios-name-servers 10.1.1.2; option routers 10.2.13.254; range 10.2.13.21 10.2.13.253;
Information returned by this command is:
z z z z z z z
The name of the pool Subnet and subnet mask Domain names Domain name servers Netbios name servers Default gateways Range of IP addresses in the pool.
Show Commands
897
Interface Commands
show port link-event
This command displays a count of up/down links on each of the switchs ports.
(Aruba) # show port status Port Status ----------Slot-Port PortType adminstate --------- -------- ---------2/0 FE Enabled 2/1 FE Enabled 2/2 FE Enabled 2/3 FE Enabled 2/4 FE Enabled 2/5 FE Enabled 2/6 FE Enabled 2/7 FE Enabled 2/8 FE Enabled 2/9 FE Enabled 2/10 FE Enabled 2/11 FE Enabled
operstate --------Up Down Down Down Up Down Up Down Down Down Down Down
poe Trusted --------Enabled Yes Disabled Yes Disabled Yes Disabled No Enabled No Disabled No Enabled No Disabled No Disabled No Disabled No Disabled No Disabled No
SpanningTree -----------Forwarding Disabled Disabled Disabled Forwarding Disabled Forwarding Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled
PortMode -------Access Access Access Access Access Access Access Access Access Access Access Access
z z z z
898
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
z z z z
z z
Show Commands
899
(Aruba) # show interface counters Port Fa2/0 Fa2/4 Fa2/6 Fa2/12 Fa2/13 Fa2/18 Fa2/22 Fa2/23 Port Fa2/0 Fa2/4 Fa2/6 Fa2/12 Fa2/13 Fa2/18 Fa2/22 Fa2/23 InOctets 236999510 305181819 72455908 307104269 273342450 3707856 1044473 49960830 OutOctets 149481842 168576835 80821297 123359080 35375874 4662501 618243 30056800 InUcastPkts 2672298 3510613 685872 3694953 3473747 17188 3295 95117 OutUcastPkts 576986 677455 380311 561104 157434 7591 4034 91694 InMcastPkts 0 0 0 0 0 34 4 281 OutMcastPkts 583 583 583 306 306 292 306 305 InBcastPkts 48 47 47 46 46 1106 4451 3861 OutBcastPkts 5710 5719 5718 1036 34 3216 52 1867
900
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) # show interface Fa 2/0 is up, line protocol is up Hardware is FastEthernet, address is 00:0B:86:00:15:81 (bia 00:0B:86:00:15:81) Description: 10/100 Copper-Level Encapsulation ARPA, loopback not set Duplex ( AUTO ), speed ( AUTO ) MTU 1500 bytes, BW is 200 Mbit Last clear of "show interface" counters 5 day 11 hr 17 min 39 sec link status last changed 5 day 11 hr 16 min 58 sec 10749889 packets input, 946118065 bytes Received 48 broadcasts, 0 runts, 0 giants, 0 throttles 0 input error bytes, 0 CRC, 0 frame 0 multicast, 10749841 unicast 1373076 packets output, 302155390 bytes 0 output errors bytes, 0 deferred 0 collisions, 0 late collisions, 0 throttles This port is TRUSTED POE Status of the port is ON
Variants of the show interface command envoked with arguments are shown below.
Show Commands
901
902
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
Show Commands
903
904
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) # show local-userdb User Details -----------Name Password ----------mprashant ******** aagarwal ******** rchou ******** kmelkote ******** kent ******** pmanglik ******** jtaylor ******** tfroess ******** ysato ******** dcallisch ******** test1 ******** khuey ******** kester ******** rbalay ******** partha ******** sdekate ******** ghuber ******** kperedia ********
Role ---employee employee employee employee employee employee employee employee employee employee test1 employee employee employee employee employee employee employee
E-Mail ------
Enabled ------Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
z z z z
Name: The users login user name Password: Password is displayed as a string of stars only Role: The role assigned to the user name Enabled
Show Commands
905
VPN Commands
IPSec Commands
show crypto dp
This command displays the last few add and delete commands sent from the control path to the data path.
(Aruba) # show crypto isakmp policy ISAKMP ENABLED Protection suite priority 10 encryption algorithm: 3DES - Triple Data Encryption Standard (168 bit keys) hash algorithm: Secure Hash Algorithm authentication method: Pre-Shared Key Diffie-Hellman Group: #2 (1024 bit) lifetime: [300 - 86400] seconds, no volume limit
Key option
(Aruba) # show crypto isakmp key ISAKMP Pre-Shared keys configured by Address -------------------------------------------IP address of the host Subnet Mask Length Key ---------------------- ------------------ --0.0.0.0 0 w3lc0m3
906
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) # show crypto ipsec transform-set Transform set default-transform: { esp-3des esp-sha-hmac } will negotiate = { Transport, },
(Aruba) # show crypto dynamic-map Crypto Map Template"default-dynamicmap" 10000 lifetime: [300 - 86400] seconds, no volume limit PFS (Y/N): N Transform sets={ default-transform }
(Aruba) # show crypto Map Crypto Map "GLOBAL-MAP" 10000 ipsec-isakmp Crypto Map Template"default-dynamicmap" 10000 lifetime: [300 - 86400] seconds, no volume limit PFS (Y/N): N Transform sets={ default-transform }
Show Commands
907
L2TP Commands
show vpdn tunnel {l2tp|pptp|tunnel} [id <tunnel ID>]
This command displays information about the tunnel specified by tunnelID in the id parameter. Information returned when the tunnel id is not specified.
(Aruba) # show vpdn tunnel l2tp L2TP Tunnel Information (Total tunnels = 1) Tunnel ID = 17767 is up, remote id is 67 Tunnel state is SCCCN: Connection Connected Remote Internet Address 10.3.14.199, port 1701 Control Ns 38, Nr 7 Local RWS 4, Remote RWS 8
Information returned when the tunnel id is specified.
NOTEThe tunnel id used in the command below is the remote id reported in the display above.
(Aruba) # show vpdn tunnel l2tp id 67 L2TP Tunnel Information (Total tunnels = 1)
908
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) # show vpdn l2tp configuration Enabled Hello timeout: 60 seconds DNS primary server: 10.1.1.2 DNS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS primary server: 10.1.1.2 WINS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 PPP client authentication methods: CACHE-SECURID: timeout 1440 minutes IP LOCAL POOLS: pool1: 10.2.15.1 - 10.2.15.100
PPTP option
(Aruba) # show vpdn pptp configuration Enabled Hello timeout: 60 seconds DNS primary server: 0.0.0.0 DNS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS primary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 PPP client authentication methods: MSCHAPv2 MPPE Configuration 40 bit encryption enabled 128 bit encryption enabled Encryption REQUIRED IP LOCAL POOLS:
Show Commands
909
(Aruba) # show vpdn l2tp local pool IP addresses used in pool p1 10.7.1.101 1 IPs used - 25498 IPs free
910
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) # show vpn-dialer default-dialer -------------Attribute --------PPTP L2TP DNETCLEAR WIREDNOWIFI PAP CHAP MSCHAP MSCHAPV2 CACHE-SECURID IKESECS IKEENC IKEGROUP IKEHASH IKEAUTH IKEPASSWD IPSecSECS IPSecGROUP IPSecENC IPSecAUTH
Value ----disabled enabled disabled disabled enabled enabled enabled enabled enabled 28800 3DES TWO SHA PRE-SHARE w3lc0m3 7200 GROUP2 ESP-3DES ESP-SHA-HMAC
Show Commands
911
PPTP Commands
show vpdn pptp configuration
This command displays the VPN configuration for PPTP . This command is exactly analogous to the show vpn {l2pp|pptp} command.
(Aruba) # show vpdn pptp configuration Enabled Hello timeout: 60 seconds DNS primary server: 0.0.0.0 DNS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS primary server: 0.0.0.0 WINS secondary server: 0.0.0.0 PPP client authentication methods: MSCHAPv2 MPPE Configuration 40 bit encryption enabled 128 bit encryption enabled Encryption REQUIRED IP LOCAL POOLS:
(Aruba) # show vpdn pptp local pool 0 IPs used - 0 IPs free
912
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
Mobility Commands
(Aruba) # show foreign-agent configuration SwitchIp: 10.3.25.1 UDP: 434 Interfaces: Device: lo IP: 127.0.0.2 Interfaces: Device: IP: 10.3.25.1 Tunnel Lifetime (secs): 500 Mode: Reverse Registration Required: TRUE Max Bindings: 300 Max Pending Allowed: 5 Max Pending Lifetime: 120 (Aruba) #show foreign-agent security Authentication Algorithm: HMac MD5 (Aruba) #show foreign-agent status Total Tunnels:0 Bindings: 0 Pending: 0 Registration Requests Status: Accepted: 0 Rejected: 0 Registration Replies Status: Accepted: 0 Rejected: 0 Rejection Statistics: Unknown Extension:0 Malformed Packet: 0 Unknown Vendor Extension: 0
Show Commands
913
(Aruba) # show home-agent security mobile Authentication Algorithm: HMac MD5 Replay Method: Nonce SPI: 1000 Binding Life: 400 Shared Secret: aruba
show home-agent options:
configurati on security
This configuration returns information related to the configuration of the home agent. There are no optional parameters or variables associated with this option. The security option displays the security associations between the home agent and either foreign or mobile agents. The security option must be invoked for either foreign or mobile as shown here: show home-agent security foreign show home-agent security mobile
status
The status option returns information regarding tunnels, bindings, registration requests, and rejection statistics.
914
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) # show mobile client Mobile Nodes -----------Id Mac -- --1 00:30:f1:71:d5:bd 2 00:30:f1:71:d5:bf 3 00:30:f1:71:d6:26 4 00:80:c8:1f:9f:d3 5 00:30:f1:71:d5:ce 6 00:09:5b:06:3e:e1 7 00:0b:86:ff:ff:b6 8 00:04:e2:38:3f:e8 9 00:30:48:51:05:d5
HomeAgent --------10.3.25.1 10.3.25.1 10.3.25.1 10.3.25.1 10.3.25.1 10.3.25.1 10.3.25.1 10.3.25.1 10.3.25.1
Location -------2/4 2/12 2/6 1.2.2 2/13 2/22 2/22 2/22 2/22
(Aruba) # show mobile client verbose 10.3.25.237 Mac: 00:30:f1:71:d5:bd IP: 10.3.25.237 Roaming State: Home Switch/Home Vlan Home Agent: 10.3.25.1 Home Network: 10.3.25.0/24 Home Vlan: 1 Current Location (Mswitch/Vlan/Slot/Port): 10.3.25.1/1/2/4 DHCP Server: 0.0.0.0 DNS Server: 0.0.0.0 Default Gateway: 0.0.0.0 Tunnel Id: No Tunnel Mode: Auto Reverse Lifetime: 300 Authentication: HMac MD5 Replay Method: Nonce Spi: 1000 Shared Secret:aruba Last Reg Request Sent: Never Last Reg Reply Recvd: Never Last Registration Reply Code: 0 (registration accepted) Total Error Count: 0
Show Commands
915
(Aruba) # show mobile configuration Switch IP: 10.3.25.1 Master: 10.3.25.1 Mobility: Enabled Proxy Dhcp: Enabled Local Mobility Agent: 127.0.0.2 Mobility Port: 434 Tunnel Mode: Auto Reverse Lifetime(secs): 300 Reregistration(secs): 275 Spi: 1000 Shared Secret: aruba Length: 32 Authentication: HMac MD5 Replay Method: Nonce Buffer Size:32
(Aruba) # show mobile dhcp proxy-stopped Id -1 2 3 4 5 6 Time ---Wed Aug Wed Aug Wed Aug Wed Aug Thu Aug Thu Aug Mac --00:05:5d:79:85:fe 00:0b:be:8d:44:1a 00:05:5d:79:85:fe 00:05:5d:79:85:fe 00:0b:be:8d:44:1a 00:0b:be:8d:44:1a IP -0.0.0.0 10.3.25.233 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 10.3.25.233 10.3.25.233 Reason -----Changed Essids Released Changed Essids Count Exceeded Released Released
6 6 6 6 7 7
z z z z z
ID Time: The time the m-manager dropped the proxy Mac: The MAC address for which the proxy was dropped IP: The IP address of the MAC for which the proxy was dropped Reason: The reason the proxy was dropped
916
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) # show mobile home-agents global Home Agent Table ---------------Id Subnet Netmask -- -----------1 10.3.25.0 255.255.255.0 2 10.1.5.0 255.255.255.0 3 10.2.12.0 255.255.255.0 4 10.2.13.0 255.255.255.0
(Aruba) # show mobile home-agents local Home Agent Table ---------------Id Subnet Netmask -- -----------1 10.3.25.0 255.255.255.0 2 10.1.5.0 255.255.255.0 3 10.2.12.0 255.255.255.0 4 10.2.13.0 255.255.255.0
z z z z z
ID: serial numbering of agents Subnet: the subnet which the agent manages Netmask: the subnet mask for the subnet which the agent manages HomeAgent: the IP address of the Home Agent Type: the type of switch used as the agent.
Show Commands
917
The messages shown by the mobile messages command are listed below, each message table contains the opcode, type of message, number sent, and number received.
z z z z z
Datapath Messages Master Messages Authentication Messages Station Management Messages Control Messages
(Aruba) # show mobile packet-counters Packet Count -----------Type ARP TCP ------ --Recvd 295 20 Sent 301 20
ICMP ---1 1
IGMP ---3 3
IPIP ---0 0
OTHERIP ------4 4
MISC ---47 47
918
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
Opcode Vlan Slot Port SrcMac ------ ---- ---- ---- -----0x2f HANDLED 0x2f HANDLED 0x2f HANDLED 0x2f HANDLED 0x2f HANDLED 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 4 4 4 4 4
DestMac -------
SrcIp -----
z z z z z z z z z z z z
No Time Opcode: manufacturing information. Vlan: VLAN on which the packet arrived. Slot: Slot on which the packet arrived. Port: Port on which the packet arrived. SrcMac: Source MAC extracted from the ethernet frame. DestMac: Destination MAC extracted from the ethernet frame. SrcIP: Source IP address extracted from the ethernet frame. DestIP: Destination IP address extracted from the ethernet frame Type: Type of packet. Action: What action the Mobility Manager took on the packet. The possible actions are:
The Mobility Manager buffered the packet and completed the necessary mobility management. The Mobility Manager returned the packet to the datapath. The packet was silently discarded and no further action was taken.
Show Commands
919
(Aruba) # show mobile registration-statistics 10.3.25.237 Requests: Registration: 0 Deregistration: 0 Reregistrations: 0 Replies: Registration: 0 Deregistration: 0 Accepted: 0 Denied: 0
(aruba) (config) #show mobile tunnel-users 4213 Tunnel Users -----------Id Mac -- --1 00:05:5d:79:85:fe
Ip -10.3.18.251
920
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(alpha) (config) # show mobile tunnels sap Sap Tunnels ----------No. TunnelId --- -------1 0x1069 2 0x106a 3 0x106b 4 0x106c 5 0x106d
Vlan ---1 7 1 7 7
(alpha) (config) # show mobile tunnels mobile-ip Mobile IP Tunnels ----------------No. TunnelId Local --- -------- ----1 4217 10.3.25.1
Remote -----10.3.18.1
This option displays all mobility information about the user. This option displays authentication information about the user. This option displays the last 10 locations of the user. This option displays VPN information about the user.
Show Commands
921
User ----
jtaylor
922
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) (config) #show mobile vlan-configuration Vlan Configuration -----------------Vid Subnet --- -----1 10.3.25.0 7 10.1.5.0 212 10.2.12.0 213 10.2.13.0 999 64.60.249.192
Show Commands
923
924
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) (config) #show am bssid-scan 10.3.25.248 1 BSSID Scanned ------------bssid ----00:06:25:0f:6e:1f 00:0b:86:20:27:19 00:00:00:00:00:00 00:0b:86:80:04:30 00:0b:86:80:20:f0 00:0b:86:80:13:60 00:0b:86:20:37:30 00:0b:86:20:27:1b 00:0b:86:20:27:a5 00:0b:86:20:27:8e 00:0b:86:80:08:10 00:0c:41:13:f9:cd 00:30:bd:62:4b:48 00:0b:86:b0:01:cb 00:0b:86:b0:02:55 00:0b:86:20:27:8f 00:06:25:b5:6f:0a 00:80:c8:b0:55:66 00:0b:86:20:27:1d
beacon -----n n n y y y y n y y y n y y y y n n y
rssi ---19 14 50 3 23 13 23 16 40 3 6 49 12 0 17 6 1 57 27
active-time ----------0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
inactive-time ------------0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Show Commands
925
(Aruba) (config) #show am pot-ap-list 10.3.25.248 Potential AP Table -----------------bssid channel ----------00:0b:86:a0:01:fc 36 00:0b:86:20:27:8e 1 00:0b:86:a0:04:15 36 00:0b:86:b0:01:47 1 00:0b:86:20:27:7f 1 00:0b:86:20:27:24 6 00:0b:86:20:27:af 1 Num Potential APs:7
num-beacons ----------0 0 0 0 0 0 0
tot-beacons ----------9 9 9 9 9 9 9
mt -27 12 13 5 18 19 28
at -0 0 0 0 0 0 0
926
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
high-noise ---------39
Show Commands
927
928
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
rsta-type --------valid
auth ---yes
phy-type -------80211b
Show Commands
929
chan ---6 52
930
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(alpha) (config) #show am scan-times 10.3.25.248 Channel Scan Time ----------------channel scan-time ------- --------1 306 2 35 3 312 4 35 5 35 6 314
RRA-scan-time ------------0 0 0 0 0 0
mask ---5 1 5 1 1 5
Show Commands
931
932
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
WMS Commands
WMS commands are privileged commands entered from the WMS sub-mode. 1 Enter the privileged mode.
Type configure terminal <Enter>
show wms
This command displays information about the wireless management system and its components. Options:
z z z z z z z z z z
ap <bssid> ap-config
Displays information about a specified access point. Displays information about valid access point configurations. Displays the ap-policy attributes. Use this command to discover how many of each phy-type devices are in each building. This command displays all the WMS counters. This command displays the currently configured WMS event threshold values. This command displays the WMS general attributes This command displays the global policy attribute This command displays the WMS general attribute This command displays information about which IDS policies are enabled and the currently configured IDS parameters. This command displays the site survey attributes. This command displays information about the access point. This command displays the station policy attributes.
ap-policy buildings
counters event-threshold
z z z
site-survey sta<MacAddr>
station-policy
Show Commands
933
(Aruba) (config) #show wms ap 00:0b:86:20:28:13 AP Info ------BSSID ----00:0b:86:20:28:13 Probe Info ---------MAC --00:0b:86:20:27:a0 00:0b:86:20:28:13 00:0b:86:20:27:ac 00:0b:86:20:27:a1 00:0b:86:20:27:a6
Type ---soft-ap
Status -----up
934
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) (config) #show wms sta 00:30:f1:71:93:d5 AP Info ------BSSID ----00:30:f1:71:93:d5 Probe Info ---------MAC --00:30:f1:71:94:08 00:0b:86:a0:00:5a 00:30:f1:71:93:54 00:30:f1:71:93:d5
Type ---soft-ap
Status -----up
Show Commands
935
Value ----2266 382945 206 105 10196 5221 14332 2480 110 19091 19080 76 1 13 107 371
The bssid of the destination calibration data The maximum packet error rate to filter on The bssid of the source calibration data
936
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
z bssid z essid
Show only information for the station with the specified bssid. Show only information for stations with the specified essid
Show Commands
937
z port
z count z mac
Specify the number of packets to display. Max count = 128 The MAC address of a station or AP from which to display packets.
938
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(aruba) (config) #show ap config location 1.1.2 CONFIG_AP_RESULT ---------------PARAMETER --------Location (Bldg.Flr.Loc) BSSID Channel ESSID Encryption Device Type Authentication Short Preamble RTS Threshold (Bytes) Transmit Power (Level)
. . .
Hidden SSID Deny_Broadcast Probes b/g Mode Country Code WPA Hexkey WPA Passphrase LMS IP Backup LMS Disabled Disabled mixed US N/A N/A N/A 0.0.0.0 Disabled Disabled N/A US N/A N/A N/A 0.0.0.0
Show Commands
939
show ap configs
This command displays the configuration information for all APs.
940
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(aruba) (config) #show ap effective-config bssid 00:0b:86:9d:63:e0 CONFIG_AP_RESULT ---------------PARAMETER --------Location (Bldg.Flr.Loc) BSSID Channel ESSID Encryption Device Type Authentication Short Preamble RTS Threshold (Bytes) Transmit Power (Level) Retry Limit DTIM Interval (beacon periods) Max Associations Beacon Period (millisecs) Basic Rates Transmit Rates AP Radio Power Management Station Ageout Time (secs) VLAN ID Hidden SSID Deny_Broadcast Probes b/g Mode Country Code WPA Hexkey WPA Passphrase LMS IP Backup LMS
802.11b/g --------1.1.3 00:0b:86:9d:63:e0 1 alpha-guest staticWep ap_mode opensystem Enabled 2333 2 8 1 64 100 1,2 1,2,5,11 Enabled Enabled 1000 7 Disabled Disabled mixed US N/A N/A 10.3.25.1 0.0.0.0
Show Commands
941
Condition
AP radio down Unsecure AP found WLAN IDS event Interference detected AP overload OK No AP connected
show ap locations
This command displays a simple table of AP locations. Use this command to get location information to use in other show ap commands.
942
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
STATE ----7 7 7 7 7 7 7
z z z z z z z z z z z z
0: SAPCP_STATE_INIT 1: SAPCP_STATE_GOT_TUN_REQ 2: SAPCP_STATE_SNT_TUN_RSP 3: SAPCP_STATE_GOT_REGISTER 4: SAPCP_STATE_SNT_REG_RESP 5: SAPCP_STATE_GOT_CONF_REQ 6: SAPCP_STATE_SNT_CONF_RSP 7: SAPCP_STATE_STEADY 8: SAPCP_STATE_SNT_CONF_UPDATE 9: SAPCP_STATE_GOT_UPDATE_RSP 10: SAPCP_STATE_SNT_IMG_PULL 11: SAPCP_STATE_SNT_APBOOT
Show Commands
943
Authentication Commands
Protocol -------udp
Ports ----1645
Inverted -------No No No No No No
z authentication-method
Show users logged in with a specific authentication method. Show information about a specific user by IP Address. Show information about users in a specific location.
z ip z location
944
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
Show information about a specific user by MAC address. Show information about mobile users. Show information about a specific user by user name. Show information about users with a specific role. Show all the information in the user table.
show user
This command displays information about users, including: roles, IP addresses, MAC addresses, user names, location, associations, and authentication methods. Executing this command without options displays all users. Options:
z z z z z
This option displays VLAN, switch, and access point for a user identified by a specific IP address. This option displays VLAN, switch, and access point for a user identified by a specific location. This option displays VLAN, switch, access point, the association table, and mobility state for a user identified by a specific MAC address
Show Commands
945
z mobile
This option displays IP address, name, role, authentication, and location information for users that have moved away or are visiting the switch. This option displays VLAN, switch, and access point for a user identified by user name. This option displays IP address, MAC address, name, and authentication information for all users with the specified role. This option displays the information from a specified range of rows in the user table.
show rights
(aruba) (config) #show rights RoleTable --------Name ---ap-role trusted-ap employee vpnemployee marketing guest stateful-dot1x stateful logon
ACL --3 5 18 19 20 2 4 21 1
Bandwidth --------No Limit No Limit No Limit No Limit No Limit No Limit No Limit No Limit No Limit
ACL List -------control ap-acl allowall vpnlogon employee vpnemployee marketing control cplogout control control captiveportal vpnlogon
Type ---System System User User User User System User User
946
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(Aruba) # show dot1x config Authentication Server Timeout :30 Client Response Timeout:30 Fail Timeout :30 Client Retry Count :3 Server Retry Count :2 Reauthentication :Disabled Reauthentication Time Interval :2147483647 Multicast Key Rotation :Disabled Multicast Key Rotation Time Interval :1200 Unicast Key Rotation :Disabled Unicast Key Rotation Time Interval :240 Statefull Authentication :Enabled Statefull Authentication Response Timeout :30
z z z z z z z
MAC Address of the supplicant User Name Authentication Status (yes/no) AP MAC Encryption Key Authorization Mode EAP type
z z z z z z z
The supplicants MAC Address User name The number of times the supplicant has been successfully authenticated. The total number of times the supplicant sent invalid user credentials and/or entered an incorrect password. The number of times authorization requests timed out. The number of times the supplicant has successfully reauthenticated. The number of times a Supplicant NAK occurred. This may be due to an EAP mismatch between the supplicant and authentication server, or if the server has been configured for multiple EAP types. The number of times the Unicast key associated with the supplicant has been rotated. with the supplicant has been rotated.
Auth-Fails
Auth-Timeout Reauths
Supp-Naks
z z
UkeyRotations
948
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
z server
[<name>]
Display all the derivation rules configured for the specified server. Use this option without specifying a name to show rules for all servers. Display the rules for deriving user roles based on user information.
z user
z server-name
[<name>]
Port ---1645
Acct ---1646
Retries ------3
Timeout ------5
Secret -----aruba
Show Commands
949
Applied ------1
950
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
Show Commands
951
Total ----13 1 1 11
Total ----1
952
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
Show Commands
953
Timeout ------5
Status -----Enabled
Inservice --------Yes
(Aruba) # show aaa dot1x Mode = 'Enabled' Default Role = 'guest' Auth Server List ---------------Pri Name Type Status --- -----------1 ARUBA RADIUS Enabled 2 IAS RADIUS Enabled
z z z z z
Pri
Applied ------1 1
The order in which the server will be queried for authentication The name of the authentication server The server type Enabled or Disabled This field indicates the status of connectivity between the switch and the server.
954
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(aruba) (config) #show aaa web admin-port https port = 4343 http port = 80
Dialer Commands
show vpn-dialer [<dialer name>]
This command displays the configuration information for the named VPN dialer. If execute the command without specifying a dialer name the command will return the configuration of all VPN dialers on the switch.
Show Commands
955
(aruba) # ip access-list session employee employee -------Priority Source Destination Service Action Log Expired Queue -------- ------ ----------- ------- -------- ------- ----1 any any tcp 80 permit High 2 any any any permit Low
Opcode ------
TimeRange ---------
show acl]
This command displays information from the acl and ace tables. Options:
This option does a screen dump of the ace table entries. This option displays the ACL table This option displays a table of ACL hits by user role.
956
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
(aruba) # show ip access-list control ip access-list session control control ------Priority Source Destination -------- ------ ----------1 any any 2 user any 3 user any 4 user any 5 user any 6 any any 7 user any
Opcode Log Queue ------ --- ----Low Low Low Low Low Low Low
show session-access-list
This command displays a list of access control lists.
(Aruba) # show session-access-list control dew airmon employee captiveportal allowall vpnlogon guest stateful-dot1x stateful-kerberos 89
Show Commands
957
show time-range
This command displays currently configured time ranges.
(aruba) (config) #show time-range Time-Range foo2, Periodic ------------------------StartDay Start-time EndDay -------- ---------- -----daily 06:00
End-time -------18:00
Applied ------No
Time-Range foo, Absolute -----------------------StartDate Start-time EndDate --------- ---------- ------12/9/2003 6: 0 12/31/2005
End-time -------23:59
Applied ------Yes
MUX Commands
show mux
This command displays information about the MUX configured on the switch. Options:
This option displays the current configuration of the MUX. This option displays the current operational state of the MUX. This option displays the VLANs assigned to the MUX.
958
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Chapter 30
z Summary Tables
The show commands that display information for a general feature or a large set of items output columns of information in a summary table. For example:
(Aruba) # show datapath user table User Table Entries -----------------IP MAC --------------- ----------------10.5.10.2 00:00:00:00:00:00 10.5.168.101 00:90:7A:01:1C:72 10.5.168.103 00:90:7A:01:35:01 10.5.168.102 00:90:7A:01:2D:B7 10.5.168.105 00:90:7A:01:2C:36 10.5.168.104 00:90:7A:01:2C:D9 10.5.168.107 00:90:7A:01:2E:30 10.5.168.106 00:90:7A:01:13:1D 10.5.2.16 00:00:00:00:00:00 10.5.2.18 00:00:00:00:00:00 10.5.2.93 00:04:E2:64:C1:C0 10.5.2.228 00:05:4E:41:EB:D0 10.5.2.236 00:03:93:EC:C2:37 10.5.2.245 00:90:7A:01:1B:8E 10.5.2.247 00:90:7A:01:1D:47 10.5.2.246 00:90:7A:01:3F:6B 10.5.2.240 00:0B:BE:8D:44:1A 10.5.2.242 00:04:23:4A:F5:FF 10.5.2.252 00:90:7A:01:48:EF
ACL ---36 34 34 34 34 34 34 34 3 3 36 36 1 34 34 34 1 36 34
Contract -------0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Location -------0.0.0 1.1.8 1.1.8 1.1.8 1.1.8 1.1.8 1.1.8 1.1.8 1.1.6 1.1.8 1.1.8 1.1.1 1.1.6 1.1.8 1.1.1 1.1.4 1.1.6 1.1.8 1.1.1
Flags -----
NOTEYou can also force most general show commands to present information in the detail list format by adding the verbose option to the end of the command (such as show wlan verbose)
Show Commands
959
z Detail Lists
The show commands that display information for a specific device, protocol, or event present detailed information in a list format. For example.
(Aruba) # show ap config location 0.0.0 CONFIG_AP_RESULT ---------------PARAMETER --------Location (Bldg.Flr.Loc) BSSID Channel ESSID Encryption Device Type Authentication Short Preamble RTS Threshold (Bytes) Transmit Power (Level) Retry Limit DTIM Interval (beacon periods) Max Associations Beacon Period (millisecs) Basic Rates Transmit Rates AP Radio Power Management Station Ageout Time (secs) VLAN ID Hidden SSID Deny_Broadcast Probes b/g Mode Country Code WPA Hexkey WPA Passphrase LMS IP Backup LMS
802.11b/g --------0.0.0 N/A 1 ether staticWep,dynamicWep ap_mode opensystem Disabled 2333 2 8 1 50 100 1,2,5,11 1,2,5,11 Enabled Enabled 1000 0 Disabled Disabled mixed US N/A N/A N/A 0.0.0.0
802.11a ------0.0.0 N/A 36 sphere TKIP ap_mode opensystem N/A 2333 2 3 1 50 100 48.54 48,54 Enabled Enabled 1000 0 Enabled Enabled N/A US N/A N/A N/A 0.0.0.0
960
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Part
Appendices
961
962
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Glossary
10BaseT*
An IEEE standard (802.3) for operating 10 Mbps Ethernet networks (LANs) with twisted pair cabling and a wiring hub.
802.11 standard*
802.11, or IEEE 802.11, is a type of radio technology used for wireless local area networks (WLANs). It is a standard that has been developed by the IEEE (Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers), http://standards.ieee.org. The IEEE is an international organization that develops standards for hundreds of electronic and electrical technologies. The organization uses a series of numbers, like the Dewey Decimal system in libraries, to differentiate between the various technology families. The 802 subgroup (of the IEEE) develops standards for local and wide area networks with the 802.11 section reviewing and creating standards for wireless local area networks. Wi-Fi, 802.11, is composed of several standards operating in different radio frequencies: 802.11b is a standard for wireless LANs operating in the 2.4 GHz spectrum with a bandwidth of 11 Mbps; 802.11a is a different standard for wireless LANs, and pertains to systems operating in the 5 GHz frequency range with a bandwidth of 54 Mbps. Another standard, 802.11g, is for WLANS operating in the 2.4 GHz frequency but with a bandwidth of 54 Mbps.
802.11a*
An IEEE specification for wireless networking that operates in the 5 GHz frequency range (5.725 GHz to 5.850 GHz) with a maximum 54 Mbps data transfer rate. The 5 GHz frequency band
Glossary
963
is not as crowded as the 2.4 GHz frequency, because the 802.11a specification offers more radio channels than the 802.11b. These additional channels can help avoid radio and microwave interference.
802.11b*
International standard for wireless networking that operates in the 2.4 GHz frequency range (2.4 GHz to 2.4835 GHz) and provides a throughput of up to 11 Mbps. This is a very commonly used frequency. Microwave ovens, cordless phones, medical and scientific equipment, as well as Bluetooth devices, all work within the 2.4 GHz frequency band.
802.11g*
Similar to 802.11b, but this standard provides a throughput of up to 54 Mbps. It also operates in the 2.4 GHz frequency band but uses a different radio technology in order to boost overall bandwidth.
Access point*
A wireless LAN transceiver or base station that can connect a wired LAN to one or many wireless devices. Access points can also bridge to each other. There are various types of access points and base stations used in both wireless and wired networks. These include bridges, hubs, switches, routers and gateways. The differences between them are not always precise, because certain capabilities associated with one can also be added to another. For example, a router can do bridging, and a hub may also be a switch. But they are all involved in making sure data is transferred from one location to another. A bridge connects devices that all use the same kind of protocol. A router can connect networks that use differing protocols. It also reads the addresses included in the packets and routes them to the appropriate computer station, working with any other routers in the network to choose the best path to send the packets on. A wireless hub or access point adds a few capabilities such as roaming and provides a network connection to a variety of clients, but it does not allocate bandwidth. A switch is a hub that has extra intelligence: It can read the address of a packet and send it to the appropriate computer station. A wireless gateway is an access point that provides additional capabilities such as NAT routing, DHCP , firewalls, security, etc.
Air Monitor
A wireless access point used to detect wireless devices within range of itself for the purpose of determining the existence near the network and to monitor their activity.
964
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Application software*
A computer program that is designed to do a general task. For example, word processing, payroll, Internet browsers and graphic design programs would all be considered applications.
Authentication server
An entity that provides an authentication service to an authenticator. This service determines, from the credentials provided by the supplicant, whether the supplicant is authorized to access the services provided by the authenticator. Example: Microsoft IAS is an Authentication Server.
Authenticator
An entity at one end of a point-to-point LAN segment that facilitates authentication of the entity attached to the other end of that link. Example: Aruba-5000 is an 802.1x Authenticator.
Backbone*
The central part of a large network that links two or more subnetworks and is the primary path for data transmission for a large business or corporation. A network can have a wired backbone or a wireless backbone.
Bandwidth*
The amount of transmission capacity that is available on a network at any point in time. Available bandwidth depends on several variables such as the rate of data transmission speed between networked devices, network overhead, number of users, and the type of device used to connect PCs to a network. It is similar to a pipeline in that capacity is determined by size: the wider the pipe, the more water can flow through it; the more bandwidth a network provides, the more data can flow through it. Standard 802.11b provides a bandwidth of 11 Mbps; 802.11a and 802.11g provide a bandwidth of 54 Mbps.
Glossary
965
byte, so if a wireless network is operating at a bandwidth of 11 megabits per second (11 Mbps or 11 Mbits/sec), it is sending data at 1.375 megabytes per second (1.375 MBps).
Bridge*
A product that connects a local area network (LAN) to another local area network that uses the same protocol (for example, wireless, Ethernet or token ring). Wireless bridges are commonly used to link buildings in campuses.
Bus adapter*
A special adapter card that installs in a PC's PCI or ISA slot and enables the use of PC Card radios in desktop computers. Some companies offer one-piece PCI or ISA Card radios that install directly into an open PC or ISA slot.
Captive Portal
A secure, dedicated, web connection between a client station and a server.
Certificates
Certificates are digital documents which are commonly used for authenticating users, computers and for securing information on open networks. Certificates bind public keys to the entity that possesses the private key and are digitally signed by the issuing certification authority (CA).
CLI
Command Line Interface
Client*
Any computer connected to a network that requests services (files, print capability) from another member of the network.
966
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Client devices*
Clients are end users. Wi-Fi client devices include PC Cards that slide into laptop computers, mini-PCI modules embedded in laptop computers and mobile computing devices, as well as USB radios and PCI/ISA bus Wi-Fi radios. Client devices usually communicate with hub devices like access points and gateways.
Collision avoidance*
A network node characteristic for proactively detecting that it can transmit a signal without risking a collision.
Crossover cable*
A special cable used for networking two computers without the use of a hub. Crossover cables may also be required for connecting a cable or DSL modem to a wireless gateway or access point. Instead of the signals transferring in parallel paths from one set of plugs to another, the signals crossover. If an eight-wire cable was being used, for instance, the signal would start on pin one at one end of the cable and end up on pin eight at the other end. They cross-over from one side to the other.
CSMA-CA*
CSMA/CA is the principle medium access method employed by IEEE 802.11 WLANs. It is a listen before talk method of minimizing (but not eliminating) collisions caused by simultaneous transmission by multiple radios. IEEE 802.11 states collision avoidance method rather than collision detection must be used, because the standard employs half duplex radiosradios capable of transmission or receptionbut not both simultaneously. Unlike conventional wired Ethernet nodes, a WLAN station cannot detect a collision while transmitting. If a collision occurs, the transmitting station will not receive an ACKnowledge packet from the intended receive station. For this reason, ACK packets have a higher priority than all other network traffic. After completion of a data transmission, the receive station will begin transmission of the ACK packet before any other node can begin transmitting a new data packet. All other stations must wait a longer pseudo randomized period of time before transmitting. If an ACK packet is not received, the transmitting station will wait for a subsequent opportunity to retry transmission.
Glossary
967
CSMA/CD*
A method of managing traffic and reducing noise on an Ethernet network. A network device transmits data after detecting that a channel is available. However, if two devices transmit data simultaneously, the sending devices detect a collision and retransmit after a random time delay.
DC power module*
Modules that convert AC power to DC. Depending on manufacturer and product, these modules can range from typical wall wart transformers that plug into a wall socket and provide DC power via a tiny plug to larger, enterprise-level Power Over Ethernet systems that inject DC power into the Ethernet cables connecting access points.
DHCP*
A utility that enables a server to dynamically assign IP addresses from a predefined list and limit their time of use so that they can be reassigned. Without DHCP , an IT Manager would have to manually enter in all the IP addresses of all the computers on the network. When DHCP is used, whenever a computer logs onto the network, it automatically gets an IP address assigned to it.
Diversity antenna*
A type of antenna system that uses two antennas to maximize reception and transmission quality and reduce interference.
DNS*
A program that translates URLs to IP addresses by accessing a database maintained on a collection of Internet servers. The program works behind the scenes to facilitate surfing the Web with alpha versus numeric addresses. A DNS server converts a name like mywebsite.com to a series of numbers like 107.22.55.26. Every website has its own specific IP address on the Internet.
DoS
Denial of Service.
EAP
(Extensible Authentication Protocol) is a general protocol for PPP authentication which supports multiple authentication mechanisms.
968 Part 0500055-03 May 2005
EAP-TLS
(EAP-Transport Level Security) is used in certificate-based security environments. It provides the strongest authentication and key determination method. EAP-TLS provides mutual authentication, negotiation of the encryption method, and encrypted key determination between the client and the authenticator.
EAP-TTLS
(EAP- Tunnelled TLS Authentication Protocol) is an EAP protocol that extends EAP-TLS. In EAP-TLS, a TLS handshake is used to mutually authenticate a client and server. EAP-TTLS extends this authentication negotiation by using the secure connection established by the TLS handshake to exchange additional information between client and server. In EAP-TTLS, the TLS handshake may be mutual; or it may be one-way, in which only the server is authenticated to the client.
Encryption key*
An alphanumeric (letters and/or numbers) series that enables data to be encrypted and then decrypted so it can be safely shared among members of a network. WEP uses an encryption key that automatically encrypts outgoing wireless data. On the receiving side, the same encryption key enables the computer to automatically decrypt the information so it can be read.
Enterprise*
A term that is often applied to large corporations and businesses. The enterprise market can incorporate office buildings, manufacturing plants, warehouses and R&D facilities, as well as large colleges and universities.
ESSID*
The identifying name of an 802.11 wireless network. When you specify your correct ESSID in your client setup you ensure that you connect to your wireless network rather than another network in range. (See SSID.) The ESSID can be called by different terms, such as Network Name, Preferred Network, SSID or Wireless LAN Service Area.
Ethernet*
International standard networking technology for wired implementations. Basic 10BaseT networks offer a bandwidth of about 10 Mbps. Fast Ethernet (100 Mbps) and Gigabit Ethernet (1000 Mbps) are becoming popular.
Glossary
969
Firewall*
A system that secures a network and prevents access by unauthorized users. Firewalls can be software, hardware or a combination of both. Firewalls can prevent unrestricted access into a network, as well as restrict data from flowing out of a network.
Gateway*
In the wireless world, a gateway is an access point with additional software capabilities such as providing NAT and DHCP . Gateways may also provide VPN support, roaming, firewalls, various levels of security, etc.
Hub*
A multiport device used to connect PCs to a network via Ethernet cabling or via WiFi. Wired hubs can have numerous ports and can transmit data at speeds ranging from 10 Mbps to multigigabyte speeds per second. A hub transmits packets it receives to all the connected ports. A small wired hub may only connect 4 computers; a large hub can connect 48 or more. Wireless hubs can connect hundreds.
HZ*
The international unit for measuring frequency, equivalent to the older unit of cycles per second. One megahertz (MHz) is one million hertz. One gigahertz (GHz) is one billion hertz. The standard US electrical power frequency is 60 Hz, the AM broadcast radio frequency band is 5351605 kHz, the FM broadcast radio frequency band is 88108 MHz, and wireless 802.11b LANs operate at 2.4 GHz.
I/O*
The term used to describe any operation, program or device that transfers data to or from a computer.
ICSA
International Computer Security Association.
970
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
IEEE*
Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, New York, www.ieee.org. A membership organization that includes engineers, scientists and students in electronics and allied fields. It has more than 300,000 members and is involved with setting standards for computers and communications.
IEEE802.11*
A set of specifications for LANs from The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE). Most wired networks conform to 802.3, the specification for CSMA/CD based Ethernet networks or 802.5, the specification for token ring networks. 802.11 defines the standard for wireless LANs encompassing three incompatible (non-interoperable) technologies: Frequency Hopping Spread Spectrum (FHSS), Direct Sequence Spread Spectrum (DSSS) and Infrared. WECAs focus is on 802.11b, an 11 Mbps high-rate DSSS standard for wireless networks.
IP*
A set of rules used to send and receive messages at the Internet address level.
IP address*
A 32-bit number that identifies each sender or receiver of information that is sent across the Internet. An IP address has two parts: an identifier of a particular network on the Internet and an identifier of the particular device (which can be a server or a workstation) within that network.
ISA*
A type of internal computer bus that allows the addition of card-based components like modems and network adapters. ISA has been replaced by PCI and is not very common anymore.
ISDN*
A type of broadband Internet connection that provides digital service from the customer's premises to the dial-up telephone network. ISDN uses standard POTS copper wiring to deliver voice, data or video.
Glossary
971
z z z z z z z z
1, Physical* 2, Data Link* 3, Network* 4, Transport* 5, Session* 6, Presentation* 7, Application* The IEEE 802.11 Standard encompasses the physical layer (PHY) and the lower portion of the data link layer. The lower portion of the data link layer is often referred to as the Medium Access Controller (MAC) sub-layer.
IKE
Internet Key Exchange. The Internet Key Exchange (IKE) protocol is a key management protocol standard which is used in conjunction with the IPSec standard.
IPSec
IPSec is an IP security feature that provides robust authentication and encryption of IP packets.
L2TP
Layer 2 Tunnelling Protocol. L2TP is an extension of Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP).
LAN*
A system of connecting PCs and other devices within the same physical proximity for sharing resources such as an Internet connections, printers, files and drives. When Wi-Fi is used to connect the devices, the system is known as a wireless LAN or WLAN.
972
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Laser-beam
A stream of de-authorization packets sent from an Air Monitor (AM) to an Access Point (AP), enforcing security policies. Typically when a Rogue AP has been detected.
MAC*
Every wireless 802.11 device has its own specific MAC address hard-coded into it. This unique identifier can be used to provide security for wireless networks. When a network uses a MAC table, only the 802.11 radios that have had their MAC addresses added to that network's MAC table will be able to get onto the network.
Mapping*
Assigning a PC to a shared drive or printer port on a network.
Mobile professional*
A salesperson or a road warrior who travels frequently and requires the ability to regularly access his or her corporate networks, via the Internet, to post and retrieve files and data and to send and receive e-mail.
NAT*
A network capability that enables a houseful of computers to dynamically share a single incoming IP address from a dial-up, cable or xDSL connection. NAT takes the single incoming IP address and creates new IP address for each client computer on the network.
Network name*
Identifies the wireless network for all the shared components. During the installation process for most wireless networks, you need to enter the network name or SSID. Different network names are used when setting up your individual computer, wired network or workgroup.
NIC*
A type of PC adapter card that either works without wires (Wi-Fi) or attaches to a network cable to provide two-way communication between the computer and network devices such as a hub or switch. Most office wired NICs operate at 10 Mbps (Ethernet), 100 Mbps (Fast Ethernet) or 10/100 Mbps dual speed. High-speed Gigabit and 10 Gigabit NIC cards are also available. See PC Card.
Glossary 973
PC card*
A removable, credit-card-sized memory or I/O device that fits into a Type 2 PCMCIA standard slot, PC Cards are used primarily in PCs, portable computers, PDAs and laptops. PC Card peripherals include Wi-Fi cards, memory cards, modems, NICs, hard drives, etc.
PCI*
A high-performance I/O computer bus used internally on most computers. Other bus types include ISA and AGP . PCIs and other computer buses enable the addition of internal cards that provide services and features not supported by the motherboard or other connectors.
PEAP
(Protected EAP) is an authentication protocol that uses TLS to enhance the security of other EAP authentication methods. PEAP for Microsoft 802.1X Authentication Client provides support for EAP-TLS, which uses certificates for both server authentication and client authentication, and Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol version 2 (EAP-MS-CHAP v2), which uses certificates for server authentication and password-based credentials for client authentication.
PHY*
The lowest layer within the OSI Network Model. It deals primarily with transmission of the raw bit stream over the PHYsical transport medium. In the case of wireless LANs, the transport medium is free space. The PHY defines parameters such as data rates, modulation method, signalling parameters, transmitter/receiver synchronization, etc. Within an actual radio implementation, the PHY corresponds to the radio front end and baseband signal processing sections.
PPTP
Point-to-Point Tunnelling Protocol. A secure method of transmitting data on a virtual private network (VPN).
974
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Proxy server*
Used in larger companies and organizations to improve network operations and security, a proxy server is able to prevent direct communication between two or more networks. The proxy server forwards allowable data requests to remote servers and/or responds to data requests directly from stored remote server data.
RADIUS
(Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service) is a distributed client/server system that secures networks against unauthorized access. Aruba-5000 can be configured as a RADIUS Client and send authentication requests to the configured RADIUS servers that contains all user authentication and network service access information.
Range*
How far will your wireless network stretch? Most Wi-Fi systems will provide a range of a hundred feet or more. Depending on the environment and the type of antenna used, Wi-Fi signals can have a range of up to mile.
RJ-45*
Standard connectors used in Ethernet networks. Even though they look very similar to standard RJ-11 telephone connectors, RJ-45 connectors can have up to eight wires, whereas telephone connectors have only four.
Roaming*
Moving seamlessly from one AP coverage area to another with no loss in connectivity.
Rogue AP
A Rogue AP is an unauthorized access point attached to a network, and providing unauthorized access to that network.
Router*
A device that forwards data packets from one local area network (LAN) or wide area network (WAN) to another. Based on routing tables and routing protocols, routers can read the network address in each transmitted frame and make a decision on how to send it via the most efficient route based on traffic load, line costs, speed, bad connections, etc.
Glossary 975
Server*
A computer that provides its resources to other computers and devices on a network. These include print servers, Internet servers and data servers. A server can also be combined with a hub or router.
Site survey*
The process whereby a wireless network installer inspects a location prior to putting in a wireless network. Site surveys are used to identify the radio- and client-use properties of a facility so that access points can be optimally placed.
SSH
Secure SHell, also known as secure socket shell. A UNIX-based command interface used to gain secure access to a computer or computer network. Aruba implements OpenSSH.
NOTEIt is Arubas policy in supporting OpenSSH to continuously apply security patches and bug fixes. However, Aruba does not update the OpenSSH version string when security patches do not update the version. Changing the version introduces possible incompatibilities with SSH client v3.2.0b267 and 4.1.3.2.
SSID*
A 32-character unique identifier attached to the header of packets sent over a WLAN that acts as a password when a mobile device tries to connect to the BSS. (Also called ESSID.) The SSID differentiates one WLAN from another, so all access points and all devices attempting to connect to a specific WLAN must use the same SSID. A device will not be permitted to join the BSS unless it can provide the unique SSID. Because an SSID can be sniffed in plain text from a packet, it does not supply any security to the network. An SSID is also referred to as a Network Name because essentially it is a name that identifies a wireless network.
SSL*
Commonly used encryption scheme used by many online retail and banking sites to protect the financial integrity of transactions. When an SSL session begins, the server sends its public key to the browser. The browser then sends a randomly generated secret key back to the server in order to have a secret key exchange for that session
976
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
Subnetwork or Subnet*
Found in larger networks, these smaller networks are used to simplify addressing between numerous computers. Subnets connect to the central network through a router, hub or gateway. Each individual wireless LAN will probably use the same subnet for all the local computers it talks to.
Supplicant
An entity at one end of a point-to-point LAN segment that is being authenticated by an authenticator attached to the other end of that link. Example: Win-XP/2K Wireless station is a supplicant.
Switch*
A type of hub that efficiently controls the way multiple devices use the same network so that each can operate at optimal performance. A switch acts as a networks traffic cop: rather than transmitting all the packets it receives to all ports as a hub does, a switch transmits packets to only the receiving port.
TCP*
A protocol used along with the Internet Protocol (IP) to send data in the form of individual units (called packets) between computers over the Internet. While IP takes care of handling the actual delivery of the data, TCP takes care of keeping track of the packets that a message is divided into for efficient routing through the Internet. For example, when a web page is downloaded from a web server, the TCP program layer in that server divides the file into packets, numbers the packets, and then forwards them individually to the IP program layer. Although each packet has the same destination IP address, it may get routed differently through the network. At the other end, TCP reassembles the individual packets and waits until they have all arrived to forward them as a single file.
TCP/IP*
The underlying technology behind the Internet and communications between computers in a network. The first part, TCP , is the transport part, which matches the size of the messages on either end and guarantees that the correct message has been received. The IP part is the user's computer address on a network. Every computer in a TCP/IP network has its own IP address that is either dynamically assigned at startup or permanently assigned. All TCP/IP messages contain the address of the destination network as well as the address of the destination station. This enables TCP/IP messages to be transmitted to multiple networks (subnets) within an organization or worldwide.
Glossary 977
TLS
(Transport Layer Security) provide privacy and data integrity between two communicating applications.
Virtual AP
An instance of a unique virtual access point.
VPN*
A type of technology designed to increase the security of information transferred over the Internet. VPN can work with either wired or wireless networks, as well as with dial-up connections over POTS. VPN creates a private encrypted tunnel from the end user's computer, through the local wireless network, through the Internet, all the way to the corporate servers and database.
WAN*
A communication system of connecting PCs and other computing devices across a large local, regional, national or international geographic area. Also used to distinguish between phone-based data networks and Wi-Fi. Phone networks are considered WANs and Wi-Fi networks are considered Wireless Local Area Networks (WLANs).
War Driver
A program or utility used to discover and gain unauthorized access to wireless access points in order to corrupt or collect information stored on the network.
WEP*
Basic wireless security provided by Wi-Fi. In some instances, WEP may be all a home or small-business user needs to protect wireless data. WEP is available in 40-bit (also called 64-bit), or in 108-bit (also called 128-bit) encryption modes. As 108-bit encryption provides a longer algorithm that takes longer to decode, it can provide better security than basic 40-bit (64-bit) encryption.
Wi-Fi*
An interoperability certification for wireless local area network (LAN) products based on the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) 802.11 standard.
978
Part 0500055-03
May 2005
WLAN*
Also referred to as LAN. A type of local-area network that uses high-frequency radio waves rather than wires to communicate between nodes.
WMS
Wireless LAN Management System
WPA WPA/2
Wireless Protected Access and the update to this standard.
Glossary
979
980
Part 0500055-03
May 2005